Академический Документы
Профессиональный Документы
Культура Документы
Pro
V8i (SELECTseries 2)
Copyright Information
TRADEMARK NOTICE
Bentley, the "B" Bentley logo, STAAD.Pro are registered or nonregistered trademarks of Bentley Sytems, Inc. or Bentley Software, Inc. All other marks are the property of their respective owners.
COPYRIGHT NOTICE
2011, Bentley Systems, Incorporated. All Rights Reserved. Including software, file formats, and audiovisual displays; may only be used pursuant to applicable software license agreement; contains confidential and proprietary information of Bentley Systems, Incorporated and/or third parties which is protected by copyright and trade secret law and may not be provided or otherwise made available without proper authorization.
ACKNOWLEDGMENTS
Windows, Vista, SQL Server, MSDE, .NET, DirectX are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. Adobe, the Adobe logo, Acrobat, the Acrobat logo are registered trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated.
ii STAAD.Pro
Table of Contents
About STAAD.Pro About the STAAD.Pro Documentation
Getting Started and Tutorials Examples Manual Graphical Environment Technical Reference Manual International Design Codes
2 4
4 4 4 4 5
7
9 19
57
59 81 113 119 123
153
155 163 207 215
Canadian Codes - Concrete Design per CSA Standard A23.3-94 Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSAS16-01 Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94 Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA086-01
247
249 261
273
275 283 313 316 405
431
433 441
451
453 459
471
473
481
493
495 521 547 569 593
601
603 613
649
651 669
683
685
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) 715
737
739
South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB01621:1993 747
773 791
793
American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports
801
Section 16 Steel Design per American Petroleum Institute Code 807 Section 17 ANSI/AISC N690 Design Codes
ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Code ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code
823
825 845
Section 18 American Society of Mechanical Engineers Nuclear Facility (ASME NF) Codes 869
ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes ASME NF 3000 - 1989 Code ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code 871 883 897 910
923
925 983 1008
1013
1013
1019
1019
1023
1023
1027
1027 1030
1035
1035
1041
1041
1045
1045
1049 1051
This documentation has been prepared to provide information pertaining to the various international codes supported by STAAD. These codes are provided as additional codes by Research Engineers. In other words, they do not come with the standard package. Hence, information on only some of the codes presented in this document may be actually pertinent to the individual user's package. This document is to be used in conjunction with the STAAD Technical Reference Manual and the STAAD Application Examples Manual. Effort has been made to provide some basic information about the analysis considerations and the logic used in the design approach. A brief outline of the factors affecting the design along with references to the corresponding clauses in the codes is also provided. Examples are provided at the appropriate places to facilitate ease of understanding of the usage of the commands and design parameters. Users are urged to refer to the Examples Manual for solved problems that use the commands and features of STAAD. Since the STAAD output contains references to the clauses in the code that govern the design, users are urged to consult the documentation of the code of that country for additional details on the design criteria.
About STAAD.Pro
STAAD.Pro is a general purpose structural analysis and design program with applications primarily in the building industry - commercial buildings, bridges and highway structures, industrial structures, chemical plant structures, dams, retaining walls, turbine foundations, culverts and other embedded structures, etc. The program hence consists of the following facilities to enable this task. 1. Graphical model generation utilities as well as text editor based commands for creating the mathematical model. Beam and column members are represented using lines. Walls, slabs and panel type entities are represented using triangular and quadrilateral finite elements. Solid blocks are represented using brick elements. These utilities allow the user to create the geometry, assign properties, orient cross sections as desired, assign materials like steel, concrete, timber, aluminum, specify supports, apply loads explicitly as well as have the program generate loads, design parameters etc. 2. Analysis engines for performing linear elastic and pdelta analysis, finite element analysis, frequency extraction, and dynamic response (spectrum, time history, steady state, etc.). 3. Design engines for code checking and optimization of steel, aluminum and timber members. Reinforcement calculations for concrete beams, columns, slabs and shear walls. Design of shear and moment connections for steel members. 4. Result viewing, result verification and report generation tools for examining displacement diagrams, bending moment and shear force diagrams, beam, plate and solid stress contours, etc. 5. Peripheral tools for activities like import and export of data from and to other widely accepted formats, links with other popular softwares for niche areas like reinforced and prestressed concrete slab design, footing design, steel connection design, etc. 6. A library of exposed functions called OpenSTAAD which allows users to access STAAD.Pros internal functions and routines as well as its graphical commands to tap into STAADs database and link input and output data to third-party software written using languages like C, C++, VB, VBA,
2 STAAD.Pro
FORTRAN, Java, Delphi, etc. Thus, OpenSTAAD allows users to link in-house or third-party applications with STAAD.Pro.
Examples Manual
This book offers examples of various problems that can be solved using the STAAD engine. The examples represent various structural analyses and design problems commonly encountered by structural engineers.
Graphical Environment
This document contains a detailed description of the Graphical User Interface (GUI) of STAAD.Pro. The topics covered include model generation, structural analysis and design, result verification, and report generation.
4 STAAD.Pro
6 STAAD.Pro
Section 1
Australian Codes
8 STAAD.Pro
For Beams: Prismatic (Rectangular & Square) For Columns: Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)
In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 350 mm diameter. It is absolutely imperative that the user not provide the cross section area (AX) as an input.
declare length and force units as Millimeter and Newton before performing the concrete design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 1A.1 - Australian Concrete Design per AS 3600 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description Must be specified as AUSTRALIAN to invokes design per AS 3600 2001. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual. CLEAR 25 mm 40 mm DEPTH YD For beam members. For column members Total depth to be used for design. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
10 STAAD.Pro
Description Concrete Yield Stress. Applicable values per Clause 6.1.1.1 of AS 3600-2001: 20 25 32 40 50 65
FYMAIN
450 N/mm2
Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. Applicable values per Table 6.2.1 of AS 36002001: 250 400 450 500
FYSEC
450 N/mm2
Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. Applicable values per Table 6.2.1 of AS 3600-2001: 250 400 450 500
Australian Codes - Concrete Design per AS 3600 - 2001 Parameter Name MAXMAIN MINMAIN MAXSEC MINSEC RATIO Default Value 60 mm 10 mm 12 mm 8 mm 4.0 Description Maximum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum main reinforcement bar size. Maximum secondary reinforcement bar size. Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Maximum percentage of longitudinal reinforcement in columns. Tied column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral reinforcement.
REINF
0.0
12 STAAD.Pro
Description BEAM DESIGN: For TRACK = 0.0, output consists of reinforcement details at START, MIDDLE and END. For TRACK = 1.0, critical moments are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. For TRACK = 2.0, required steel for intermediate sections defined by NSECTION are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. COLUMN DESIGN: With TRACK = 0.0, reinforcement details are printed.
Australian Codes - Concrete Design per AS 3600 - 2001 Parameter Name WIDTH Default Value ZD Description Width to be used for design. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
14 STAAD.Pro
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE AUSTRALIAN FYMAIN 415 ALL FYSEC 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEM 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 TRACK 1.0 MEMB 2 TO 9 DESIGN BEAM 2 TO 9 END CONCRETE DESIGN
16 STAAD.Pro
18 STAAD.Pro
20 STAAD.Pro
Limit State
AS 4100 3.11
Connection Design
STAAD.Pro and Bentleys RAM Connection program currently do not support design of connections in accordance with AS 4100. In some cases connection design may govern the size of members. Such considerations are not considered in STAAD.Pros AS 4100 and should be checked by separately.
Elastic Analysis
Two types of elastic analysis can be performed using STAAD.Pro in accordance with AS4100: i. First Order Linear, Elastic Analysis - used to perform a regular elastic stiffness analysis as per AS 4100 4.4.2.1. Refer to Section 5.37.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on this feature. ii. Second Order PDelta Linear, Elastic Analysis - Depending on the type of structure, a PDelta analysis may be required in order to capture secondorder effects as per AS 4100 4.4.1.2. Second-order effects can be captured in STAAD.Pro by performing a PDelta second-order elastic analysis as per AS 4100 Appendix E. Refer to Section 5.37.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on this feature. Note: Moment amplification as per AS 4100 clause 4.4.2 is not considered.
Hint: In order to correctly capture second-order effects for combination load cases using a PDelta Analysis, the Repeat Load feature must be used. Second-order effects will not be correctly evaluated if the Load Combination feature is used. Load Combinations are combinations of results where Repeat Loads instruct the program to perform the analysis on the combined load actions. Refer to Section 5.32.11 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on using Repeat Loads.
Dynamic Analysis
Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results. Refer Section 5.32.10 of the Technical Reference Manual for further information on Dynamic Loading and Analysis features.
22 STAAD.Pro
more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.
Welded beams and columns Universal beams and columns Tees cut from universal beams and columns Parallel flange channels Equal and unequal angles Square and rectangular hollow sections Circular hollow sections
Note: STAAD.Pro will not design the following section types to AS 4100: Double Profiles (D), Composite Sections (C), Top Cover Plates (TC), Bottom Cover Plates (BC), and Top & Bottom Cover Plates (TB), Double Channels (D, BA, & FR) and Double Angles (LD & SD). Refer to Section Profile Tables in the Graphical Environment for these options.
Hint: When adding and assigning sections using the built-in steel section library through the Graphical Environment, STAAD.Pros default tables are American. To change the default tables to Australian, select File > Configuration from the STAAD.Pro Start page (no input file open). Set the Default Profile Table to Australian on the Configure Program dialog Section Profile Table. Following are the descriptions of different types of sections.
UB Shapes
These shapes are designated in the following way.
20 TO 30 TA ST UB150X14.0 36 TO 46 TA ST UB180X16.1
UC Shapes
The designation for the UC shapes is similar to that for the UB shapes.
25 TO 35 TA ST UC100X14.8 23 56 TA ST UC310X96.8
Welded Beams
Welded Beams are designated in the following way.
25 TO 35 TA ST WB700X115 23 56 TA ST WB1200X455
Welded Columns
Welded Columns are designated in the following way.
25 TO 35 TA ST WC400X114 23 56 TA ST WC400X303
24 STAAD.Pro
Double Channels
Back-to-back double channels, with or without a spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel.
11 TA D PFC230 17 TA D C230X75X25 SP 0.5
In the above set of commands, member 11 is a back-to-back double channel PFC230 with no spacing in between. Member 17 is a double channel PFC300 with a spacing of 0.5 length units between the channels.
Angles
Two types of specification may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
16 20 TA ST A30X30X6
The above section signifies an angle with legs of length 30 mm and a leg thickness of 6 mm. This specification may be used when the local Z axis corresponds to the zz axis specified in Chapter 2. If the local Y axis corresponds to the z-z axis, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) may be used.
17 21 TA RA A150X150X16
Note: Single angles must be specified with an RA (Single Angle w/Reverse YZ Axis) in order to be designed to AS 4100. This is to ensure that the major and minor principal axes align with the local member z and y axes respectively, similar to other section profiles.
Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by means of input of the words SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose.
33 35 TA SD A65X50X5 SP 0.6 37 39 TA LD A75X50X6 43 TO 47 TA LD A100X75X10 SP 0.75
In the second method, tubes are specified by their dimensions. For example,
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5
is a tube that has a height of 8 length units, width of 6 length units, and a wall thickness of 0.5 length units. Only code checking, no member selection, will be performed for TUBE sections specified in this latter manner.
26 STAAD.Pro
6 TO 10 TA ST PIP273X6.5
In the second method, pipe sections may be provided by specifying the word PIPE followed by the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0
specifies a pipe with outside diameter of 25 length units and inside diameter of 20 length units. Only code checking, no member selection, will be performed on pipes specified in this latter manner.
6 TA RA A150X150X16 * DOUBLE ANGLES - SHORT LEGS BACK TO BACK 7 TA SD A65X50X5 SP 0.6 * DOUBLE ANGLES - LONG LEGS BACK TO BACK 8 TA LD A100X75X10 SP 0.75 * TUBES (RECTANGULAR OR SQUARE HOLLOW SECTIONS) 9 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5 * PIPES (CIRCULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS) 10 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0 PRINT MEMB PROP FINISH
28 STAAD.Pro
change the steel material through the input file or GUI for each file created define a new steel material for each file created change the default STAAD.Pro metric E value in the file C:/WINDOWS/STAADPRO20070.INI, going to the [Material-Metric] section, and changing E1=205.0e6 to E1=200.0e6. Restart STAAD.Pro for this to take effect. Warning: Virtualization features of Windows Vista and Windows 7 may require additional files to be modified. Contact Bentley Technical Support for assistance.
The nominal section capacity refers to the capacity of a cross-section to resists applied loads, and accounts for cross-section yielding and local buckling effects. The nominal member capacity on the other hand refers to the capacity of a member to resist applied loads, and includes checks for global member buckling effects including Euler buckling, lateral-torsional buckling, etc.
Axial Tension
The criteria governing the capacity of tension members are based on two limit states per AS 4100 Section 7. The limit state of yielding of the gross section is
intended to prevent excessive elongation of the member. The second limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area N section axial tension capacities are calculated (Cl.7.2). Through the t use of the NSF parameter (see Table 1B.1), you may specify the net section area. STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on these two limit states per Cl.7.1 and Cl.7.2 respectively of AS 4100. Eccentric end connections can be taken into account using the KT correction factor, perCl.7.3. The f yield stress is y based on the minimum plate yield stress. Parameters FYLD, FU, and NSF are applicable for these calculations.
Axial Compression
The compressive strength of members is based on limit states per AS 4100 Section 6. It is taken as the lesser of nominal section capacity and nominal member capacity. Nominal section capacity, N , is a function of form factor (Cl.6.2.2), net s area of the cross section, and yield stress of the material. Through the use of the NSC parameter (see Table 1B.1), you may specify the net section area. Note that this parameter is different from that corresponding to tension. The program automatically calculates the form factor. The k form factors are calculated based f on effective plate widths per Cl.6.2.4, and the f yield stress is based on the y minimum plate yield stress. Nominal member capacity, N , is a function of nominal section capacity and c member slenderness reduction factor (Cl.6.3.3). This value is calculated about both principal x and y axes. Here, you are required to supply the value of b (Cl.6.3.3) through the ALBparameter (see Table 1B.1). The effective length for the calculation of compressive strength may be provided through the use of the parameters KY, KZ, LY, and LZ (see Table 1B.1).
Bending
Bending capacities are calculated to AS 4100 Section 5. The allowable bending moment of members is determined as the lesser of nominal section capacity and nominal member capacity (ref. Cl.5.1). The nominal section moment capacity, M , is calculated about both principal x s and y axes and is the capacity to resist cross-section yielding or local buckling and is expressed as the product of the yield stress of the material and the effective section modulus (ref. Cl.5.2). The effective section modulus is a function of section type (i.e., compact, noncompact, or slender) and minimum plate yield stress f .
y
30 STAAD.Pro
The nominal member capacity depends on overall flexural-torsional buckling of the member (ref.Cl.5.3). Note: For sections where the web and flange yield stresses (f and f y,web y.flange respectively) are different, the lower of the two yield stresses is applied to both the web and flange to determine the slenderness of these elements. Member moment capacity, M , is calculated about the principal x axis only (ref. b Cl.5.6). Critical flange effective cross-section restraints and corresponding design segment and sub-segments are used as the basis for calculating capacities.
Shear
Section web shear capacity, V , is calculated per Cl.5.11, including both shear v yield and shear buckling capacities. Once the capacity is obtained, the ratio of the shear force acting on the cross section to the shear capacity of the section is calculated. If any of the ratios (for both local Y & Z-axes) exceed 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 1B.1), the section is considered to have failed under shear. Table 1B.6-1 below highlights which shear capacities are calculated for different profile types.
Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Table 1B.3 - Section Type Shear Checks General Profile Type Australian Section WB, WC, UB, UC Shear Checks
I-SECTION (i.e., parallel to minor principal y-axis) T-SECTION CHANNEL ANGLE TUBE PIPE
BT, CT PFC EA, UA SHS, RHS CHS No checks performed Calculated parallel to both x & y principal axes Per AS 4100 5.11.4
Note: Only unstiffened web capacities are calculated. Stiffened webs are not considered. Bearing capacities are not considered.
Torsion
STAAD.Pro does not design sections or members for torsion for AS4100.
32 STAAD.Pro
Table 1B.4 - Australian Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Design Scope Description
Must be specified as AUSTRALIAN to invoke design per AS 4100 - 1998. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
ALB
0.0
Member section constant (refer cl. 6.3.3) If ALB is 0.0, it is automatically calculated based on TABLE 6.3.3(1), 6.3.3(2); otherwise the input value is used.
ALM
0.0
Moment modification factor (refer cl. 5.6.1.1) If ALM is 0.0, it is automatically calculated based cl.5.6.1.1; otherwise the input value is used.
BEAM
0.0
0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by SECTION
Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Parameter Name Default Value Design Scope Description
command. 1.0 = Perform design for moments at twelfth points along the beam. DFF None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member Analytical Deflection Length/ members Maximum Allowable only local deflection. Joint No. denoting start point for calculation of deflection length Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of deflection length Maximum allowable depth (Applicable for member selection) Minimum required depth (Applicable for member selection) Physical Used to specify the members type of end cononly nection to account for eccentric connection effects for compression and tension members. Steel type - 1 - SR, 2 - HR, 3 - CF, 4 -
DJ1
DJ2
DMAX
45.0 [in.]
DMIN
0.0 [in.]
EEC
0.0
IST
34 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Design Scope
Description
LW, 5 - HW FU FYLD KT 500.0 [MPa] 250.0 [MPa] 1.0 Ultimate strength of steel. Yield strength of steel. Correction factor for distribution of forces (refer cl. 7.2) K value for general column flexural buckling about the local Y-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. K value for general column flexural buckling about the local Z-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. Physical Load height position members as described in Table only 5.6.3(2)of AS 4100:1998 0 = at Shear center 1 = At top flange LY Member Length Length for general column flexural
KY
1.0
KZ
1.0
LHT
Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Parameter Name Default Value Design Scope Description
buckling about the local Y-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. LZ Member Length Length for general column flexural buckling about the local Z-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. 0.0 = Check slenderness ratio against the limits.
l
MAIN
0.0
1.0 = Suppress the slenderness ratio check. Any value greater than 1.0 is used as the limit for slenderness in compression. NSC 1.0 Net section factor for compression members = An / Ag (refer cl. 6.2.1)
36 STAAD.Pro
Default Value
Design Scope
Description
1.0 None
Net section factor for tension members. Physical Refer to section members 1B.11 for details on only the PBRACE parameter. Capacity reduction factor Permissible ratio of actual load effect to the design strength. Steel Grade. Refer to Note a below. 0= Normal grade 1 = High strength grade of steel
PHI RATIO
0.9 1.0
SGR
SKT
1.0
A twist restraint factor given in Table 5.6.3(1) A load height factor given in Table 5.6.3(2) A lateral rotation restraint factor given in Table 5.6.3(3) Physical Used to specify members whether eccentric only
SKL
1.0
SKR
1.0
TEE
0.0
Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Parameter Name Default Value Design Scope Description
effects for tension members are checked based on simplified kt corrections factors to AS 4100 7.3.2, or by using calculated eccentric moments in combination with axial tension per AS 4100 Section 8. TMAIN 180.0 Slenderness limit in tension. Slenderness limit is checked based MAIN parameter. Output detail 0.0 = Report only minimum design results. 1.0 = Report design strengths also. 2.0 = Provide full details of design. UNB Member Length Unsupported length
TRACK
0.0
38 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Design Scope
Description
UNT
Member Length
Unsupported length in bending compression of the top flange for calculating moment resistance.
Notes
a. Deflection calculations
b. LHT Parameter If the shear force is constant within the segment, longitudinal position of the load is assumed to be at the segment end. If there is any variation of the shear force and the load is acting downward determined from shear force variation and load height parameter indicates the load is acting on top flange (flange at the positive local y axis) and restraints at the end of the segment is not FU (FRU) or PU (PRU) Kl is assumed to be 1.4. If there is any variation of the shear force and the load is acting upward determined from shear force variation and load height parameter indicates the load is acting on top flange (flange at the positive local y axis) and restraints at the end of the segment is not FU (FRU) or PU (PRU) Kl is assumed to be 1.0 as the load acting at the top flange is contributing to stabilize against local torsional buckling. c. SGR Parameter
AS 4100 defines the values of steel grades that are used as either normal steel or high grade steel. The following table explains the material values used when either option is specified for a particular shape: Table 1B.5 - Steel Grades used for the SGR Parameter Section Type SGR Value Steel Grade Used 300 400 300 350 250 350
WB, WC, Tee section cut from WB and WC WB, WC, Tee section cut from WB and WC
0 (Normal) 1 (High)
UB, UC, Tee section cut from UB and 0 (Normal) UC, EA, UA and all UPT sections UB, UC, Tee section cut from UB and UC, 1 (High) EA, UA and all UPT sections Pipe, Tube, CHS, RHS, SHS Pipe, Tube, CHS, RHS, SHS 0 (Normal) 1 (High)
Note: If a value for theFYLDparameter has been specified, then that value will be used. Otherwise, the SGR value will be used to determine the yeild strength and tensile strength values for the steel. based on maximum thickness of the individual elements of the section. Only for shear capacity calculation web thickness is used. Similarly, Tensile Strength is determined either from FU parameter or from SGR parameter.
Warning: A check is introduced to see if yield stress is more than 450 MPa or not. If it is, a warning is issued and the yield stress is set to 450 MPa. The following example uses the Member design facility in STAAD.Pro. However, it is strongly recommended to use the Physical member design capabilities for AS4100:
PARAMETER 1 CODE AUSTRALIAN ALB 0.0 MEMBER ALL
40 STAAD.Pro
ALM 1.13 MEMBER ALL BEAM 1.0 MEMBER ALL DFF 250.0 MEMBER ALL DMAX 0.4 MEMBER ALL DMIN 0.25 MEMBER ALL FU 400.0 MEMBER ALL FYLD 310.0 MEMBER ALL IST 2.0 MEMBER ALL KT 0.85 MEMBER ALL KX 0.75 MEMBER ALL KY 1.0 MEMBER ALL LX 4.5 MEMBER ALL LY 6.0 MEMBER ALL MAIN 1.0 MEMBER ALL TMAIN 135.0 MEMBER ALL NSC 0.9 MEMBER ALL NSF 1.0 MEMBER ALL PHI 0.9 MEMBER ALL RATIO 0.9 MEMBER ALL SGR 1.0 MEMBER ALL SKT 1.0 MEMBER ALL SKL 1.0 MEMBER ALL SKR 1.0 MEMBER ALL TRACK 2.0 MEMBER ALL UNB 3.4 MEMBER ALL UNT 6.8 MEMBER ALL CHECK CODE MEMBER ALL
42 STAAD.Pro
Physical Members
For physical members (PMEMBERs), code checks are performed at section stations positioned at 1/12th points along each analytical member included in the PMEMBER. It is up to you to determine if these locations cover critical sections for design, and adjust as necessary. The number of stations for PMEMBER Design cannot be altered, however the analytical members can be split so that in effect more stations are checked for a PMEMBER. For each section station along a PMEMBER, section capacity checks are carried for design actions at that station location. Member capacity checks are also carried out for each station. For these the program searches each side of the station to find adjacent effective restraints and design forces and moments. This allows the program to determine the segment / sub-segment that the section station resides in, and then proceeds to calculate the member capacities. Enough section stations should be included to capture all segments / sub-segments for checking. Note: When checking combined actions for the section capacities, the design actions at the section station are used. However when checking combined actions for the member capacities, the maximum forces from anywhere along the segment / sub-segment being considered are used. This is as stipulated in AS 4100 8.2. The output reports whether the member has PASSed or FAILed the design checks, as well as the critical condition, critical load case, magnitudes of design actions for the most critical cross-section location (distance from the start joint), and complete calculations for design. The TRACK design parameter can be used to control the level of detail provided in the output. Color-coded results can also be viewed in the GUIs Post Processing Beam |Unity Check page. In some cases some of the output will report N/A values. This occurs where a calculation does not apply to a member. For example if a member never goes into tension then no values can be reported in the tension capacity output sections. Note: As per AS 4100 1.4, the TRACK 2.0 detailed level of output for PMEMBER Design uses x and y subscripts to refer to major and minor principal axes respectively. These differ to STAAD.Pro local member axes, where z and y refer to major and minor principal axes.
Note: Member Selection will change member sizes, and hence will change the structures stiffness matrix. In order to correctly account for this, a subsequent analysis and Code Check should be performed to ensure that the final structure is acceptable. This may need to be carried out over several iterations. Example of commands for member selection:
UNIT NEWTON METER PARAMETER FYLD 330E6 MEMB 3 4 NSF 0.85 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL SELECT MEMB 3 4
44 STAAD.Pro
automated steel grades based on section type; automated tensile stress (f ) and yield stress (f ) values based on plate thicku y nesses; automated segment / sub-segment design; improved detailed design calculation output; and
Thus, it is strongly recommended that PMEMBER Design be used, even for the design of single analytical members.
STAAD.Pro Editor - Directly specify physical members in the input file. Refer to Section 5.16.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information. Graphical Environment - Using the tools in the Steel Design toolbar, members can be manually or automatically formed. Refer to Section 1.4 of the Graphical Environment manual for additional information.
Note: When creating PMEMBERs for AS 4100, this must be performed in STAAD.Pros Modeling mode. Do not use the Steel Design mode.
46 STAAD.Pro
The PMEMBER Design uses the following routine to determine effective crosssection restraints for each load case considered: i. first all user-defined restraints are checked to see if they are applied to the compression flange, with those that arent ignored; ii. next a check is made to see if a U type restraint is found at either end of the PMEMBER. If this is the case then any adjacent L restraints up to the next F, FR, P or PR restraint are also ignored, regardless of whether they are placed on the critical or non-critical flange. Refer AS 4100 5.4.2.4. The compression flange in step 1 of the routine above is calculated based on the bending moments at the locations of the restraints being considered. If the bending moment is zero at the same location as a restraint then the following method is used to determine which flange is critical at the zero moment location: a. If the zero moment is at the end of the PMEMBER, then the compression flange is based on the bending moment at a small increment from then end; b. If the zero moment is along the PMEMBER and is a peak value, then the compression flange is based on the bending moment at a small increment from that location; c. If neither 1 or 2 above is valid, then the stiffer of the restraints at that location is taken. The stiffness of different restraint types from the most stiff to least stiff are taken as outlined in Table 1B.9-3. Table 1B.6 - Assumed Order of Restraint Stiffness for Zero Moment Critical Flange Stiffness Most Stiff Restraint Type FR F PR P L U Least Stiff None
Once the effective restraints have been determined, the PMEMBER is divided into segments bounded by F, P, FR, PR or U effective restraints. These segments are then further divided into sub-segments by effective L restraints. Note: Sub-segment lengths are not automatically checked to determine if they provide full lateral restraint as per AS 4100 5.3.2.4. For design of cantilevers, the free tip should have user-defined U restraints applied to both top and bottom flanges. Note: If the effective restraints for any load case consist of U or L restraints only, an error will be reported.
General Format
PBRACE { TOP | BOTTOM } f1 r1 f2 r2 f52 r52 (PMEMBpmemberlist) Where: f is a fraction of the PMEMBER length where restraint condition is n being specified. This value is any ratio between 0.0 and 1.0. r is one of the possible restraint condition as in the following:
n
Description
F P
48 STAAD.Pro
Designation, r
1
Description
Cannot be specified at the ends of design members. Can only be applied at the ends of design members, and must be applied to both flanges to be effective. Warning: Both top and bottom flanges can not be unrestrained at the same location (as this is unstable).
FR
Fully and rotationally restrained Partially and rotationally restrained Continuously The flange is assumed restrained to be continuously supported at that flange up to next restraint location. For continuously supported flange unbraced length is assumed to be zero.
PR
Example
PBRACE TOP 0.85 FR 0.33 PR 0.33 PR 0.25 F 0.75 L 0.5 PR 1.0 U 0.0
Description
Refer to AS 4100 Section 5.5 for a full definition of the critical flange. Typically this will be the compression flange, except for segments with U restraint at one end, then it will be the tension flange (as is the case for cantilever portion at the end).
l
when gravity loads are dominant (i.e., negative local y-axis direction), the critical flange of a segment shall be the top flange (i.e., tension). when upward wind loads are dominant (i.e., positive local y-axis direction), the critical flange shall be the bottom flange (i.e., tension).
Design physical members are divided into segments by F, P, FR, PR or U effective section restraints. Segments are further broken down into sub-segments by L restraints, but only if the L restraints are deemed to be effective. L restraints are only considered to be effective when positioned on the critical flange between F, P, FR or FP restraints. If an L restraint is positioned on the non-critical flange it shall be completely ignored. Further, if an L restraint is positioned between a U and an F, P, FR or PR restraint, it shall be ignored (regardless of whether it is on the critical or non-critical flange). Design members must have either a F, P, FR, PR, or U restraint specified at both ends, for both flanges.
l
If UNL is not specified, segment length is used as UNL and used as L in effective length calculation as per 5.6.3. If ALM i.e., _m is not provided, automatic calculation of ALM is done based on moments within the segment. If SKR i.e., Kr is not provided, it is automatically calculated based on table 5.6.3(3) considering restraint conditions are the end of the segment. If FR or PR is found at only one of the end, Kr is assumed to be 0.85; if FR or PR is found at both the ends, 0.70 is used as Kr. If SKT i.e., Kt is not provided, it is automatically calculated based on Table 5.6.3(1) considering end restraints of the segment and section geometric information and segment length.
50 STAAD.Pro
If SKL i.e., Kl is not provided, it is automatically calculated based on Table 5.6.3(2) considering end restraints of the segment, Load Height Position parameter, LHT and shear force variation within the segment.
Notes
a. If PMEMBER list is not provided, all the PMEMBERS are restrained by same configuration. b. It is not necessary to provide the restraint locations in sequence as the program sorts them automatically. c. Unless specified, PMEMBER ends are assumed to be Fully Restrained (F). d. While designing any section of the member, effective restraints are searched on each side of the section along the critical flange. e. The types of restraints applied to the top and bottom flanges at each location determines the effective section restraints. These are outlined in the table below: Table 1B.8 - Restraint Meanings in Critical and Noncritical Flanges Case Flange Restraint on a Critical Flange U 1 2 III 1 2 L Nothing P or F Nothing or U Restraint on a NonCritical Flange U Nothing L Nothing or U P or F Effective Section Restraint
I II
U L None F P
Case
Flange
IV
1 2
FR PR F FR
1 2
Note: The critical flange can change for each load case considered.
ALM
52 STAAD.Pro
Automated PMEMBER Design CalDesign culations Parameter 5.6.1.1. f tensile u strength per AS 4100 2.1.2. f yield stress y per AS 4100 2.1.1. residual stress category for AS 4100 Table 5.2 and AS 4100 Table 6.2.4. correction factor for distribution of forces in a tension member per AS 4100 7.3. Load height position for automated calculation of the kl load height factor per AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(2). FU
Comments
Based on nominal steel grade specified using SGR design parameter and section type. Based on nominal steel grade specified using SGR design parameter and section type. Based on section type.
FYLD
IST
KT
Based on section type and eccentric end connection specified using EEC design parameter.
LHT
LHT is used for automating calculation of kl load height factors for segments and sub-segments, per AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(2). When LHT is set to 1.0 to specify a top flange load height position, STAAD.Pro takes the top to be the positive local y-axis of the member. Note: This may not literally be
Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Automated PMEMBER Design CalDesign culations Parameter Comments
the top flange for say a column or beam with a beta angle. The local member axes can be viewed in the GUI by selecting Beam Orientation in the Diagrams Labels dialog (or Ctrl+O keyboard shortcut). To automate kl using AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(2), the longitudinal position of the load also needs to be considered, i.e., as either within segment or at segment end. To determine which of these applies, the shear forces at the ends of each design segment / subsegment is considered. If the shear force is found to have the same direction and magnitude at both ends, it is assumed that loads act at the segment end. If on the other hand the shear force at each end is found to have different directions or magnitudes, loads are assumed to act within the segment. Note: The above method includes an allowance for the self-weight of the member to be considered, as the self-weight always acts through the shear center.
54 STAAD.Pro
Comments
The net sum of the end shears is also used to determine if the load is acting in the positive or negative local member y-axis direction. If LHT is set to 1.0 for top flange loading, the net sum is used to determine whether the top flange loading is acting to stabilise or destabilise the member for lateral torsional buckling. Negative local yaxis net loads act to destabilise the segments / sub-segments, whereas positive local y-axis net loads act to stabilise segments / sub-segments. Segment and sub-segment layout. Nominal steel grade. k twist t restraint factor as per AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(1). k load height l factor as per AS 4100 Table 5.6.3(2). k lateral rotar tion restraint factor as per AS 4100 PBRACE Refer to the Segment and Sub-Segment Layout section above for details. Based on section types. Based on effective end restraints for each segment / sub-segment.
SGR SKT
SKL
Based on effective end restraints for each segment / sub-segment, and LHT design parameter (refer above). Based on effective end restraints for each segment / sub-segment. This is where the distinction between F and FR, as well as P and PR is used.
SKR
Australian Codes - Steel Design per AS 4100 - 1998 Automated PMEMBER Design CalDesign culations Parameter Table 5.6.3(3). Comments
Example
PARAMETER 1 CODE AUSTRALIAN DMAX 0.4 PMEMBER ALL DMIN 0.25 PMEMBER ALL KX 0.75 PMEMBER ALL KY 1.0 PMEMBER ALL LX 4.5 PMEMBER ALL LY 6.0 PMEMBER ALL LHT 0.0 PMEMBER ALL NSC 0.9 PMEMBER ALL NSF 1.0 PMEMBER ALL PBRACE BOTTOM 0.0 F 1.0 F PMEMBER ALL PBRACE TOP 0.0 P 0.5 L 1.0 P PMEMBER ALL SGR 0.0 PMEMBER ALL TRACK 2.0 PMEMBER ALL CHECK CODE PMEMBER ALL
56 STAAD.Pro
Section 2
British Codes
58 STAAD.Pro
Must be specified as BRITISH to invoke design per BS8110. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BRACE
0.0
0.0 = Column braced in both directions. 1.0 = Column unbraced about local Z
British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110 Parameter Name Default Value Description
direction only 2.0 = Column unbraced about local Y direction only 3.0 = Column unbraced in both Y and Z directions CLEAR 20 mm Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. ELY ELZ FC FYMAIN 1.0 1.0 30 N/mm2 460 N/mm2 460 N/mm2 Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength, in current units Yield Stress for main reinforcement, in current units (For slabs, it is for reinforcement in both directions) Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a, in current units. Applicable to shear bars in beams
DEPTH
YD
EFACE
0.0
FYSEC
60 STAAD.Pro
Description
Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Factor by which column design moments are magnified Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 20. Serviceability checks: 0.0 = No serviceability check performed. 1.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were continuous. 2.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were simply supported. 3.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were cantilever beams.
MINMAIN
8mm
MINSEC
8mm
MMAG NSECTION
1.0 10
SERV
0.0
SFACE
0.0
British Codes - Concrete Design per BS8110 Parameter Name Default Value Description
beam, in current units. (Only applicable for shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending ) SRA 0.0 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy -slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calculate Wood & Armer moments for design. A = skew angle considered in Wood & Armer equations where A is the angle in degrees. TRACK 0.0 0.0 = Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1.0 = For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2.0 = Output of TRACK 1.0 List of design sag/hog moments and corresponding required steel area at each section of member WIDTH ZD Width of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.
62 STAAD.Pro
equivalent to the procedure presented in BS8110 Part 1 1985 Section 3.8.2.2 In this section, the code recognizes that additional moments induced by deflection are present and states that these 'secondary' moments are accounted for by the design formula in Section 3.8.3. This is the method used in the design for concrete in STAAD. Alternatively STAAD houses a PDELTA ANALYSIS facility, which allows the effects of these second order moments to be considered in the analysis rather than the design. In a PDELTA analysis, after solving the joint displacements of the structure, the additional moments induced in the structure are calculated. These can be compared to those calculated using the formulation of BS8110.
In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450mm depth x 300mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 300mm diameter. Note that area (AX) is not provided for these members. If shear area areas ( AY & AZ ) are to be considered in analysis, the user may provide them along with YD and ZD. Also note that if moments of inertias are not provided, the program will calculate them from YD and ZD. Finally a T section can be considered by using the third definition above.
LEVEL - Serial number of the bar center which may contain one or more bar groups. HEIGHT - Height of bar level from the soffit of the beam in relation to its local y axis. BAR INFO - Reinforcement bar information specifying number of bars and their size. FROM - Distance from the start of the beam to the start of the reinforcing bar. TO - Distance from the start of the beam to the end of the reinforcing bar. ANCHOR - States whether anchorage, either a hook or (STA,END) continuation, is needed at start (STA) or at the end (END).
64 STAAD.Pro
mm mm mm STA END ------------------------------------------------------------------1 29. 4- 8 MM 467. 1500. NO YES 2 264. 4- 8 MM 0. 1158. YES NO REQUIRED REINF. STEEL SUMMARY : ------------------------------SECTION REINF STEEL(+VE/-VE) MOMENTS(+VE/-VE) LOAD(+VE/VE) ( MM ) (SQ. MM ) (KN-METER) 0. 0.0/ 184.4 0.00/ 19.71 0/ 3 125. 0.0/ 157.2 0.00/ 16.80 0/ 3 250. 0.0/ 129.9 0.00/ 13.89 0/ 3 375. 0.0/ 117.0 0.00/ 10.98 0/ 3 500. 0.0/ 117.0 0.00/ 8.07 0/ 3 625. 0.0/ 117.0 0.00/ 5.16 0/ 3 750. 0.0/ 117.0 0.00/ 2.25 0/ 3 875. 117.0/ 0.0 2.15/ 0.00 1/ 0 1000. 117.0/ 0.0 5.25/ 0.00 1/ 0 1125. 117.0/ 0.0 8.36/ 0.00 1/ 0 1250. 117.0/ 0.0 11.46/ 0.00 1/ 0 1375. 136.3/ 0.0 14.57/ 0.00 1/ 0 1500. 165.3/ 0.0 17.67/ 0.00 1/ 0 N O. 13 D E S I G N R E S U L T S - SHEAR PROVIDE SHEAR LINKS AS FOLLOWS |----------------------------------------------------------------| | FROM - TO | MAX. SHEAR | LOAD | LINKS | NO. | SPACING C/C | |----------------|------------|------|-------|-----|-------------| | END 1 749 mm | 24.8 kN | 1 | 8 mm | 5 | 187 mm | | 749 END 2 | 24.8 kN | 1 | 8 mm | 5 | 187 mm | |----------------------------------------------------------------| ___ 7J____________________ 1500.X 300.X 300_____________________ 8J____ | | ||========================================================= | | 4No8 H 264. 0.TO 1158 | | | | | 5*8 c/c187 | | | 5*8 c/c187 | | 4No8 H |29. 467.TO 1500 | | | ====================================================|| | | |_____________________________________________________________________ ______| _______________ _______________ _______________ _________ ______ | | | | | | | | B E A M
| | 4T8 | | 4T8 | |
oooo
| | | |
| | 4T8 | | 4T8 | |
oooo
| | | |
| | | | 4T8 | | |________
oooo
| |
oooo
| |
|_______________|
|_______________|
66 STAAD.Pro
|BRACED /SLENDER in y E.L.y= 4500 mm (3.8.1.3 & 5)| |END MOMS. MZ1= -12 MZ2= -24 MY1= -15 MY2= -31| |SLENDERNESS MOMTS. KNM: MOMZ= 2 MOMY= 2 | |DESIGN LOADS KN METER: MOM.= 55 AXIAL LOAD= 74| |DESIGNED CAP. KN METER: MOM.= 55 AXIAL CAP.= 74| ----------------------------------------------------
FYMAIN - Yield stress for all reinforcing steel FC - Concrete grade CLEAR - Distance from the outer surface to the edge of the bar. This is considered the same on both surfaces. SRA - Parameter which denotes the angle of the required transverse reinforcement relative to the longitudinal reinforcement for the calculation of Wood & Armer design moments.
the reinforcement bar. The resulting Mx* and My* moments are calculated and shown in the design format. The design of the slab considers a fixed bar size of 16 mm in both directions with the longitudinal bar being the layer closest to the slab exterior face. Typical output is as follows:
ELEMENT DESIGN SUMMARY-BASED ON 16mm BARS ----------------------------------------MINIMUM AREAS ARE ACTUAL CODE MIN % REQUIREMENTS. PRACTICAL LAYOUTS ARE AS FOLLOWS: FY=460, 6No.16mm BARS AT 150mm C/C = 1206mm2/metre FY=250, 4No.16mm BARS AT 250mm C/C = 804mm2/metre ELEMENT LONG. REINF MOM-X /LOAD TRANS. REINF MOM-Y /LOAD (mm2/m) (kN-m/m) (mm2/m) (kN-m/m) ------------------------------------------------------------------------| WOOD & ARMER RESOLVED MOMENTS FOR ELEMENT: 47 UNITS: METRE kN | | LOAD MX MY MXY MX* MY*/Ma* ANGLE | | 1 -10.441 -13.347 1.270 0.000 0.000 0.000 TOP | | 1 -10.441 -13.347 1.270 -11.710 -14.617 0.000 BOTT | | 3 -9.541 -11.995 0.986 0.000 0.000 0.000 TOP | | 3 -9.541 -11.995 0.986 -10.527 -12.981 0.000 BOTT | ------------------------------------------------------------------------47 TOP : 195. 0.00 / 0 195. 0.00 / 0 BOTT: 229. -11.71 / 1 329. -14.62 / 1
68 STAAD.Pro
presented in the context of the entire wall rather than individual finite elements thereby allowing users to quickly locate required information. The program reports shear wall design results for each load case/combination for user specified number of sections given by SURFACE DIVISION (default value is 10) command. The shear wall is designed at these horizontal sections. The output includes the required horizontal and vertical distributed reinforcing, the concentrated (in-plane bending) reinforcing and the link required due to out-ofplane shear.
General Format
START SHEARWALL DESIGN CODE BRITISH FYMAIN f1 FC f2 HMIN f3 HMAX f4 VMIN f5 VMAX f6 EMIN f7 EMAX f8 LMIN f9 LMAX f10 CLEAR f11 TWOLAYERED f12 KSLENDER f13 DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST shearwall-list END
The next table explains parameters used in the shear wall design command block above. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 2A.2 - Shear Wall Design Parameters Parameter Name FYMAIN FC HMIN Default Value 460 Mpa 30 Mpa 6 Description
Yield strength of steel, in current units. Compressive strength of concrete, in current units. Minimum size of horizontal reinforcing bars (range 6 mm 36 mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Maximum size of horizontal reinforcing bars (range 6 mm 36 mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge
HMAX
36
VMIN
VMAX
36
EMIN
70 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
zones (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. EMAX 36 Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge zones (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of links (range 6mm 16mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Maximum size of links (range 6mm 16mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Clear concrete cover, in current units. Reinforcement placement mode: 0. single layer, each direction 1. two layers, each direction KSLENDER 1.5 Slenderness factor for finding effective height.
LMIN
LMAX
16
CLEAR TWOLAYERED
25 mm 0
The following example starts from the definition of shear wall and ends at the shear wall design.
Example
.
. SET DIVISION 12 SURFACE INCIDENCES 2 5 37 34 SUR 1 19 16 65 68 SUR 2 11 15 186 165 SUR 3 10 6 138 159 SUR 4 . . . SURFACE PROPERTY 1 TO 4 THI 18 SUPPORTS 1 7 14 20 PINNED 2 TO 5 GEN PIN 6 TO 10 GEN PIN 11 TO 15 GEN PIN 19 TO 16 GEN PIN . . SURFACE CONSTANTS E 3150 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 8.68E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 . . START SHEARWALL DES CODE BRITISH UNIT NEW MMS
72 STAAD.Pro
FC 25 FYMAIN 460 TWO 1 VMIN 12 HMIN 12 EMIN 12 DESIGN SHEA LIST 1 TO 4 END
Notes
1. Command SET DIVISION 12 indicates that the surface boundary node-tonode segments will be subdivided into 12 fragments prior to finite element mesh generation. 2. Four surfaces are defined by the SURFACE INCIDENCES command. 3. The SUPPORTS command includes the new support generation routine. For instance, the line 2 TO 5GEN PIN assigns pinned supports to all nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As the node-to-node distances were previously subdivided by the SET DIVISION 12 command, there will be an additional 11 nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As a result, all 13 nodes will be assigned pinned supports. Please note that the additional 11 nodes are not individually accessible to the user. They are created by the program to enable the finite element mesh generation and to allow application of boundary constraints. 4. Surface thickness and material constants are specified by the SURFACE PROPERTY and SURFACE CONSTANTS, respectively. 5. The shear wall design commands are listed between lines START SHEARWALL DES and END. The CODE command selects the design code that will be the basis for the design. For British code the parameter is BRTISH. The DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST command is followed by a list of previously defined Surface elements intended as shear walls and/or shear wall components.
Technical Overview
The program implements provisions of section 3.9 of BS 8110:Part 1:1997 and relevant provisions as referenced therein, for all active load cases. The wall is designed as unbraced reinforced wall. The following steps are performed for each of the horizontal sections of the wall set using the SURFACE DIVISION command (see Description above).
74 STAAD.Pro
The wall panel is designed as simply supported (at top and bottom), axially loaded with out-of-plane uniform lateral load, with maximum moments and deflections occurring at mid-height. Design is done as per clause no. 3.8.4 for axially loaded column with uni-axial bending. The minimum reinforcement percentage is as per table 3.25. The maximum reinforcement percentage of vertical reinforcement is as per clause no. 3.12.6.3. Links if necessary are calculated as per the provisions of clause 3.12.7.5. Design for out-of-plane shear (denoted by Qy in the shear wall force output) The out-of-plane shear arises from out-of-plane loading. The design shear stress is calculated as per 3.4.5.2 and shear strength of concrete section is calculated as per table 3.8 considering vertical reinforcement as tension reinforcement. Shear reinforcements in the form of links are computed as per table 3.7 and the provisions of clause 3.12.7.5. Design for out-of-plane horizontal bending (denoted by Mx in the shear wall force output) The horizontal reinforcement already calculated from in-plane shear is checked against the whole section subjected to out-of-plane bending and axial load. The axial load in this case is the in-plane shear. The section is again designed as axially loaded column under uni-axial bending as per the provisions of clause 3.8.4. Extra reinforcement in the form of horizontal bars, if necessary, is reported. Shear Wall Design With Opening The Surface element has been enhanced to allow design of shear walls with rectangular openings. The automatic meshing algorithm has been improved to allow variable divisions along wall and opening(s) edges. Design and output are available for user selected locations.
Description
Shear walls modeled in STAAD.Pro may include an unlimited number of openings. Due to the presence of openings, the wall may comprise up with different wall panels. 1. Shear wall set-up Definition of a shear wall starts with a specification of the surface element perimeter nodes, meshing divisions along node-to-node segments,
opening(s) corner coordinates, and meshing divisions of four edges of the opening(s). SURFACE INCIDENCE n1, ..., ni SURFACE s DIVISION sd1, ..., sdj RECOPENING x1 y1 z1 x2 y2 z2 x3 y3 z3 x4 y4 z4 DIVISION od1, ..., odk Where: n1, ..., ni -node numbers on the perimeter of the shear wall, s -surface ordinal number, sd1, ..., sdj - number of divisions for each of the node-to-node distance on the surface perimeter, x1 y1 z1 (...)- od1, ..., odk- coordinates of the corners of the opening, divisions along edges of the opening.
Note: If the sd1, ..., sdj or the od1, ..., odk list does not include all node-to-node segments, or if any of the numbers listed equals zero, then the corresponding division number is set to the default value (=10, or as previously input by the SET DIVISION command). Default locations for stress/force output, design, and design output are set as follows: SURFACE DIVISION X xd SURFACE DIVISION Y yd where: xd - number of divisions along X axis, yd - number of divisions along Y axis. Note: xd and yd represent default numbers of divisions for each edge of the surface where output is requested. The output is provided for sections located between division segments. For example, if the number
76 STAAD.Pro
of divisions = 2, then the output will be produced for only one section (at the center of the edge).
2. Stress/force output printing Values of internal forces may be printed out for any user-defined section of the wall. The general format of the command is as follows: PRINT SURFACE FORCE (ALONG ) (AT a) (BETWEEN d1, d2) LIST s1, ...,si where: - local axis of the surface element (X or Y), a - distance along the full cross-section of the wall, axis from start of the member to the
d1, d2 - coordinates in the direction orthogonal to , delineating a fragment of the full cross-section for which the output is desired.** s1, ...,si - list of surfaces for output generation ** The range currently is taken in terms of local axis. If the local axis is directed away from the surface, the negative range is to be entered. Note: If command ALONG is omitted, direction Y (default) is assumed. If command AT is omitted, output is provided for all sections along the specified (or default) edge. Number of sections will be determined from the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values. If the BETWEEN command is omitted, the output is generated based on full cross-section width.
3. Definition of wall panels Input syntax for panel definition is as follows: START PANEL DEFINITION
SURFACE i PANEL j ptype x1 y1 z1 x2 y2 z2 x3 y3 z3 x4 y4 z4 ENDPANEL DEFINITION where: i - ordinal surface number, j - ordinal panel number, ptype - WALL x1 y1 z1 (...) - coordinates of the corners of the panel
Note: Design of COLUMN and BEAM panels is currently not available. 4. Shear wall design The program implements different provisions of design of walls as per code BS 8110. General syntax of the design command is as follows: START SHEARWALL DESIGN (...) DESIGN SHEARWALL (AT c) LIST s TRACK tr ENDSHEARWALL DESIGN Parameter TRACK specifies how detailed the design output should be: 0 - indicates a basic set of results data (default), 1 - full design output will be generated. If the command AT is omitted, the design proceeds for all cross sections of the wall or panels, as applicable, defined by the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values.
78 STAAD.Pro
a. No panel definition. Design is performed for the specified horizontal full cross-section, located at a distance c from the origin of the local coordinates system. If opening is found then reinforcement is provided along sides of openings. The area of horizontal and vertical bars provided along edges of openings is equal to that of the respective interrupted bars. b. Panels have been defined. Design is performed for all panels, for the cross-section located at a distance c from the start of the panel.
80 STAAD.Pro
section 5B.6 for more information on the LEG parameter. The effective length in the a-a axis is taken as LY * KY and the effective length in the b-b axis as LZ * KZ. The following diagram shows the axes for angles which have been defined with either an ST or RA specification and is connected by its longer leg (i.e., a-a axis is parallel to the longer leg).
Figure 2.1 - Single angle sections A) STangle & USERtable angles and B) RAangle
82 STAAD.Pro
GENERAL or PRISMATIC sections. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.
Channels
All rolled steel channel sections from the BSI table have been incorporated in STAAD. The designation is similar to that of the joists. The same designation scheme as in BSI tables may be used with the weight omitted.
10 TO 15 TA ST CH305X102 55 57 59 61 TA ST CH178X76
Double Channels
Back-to-back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are available. The letter "D" in front of the section name will specify a double channel (e.g., D CH102X51, D CH203X89, etc.)
51 52 53 TA D CH152X89 70 TO 80 TA D CH305X102 SP 5.
(specifies a double channel with a spacing of 5 length units) Note: Face-to-face double channels can not be used in a CHECK CODE command.
Tee Sections
Tee sections are not input by their actual designations, but instead by referring to the universal beam shapes from which they are cut. For example,
54 55 56 TA T UB254X102X22
Angles
All equal and unequal angles are available for analysis. Two types of specifications may be used to describe an angle section, either a standard, ST specification or reversed angle, RA specification. Note, however, that only angles specified with an RA specification can be designed.
84 STAAD.Pro
This specification may be used when the local STAAD z-axis corresponds to the V-V axis specified in the steel tables. If the local STAAD y-axis corresponds to the V-V axis in the tables, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) may be used.
35 TO 45 TA RA UA200X150X18
Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by inputting the word SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either LD or SD will serve the purpose. For example,
14 TO 20 TA LD UA200X200X16 SP 1.5 23 27 TA SD UA80X60X6
"SP" denotes spacing between the individual angle sections. Note: If the section is defined from a Double Angle User Table, then the section properties must be defined with an 11th value which defines the radius of gyration about an individual sections principal v-v axis (See Technical Reference Manual, 5.19 User Steel Table Specification)
(specifies a 21.3 mm dia. pipe with 3.2 mm wall thickness) Circular hollow sections may also be provided by specifying the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
(specifies a pipe with outside dia. of 25 and inside dia. of 20 in current length units) Only code checking and no member selection will be performed if this type of specification is used.
Example:
15 TO 25 TA ST TUB160808.0
Tubes, like pipes, can also be input by their dimensions (Height, Width and Thickness) and not by any table designations.
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5 (A TUBE THAT HAS A HEIGHT OF 8, A WIDTH OF 6, AND A WALL THICKNESS OF 0.5 LENGTH UNITS)
Note: Only code checking and no member selection is performed for TUBE sections specified this way.
86 STAAD.Pro
BS449, in which the limiting condition was attainment of yield stress at the extreme fibres of a given section. With the introduction of the plastic moment as the basic measure of capacity, careful consideration must be given to the influence of local buckling on moment capacity. To assist this, sections are classified as either Class 1, plastic, Class 2, compact, Class 3, semi-compact or Class 4, slender, which governs the decision whether to use the plastic or the elastic moment capacity. The section classification is a function of the geometric properties of the section. STAAD is capable of determining the section classification for both hot rolled and built up sections. In addition, for slender sections, BS5950 recommends the use of a 'stress reduction factor' to reduce the design strength. This factor is again a function of the geometry of the section and is automatically determined by STAAD for use in the design process.
Axial Tension
In members with axial tension, the tensile load must not exceed the tension capacity of the member. The tension capacity of the member is calculated on the basis of the effective area as outlined in Section 4.6 of the code. STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a given member per this procedure, based on a user supplied net section factor (NSF-a default value of 1.0 is present but may be altered by changing the input value - see Table 2B.1), proceeding with member selection or code check accordingly. BS5950 does not have any slenderness limitations for tension members.
Compression
Compression members must be designed so that the compression resistance of the member is greater than the axial compressive load. Compression resistance is determined according to the compressive strength, which is a function of the slenderness of the gross section, the appropriate design strength and the relevant strut characteristics. Strut characteristics take into account the considerable influence residual rolling and welding stresses have on column behavior. Based on data collected from extensive research, it has been determined that sections such as tubes with low residual stresses and Universal Beams and Columns are of intermediate performance. It has been found that I-shaped sections are less sensitive to imperfections when constrained to fail about an axis parallel to the flanges. These research observations are incorporated in BS5950 through the use of four strut curves together with a selection of tables to indicate which curve to use for a particular case. Compression strength for a particular section is calculated in
STAAD according to the procedure outlined in Annex C of BS5950 where compression strength is seen to be a function of the appropriate Robertson constant ( representing Strut Curve) corresponding Perry factor, limiting slenderness of the member and appropriate design strength. A departure from BS5950:1990, generally compression members are no longer required to be checked for slenderness limitations, however, this option can be included by specifying a MAIN parameter. Note, a slenderness limit of 50 is still applied on double angles checked as battened struts as per clause 4.7.9.
88 STAAD.Pro
above with all axial forces set to zero. STAAD also carries out cross checks for compression only, which for compact/plastic sections may be more critical. If this is the case, COMPRESSION will be the critical condition reported despite the presence of moments.
Shear
A member subjected to shear is considered adequate if the shear capacity of the section is greater than the shear load on the member. Shear capacity is calculated in STAAD using the procedure outlined in section 4.2.3, also 4.4.5 and Annex H3 if appropriate, considering the appropriate shear area for the section specified.
For n 2t(B-2t)/A
BEAM
3.0
90 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description 2. Same as BEAM = 1.0 but additional checks are carried out for each end. 3. Calculate moments at 12th points along the member. Clause checks at each location including the ends of the member. Deflection check method. See Note 1 below. 0. Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1. Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type (see note below) Moment calculation: 1. BS5950 per clause B.2.5 (continuous) to calculate Mb. 2. To calculate Mbs (simple) as per Clause 4.7.7 as opposed to Mb.
CAN
CB
1.0
DFF
Default Value
Description Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" . See Note 1 below. Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length". See Note 1 below. Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Clauses 4.8.3.3.1 and 4.8.3.3.2 0.0 = Fail ratio uses MIN of 4.8.3.3.1, 4.8.3.3.2. and Annex I1 checks. 1.0 = Fail ratio uses MAX of 4.8.3.3.1, 4.8.3.3.2. and Annex I1 checks.
DJ1
ESTIFF
0.0
KY KZ
1.0 1.0
K factor value in local y - axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K factor value in local z - axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Valid range from 0 7 and 10. The values correspond to table 25 of BS5950 for fastener conditions. See note 2 below.
LEG
0.0
92 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Description
LVV *
Used in conjunction with LEG for Lvv as per BS5950 table 25 for double angles. See note 6 below. Length in local y - axis (current units) to calculate (KY)(LY)/Ryy slenderness ratio. Length in local z - axis (current units) to calculate (KZ)(LZ)/Rzz slenderness ratio. Equivalent moment factor for lateral torsional buckling as defined in clause 4.8.3.3.4 Equivalent moment factor for major axis flexural buckling as defined in clause 4.8.3.3.4 Equivalent moment factor for minor axis flexural buckling as defined in clause 4.8.3.3.4 Equivalent moment factor for minor axis lateral flexural buckling as defined in clause 4.8.3.3.4 Net section factor for tension members.
LY *
Member Length
LZ *
Member Length
MLT
1.0
MX
1.0
MY
1.0
MYX
1.0
NSF
1.0
Default Value
PNL *
0.0
PY *
Set according to Design strength of steel steel grade (SGR) Slenderness limit for members with compression forces, effective length/ radius of gyration, for a given axis: 0.0 = Slenderness not performed.
MAIN
0.0
1.0 = Main structural member (180) 2.0 = Secondary member. (250) 3.0 = Bracing etc (350)
RATIO
1.0
94 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description Controls the sections to try during a SELECT process. 0.0 = Try every section of the same type as original 1.0 = Try only those sections with a similar name as original, e.g., if the original is an HEA 100, then only HEA sections will be selected, even if there are HEMs in the same table. Identify Section type for section classification 0.0 = Rolled Section
SAME**
0.0
SBLT
0.0 1.0 = Built up Section 2.0 = Cold formed section Specifies a load case number to provide the sway loading forces in clause 4.8.3.3.4 (See additional notes)
SWAY
none
Default Value
SGR
0.0
1.0 = Grade S 355 2.0 = Grade S 460 3.0 = As per GB 1591 16 Mn 0.0 = Elastic stress analysis
TB
0.0 1.0 = Plastic stress analysis Output details 0.0 = Suppress all member capacity info. 1.0 = Print all member capacities.
TRACK
0.0
2.0 = Print detailed design sheet. 4.0 = Deflection Check (separate check to main select / check code) Factor applied to unsupported length for Lateral Torsional Buckling effective length per section 4.3.6.7 of BS5950.
UNF
1.0
96 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description Unsupported Length for calculating Lateral Torsional Buckling resistance moment section 4.3.6.7 of BS5950. Weld Type, see AISC steel design 1.0 = Closed sections. Welding on one side only (except for webs of wide flange and tee sections) 2.0 = Open sections. Welding on both sides (except pipes and tubes)
UNL *
Member Length
* current units must be considered. **For angles, if the original section is an equal angle, then the selected section will be an equal angle and vice versa for unequal angles. Note: There was an NT parameter in STAAD.Pro 2005 build 1003 which is now automatically calculated during the design as it is load case dependant.
Notes
1. CAN, DJ1, and DJ2 Deflection a. When performing the deflection check, you can choose between two methods. The first method, defined by a value 0 for the CAN parameter, is based on the local displacement. Local displacement is described in Section 5.44 of the Technical Reference Manual.
If the CAN parameter is set to 1, the check will be based on cantilever style deflection. Let (DX1, DY1, DZ1) represent the nodal displacements (in global axes) at the node defined by DJ1 (or in the absence of DJ1, the start node of the member). Similarly, (DX2, DY2, DZ2) represent the deflection values at DJ2 or the end node of the member. Compute Delta = SQRT((DX2 - DX1)2 + (DY2 - DY1)2 + (DZ2 - DZ1)2) Compute Length = distance between DJ1 & DJ2 or, between start node and end node, as the case may be. Then, if CAN is specified a value 1, dff = L/Delta Ratio due to deflection = DFF/dff b. If CAN = 0, deflection length is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the Deflection Length will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the Deflection Length may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.
98 STAAD.Pro
c. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. d. It is important to note that unless a DFF value is specified, STAAD will not perform a deflection check. This is in accordance with the fact that there is no default value for DFF. e. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design. 2. LEG follows the requirements of BS5950 table 28. This table concerns the fastener restraint conditions for angles, double angles, tee sections and channels for slenderness. The following values are available: Table 2B.2 - LEG Parameter values Clause Bold Configuration (a) - 2 bolts 4.7.10.2 Single Angle (b) - 1 bolts long leg short leg (a) - 2 bolts long leg short leg (b) - 1 bolts 4.7.10.3 Double Angles (c) - 2 bolts short leg long leg (d) - 1 bolts short leg 4.0 5.0 0.0 long leg long leg 6.0 1.0 7.0 2.0 2.0 3.0 long leg short leg 3.0 0.0 Leg short leg LEG Parameter 1.0
Clause
Bold Configuration
Leg
4.7.10.4 Channels
(a) - 2 or more rows of 4.7.10.5 Tee Sec- bolts tions (b) - 1 row of bolts
The slenderness of single and double angle, channel and tee sections are specified in BS 5950 table 25 depending on the connection provided at the end of the member. To define the appropriate connection, a LEG parameter should be assigned to the member. The following list indicates the value of the LEG parameter required to match the BS5950 connection definition: Clause 4.7.10.2 Single Angle: a. 2 Bolts: Short leg = 1.0, Long Leg = 3.0 b. 1 Bolt: Short Leg = 0.0, Long Leg = 2.0 For single angles, the slenderness is calculated for the geometric axes, a-a and b-b as well as the weak v-v axis. The effective lengths of the geometric axes are defined as: La = KY * KY Lb = KZ * LZ The slenderness calculated for the v-v axis is then used to calculate the compression strength p for the weaker principal axis (z-z for ST angles or yc y for RA specified angles). The maximum slenderness of the a-a and b-b axes is used to calculate the compression strength p for the stronger c principal axis. Alternatively for single angles where the connection is not known or Table 25 is not appropriate, by setting the LEG parameter to 10, slenderness is calculated for the two principal axes y-y and z-z only. The LVV parameter is not used.
100 STAAD.Pro
For double angles, the LVV parameter is available to comply with note 5 in table 25. In addition, if using double angles from user tables, (Technical Reference Manual section 5.19) an eleventh value, r , should be supplied at vv the end of the ten existing values corresponding to the radius of gyration of the single angle making up the pair. 3. PY Steel Design Strength The design parameter PY should only be used when a uniform design strength for an entire structure or a portion thereof is required. Otherwise the value of PY will be set according to the stipulations of BS5950 table 9 in which the design strength is seen as a function of cross sectional thickness for a particular steel grade (SGR parameter) and particular element considered. Generally speaking this option is not required and the program should be allowed to ascertain the appropriate value. 4. UNL, LY, and LZ Relevant Effective Length The values supplied for UNL, LY and LZ should be real numbers greater than zero in current units of length. They are supplied along with or instead of UNF, KY and KZ (which are factors, not lengths) to define lateral torsional buckling and compression effective lengths respectively. Please note that both UNL or UNF and LY or KY values are required even though they are often the same values. The former relates to compression flange restraint for lateral torsional buckling while the latter is the unrestrained buckling length for compression checks. 5. TRACK Control of Output Formats When the TRACK parameter is set to 0.0, 1.0 or 2.0, member capacities will be printed in design related output (code check or member selection) in kilonewtons per square metre. TRACK 4.0 causes the design to carry out a deflection check, usually with a different load list to the main code check. The members that are to be checked must have the parameters, DFF, DJ1 and DJ2 set. An example of each TRACK setting follows: Example output for TRACK 0.0
MEMBER RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= TABLE
BS-4.3.6 0.00
0.769 334.46
3 0.00
102 STAAD.Pro
Effective Length : 6.000 6.000 LTB Moment Capacity (kNm) and LTB Length (m): 435.00, 6.000 LTB Coefficients & Associated Moments (kNm): mLT = 1.00 : mx = 1.00 : my = 1.00 : myx = 1.00 Mlt = 334.46 : Mx = 334.46 : My = 0.00 : My = 0.00 CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (units- kN,m): CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY BS-4.2.3-(Y) 0.143 3 85.6 BS-4.3.6 0.769 3 85.6 334.5 BS-4.7 (C) 0.098 1 239.7 BS-4.8.3.2 0.647 3 179.7 85.6 0.0 334.5 0.0 BS-4.8.3.3.1 0.842 3 179.7 334.5 0.0 BS-4.8.3.3.2 0.842 3 179.7 334.5 0.0 ANNEX I.1 0.714 3 179.7 334.5 0.0 Torsion and deflections have not been considered in the design.
6. MX, MY, MYX, and MLT Equivalent Moment Factors The values for the equivalent moment factors can either be specified directly by the user as a positive value between 0.4 and 1.0 for MX, MY and MYX and 0.44 and 1.0 for MLT. The program can be used to calculate the values for the equivalent moment factors by defining the design member with a GROUP command (see the Technical Reference Manual section 5.16 Listing of Members/Elements/Joints by Specification of GROUPS). The nodes along the beam can then be defined as the location of restraint points with J settings. Additionally for the MLT parameter, the joint can be defined as having the upper flange restrained (positive local Y) with the a U setting or the lower flange restrained (negative local Y) with a L setting. For example, consider a series of 5 beam elements as a single continuous member as shown below:
To enable the steel design, the beam needs to be defined as a group, called MainBeam:
START GROUP DEFINITION MEMBER _MAINBEAM 11 2 38 12 3 END GROUP DEFINITION
Note: This can be done in the User Interface by selecting Tools > Create New Group. Therefore, this 5 beam member has 6 joints such that: Joint 1 = Node 3 Joint 2 = Node 1 Joint 3 = Node 33 Joint 4 = Node 14 Joint 5 = Node 7 Joint 6 = Node 2
104 STAAD.Pro
a. Consider MX, MY and MYX Say that this member has been restrained in its major axis (local Y) only at the ends. In the minor axis (local Z) it has been restrained at the ends and also at node number 33 (joint 3). For local flexural buckling, it has only been restrained at its ends. Hence: For the major axis, local Y axis: MX _MainBeam J1 J6 For the minor axis, local Z axis: MY _ MainBeam J1 J3 J6 For the lateral flexural buckling, local X axis: MYX _ MainBeam J1 J6 b. Consider MLT Say that this member has been restrained at its ends against lateral torsional buckling and the top flange has been restrained at node number 33 (joint 3) and only the lower flange at node number 7, (joint 5). Hence: MLT _MainBeam J1 T3 L5 J6 To split the beam into two buckling lengths for L at joint 14:
y
MY _groupname J1 J4 J6 7. SWAY Sway Loadcase This parameter is used to specify a load case that is to be treated as a sway load case in the context of clause 4.8.3.3.4. This load case would be set up to represent the k M mentioned in this clause and the steel design module amp s would add the forces from this load case to the forces of the other load case it is designed for. Note that the load case specified with this parameter will not be designed as a separate load case. The following is the correct syntax for the parameter:
Default Value
Description
Example
SWAY 5 MEM 1 TO 10 SWAY 6 _MAINBEAMS
Specify the load cases to be considered in the design; the default is all load cases. Specify design parameter values, if different from the default values. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection along with the list of members.
These operations may be repeated by the user any number of times depending upon the design requirements.
106 STAAD.Pro
When code checking is selected, the program calculates and prints whether the members have passed or failed the checks; the critical condition of BS5950 code (like any of the BS5950 specifications for compression, tension, shear, etc.); the value of the ratio of the critical condition (overstressed for value more than 1.0 or any other specified RATIO value); the governing load case, and the location (distance from the start of the member of forces in the member where the critical condition occurs). Code checking can be done with any type of steel section listed in Section 2B.4 or any of the user defined sections as described in Section 1.7.3 of the Technical Reference Manual, GENERAL and ISECTION. In BS5950, these will only be considered for design as I-shape sections. Note: PRISMATIC sections are also not acceptable steel sections for design per BS5950 in STAAD.Pro. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.
108 STAAD.Pro
Minimum web thickness for serviceability and 4.4.3.3 - Minimum web thickness to avoid compression flange buckling. The following printout is then included if a TRACK 2.0 output is selected:
Shear Buckling check is required: Vb = 1070 kN : qw = 118 N/mm2 d = 900 mm : t = 10 mm : a = 200 mm : pyf = 275 N/mm2 BS-4.4.3.2 status = PASS : BS-4.4.3.3 status = PASS
The section is then checked for shear buckling resistance using clause 4.4.5.2 Simplified method and the result is included in the ratio checks.
You must specify the effective length of unrestrained compression flange using the parameter UNL. The program compares the resistance of members with the applied load effects, in accordance with BS 5950-1:2000. Code checking is carried out for locations specified by the user via the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter. The results are presented in a form of a PASS/FAIL identifier and a RATIO of load effect to resistance for each member checked. The user may choose the degree of detail in the output data by setting the TRACK parameter. The beam is designed as other wide flange beams apart from the Lateral Torsional Buckling check which is replaced by the Annex G.2.2. check.
Design Equations
A beam defined with tapered properties as defined above will be checked as a regular wide flange (e.g., UB or UC), except that the following is used in place of clause 4.3.6, the lateral torsional buckling check.
M is the buckling resistance moment M from 4.3.6 for an equivalent bi b slenderness , see G.2.4.2, based on the appropriate modulus S, TB S , Z or Z of the cross-section at the point i considered;
eff eff
M is the moment about the major axis acting at the point i xi considered;
110 STAAD.Pro
P is the compression resistance from 4.7.4 for a slenderness . , see c TC y G.2.3, based on the properties of the minimum depth of cross-section within the segment length L
TC
= y
Where:
= L /r Where:
y y
a is the distance between the reference axis and the axis of restraint, h is the distance between the shear centers of the flanges;
s
TB
= cn
t t
Where: D is the maximum depth of cross-section within the length Ly, see max Figure G.3; D is the minimum depth of cross-section within the length Ly, see min Figure G.3; x is the torsional index of the minimum depth cross-section, see 4.3.6.8 Otherwise, c is taken as 1.0 (unity).
112 STAAD.Pro
is determined then the moment capacity appropriate to the section type can be calculated. STAAD takes the effective length as that provided by the user, defaulting to the length of the member during construction stage and as zero, assuming full restraint throughout, for the composite stage. The program then proceeds to calculate the allowable compressive stress based on appendix G7 from which the moment capacity is then determined.
114 STAAD.Pro
Description
Set according to Design Strength of steel SGR Net section factor for tension members. Steel Grade per BS4360 0.0 = Grade 43 1.0 = Grade 50 2.0 = Grade 55
SBLT
0.0
MAIN
1.0
1.0 = Grade of concrete 30 N/mm2 2.0 = Grade of concrete 40 N/mm2 3.0 = Grade of concrete 50 N/mm2
WET
0.0
0.0 = Wet stage with no data saved for composite stage. 1.0 = Wet stage with data saved for composite stage. 2.0 = Composite and wet stage combined. 3.0 = Composite stage only.
TRACK
1.0
1.0 = Print all member capacities. 0.0 = suppress all member capacities.
BEAM LY
0.0
*Member Length to calculate slenderness ratio Length for bending about Y-axis.
British Codes - Design per BS5400 Parameter Name LZ KY KZ STIFF Default Value Description
*Member Length to calculate slenderness ratio Length for bending about Z-axis. 1.0 1.0 1.0 K value for bending about Y-axis. Usually this is minor axis. K value for bending about Z-axis. Usually this is major axis. Factor of length for panel length in the shear calculation.
ISection
The same is true for ISECTION definition in user table.
116 STAAD.Pro
Example
UNIT CM WIDE FLANGE C45752 -66.5 44.98 .76 15.24 1.09 21345 645 21.3 34.185 33.223 150 150 30 10 ISECTION PG9144 -92.05 2.15 92.05 42.05 3.66 42.05 3.66 197.9 153.9 1730 40 40 12 1
The larger British sections have been coded as USER TABLES under wide flange and are available on request to any existing user. Please note however that composite design is not available in this portion of STAAD.
118 STAAD.Pro
indicating critical serviceability load cases and moments for top and bottom of the slab is then produced. 3. Thermal crack widths Finally thermal, crack width calculations are carried out. Through available parameters, the user is able to provide information on the type of slab, temperature range and crack width limits. Surface zone depths are determined based on the type of slab and critical areas of reinforcements are calculated and printed in a tabulated form. Four bar sizes are considered and for each, max crack spacing, Smax and crack widths are calculated for the critical reinforcements and printed under each bar size. Maximum bar spacing to limit crack widths to the user's limit is also printed under each bar size.
Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering t 500. orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calcu
120 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Description
Parameter which indicates the type of slab ee. ground o BS8007 1 = Suspended Slab 2 = Ground Slab
TEMP CRACK *
30C *0.2 mm
STAAD analysis. The SRA parameter (Set Reinforcement Angle) can be manipulated to introduce Wood & Armer moments into the design replacing the pure Mx, My moments. These new design moments allow the Mxy moment to be considered when designing the section. Orthogonal or skew reinforcement may be considered. SRA set to -500 will assume an orthogonal layout. If however a skew is to be considered, an angle is given in degrees, measured between the local element x axis anti-clockwise (positive). The resulting Mx* and My* moments are calculated and shown in the design format.
122 STAAD.Pro
Channel with Lips Channel without Lips Z with Lips Pipe Tube
Shape assignment may be done using the General |Property page of the graphical user interface (GUI) or by specifying the section designation symbol in the input file. The properties listed in the tables are gross section properties. STAAD.Pro uses unreduced section properties in the structure analysis stage. Both unreduced and effective section properties are used in the design stage, as applicable.
1. Code Checking The program compares the resistance of members with the applied load effects, in accordance with BS 5950-5:1998. Code checking is carried out for locations specified by the user via the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter. The results are presented in a form of a PASS/FAIL identifier and a RATIO of load effect to resistance for each member checked. The user may choose the degree of detail in the output data by setting the TRACK parameter. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. 2. Member Selection The user may request that the program search the cold formed steel shapes database (BS standard sections) for alternative members that pass the code check and meet the least weight criterion. In addition, a minimum and/or maximum acceptable depth of the member may be specified. The program will then evaluate all database sections of the type initially specified (i.e., channel, angle, etc.) and, if a suitable replacement is found, presents design results for that section. If no section satisfying the depth restrictions or lighter than the initial one can be found, the program leaves the member unchanged, regardless of whether it passes the code check or not. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. The program calculates effective section properties in accordance with Section 4 of the subject code. Cross-sectional properties and overall slenderness of members are checked for compliance with:
l
Clause 6.2.2, Maximum Effective Slenderness Ratio for members in Compression Clause 4.2, Maximum Flat Width Ratios for Elements in Compression
124 STAAD.Pro
P =Ap
t
e y
+M /M
y
cy
M /M
z
cz
and M /M
y cy
P is the tensile capacity determined in accordance with clause 7.2.1 of t the subject code M ,M ,M ,M
z y cz cy
Compressive Strength
The allowable Compressive strength, as calculated in STAAD as per BS5950-5, section 6 is described below
For sections symmetrical about both principal axes or closed cross-sections which are not subjected to torsional flexural buckling, the buckling resistance under axial load, Pc, may be obtained from the following equation as per clause 6.2.3 of the subject code
For Sections symmetrical about a single axis and which are not subject to torsional flexural buckling, the buckling resistance under axial load, Pc, may be obtained from the following equation as per clause 6.2.4 of the subject code
Where the meanings of the symbols used are indicated in the subject clauses.
= 1, otherwise Where the meanings of the symbols used are indicated in the subject clause.
+M /M
y
cy
126 STAAD.Pro
For Beams subjected to lateral buckling, the following relationship should be satisfied
cs z
M is the applied bending moment about z axis M is the applied bending moment about y axis
y
M is the moment capacity in bending about the local Z axis in the cz absence of F and M , as per clause 5.2.2 and 5.6
c y
M is the moment capacity in bending about the local Y axis, in the cy absence of F and M ,as per clause 5.2.2 and 5.6
c z
P is the flexural buckling load in compression for bending about the Ez local Z axis P is the flexural buckling load in compression for bending about the Ey local Y axis C ,C
bz by
are taken as unity unless their values are specified by the user
The M M and M are calculated from clause numbers 5.2.2 and 5.6 in cz, cy b the manner described herein below.
M M
cz cy
=S
zz yy
xp
o
=S xp
M is the Moment resistance of the section in z axis p is the limiting stress for bending elements under stress gradient and o should not greater then design strength p
y
For unrestrained beams the applied moment based on factored loads should not be greater than the smaller of the bending moment resistance of the section , M , c and the buckling resistance moment of the beam, M
b
M is the yield moment of the section , product of design strength p Y y and elastic modules of the gross section with respect to the compression flange Zc M is the elastic lateral buckling resistance as per clause 5.6.2.2
E
128 STAAD.Pro
Please refer clause numbers 5.2.2 and 5.6 of the subject code for a detailed discussion regarding the parameters used in the abovementioned equations.
Shear Strength
The maximum shear stress should not be greater then 0.7 p as per clause 5.4.2
y
The average shear stress should not exceed the lesser of the shear yield strength, p or the shear buckling strength, q as stipulated in clause 5.4.3 of the subject v cr code. The parameters are calculated as follows : p = 0.6p
v cr v y
p is the design strength in N/mm2 t is the web thickness in mm D is the web depth in mm
130 STAAD.Pro
Description When this parameter is set to 1.0 (default), the adequacy of the member is determined by checking a total of 13 equally spaced locations along the length of the member. If the BEAM value is 0.0, the 13 location check is not conducted, and instead, checking is done only at the locations specified by the SECTION command (See STAAD manual for details. For TRUSS members only start and end locations are designed. Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending C . See b BS:5950-5:1998,5.6. Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending C . See b BS:5950-5:1998,5.6. Used for Combined axial load and bending design.
CMZ
1.0
CMY
1.0
British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name Default Value CWY 1.0 Description Specifies whether the cold work of forming strengthening effect should be included in resistance computation. See BS:5950-5:1998,3.4 0 effect should not be included 1 effect should be included FLX 1 Specifies whether torsional-flexural buckling restraint is provided or is not necessary for the member. See BS:59505:1998, 5.6 Values: 0 Section subject to torsional flexural buckling 1 Section not subject to torsional flexural buckling FU 430 MPa Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units.
132 STAAD.Pro
Description Yield strength of steel in current units. Effective length factor for torsional buckling. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall buckling about the local Y-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression.
KY
1.0
British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name Default Value KZ 1.0 Description Effective length factor for overall buckling in the local Z-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Unbraced length for twisting. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression.
LX
Member length
134 STAAD.Pro
Description Effective length for overall buckling in the local Y-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length for overall buckling in the local Z-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression.
LZ
Member length
British Codes - Design per British Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name Default Value MAIN 0 Description Specify the design for slenderness against the maximum slenderness as per Clause 6.2.2: 0 Do not check slenderness ratio 1 Check members resisting normal loads (180) 2 - Check members resisting selfweight and wind loads (250) 3 - Check members resisting reversal of stress (350) NSF DMAX 1.0 2540.0 cm. RATIO 1.0 Net section factor for tension members Maximum allowable depth. It is input in the current units of length. Permissible ratio of actual to allowable stresses
136 STAAD.Pro
Description This parameter is used to control the level of detail in which the design output is reported in the output file. The allowable values are: 0 - Prints only the member number, section name, ratio, and PASS/FAIL status. 1 - Prints the design summary in addition to that printed by TRACK 1 2 - Prints member and material properties in addition to that printed by TRACK 2.
been assigned from the AISI shapes database (American cold-formed steel) and designed in accordance with that code. The excerpts from the design output for member number 1 are as follows:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (BS59505-V1.1) *********************** UNITS : MM, KN, KNM, MPA -----------------------------------------------------------------------------| MEMBER# 1 SECTION: 170CLHS56X18 LEN: 609.60 LOCATION: 609.60 | | STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.278 GOV.MODE: 6.4-BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| MATERIAL DATA: YIELD STRENGTH OF STEEL : ULTIMATE TENSILE STRENGTH : SECTION PROPERTIES:(UNITS - CM) SECTION NAME : MEMBER LENGTH : GROSS AREA(AG) : (AE): 4.58 AXIS MOMENT OF INERTIA (I) 21.93 MOMENT OF INERTIA (IE) 19.42 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZET) 5.20 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZEC) 10.42 DESIGN DATA: Z-Z AXIS AXIS COMPRESSION CAPACITY (PC) MOMENT CAPACITY (MC) 3.47 SHEAR CAPACITY (PV) 33.50 LTB CAPACITY (MB) : 9.17 EACH CLAUSE CHECK UNDER CRITICAL LOAD : CLAUSE COMBINATION BS-6.3 COMPRESSION RATIO - AXIAL BS-6.4 BEND-COMPRESSION RATIO BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Z BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Y BS-5.1 BIAXIAL BENDING RATIO BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Z BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Y BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Z & SHEAR - Y RATIO : 21.00 : : 93.70 9.17 Y-Y : 27.55 : 27.85 : 235.46 : 237.27 379.21 N/MM2 430.00 N/MM2 170CLHS56X18 60.96 5.45 NET AREA Z-Z AXIS Y-Y
138 STAAD.Pro
BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Y & SHEAR - Z RATIO 0.000 TORSION AND DEFLECTIONS HAVE NOT BEEN CONSIDERED IN THE DESIGN.
1. Bending Check As per Clause 5.2.2.2 of BS 5950 Part 5 the limiting compressive stress(p ) for stiffened webs is given by the minimum of
o
The limiting compressive moments in local Y and Z axes will be given by M = S p = 27,632.4(332.727) = 9.19(10) Nmm
cz zz o 6
cy
Maximum bending moment about local Z = 2159 Nm at node 7 Maximum bending moment about local Y = 19.755 Nm at node 7 Bending Ratio Z = 2.15 X106 / 9.19 X106 = 0.235 hence verified Bending Ratio Y = 19755.3 / 3.46 X106 = 0.0057 hence verified Buckling resistance moment M As per section 5.6.2, The buckling resistance moment
b
Where:
The elastic buckling resistance moment as per clause 5.6.2.2 is calculated to be M = 4.649(10)6 Nmm
E
Which yields M = (4.6491069.19106 )/{2.3251010 +[(2.3251010)2 b 4.6491069.19106 ] 1/2} = 9.98(10)6 Nmm 2. Compression Check The Axial force induced in member# 1 is 3,436.75 N The elastic flexural buckling load P = 1.185(10)6 N
E
Buckling resistance
P = 153,782 N
c
For Channel section (being singly symmetric), Buckling Resistance as per clause 6.2.4 is
140 STAAD.Pro
Where: The limiting compressive moment, M , in the relevant directionis equal to c 9.19(10)6 Nmm,as calculated above And the distance, e , of the geometric neutral axis of the gross cross section s and that of the effective cross section is equal to 38.24 m So that, P' = (9.19106 153,782)/[9.19106 +153,782(38.24)] = 93,788.7 N
c
Compression ratio = 3,436.75/93,788.7 = 0.0366 hence verified 3. Axial Compression and Bending Local capacity check as per clause 6.4.2 F /P +M /M
c cs z cz
+M /M
y
cy
= 0.2773 hence verified 4. Shear Check as per clause 5.4.2 and 5.4.3 p = 0.6p = 0.6(379.212) = 227.52 N/mm2
v y
P = Amin(p , q )
v cr
Shear resistance Z = 21,148.6 N Shear Ratio Y = 5,627.72/33,579.4 = 0.1675 hence verified Shear Ratio Z = 5,627.72/21,148.6 = 0.0031 hence verified 5. Shear Check with Bending as per clause 5.5.2 Shear with bending on Z (F /P )2 + (M /M )2 = (5,627.72/33,579.4)2 +[2.15106 /(9.19106 )] 2 = v v z cz 0.08327 hence verified Shear with bending on Y (F /P )2 + (M /M )2 = (67.114/21,148.6)2 +[19,755.3/(3.46106 )] 2 = v v y cy 0.0000427 hence verified
Input File
STAAD SPACE SET ECHO OFF INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 5 0; 2 0 5 10; 3 10 5 0; 4 10 5 10; 5 5 5 0; 6 5 5 10; 7 0 5 2; 8 0 5 4; 9 0 5 6; 10 0 5 8; 11 10 5 2; 12 10 5 4; 13 10 5 6; 14 10 5 8; 15 5 5 2; 16 5 5 4; 17 5 5 6; 18 5 5 8; 19 10 0 0; 20 10 0 10; 21 0 0 10; 22 0 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 7; 2 3 11; 3 1 5; 4 2 6; 5 5 3; 6 6 4; 7 7 8; 8 8 9; 9 9 10; 10 10 2; 11 11 12; 12 12 13; 13 13 14; 14 14 4; 15 5 15; 16 15 16; 17 16 17; 18 17 18;
142 STAAD.Pro
19 18 6; 20 7 15; 21 15 11; 22 8 16; 23 16 12; 24 9 17; 25 17 13; 26 10 18; 27 18 14; 28 1 22; 29 2 21; 30 3 19; 31 4 20; 32 1 21; 33 21 4; 34 4 19; 35 19 1; 36 2 20; 37 20 3; 38 3 22; 39 22 2; MEMBER PROPERTY COLDFORMED AMERICAN 32 TO 39 TABLE ST 3LU3X060 20 TO 27 TABLE ST 3HU3X075 MEMBER PROPERTY COLDFORMED BRITISH 28 TO 31 TABLE ST 230CLHS66X16 3 TO 6 15 TO 19 TABLE ST 230CLMIL70X30 1 2 7 TO 14 TABLE ST 170CLHS56X18 UNIT MMS PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES LIST 32 20 28 3 1 SUPPORTS 19 TO 22 PINNED UNIT FEET DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 4.176E+006 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 0.489024 ALPHA 6.5E-006 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL CONSTANTS BETA 90 MEMB 20 TO 27 MATERIAL STEEL MEMB 1 TO 39 MEMBER TENSION 32 TO 39 UNIT FEET KIP
LOAD 1 VERTICAL AND HORIZONTAL MEMBER LOAD 3 TO 6 20 TO 27 UNI GY -0.3 0 5 JOINT LOAD 1 2 FX 0.6 2 4 FZ -0.6 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK UNIT KGS CM PRINT JOINT DISP LIST 1 4 16 PRINT SUPPORT REACTIONS PRINT MEMBER FORCES LIST 3 24 28 UNIT KIP INCH PARAMETER 1 CODE AISI FYLD 55 ALL CWY 1 ALL BEAM 1 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE MEMB 20 21 PARAMETER 2 CODE BS5950 COLD TRACK 2 MEMB 1 TO 19 28 TO 31 CHECK CODE MEMB 1 2 FINISH
**************************************************** * *
144 STAAD.Pro
* * * * * * * * * * * * * * * *
16: 0:53
**************************************************** 1. STAAD SPACE INPUT FILE: BRITISH COLD FORMED VERIFICATION.STD 2. SET ECHO OFF STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 2 MEMBER PROPERTIES. UNIT - CM ----------------MEMB PROFILE AX/ IZ/ IX/ AY AZ SY 32 ST 3LU3X060 2.26 21.81 5.17 0.02 1.51 1.51 4.05 1.93 20 ST 3HU3X075 4.91 63.15 40.66 0.06 1.24 2.40 10.63 9.59 28 ST 230CLHS66X16 8.78 663.30 42.82 0.17 5.31 2.76 60.05 9.06 3 ST 230CLMIL70X30 11.40 868.90 66.93 0.35 6.61 3.61 79.03 13.84 1 ST 170CLHS56X18 5.23 224.50 20.49 0.06 2.93 1.75 27.47 5.28 ************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 4
IY/ SZ
22/
39/
SOLVER USED IS THE IN-CORE ADVANCED SOLVER TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 1, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = 120 STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 3 **START ITERATION NO. 2 **NOTE-TENSION/COMPRESSION CONVERGED AFTER 2 ITERATIONS, CASE= 1 STATIC LOAD/REACTION/EQUILIBRIUM SUMMARY FOR CASE NO. 1 VERTICAL AND HORIZONTAL CENTER OF FORCE BASED ONFORCES ONLY (FEET). (FORCES IN NON-GLOBAL DIRECTIONS WILL INVALIDATE RESULTS) = 0.000000000E+00 Y = 0.500000015E+01 Z = 0.500000015E+01 CENTER OF FORCE BASED ON Y FORCES ONLY (FEET). (FORCES IN NON-GLOBAL DIRECTIONS WILL INVALIDATE RESULTS) = 0.500000015E+01 Y = 0.500000015E+01 Z = 0.500000015E+01 CENTER OF FORCE BASED ON Z FORCES ONLY (FEET). (FORCES IN NON-GLOBAL DIRECTIONS WILL INVALIDATE RESULTS) = 0.500000015E+01 Y = 0.500000015E+01 Z = 0.100000003E+02 ***TOTAL APPLIED LOAD ( KIP FEET ) SUMMARY (LOADING 1 ) SUMMATION FORCE-X = 1.20 SUMMATION FORCE-Y = -18.00 SUMMATION FORCE-Z = -1.20 SUMMATION OF MOMENTS AROUND THE ORIGINMX= 84.00 MY= 12.00 MZ= 96.00
***TOTAL REACTION LOAD( KIP FEET ) SUMMARY (LOADING 1 ) SUMMATION FORCE-X = -1.20 SUMMATION FORCE-Y = 18.00 SUMMATION FORCE-Z = 1.20 SUMMATION OF MOMENTS AROUND THE ORIGINMX= -84.00 MY= -12.00 MZ= 96.00 STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 4 MAXIMUM DISPLACEMENTS ( INCH /RADIANS) (LOADING 1) MAXIMUMS AT NODE = 1.56273E-02 1 Y = -4.80478E-01 16 Z = -1.74875E-02 4 RX= -8.28315E-03 6 RY= -2.09547E-05 14
146 STAAD.Pro
RZ= -8.32083E-03
************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 5 JOINT DISPLACEMENT (CM RADIANS) STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE -----------------JOINT LOAD X-TRANS Y-TRANS Z-TRANS X-ROTAN YROTAN Z-ROTAN 1 1 0.0397 -0.0184 -0.0339 0.0074 0.0000 -0.0027 4 1 0.0305 -0.0185 -0.0444 -0.0074 0.0000 0.0025 16 1 0.0352 -1.2204 -0.0392 0.0025 0.0000 0.0000 ************** END OF LATEST ANALYSIS RESULT ************** STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 6 SUPPORT REACTIONS -UNIT KGS CM STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE ----------------JOINT LOAD FORCE-X FORCE-Y FORCE-Z MOM-X MOM-Y MOM Z 19 1 -447.20 2312.64 85.07 0.00 0.00 0.00 20 1 -446.98 2041.85 186.40 0.00 0.00 0.00 21 1 174.14 1768.33 187.80 0.00 0.00 0.00 22 1 175.72 2041.85 85.04 0.00 0.00 0.00 ************** END OF LATEST ANALYSIS RESULT ************** STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 7 MEMBER END FORCES STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE ----------------ALL UNITS ARE -- KGS CM (LOCAL ) MEMBER LOAD JT AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOM-Y MOM-Z 3 -214.95 1 1 669.35 61567.53 5 -669.35 -195.56 107264.16 24 1 9 -0.62 -0.08 0.91 17 0.62 8362.12 -9.69 28 1 1 2155.99 12959.61 -61571.77 22 -2155.99 0.00 0.00 1448.01 -767.63 -0.06 0.06 -404.01 404.01 2.69 -2.69 -285.32 -395.06 -85.04 85.04
************** END OF LATEST ANALYSIS RESULT ************** STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 8 STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (AISI) *********************** UNITS ARE: IN, KIP, KIP-IN, KSI |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | MEMBER# 20 SECTION: 3HU3X075 LEN: 60.00 GOV.LOC: 60.00 | | STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.285 GOV.MODE: BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | | | | RESISTANCES: AX.TENS: 0.00 ECC.TENS: 0.00 COMPRESS: 7.51 | | BEND. Z: 28.21 BEND. Y: 30.98 SHEAR Z: 11.76 SHEAR Y: 5.88 | | | | FYLD: 55.00 COLD WORK FYLD: 55.71 FU: 58.00 A: 0.76 AE: 0.76 | | IZ: 1.5173E+00 IZE: 1.5173E+00 IY: 9.7684E-01 IYE: 9.7684E-01 | | SZE_T: 6.4841E-01 SZE_C: 6.4841E-01 SYE_T: 5.8539E-01 SYE_C: 7.3374E-01 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | MEMBER# 21 SECTION: 3HU3X075 LEN: 60.00 GOV.LOC: 0.00 | | STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.284 GOV.MODE: BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | | | | RESISTANCES: AX.TENS: 0.00 ECC.TENS: 0.00 COMPRESS: 7.51 | | BEND. Z: 28.21 BEND. Y: 30.98 SHEAR Z: 11.76 SHEAR Y: 5.88 | | | | FYLD: 55.00 COLD WORK FYLD: 55.71 FU: 58.00 A: 0.76 AE: 0.76 | | IZ: 1.5173E+00 IZE: 1.5173E+00 IY: 9.7684E-01 IYE: 9.7684E-01 | | SZE_T: 1.0115E+00 SZE_C: 1.0115E+00 SYE_T: 7.3374E-01 SYE_C: 5.8539E-01 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 9 STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 10
148 STAAD.Pro
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (BS59505-V1.1) *********************** UNITS : MM, KN, KNM, MPA -----------------------------------------------------------------------------| MEMBER# 1 SECTION: 170CLHS56X18 LEN: 609.60 LOCATION: 609.60 | | STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.278 GOV.MODE: 6.4-BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| MATERIAL DATA: YIELD STRENGTH OF STEEL : ULTIMATE TENSILE STRENGTH : SECTION PROPERTIES:(UNITS - CM) SECTION NAME : MEMBER LENGTH : GROSS AREA(AG) : (AE): 4.58 AXIS MOMENT OF INERTIA (I) MOMENT OF INERTIA (IE) ELASTIC MODULUS (ZET) 5.20 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZEC) 10.42 DESIGN DATA: Z-Z AXIS AXIS COMPRESSION CAPACITY (PC) : 93.70 MOMENT CAPACITY (MC) : 9.17 3.47 SHEAR CAPACITY (PV) : 21.00 33.50 LTB CAPACITY (MB) : 9.17 EACH CLAUSE CHECK UNDER CRITICAL LOAD : CLAUSE COMBINATION RATIO BS-6.3 COMPRESSION RATIO - AXIAL 0.037 BS-6.4 BEND-COMPRESSION RATIO 0.278 BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Z 0.236 BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Y 0.006 BS-5.1 BIAXIAL BENDING RATIO 0.241 BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Z 0.168 BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Y 0.003 BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Z & SHEAR - Y RATIO 0.084 BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Y & SHEAR - Z RATIO 0.000 TORSION AND DEFLECTIONS HAVE NOT BEEN CONSIDERED IN THE DESIGN. ----------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------| MEMBER# 2 SECTION: 170CLHS56X18 LEN: 609.60 LOCATION: 609.60 | Y-Y : 27.55 : : : 237.27 235.46 27.85 21.93 19.42 379.21 N/MM2 430.00 N/MM2 170CLHS56X18 60.96 5.45 NET AREA Z-Z AXIS Y-Y
| STATUS: PASS RATIO = 0.283 GOV.MODE: 6.4-BEND + COMPRESS GOV.LOAD: 1 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 11 MATERIAL DATA: YIELD STRENGTH OF STEEL : 379.21 N/MM2 ULTIMATE TENSILE STRENGTH : 430.00 N/MM2 SECTION PROPERTIES:(UNITS - CM) SECTION NAME : 170CLHS56X18 MEMBER LENGTH : 60.96 GROSS AREA(AG) : 5.45 NET AREA (AE): 4.58 Z-Z AXIS Y-Y AXIS MOMENT OF INERTIA (I) : 237.27 21.93 MOMENT OF INERTIA (IE) : 235.46 21.93 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZET) : 27.85 14.17 ELASTIC MODULUS (ZEC) : 27.55 5.41 DESIGN DATA: Z-Z AXIS AXIS COMPRESSION CAPACITY (PC) MOMENT CAPACITY (MC) 1.80 SHEAR CAPACITY (PV) 33.50 LTB CAPACITY (MB) : 9.17 EACH CLAUSE CHECK UNDER CRITICAL LOAD : CLAUSE COMBINATION RATIO BS-6.3 COMPRESSION RATIO - AXIAL 0.037 BS-6.4 BEND-COMPRESSION RATIO 0.283 BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Z 0.236 BS-5.1 BENDING RATIO - Y 0.010 BS-5.1 BIAXIAL BENDING RATIO 0.246 BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Z 0.168 BS-5.4 SHEAR RATIO - Y 0.003 BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Z &L SHEAR - Y RATIO 0.084 BS-5.5.2 BENDING -Y & SHEAR - Z RATIO 0.000 TORSION AND DEFLECTIONS HAVE NOT BEEN CONSIDERED IN THE DESIGN. -----------------------------------------------------------------------------STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 12 *********** END OF THE STAAD.PRO RUN *********** **** DATE= FEB 9,2011 TIME= 16: 0:54 **** : 21.00 : : 93.70 9.17 Y-Y
150 STAAD.Pro
************************************************************ * FOR QUESTIONS ON STAAD.PRO, PLEASE CONTACT * * BENTLEY SYSTEMS OFFICES AT THE FOLLOWING LOCATIONS * * * * TELEPHONE WEB / EMAIL * * * * USA: +1 (714)974-2500 * * UK +44(1454)207-000 * * SINGAPORE +65 6225-6158 * * EUROPE +31 23 5560560 * * INDIA +91(033)4006-2021 * * JAPAN +81(03)5952-6500 HTTP://WWW.CTCG.CO.JP * * CHINA +86 10 5929 7000 * * THAILAND +66(0)2645-1018/19 PARTHA.P@REISOFTWARETH.COM * * * * WORLDWIDE HTTP://SELECTSERVICES.BENTLEY.COM/EN-US/ * * * ***********************************************************
152 STAAD.Pro
Section 3
Canadian Codes
154 STAAD.Pro
For Beams - Prismatic (Rectangular, Square & Tee) For Columns - Prismatic (Rectangular, Square and Circular) For Slabs - 4-noded Plate Elements
In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450mm depth and 300mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with a 300mm diameter
accounts for the secondary moments, due to axial loads and deflections, when the PDELTA ANALYSIS command is used. After solving for the joint displacements of the structure, the program calculates the additional moments induced in the structure due to the P-Delta effect. Therefore, by performing a P-Delta analysis, member forces are calculated which will require no user modification before beginning member design. Refer to Section 5.37.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on this analysis facility. The second method by which STAAD allows the user to account for the slenderness effect is through user supplied moment magnification factors (see the parameter MMAG in Table 3A.1). Here the user approximates the additional moment by supplying a factor by which moments will be multiplied before beginning member design. This second procedure allows slenderness to be considered in accordance with Clause 10.14 of the code. It should be noted that STAAD does not factor loads automatically for concrete design. All the proper factored loads must be provided by the user before the ANALYSIS specification. While performing a P-Delta analysis, all load cases must be defined as primary load cases. If the effects of separate load cases are to be combined, it should be done either by using the REPEAT LOAD command or by specifying the load information of these individual loading cases under one single load case. Usage of the LOAD COMBINATION command will yield incorrect results for P-Delta Analysis in STAAD.Pro.
156 STAAD.Pro
Table 3A.1 - Canadian Concrete Design CSA-A23.3-94 Parameters Parameter Name CLB CLS CLT DEPTH Default Value 40mm 40mm 40mm YD Description
Clear cover to reinforcing bar at bottom of cross section. Clear cover to reinforcing bar along the side of the cross section. Clear cover to reinforcing bar at top of cross section. Depth of the concrete member. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES. Distance of face of support from end node of beam. Used for shear and torsion calculation. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.
EFACE
30 N/mm2
400N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. 400 N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. Number 55 bar Number 10 bar Number 10 bar 1.0 12 Maximum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Minimum secondary (stirrup) reinforcement bar size. A factor by which the column design moments will be magnified. Number of equally-spaced sections to be
Canadian Codes - Concrete Design per CSA Standard A23.3-94 Parameter Name Default Value Description
considered in finding critical moments for beam design. REINF SFACE 0.0 0.0 Tied Column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral. Distance of face of support from start node of beam. Used for shear and torsion calculation. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. TRACK 0.0 0. Critical Moment will not be printed out with beam design report. 1. Moments will be printed. WIDTH ZD Width of the concrete member. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
158 STAAD.Pro
output. Flexural design of beams is performed in two passes. In the first pass, effective depths of the sections are determined with the assumption of single layer of assumed reinforcement and reinforcement requirements are calculated. After the preliminary design, reinforcing bars are chosen from the internal database in single or multiple layers. The entire flexure design is performed again in a second pass taking into account the changed effective depths of sections calculated on the basis of reinforcement provided after the preliminary design. Final provision of flexural reinforcements are made then. Efforts have been made to meet the guideline for the curtailment of reinforcements as per CSA Standard A23.3-94. Although exact curtailment lengths are not mentioned explicitly in the design output (which finally will be more or less guided by the detailer taking into account other practical considerations), the user has the choice of printing reinforcements provided by STAAD at 13 equally spaced sections from which the final detailed drawing can be prepared. The following annotations apply to the output for Beam Design. 1. LEVEL - Serial number of bar level which may contain one or more bar group. 2. HEIGHT - Height of bar level from the bottom of beam. 3. BAR INFOrmation - Reinforcement bar information specifying number of bars and size. 4. FROM - Distance from the start of the beam to the start of the rebar. 5. TO - Distance from the start of the beam to the end of the rebar. 6. ANCHOR - States whether anchorage, either a hook (STA,END) or continuation, is needed at start (STA) or at the end (END) of the bar.
one. The calculations are performed assuming 2-legged stirrups will be provided. The additional longitudinal steel area required for torsion is reported. The stirrups are assumed to be U-shaped for beams with no torsion, and closed hoops for beams subjected to torsion. Example of Input Data for Beam Design
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE CANADA FYMAIN 415 ALL FYSEC 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEMB 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 TRACK 1.0 MEMB 2 TO 9 DESIGN BEAM 2 TO 9 END CONCRETE DESIGN
160 STAAD.Pro
FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEMB 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 DESIGN COLUMN 2 TO 6 END CONCRETE DESIGN
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE CANADA FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLB 40 ALL DESIGN ELEMENT 15 TO 20 END CONCRETE DESIGN
162 STAAD.Pro
specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results.
164 STAAD.Pro
S, M, HP shapes
In addition to welded wide flanges and regular wide flanges, other I shaped sections like S, M and HP shapes are also available. The designation scheme is identical to that listed in the CSA tables. While specifying the sections, it should be remembered that the portion after the decimal point should be omitted. Thus, M310X17.6 should be specified as M310X17 and S180X22.8 should be specified as S180X22. Examples illustrating specifications of these shapes are provided below.
10 TO 20 BY 2 TA ST S510X98 45 TO 55 TA ST M150X6 88 90 96 TA ST HP310X79
Double Channels
Back-to-back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are specified by preceding the section designation by the letter D. For example, a back-to-back double channel section C200X28 without any spacing in between should be specified as:
100 TO 120 TA D C200X28
Note that the specification SP after the section designation is used for providing the spacing. The spacing should always be provided in the current length unit.
Angles
To specify angles, the angle name is preceded by the letter L. Thus, a 200X200 angle with a 25mm thickness is designated as L200X200X25. The following examples illustrate angle specifications.
75 TO 95 TA ST L100X100X8 33 34 35 TA ST L200X100X20
Note that the above specification is for standard angles. In this specification, the local z-axis (see Fig. 2.6 in the Technical Reference Manual) corresponds to the YY axis shown in the CSA table. Another common practice of specifying angles assumes the local y-axis to correspond to the Y-Y axis. To specify angles in accordance with this convention, the reverse angle designation facility has been provided. A reverse angle may be specified by substituting the word ST with the word RA. Refer to the following example for details.
10 TO 15 TA RA L55X35X4
The local axis systems for STANDARD and REVERSE angles is shown in Fig. 2.6 of the STAAD Technical Reference manual.
Double Angles
To specify double angles, the specification ST should be substituted with LD (for long leg back-to-back) or SD (short leg back-to-back). For equal angles, either SD or LD will serve the purpose. Spacing between angles may be provided by using the word SP followed by the value of spacing (in current length unit) after section designation.
25 35 45 TA LD L150X100X16 80 TO 90 TA SD L125X75X6 SP 2.5
The second example above describes a double angle section consisting of 125X75X6 angles with a spacing of 2.5 length units.
166 STAAD.Pro
Tees
Tee sections obtained by cutting W sections may be specified by using the T specification instead of ST before the name of the W shape. For example:
100 TO 120 TA T W200X42
In addition, any tube section may be specified by using the DT(for depth), WT(for width), and TH(for thickness) specifications. For example:
100 TO 200 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5
will describe a tube with a depth of 8 in., width of 6 in. and a wall thickness of 0.5 inches. Note that the values of depth, width and thickness must be provided in current length unit.
15 TO 25 TA ST PIP33X2.5
In addition to sections listed in the CSA tables, circular hollow sections may be specified by using the OD (outside diameter) and ID (inside diameter) specifications. For example:
70 TO 90 TA ST PIPE OD 10.0 ID 9.0
will describe a pipe with an outside diameter of 10 length units and inside diameter of 9.0 length units. Note that the values of outside and inside diameters must be provided in terms of current length unit. Sample input file to demonstrate usage of Canadian shapes
STAAD SPACE UNIT METER KNS JOINT COORD 1 0 0 0 17 160 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2 16 UNIT CM MEMBER PROPERTIES CANADIAN *W SHAPES 1 TA ST W250X18 *WW SHAPES 2 TA ST WW700X185 *S SHAPES
168 STAAD.Pro
3 TA ST S200X27 *M SHAPES 4 TA ST M130X28 *HP SHAPES 5 TA ST HP310X132 *MC CHANNELS 6 TA ST MC150X17 *C CHANNELS 7 TA ST C180X18 * DOUBLE CHANNELS 8 TA D C250X37 SP 1.0 *ANGLES 9 TA ST L55X35X5 *REVERSE ANGLES 10 TA RA L90X75X5 *DOUBLE ANGLES, LONG LEG BACK TO BACK 11 TA LD L100X90X6 SP 2.0 *DOUBLE ANGLES, SHORT LEG BACK TO BACK 12 TA SD L125X75X6 SP 2.5 *TUBES 13 TA ST TUB120807 *TUBES 14 TA ST TUBE DT 16.0 WT 8.0 TH 0.8 *PIPES 15 TA ST PIP273X6.3 *PIPES 16 TA ST PIPE OD 16.0 ID 13.0 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH
Nomenclature
A = Area. A = Effective area.
e f
170 STAAD.Pro
C = Axial compressive load at yield stress. D = Outside diameter of pipe section. E = Elastic modulus of steel. F = Elastic critical buckling stress.
e y
F = Yield strength. F = Effective yield stress of section in compression to account for elastic local ye buckling. h = Clear depth of web. K = Effective length factor. L = Length or span of member. M = Bending moment in a member or component under factored load.
f
W = Web thickness. = Non-dimensional slenderness parameter in column formula. = Effective non-dimensional slenderness parameter in column formula ye considering effective yield stress. = Resistance factor
Axial Tension
The criteria governing the capacity of tension members is based on two limit states. The limit state of yielding in the gross section is intended to prevent excessive elongation of the member. The second limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area. The net section area may be specified by the
user through the use of the parameter NSF (see Table 3B.1). STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on these two limits states per Cl.13.2 of CAN/CSA-S16-01. Parameters FYLD, FU, and NSF are applicable for these calculations.
Axial Compression
The compressive resistance of columns is determined based on Clause 13.3 of the code. The equations presented in this section of the code assume that the compressive resistance is a function of the compressive strength of the gross section (Gross section Area times the Yield Strength) as well as the slenderness factor (KL/r ratios). The effective length for the calculation of compression resistance may be provided through the use of the parameters KT, KY, KZ, LT, LY, and LZ (see Table 3B.1). Some of the aspects of the axial compression capacity calculations are : 1. For frame members not subjected to any bending, and for truss members, the axial compression capacity in general column flexural buckling is calculated from Cl.13.3.1 using the slenderness ratios for the local Y-Y and Z-Z axis. The parameters KY, LY, KZ and LZ are applicable for this. 2. For single angles, which are frame members not subjected to any bending or truss members, the axial compression capacity in general column flexural buckling and local buckling of thin legs is calculated using the rules of the AISC - LRFD code, 2nd ed., 1994. The reason for this is that the Canadian code doesnt provide any clear guidelines for calculating this value. The parameters KY, LY, KZ, and LZ are applicable for this. 3. The axial compression capacity is also calculated by taking flexural-torsional buckling into account. The rules of Appendix D, page 1-109 of CAN/CSAS16-01are used for this purpose. Parameters KT and LT may be used to provide the effective length factor and effective length value for flexuraltorsional buckling. Flexural-torsional buckling capacity is computed for single channels, single angles, Tees and Double angles. 4. The variable n in Cl.13.3.1 is assumed as 2.24 for WWF shapes and 1.34 for all other shapes. 5. While computing the general column flexural buckling capacity of sections with axial compression + bending, the special provisions of 13.8.1(a),
172 STAAD.Pro
13.8.1(b) and 13.8.1(c) are applied. For example, Lambda = 0 for 13.8.1(a), K=1 for 13.8.1(b), etc.) For Class 4 members subjected to axial compression, factored compressive resistance should be determined by either of the following equations. a. C = A F (1+2n )-1n
r e y
Where: n = 1.34 = (F /F )
y e
F =(2 E)/(KL/r)2
e
Ae is calculated using reduced element widths meeting the maximum width to thickness ratio specified in Table 1. Effective width required for the calculation of effective area Ae, for different section shapes are as follows.
l
For flanges of I-section, T-section and channel section and legs of angle section b = 200t/((F )
e y
b. C = AF
r
ye
(1+
ye
Where: n = 1.34
ye e
= (F /F_e )
ye
F =(2 E)/(KL/r)2
With an effective yield stress, F , determined from the maximum width (or ye diameter)-to-thickness ratio meeting the limit specified in Table 1. Following are the expressions for effective yield stress for different shaped section.
l
Bending
The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange for the purpose of computing the factored moment resistance is specified in STAAD with the help of the parameter UNL. If UNL is less than one tenth the member length (member length is the distance between the joints of the member), the member is treated as being continuously laterally supported. In this case, the moment resistance is computed from Clause 13.5 of the code. If UNL is greater than or equal to one tenth the member length, its value is used as the laterally unsupported length. The equations of Clause 13.6 of the code are used to arrive at the moment of resistance of laterally unsupported members. Some of the aspects of the bending capacity calculations are : 1. The weak axis bending capacity of all sections except single angles is calculated as For Class 1 & 2 sections, P For Class 3 sections, S where = Resistance factor = 0.9 P = Plastic section modulus about the local Y axis
y y y
174 STAAD.Pro
2. For single angles, the bending capacities are calculated for the principal axes. The specifications of Section 5, page 6-283 of AISC-LRFD 1994, 2nd ed., are used for this purpose because the Canadian code doesnt provide any clear guidelines for calculating this value. 3. For calculating the bending capacity about the Z-Z axis of singly symmetric shapes such as Tees and Double angles, CAN/CSA-S16-01 stipulates in Clause 13.6(d), page 1-31, that a rational method, such as that given in SSRCs Guide to Stability Design Criteria of Metal Structures, be used. Instead, STAAD uses the rules of Section 2c, page 6-55 of AISC-LRFD 1994, 2nd ed.
Mr = SeFy Where: Se = effective section modulus determined using effective flange width.
l
For I-section, T-section, Channel section, effective flange width and for Angle section, effective length width b_e= 200t/(F_y ) But shall not exceed 60t.
When bending moment at any point within the unbraced length is larger than the larger end moment or when there is no effective lateral support for the compression flange at one of the ends of unsupported length = 1.0
2
176 STAAD.Pro
k = Ratio of the smaller factored moment to the larger moment at opposite ends of the unbraced length, positive for double curvature and negative for single curvature. Se = effective section modulus determined using effective flange width.
l
For I-section, T-section, Channel section, effective flange width and for Angle section, effective length width b_e= 200t/(F_y ) But shall not exceed 60t.
This clause is applicable only for I shaped and Channel shaped section as there is no guide line in the code for other sections.
Shear
The shear resistance of the cross section is determined using the equations of Clause 13.4 of the code. Once this is obtained, the ratio of the shear force acting on
the cross section to the shear resistance of the section is calculated. If any of the ratios (for both local Y & Z axes) exceed 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 3B.1), the section is considered to have failed under shear. The code also requires that the slenderness ratio of the web be within a certain limit (See Cl.13.4.1.3, page 1-29 of CAN/CSA-S16-01). Checks for safety in shear are performed only if this value is within the allowable limit. Users may by-pass this limitation by specifying a value of 2.0 for the MAIN parameter.
178 STAAD.Pro
Description 0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by SECTION command. 1.0 = Perform design for moments at twelfth points along the beam.
CB
1.0
Greater than 0.0 and less than 2.5 : Value of Omega_2 (Cl.13.6) to be used for calculation. Equal to 0.0 : Calculate Omega_2
CMY
1.0
1.0 = Do not calculate Omega1 for local Y axis. 2.0 = Calculate Omega-1 for local Y axis. Used in Cl.13.8.4 of code
CMZ
1.0
Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01 Parameter Name Default Value Description 1 for local Z axis. 2.0 = Calculate Omega-1 for local Z axis. Used in Cl.13.8.4 of code DFF None(Mandatory for deflection check) Deflection Length/Maxm. Allowable local deflection. Joint No. denoting start point for calculation of deflection length Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of deflection length Maximum allowable depth (Applicable for member selection) Minimum required depth (Applicable for member selection) Yield strength of
DJ1
DJ2
DMAX
45.0 in.
DMIN
0.0 in.
FYLD
300.0 MPa
180 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description steel.
FU KT
Ultimate strength of steel. K value for flexural torsional buckling. K value for general column flexural buckling about the local Y-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. K value for general column flexural buckling about the local Z-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. Length for flexural torsional buckling. Length for general column flexural buckling about the local Y-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. Length for
KY
1.0
KZ
1.0
LT
Member Length
LY
Member Length
LZ
Member Length
Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01 Parameter Name Default Value Description general column flexural buckling about the local Z-axis. Used to calculate slenderness ratio. MAIN 0.0 0.0 = Check slenderness ratio against the limits. 1.0= Suppress the slenderness ratio check. 2.0 = Check slenderness ratio only for column buckling, not for web (See Section 3B.6, Shear) NSF 1.0 Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of actual load effect to the design strength. 0.0 = Report only minimum design results. 1.0 = Report design strengths also. 2.0 = Provide
RATIO
1.0
TRACK
0.0
182 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
UNB
Member Length
Unsupported length in bending compression of the bottom flange for calculating moment resistance. Unsupported length in bending compression of the top flange for calculating moment resistance.
UNT
Member Length
UNIT NEWTON METER PARAMETER CODE CANADIAN FYLD 330E6 MEMB 3 4 NSF 0.85 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4 UNL 15 MEMB 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL CHECK CODE MEMB 3 4
184 STAAD.Pro
CR2 = CAPACITY (C ) PER 13.8.2(b) CRZ = SEE 13.8.2(b) for uniaxial bending (called C CTORFLX = Capacity in accordance with 13.8.2(c)
RX
in that Clause)
Type
Static analysis, 3D beam element. International Design Codes Manual 185
Reference
CAN/CSA-S16.1-94, National Standard of Canada, Limit States Design of Steel Structures. The Canadian Standards Association, 1994 with CISC (Canadian Institute of Steel Construction) handbook. CISC Example 1 page 5_91.
Problem
Find the interaction ratio, beam resistance and beam deflection.
Given
E = 200000 MPa (STEEL) F = 300 Mpa CSA G40.21-M
y
Simply supported beam has a 8.0 m span; Ky is 1.0, Kz 1.0, unsupported length 1.0 m Allowable Live Load deflection, L/300 = 8000/300 = 27 mm Factored Uniform Load IS 7 kN/m DEAD, 15 kN/m LIVE. Steel section is W410X54
Comparison
Table 3B.2 - CAN/CSA-S16 Verification Problem comparison Source Interaction Beam Beam Ratio Resistance Deflection (kN*m) (mm) 0.88 0.883 284 283.20 21 20.81
Reference STAAD.Pro
**************************************************** * * * STAAD.PRO *
186 STAAD.Pro
* VERSION BLD * * PROPRIETARY PROGRAM OF * * RESEARCH ENGINEERS, INTL. * * DATE= * * TIME= * * * * USER ID: * **************************************************** 1. STAAD SPACE VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 5-91 3. * CISC EXAMPLE 1 PAGE 5-91, LIMIT STATES DESIGN, CSA-S16.1-94 4. * SIMPLY SUPPORTED BEAM WITH UNIFORM LOAD 5. * LIVE LOAD DEFLECTION OF L/300 7. UNIT MMS KN 8. JOINT COORDINATES 9. 1 0 0 0; 2 8000 0 0 10. MEMBER INCIDENCES 11. 1 1 2 13. MEMBER PROPERTY CANADIAN 14. 1 TABLE ST W410X54 16. CONSTANTS 17. E STEEL ALL 18. POISSON 0.3 ALL 20. SUPPORTS 21. 1 PINNED 22. 2 FIXED BUT MY MZ 24. UNIT METER KN 25. LOAD 1 DEAD 26. MEMBER LOAD 27. 1 UNI GY -7 29. LOAD 2 LIVE 30. MEMBER LOAD 31. 1 UNI GY -15 33. LOAD COMB 3 1.25DL + 1.5 LL 34. 1 1.25 2 1.5 36. PERFORM ANALYSIS P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 2/ 1/ 2 ORIGINAL/FINAL BAND-WIDTH= 1/ 1/ 5 DOF TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 2, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = 5 SIZE OF STIFFNESS MATRIX = 1 DOUBLE KILO-WORDS REQRD/AVAIL. DISK SPACE = 12.0/ 19641.6 MB 37. LOAD LIST 2 38. PRINT SECTION DISPLACEMENTS MEMBER SECTION DISPLACEMENTS
---------------------------UNIT =INCHES FOR FPS AND CM FOR METRICS/SI SYSTEM MEMB LOAD GLOBAL X,Y,Z DISPL FROM START TO END JOINTS AT 1/12TH PTS 1 2 0.0000 0.0000 0.0000 0.0000 -0.5471 0.0000 0.0000 -1.0528 0.0000 0.0000 -1.4824 0.0000 0.0000 -1.8086 0.0000 0.0000 -2.0120 0.0000 0.0000 -2.0812 0.0000 0.0000 -2.0120 0.0000 0.0000 -1.8086 0.0000 0.0000 -1.4824 0.0000 0.0000 -1.0528 0.0000 0.0000 -0.5471 0.0000 0.0000 0.0000 0.0000 MAX LOCAL DISP = 2.08115 AT 400.00 LOAD 2 L/DISP= 384 ************ END OF SECT DISPL RESULTS *********** 40. LOAD LIST 3 41. PARAMETER 42. CODE CANADIAN 43. TRACK 2 ALL 44. UNL 1 ALL 45. FYLD 300000 ALL 46. BEAM 1 ALL 47. CHECK CODE ALL STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (CAN/CSAS16-01) ****************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST W410X54 (CANADIAN SECTIONS) PASS CSA-13.8.2+ 0.883 3 0.00 C 0.00 250.00 4.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 6.84E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = 8.00E+02 IZ = 1.86E+04 SZ = 9.26E+02 PZ = 1.05E+03 IY = 1.02E+03 SY = 1.15E+02 PY = 1.77E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CR1 = 1.846E+03 CR2 = 2.732E+02 CRZ = 1.570E+03 CTORFLX = 2.732E+02
188 STAAD.Pro
TENSILE CAPACITY = 1.805E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 2.732E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 4.778E+01 MRZ = 2.832E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 5.379E+02 VRZ = 4.604E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 207.170 KL/RZ = 48.447 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 300.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 1.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.00 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 0.000E+00 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 5.08E+01 48. STEEL TAKE OFF ALL STEEL TAKE-OFF -------------PROFILE LENGTH(METE) WEIGHT(KN ) IN STEEL TAKEOFF THE DENSITY OF STEEL IS ASSUMED FOR MEMBERS WITH NO DENSITY. ST W410X54 8.00 4.203 PRISMATIC STEEL 0.00 0.000 ---------------TOTAL = 4.203 ************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ 49. FINISH
Type
Static Analysis, 3D beam element.
Reference
CAN/CSA-S16.1-94, National Standard of Canada, Limit States Design of Steel Structures. The Canadian Standards Association, 1994 with CISC (Canadian Institute of Steel Construction) handbook. CISC Handbook Example, Page 4_106.
Problem
Find the interaction ratio, beam and column resistance.
Given
E = 200000 MPa (STEEL). F = 300 MPa CSA G40.21-M
y
Simply supported beam/column has a 3.7 m span, Ky is 1.0, Kz 1.0 factored axial load is 2000 kN and end moments of 200 kN*m and 300 kN*m Steel section is W310X129
Comparison
CAN/CSAS16 Interaction Ratio Beam Resistance (kN*m) REFERENCE STAAD.Pro 0.96 0.98 583 584 Column Resistance (kN) 3800 3820
**************************************************** * * * STAAD.PRO * * VERSION BLD * * PROPRIETARY PROGRAM OF * * RESEARCH ENGINEERS, INTL. * * DATE= * * TIME= * * *
190 STAAD.Pro
* USER ID: * **************************************************** 1. STAAD SPACE VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 4-106 2. * 3. * COMPRESSION + MAJOR AXIS BENDING 4. * 5. UNIT METER KN 6. JOINT COORDINATES 7. 1 0 0 0; 2 0 3.7 0 8. * 9. MEMBER INCIDENCES 10. 1 1 2 11. * 12. MEMBER PROPERTY CANADIAN 13. 1 TABLE ST W310X129 14. * 15. CONSTANTS 16. E STEEL ALL 17. POISSON STEEL ALL 18. * 19. SUPPORTS 20. 1 FIXED BUT MX MZ 21. 2 FIXED BUT FY MY MZ 22. * 23. LOAD 1 FACTORED LOAD 24. JOINT LOAD 25. 2 FY -2000 26. 2 MZ 200 27. 1 MZ 300 28. * 29. PDELTA 3 ANALYSIS P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 2/ 1/ 2 ORIGINAL/FINAL BAND-WIDTH= 1/ 1/ 5 DOF TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 1, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = 5 SIZE OF STIFFNESS MATRIX = 1 DOUBLE KILO-WORDS REQRD/AVAIL. DISK SPACE = 12.0/ 19641.2 MB ++ ADJUSTING DISPLACEMENTS 8:54:35 ++ ADJUSTING DISPLACEMENTS 8:54:35 ++ ADJUSTING DISPLACEMENTS 8:54:35 31. PRINT MEMBER FORCES MEMBER END FORCES STRUCTURE TYPE = SPACE ----------------ALL UNITS ARE -- KN METE MEMBER LOAD JT AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z TORSION MOM-Y MOM-Z
1 1 1 2000.00 135.14 0.00 0.00 0.00 300.00 2 -2000.00 -135.14 0.00 0.00 0.00 200.00 ************** END OF LATEST ANALYSIS RESULT ************** 33. PARAMETER 34. CODE CANADIAN 35. TRACK 2 ALL 36. FYLD 300000 ALL 37. LY 3.7 ALL 38. LZ 3.7 ALL 39. CHECK CODE ALL STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (CAN/CSAS16-01) ****************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST W310X129 (CANADIAN SECTIONS) PASS CSA-13.8.2C 0.980 1 2000.00 C 0.00 300.00 0.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 1.65E+02 MEMBER LENGTH = 3.70E+02 IZ = 3.08E+04 SZ = 1.94E+03 PZ = 2.16E+03 IY = 1.00E+04 SY = 6.51E+02 PY = 9.90E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CR1 = 4.459E+03 CR2 = 3.820E+03 CRZ = 4.296E+03 CTORFLX = 3.820E+03 TENSILE CAPACITY = 4.359E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 3.820E+03 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 2.672E+02 MRZ = 5.840E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 7.419E+02 VRZ = 1.505E+03 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 47.477 KL/RZ = 27.094 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 200.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 3.700 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.00
192 STAAD.Pro
SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 1.351E+02 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 2.12E+01 40. STEEL MEMBER TAKE OFF ALL STEEL TAKE-OFF -------------PROFILE LENGTH(METE) WEIGHT(KN ) IN STEEL TAKEOFF THE DENSITY OF STEEL IS ASSUMED FOR MEMBERS WITH NO DENSITY. ST W310X129 3.70 4.694 PRISMATIC STEEL 0.00 0.000 ---------------TOTAL = 4.694 MEMBER PROFILE LENGTH WEIGHT (METE) (KN ) 1 ST W310X129 3.70 4.694 ************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ 42. FINISH
Type
Static Analysis, 3D beam element.
Reference
CAN/CSA-S16.1-94, National Standard of Canada, Limit States Design of Steel Structures. The Canadian Standards Association, 1994 with CISC (Canadian Institute of Steel Construction) handbook. CISC Handbook Example, Page 4_108.
Problem
Find the interaction ratio, beam and column resistance.
Given
E = 200000 MPa (STEEL).
Simply supported beam/column has a 3.7 m span, Ky is 1.0, Kz 1.0, Lu = 3.7 m factored axial load is 2000 kN and end moments of 200 kN*m and 300 kN*m in the strong axis and 100 kN*m at each end in the weak axis. Steel section is W310X143.
Comparison
CAN/CSA-S16 Interaction Ratio Beam Resistance Column Resistance (kN*m) (kN)
**************************************************** * * * STAAD.PRO * * VERSION BLD * * PROPRIETARY PROGRAM OF * * RESEARCH ENGINEERS, INTL. * * DATE= * * TIME= * * * * USER ID: * **************************************************** 1. STAAD SPACE VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 4-108
194 STAAD.Pro
* * ( COMPRESSION + BIAXIAL BENDING ) * UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 3.7 0 * MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2 * MEMBER PROPERTY CANADIAN 1 TABLE ST W310X143 * CONSTANTS E STEEL ALL POISSON STEEL ALL * SUPPORTS 1 FIXED BUT MX MZ 2 FIXED BUT FY MX MY MZ * LOAD 1 FACTORED LOAD JOINT LOAD 2 FY -2000 2 MZ 200 2 MX 100 1 MZ 300 1 MX 100 * PERFORM ANALYSIS P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 2/ 1/ 2 ORIGINAL/FINAL BAND-WIDTH= 1/ 1/ 6 DOF TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = 1, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREEDOM = 6 SIZE OF STIFFNESS MATRIX = 1 DOUBLE KILO-WORDS REQRD/AVAIL. DISK SPACE = 12.0/ 19641.2 MB 33. PARAMETER 34. CODE CANADIAN 35. CMY 2 ALL 36. CMZ 2 ALL 37. CB 1 ALL 38. TRACK 2 ALL 39. FYLD 300000 ALL 40. CHECK CODE ALL STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - (CAN/CSAS16-01) ****************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION
2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. 10. 11. 12. 13. 14. 15. 16. 17. 18. 19. 20. 21. 22. 23. 24. 25. 26. 27. 28. 29. 30. 31.
======================================================================= * 1 ST W310X143 (CANADIAN SECTIONS) FAIL CSA-13.8.2A 1.000 1 2000.00 C -100.00 300.00 0.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 1.82E+02 MEMBER LENGTH = 3.70E+02 IZ = 3.47E+04 SZ = 2.15E+03 PZ = 2.41E+03 IY = 1.12E+04 SY = 7.28E+02 PY = 1.11E+03 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CR1 = 4.912E+03 CR2 = 4.222E+03 CRZ = 4.737E+03 CTORFLX = 4.222E+03 TENSILE CAPACITY = 4.802E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 4.912E+03 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 2.987E+02 MRZ = 6.504E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 8.037E+02 VRZ = 1.678E+03 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 47.077 KL/RZ = 26.802 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 200.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 3.700 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 0.40 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 0.40 OMEGA-2 = 1.00 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 1.351E+02 Z AXIS = 5.405E+01 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 1.98E+01 41. STEEL MEMBER TAKE OFF ALL STEEL TAKE-OFF -------------PROFILE LENGTH(METE) WEIGHT(KN ) IN STEEL TAKEOFF THE DENSITY OF STEEL IS ASSUMED FOR MEMBERS WITH NO DENSITY. ST W310X143 3.70 5.171 PRISMATIC STEEL 0.00 0.000 ---------------TOTAL = 5.171 MEMBER PROFILE LENGTH WEIGHT (METE) (KN ) 1 ST W310X143 3.70 5.171 ************ END OF DATA FROM INTERNAL STORAGE ************ 42. FINISH
196 STAAD.Pro
Type
Static analysis, 3D beam element.
Reference
CISC Example 1, page 5-91, Limit State Design, CSA-S16.1-94
Problem
A cantilever beam of length 4 meter is subjected to uniformly distributed load of 3 KN/Meter in both major and minor axis. Axial compression of 8 KN is also applied to the member. User defined steel section Sect_Class-4 from is assigned to the member.
Given
Design forces 8.0 KN (Compression) 6.0 KNm (Bending-Y) 6.0 KNm (Bending-Z) 6.0 KN (Shear-Y) 6.0 KN (Shear-Z) Section Properties(Sect_Class-4): Area = 2766 mm2 Depth of section, D = 150 mm Thickness of web Tw = 7 mm
Width of flange Bf = 150 mm Thickness of flange Tf = 6 mm Moment of inertia about Z axis, Iz = 1086.96X104 mm4 Moment of inertia about Y axis, Iy = 337.894X104 mm4 Moment of inertia about X axis, Ix = 3.7378X104 mm4 Warping constant, Cw = 1.752X1010 mm6 Member Length L = 2 m, Unbraced length = 100mm. Material FYLD = 300 MPa E = 2.05E+05 MPa G = E/2.6 MPa
Solution
Slenderness Ratio
Effective Length factor along Local Y-Axis = KY = 1 Effective Length factor along Local Z-Axis = KZ = 1 Slenderness ratio about Z axis, L/Rz = 31.9 Slenderness ratio about Y axis, L/Ry = 57.22 Maximum Slenderness Ratio, L/Rmax = 57.22
Section Classification
Bf/Tf = 150*0.5/6 = 12.5 > 200/sqrt(Fy) = 11.54 Flange is Class 4. d/Tw = (150-2.0*6)/7 = 19.714 (1100/sqrt(Fy))*(1-0.39*Cf/*Cy)=(1100/sqrt(300))*(10.39*8000/(0.9*2766*300)) = 63.24 Web is Class 1.
198 STAAD.Pro
Canadian Codes - Steel Design per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-S16-01 mm4. Effective section modulus about Y axis, Syeff = 2657648.856/69.24 = 38383.144 mm3. Major axis bending resistance if member is laterally supported, Mrz1 = *Szeff*FYLD= 0.9*135367.88*300 =36549327.6 N-mm. Minor axis bending resistance, Mry = *Syeff*FYLD = 0.9*38383.144*300 = 10363448.88 N-mm. If the member is laterally unsupported major axis bending resistance is determined by clause 13.6(b). As the value of one of the end moments is 0.0, 2 = 1.75. Where, as per clause 13.6(a), Mu = (1.75*3.14/2000)*sqrt(205000*337.894X10 4*78846.154*3.7378X104 + (3.14*205000/2000)4*337.894X104*1.752X10^10) =2.48X108 My = Sz*FYLD = (1086.96X104X2/150) *300 =43478400. Since Mu > 0.65My, Moment of resistance Mrz2 = 1.15*0.9*43478400*(1-0.28*43478400/2.48X108) =42791153.71 N-mm = 42.79 KN-m. Mrz2 should not be more than Mrz1. Since, Mrz2 > Mrz1 in this example, Mrz2 = Mrz1. Mrz2 = 36549327.6 N-mm = 36.549 KN-m
200 STAAD.Pro
Comparison
Hand Calculation Axial compressive resistance Major axis bending resistance Minor axis bending resistance 521.73 KN 36.549KNm 10.363 KNm STAAD.Pro Result 5.219X102 KN Comments
Negligible difference.
**************************************************** * * * STAAD.PRO V8I SELECTSERIES2 * * VERSION 20.07.07.XX * * PROPRIETARY PROGRAM OF * * BENTLEY SYSTEMS, INC. * * DATE= AUG 17, 2010 * * TIME= 17: 6:23 * * * * USER ID: BENTLEY * ****************************************************
1. STAAD SPACE VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 5-91 INPUT FILE: S-16-01 VERIFICATION EXAMPLE.STD 2. START JOB INFORMATION 3. ENGINEER DATE 16-FEB-10 4. END JOB INFORMATION 5. * CISC EXAMPLE 1 PAGE 5-91, LIMIT STATES DESIGN, CSA-S16.1-94 6. * SIMPLY SUPPORTED BEAM WITH UNIFORM LOAD 7. * LIVE LOAD DEFLECTION OF L/300 8. UNIT MMS KN 9. JOINT COORDINATES 10. 1 0 0 0; 2 2000 0 0 11. MEMBER INCIDENCES
12. 1 1 2 13. START USER TABLE 14. TABLE 1 15. UNIT METER KN 16. WIDE FLANGE 17. SECT_CLASS-4 18. 0.002766 0.15 0.007 0.15 0.006 1.08696E-005 3.37894E-006 3.7378E-008 19. 0.00105 0.0018 20. END 21. UNIT METER KN 22. DEFINE MATERIAL START 23. ISOTROPIC MATERIAL1 24. E 2.05E+008 25. POISSON 0.3 26. ISOTROPIC STEEL 27. E 2.05E+008 28. POISSON 0.3 29. DENSITY 76.8195 30. ALPHA 1.2E-005 31. DAMP 0.03 32. END DEFINE MATERIAL 33. MEMBER PROPERTY 34. 1 UPTABLE 1 SECT_CLASS-4 35. UNIT MMS KN 36. CONSTANTS 37. MATERIAL STEEL ALL 38. SUPPORTS 39. 1 FIXED 40. UNIT METER KN 41. LOAD 1 LC1 42. MEMBER LOAD 43. 1 UNI GY -3 44. 1 UNI GZ -3 45. JOINT LOAD 46. 2 FX -8 47. PERFORM ANALYSIS
P R O B L E M S T A T I S T I C S ----------------------------------NUMBER OF JOINTS/MEMBER+ELEMENTS/SUPPORTS = 1 2/
1/
SOLVER USED IS THE IN-CORE ADVANCED SOLVER TOTAL PRIMARY LOAD CASES = DOM = 6 1, TOTAL DEGREES OF FREE-
48. LOAD LIST 1 49. PRINT MEMBER FORCES LIST 1 VERIFICATION CISC 1994 HANDBOOK EXAMPLE PAGE 5-91 -- PAGE NO. 3
202 STAAD.Pro
MEMBER END FORCES ----------------ALL UNITS ARE -- KN MEMBER MOM-Y LOAD JT MOM-Z
1 -6.00 0.00
1 6.00 2 0.00
8.00 -8.00
6.00 0.00
6.00 0.00
0.00 0.00
PARAMETER 1 CODE CANADIAN CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL CHECK CODE ALL
********************************************
MET
RESULT/ FX
=======================================================================
1 ST 1
0.760 6.00
0.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 2.77E+01 2.00E+02 IZ = 1.09E+03 SZ = 1.45E+02 IY = 3.38E+02 SY = 4.51E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = PZ = PY = 1.63E+02 6.92E+01
IX =
3.74E+00
CW =
1.75E+04
EFFECTIVE MEMBER PROPERTIES FOR CLASS-4 SECTION(UNIT = CM) --------------------------------------------------------EFFECTIVE CROSS SECTION AREA = 2.63E+01 EFFECTIVE IZ = 1.02E+03 EFFECTIVE SZ = EFFECTIVE IY = 2.66E+02 EFFECTIVE SY = EFFECTIVE YILED STRESS = 256.0 MPA
1.35E+02 3.85E+01
COMPRESSIVE CAPACITIES FOR CLASS 4 SECTION(UNIT = MPA) -----------------------------------------------------BASED ON EFFECTIVE AREA CR1 = 7.098E+02 CR2 = CTORFLX = 5.582E+02
5.582E+02
CRZ =
6.705E+02
BASED ON EFFECTIVE YIELD STRENGTH CR1 = 6.373E+02 CR2 = 5.219E+02 CTORFLX = 5.219E+02
CRZ =
6.084E+02
SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CR1 = 6.373E+02 CR2 = 5.219E+02 SECTION CLASS 4 CRZ = 6.084E+02 CTORFLX = 5.219E+02 TENSILE CAPACITY = 7.300E+02 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 5.219E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 1.038E+01 MRZ = 3.657E+01 MU = 2.486E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 1.871E+02 VRZ = 3.208E+02
MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 57.222 KL/RZ = 31.904 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 200.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 2.000
204 STAAD.Pro
OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.75 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 6.000E+00 Z AXIS = 6.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 1.97E+01 56. FINISH
*********** END OF THE STAAD.PRO RUN *********** **** DATE= AUG 17,2010 TIME= 17: 6:28 ****
************************************************************ * FOR QUESTIONS ON STAAD.PRO, PLEASE CONTACT * * BENTLEY SYSTEMS OFFICES AT THE FOLLOWING LOCATIONS * * * * TELEPHONE WEB / EMAIL * * * * USA: +1 (714)974-2500 * * UK +44(1454)207-000 * * SINGAPORE +65 6225-6158 * * EUROPE +31 23 5560560 * * INDIA +91(033)4006-2021 * * JAPAN +81(03)5952-6500 HTTP://WWW.CTCG.CO.JP * * CHINA +86 10 5929 7000 * * THAILAND +66(0)2645-1018/19 PARTHA.P@REISOFTWARETH.COM * * * * WORLDWIDE HTTP://SELECTSERVICES.BENTLEY.COM/EN-US/ * * * ************************************************************
206 STAAD.Pro
Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94
3C.1 General
Provisions of CSA S136-94, including revisions dated May, 1995, have been implemented. The program allows design of single (non-composite) members in tension, compression, bending, shear, as well as their combinations. For laterally supported members in bending, the Initiation of Yielding method has been used. Cold work of forming strengthening effects have been included as an option.
Channel with Lips Channel without Lips Angle with Lips Angle without Lips Z with Lips Z without Lips Hat
Shape selection may be done using the member property pages of the graphical user interface (GUI) or by specifying the section designation symbol in the input file. The properties listed in the tables are gross section properties. STAAD.Pro uses unreduced section properties in the structure analysis stage. Both unreduced and effective section properties are used in the design stage, as applicable.
Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94
a. Code Checking The program compares the resistance of members with the applied load effects, in accordance with CSA 136. Code checking is carried out for locations specified via the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter. The results are presented in a form of a PASS/FAIL identifier and a RATIO of load effect to resistance for each member checked. You may choose the degree of detail in the output data by setting the TRACK parameter. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. b. Member Selection You may request that the program search the cold formed steel shapes database (AISI standard sections) for alternative members that pass the code check and meet the least weight criterion. In addition, a minimum and/or maximum acceptable depth of the member may be specified. The program will then evaluate all database sections of the type initially specified (i.e., channel, angle, etc.) and, if a suitable replacement is found, present design results for that section. If no section satisfying the depth restrictions or lighter than the initial one can be found, the program leaves the member unchanged, regardless of whether it passes the code check or not. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. The program calculates effective section properties in accordance with Clauses 5.6.2.1 through 3 and 5.6.2.6 through 8. Cross-sectional properties and overall slenderness of members are checked for compliance with
l
Clause 5.3, Maximum Effective Slenderness Ratio for members in Compression Clause 5.4, Maximum Flat Width Ratios for Elements in Compression Clause 5.5, Maximum Section Depths.
The program will check member strength in accordance with Clause 6 of the Standard as follows:
208 STAAD.Pro
Resistance factors listed in Clauses 6.2 (a), (b), and (e) are used, as applicable. Members in tension - Resistance is calculated in accordance with Clauses 6.3.1 and 6.3.2. Members in bending and shear
6.4.1 General, 6.4.2 and 6.4.2.1 Laterally Supported Members, compressive limit stress based on Initiation of Yielding, 6.4.3 Laterally Unsupported Members, 6.4.4 Channels and Z-Shaped Members with Unstiffened Flanges - additional limitations, 6.4.5 Shear in Webs, 6.4.6 Combined Bending and Shear in Webs. Members in compression Resistance calculations are based on Clauses:
o o o o o
6.6.1.1, 6.6.1.2 (a) and (d), and 6.6.1.3 General, 6.6.2 Sections Not Subject to Torsional-Flexural Buckling, 6.6.3 Singly Symmetric Sections, 6.6.4 Point-Symmetric Sections, 6.6.5 Cylindrical Tubular Sections.
Members in compression and bending Resistance calculations are based on Clause 6.7.1, Singly and Doubly Symmetric Sections. Input for the coefficients of uniform bending must be provided.
Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94
Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 3C.1 - Canadian Cold Formed Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified S136. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BEAM
1.0
When this parameter is set to 1.0 (default), the adequacy of the member is determined by checking a total of 13 equally spaced locations along the length of the member. If the BEAM value is 0.0, the 13 location check is not conducted, and instead, checking is done only at the locations specified by the SECTION command (See STAAD manual for details). If neither the BEAM parameter nor any SECTION command is specified, STAAD will terminate the run and ask the user to provide one of those 2 commands. This rule is not enforced for TRUSS members. Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending W . See CSA 136, 6.7.2. z Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0.
CMZ
1.0
210 STAAD.Pro
Description
Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending W . See CSA 136, 6.7.2. y Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0. Specifies whether the cold work of forming strengthening effect should be included in resistance computation. See CSA 136, 5.2. 0. effect should not be included 1. effect should be included
CWY
DMAX
1000.0
Maximum depth permissible for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units. Minimum depth required for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units. Specifies whether torsionalflexural buckling restraint is provided or is not necessary for the member. See CSA 136, 6.6.2 0. Section subject to torsional flexural buckling and restraint not provided 1. restraint provided or unnecessary
DMIN
0.0
FLX
FU FYLD
Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. Yield strength of steel in current units.
Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94 Parameter Name KT Default Value 1.0 Description
Effective length factor for torsional buckling. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall column buckling about the local Yaxis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Unbraced length for twisting. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression.
KY
1.0
KZ
1.0
LT
Member length
212 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name LY
Description
Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Y-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Net section factor for tension members, See CSA 136, 6.3.1. Spacing in the longitudinal direction of shear stiffeners for stiffened flat webs. It is input in the current units of length. See section CSA 136, 6.4.5
LZ
Member length
NSF STIFF
Canadian Codes - Design Per Canadian Cold Formed Steel Code S136-94 Parameter Name TRACK 0 Default Value Description
This parameter is used to control the level of detail in which the design output is reported in the output file. The allowable values are: 0. Prints only the member number, section name, ratio, and PASS/FAIL status. 1. Prints the design summary in addition to that printed by TRACK 1 2. Prints member and material properties in addition to that printed by TRACK 2.
TSA
Specifies whether bearing and intermediate transverse stiffeners satisfy the requirements of CSA 136, 6.5. If true, the program uses the more liberal set of interaction equations in 6.4.6. 0. stiffeners do not comply with 6.5 1. stiffeners comply with 6.5
214 STAAD.Pro
from the built-in table. The assignment is done with the help of the PRISMATIC option (Refer to Section 5.20 of the Technical Reference Manual)
Douglas Fir-Larch
The following example illustrates the specification of Douglas Fir-Larch species combination.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST DFL_SELSTR_2X2_BM
Hem-Fir
Designation of Hem-Fir species combination in STAAD is as follows.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST HEM-FIR_SELSTR_2X10_BM
Northern Species
Designation of Northern species combination in STAAD is as follows.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST NORTHERN_SELSTR_3X12_BM
216 STAAD.Pro
Spruce-Pine-Fir
Designation of Spruce-Pine-Fir species combination in STAAD is as follows.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST SPF_SELSTR_3X8_BM
UNIT FEET POUND JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 6 0 0; 3 12 0 0; 4 18 0 0; 5 24 0 0; 6 6 3 0; 7 12 6 0; 8 18 3 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; 2 2 3; 3 3 4; 4 4 5; 5 1 6; 6 6 7; 7 7 8; 8 8 5; 9 2 6; 10 3 7; 11 4 8; 12 6 3; 13 3 8; UNIT FEET POUND DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM E 1224 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY TIM CAN 1 TO 4 9 TO 11 TABLE ST SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM 5 TO 8 12 13 TABLE ST SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM CONSTANTS MATERIAL SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM MEMB 1 TO 4 9 TO 11 MATERIAL SPF_SELSTR_4X10_BM MEMB 5 TO 8 12 13 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH
218 STAAD.Pro
a. KD = Load duration factor (Clause 4.3.2.2-CSA086-01, Table 4.3.2.2) b. KH = System factor(Clause 5.4.4 and 6.4.3 and Table 5.4.4 -CSA086-01) c. K_T = Treatment factor(Clause 5.4.3 and 6.4.4 -CSA086-01) d. KSB = Service condition factor applicable to Bending at extreme fibre (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 -CSA086-01) e. KSV = Service condition factor applicable to longitudinal shear (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) f. KSC = Service condition factor applicable to Compression parallel to the grain (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) g. K_SCP = Service condition factor applicable to Compression perpendicular to the grain (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) h. KSE = Service condition factor applicable to modulus of elasticity (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) i. KST = Service condition factor applicable to tension parallel to the grain (Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2 CSA086-01) j. KZB = Size factor applicable to bending (Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 CSA086-01) k. KZV = size factor applicable to shear(Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 -CSA08601) l. KZT = size factor applicable to tension parallel to grain (Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 -CSA086-01) m. KZCP = size factor applicable to compression perpendicular to grain (Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 -CSA086-01) n. K_ZC = size factor applicable to compression parallel to grain (Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5 -CSA086-01) o. CHIX = Curvature factor (Clause 6.5.6.5.2-CSA086-01) p. CV = shear load coefficient (Table 6.5.7.4A- CSA086-01) q. KN = Notch factor(Clause 5.5.5.4-CSA086-01) All of these factors must be specified as input according to the classification of timber and stress grade.
Explained here is the procedure adopted in STAAD for calculating the member resistances.
Axial Tension
i. For Sawn timber The criterion governing the capacity of tension members is based on one limit state. The limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area. The net section area may be specified by the user through the use of the parameter NSF (see Table 3B.1). STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on this limit state per Clause 5.5.9 of CSA08601. ii. For Glulam timber The design of glulam tension members differs from sawn timber since CSA 086-01 assigns different specified strength for gross and net section. The specified strength at net section is slightly higher than the strength of the gross section. Therefore, Glulam tension members are designed based on two limit states. The first one is the limit state of yielding in the gross section. The second limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area. The net-section area may be specified by the user through the use of the parameter NSF (see Table 3B.1). STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on these two limits states per Clause.6.5.11 of CSA086-01.
Axial Compression
The compressive resistance of columns is determined based on Clause.5.5.6 and Clause.6.5.8.4 of CSA086-01. The equations presented in this section of the code assume that the compressive resistance is a function of the compressive strength of the gross section (Gross section Area times the Yield Strength) as well as the slenderness factor (Kc). The effective length for the calculation of compression resistance may be provided through the use of the parameters KX, KY, KZ, LX, LY and LZ (see Table 3B.1).
220 STAAD.Pro
Bending
The bending resistance of Sawn members are determined based on Clause 5.5.4 of CSA086-01 and for glulam members are determined based on Clause 6.5.6.5 of CSA086-01. The allowable stress in bending is multiplied by Lateral stability factor, KL to take in account whether lateral support is provided at points of bearing to prevent lateral displacement and rotation
Shear
The shear resistance of the cross section is determined using the equations of Clause 5.5.5 and 6.5.7.2 of the code. Once this is obtained, the ratio of the shear force acting on the cross section to the shear resistance of the section is calculated. If any of the ratios (for both local Y & Z axes) exceed 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 3B.1), the section is considered to have failed under shear.
the program and thus allows the engineer to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 3D.1 - Canadian Timber Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as TIMBERCANADIAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.51.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
CHIX CV KD KH KN KSB
Curvature Factor for Compression [Clause 6.5.6.5.2] Shear Load Coefficient [Table 6.5.7.4A] Load Duration Factor [Clause.4.3.2, Table 4.3.2] System Factor [Clause 5.4.4/6.4.3, Table 5.4.4] Notch Factor [Clause 5.4.7.2.2] Service Condition Factor for Bending at Extreme Fibre Applicable for bending at extreme fibre [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]
222 STAAD.Pro
Description
Service Condition Factor for Compression, Applicable for compression parallel to grain [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]
KSE
1.0
Service Condition Factor for Modulus of Elasticity, Applicable for modulus of elasticity [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]
KST
1.0
Service Condition Factor for Tension, Applicable for tension parallel to grain [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]
KSV
1.0
Service Condition Factor for Shear, Applicable for longitudinal shear [Table 5.4.2 and 6.4.2]
KX KY KZ KZB
K value for flexural torsional buckling K value in local Y-axis, usually minor axis K value in local Z-axis, usually major axis Size Factor for Bending, Applicable for bending [Clause.5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5]
KZCP
1.0
Size Factor for Compression, Applicable for compression perpendicular to grain [Clause .5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5]
Canadian Codes - Wood Design Per CSA Standard CAN/CSA-086-01 Parameter Name KZT Default Value 1.0 Description
Size Factor for Tension, Applicable for tension parallel to grain [Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5]
KZV K_SCP
1.0 1.0
Size Factor for Shear [Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5] Service Condition Factor for Compression, Applicable for compression perpendicular to grain [Clause 5.4.2 and Table 6.4.2]
K_T K_ZC
1.0 1.0
Treatment Factor [Clause 5.4.3/6.4.4] Size Factor for Compression, Applicable for compression parallel to grain [Clause 5.4.5 and Table 5.4.5]
LX LY LZ NSF RATIO
Length for flexural torsional buckling Length in local Y axis for slenderness value KL/r Length in local Z axis for slenderness value KL/r Net section factor for tension members Permissible Ratio of Actual to Allowable Value
224 STAAD.Pro
226 STAAD.Pro
Problem
To determine the Canadian Glulam section column in axial compression, with design per Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01 . Column is effectively pinned at both ends and braced at mid-height in all direction.
Given
Length = 9000 mm
Comparison
Table 3D.2 - CAN/CSA-086-01 Verification Problem 1 Source Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Design Strength (kN) 295 293.793 0.43% (Negligible)
Input File
This file is included in as \STAAD\EXAMP\CAN\CANADA_GLULAMCOLUMN.STD.
STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR GLULAM DESIGN INPUT FILE: GLULAMCOLUMN.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 10-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79
UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 9 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; UNIT INCHES KIP DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-12C-E E 9.7 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 1.44676E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 PRIS YD 0.748031 ZD 0.574147 UNIT INCHES KIP CONSTANTS MATERIAL GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-12C-E MEMB 1 SUPPORTS 1 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FY -214 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KY 0.5 ALL KZ 0.5 ALL
228 STAAD.Pro
| ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 413.943 | | PZ = 293.793 | | T = 0.000 | | MY = 0.000 | | MZ = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | SLENDERNESS = 50.000 | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------|
Verification Problem: 2
Objective:- To determine the bending capacity of a Canadian Glulam section single span floor beam. The compression edge assumed fully supported. Design Code:- Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference: - Example 2, page 59, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given:- Length =7500mm, Beam Spacing = 5000mm, Standard load condition, Dry service condition, Untreated Comparison: Solution Design Strength in bending (kNm) 208 208.323 0.155% Design Strength in shear (kN) 101 100.776 -0.221 %
STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR GLULAM DESIGN INPUT FILE: GLULAMBEAM.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 10-JUN-05
230 STAAD.Pro
END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 7.5 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 UNIT INCHES KIP DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-12C-E E 9.7 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 1.44676E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 ISOTROPIC GLT_D.FIR-L-20F-E E 12.4 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 1.44676E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 ISOTROPIC CONCRETE E 3150 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 8.68E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 DAMP 0.05 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 PRIS YD 2.11942 ZD 0.426508 UNIT INCHES KIP
CONSTANTS MATERIAL GLT_D.FIR-L-20F-E MEMB 1 SUPPORTS 1 2 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -27.1 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
*********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================== 1 130.00X646.00 CANADIAN GLULAM GRADE:GLT_D.FIR-L-20F-E FAIL CL.5.5.5/6.5. 1.008 1 0.00 T 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 7500.000 LEY = 7500.000 LUZ = 7500.000 LUY = 7500.000mm | | |
232 STAAD.Pro
| KD = 1.000 KH = 1.000 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 1.000 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 1.000 | | KZV = 1.000 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.000 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) | | Pu = 0.000 | | Tu = 0.000 | | Muy = 0.000 | | Muz = 0.000 | | V = 101.625 | | SLENDERNESS_Y = 16.932 | | SLENDERNESS_Z = 1.529 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 0.000 | | PZ = 0.000 | | T = 0.000 | | MY = 41.923 | | MZ = 208.323 | | V = 100.776 | | SLENDERNESS = 50.000 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| 46. FINISH
Verification Problem: 3
Objective:- To determine the capacity of a Canadian Glulam section in axial tension. Design Code: - Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference:- Example 3, page 158, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given:- Dry service condition, Untreated Comparison: Solution Design Strength in Tension (kN) 257 256.636 -0.141 %
STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR GLULAM DESIGN INPUT FILE: GLULAMTENSION.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 10-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 9 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 UNIT INCHES KIP DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-14T-E
234 STAAD.Pro
E 10.7 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 1.44676E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 ISOTROPIC CONCRETE E 3150 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 8.68E-005 ALPHA 5.5E-006 DAMP 0.05 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 PRIS YD 0.872702 ZD 0.262467 UNIT INCHES KIP CONSTANTS MATERIAL GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-14T-E MEMB 1 SUPPORTS 1 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FY 250 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KY 0.5 ALL KZ 0.5 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Relevant portion of Output: STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (S086) *********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================== 1 80.00X266.00 CANADIAN GLULAM GRADE:GLT_SPRUCE-PINE-14T-E PASS CL.5.5.10/6.5 0.974 1 250.00 T 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 4500.000 LEY = 4500.000 LUZ = 9000.000 LUY = 9000.000mm | | | | KD = 1.000 KH = 1.000 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 1.000 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 1.000 | | KZV = 1.000 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.000 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) | | Pu = 0.000 | | Tu = -250.000 | | Muy = 0.000 | | Muz = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 0.000 |
236 STAAD.Pro
Verification Problem: 4
Objective:- To determine the Canadian Sawn section column in axial compression. Column is effectively pinned at both ends. Design Code: - Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference:- Example 2, page 113, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given: - Unbraced Length = 5000mm Comparison: Solution Design Strength (kN) 130 129.223 -0.597 %
STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR DIMENSIONAL LUMBER INPUT FILE: SAWN_ LUMBER_ COLUMN.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 08-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT FEET POUND JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 16.4042 0
MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC DFL_NO2_8X8_POST E 1.368E+006 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT METER KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL DFL_NO2_8X8_POST MEMB 1 UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 TABLE ST DFL_NO2_8X8_POST SUPPORTS 1 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 DEAD+LIVE LOAD JOINT LOAD 2 FY -114 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KSC 0.91 ALL K_ZC 1.05 ALL CHECK CODE FINISH
*********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION
========================================================= 1 ST DFL_NO2_8X8_POST PASS CL.5.5.10/6.5.12 0.882 1 114.00 C 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 5000.000 LEY = 5000.000 LUZ = 5000.000 LUY = 5000.000mm | | | | KD = 1.000 KH = 1.000 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 0.910 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 1.000 | | KZV = 1.000 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.050 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) | | Pu = 114.000 | | Tu = 0.000 | | Muy = 0.000 | | Muz = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | SLENDERNESS_Y = 26.178 | | SLENDERNESS_Z = 26.178 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 129.223 |
Verification Problem: 5
Objective: - To determine the bending capacity of a Canadian sawn section single span floor beam. Design Code: - Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference:- Example 1, page 58, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given:- Length =6000mm, Beam Spacing = 3000mm, Standard load condition, Dry service condition, Untreated Comparison: Solution Design Strength in bending (kNm) 79.8 79.732 -0.085% Design Strength in shear (kN) 46.1 46.170 No
STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR DIMENSIONAL LUMBER: SAWN_ LUMBER_BEAM.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 08-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN
240 STAAD.Pro
JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 6 0 0; 3 3 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 3; 2 3 2; UNIT FEET POUND DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC DFL_NO1_10X16_BM E 1.728E+006 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT METER KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL DFL_NO1_10X16_BM MEMB 1 2 UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 2 TABLE ST DFL_NO1_10X16_BM SUPPORTS 1 2 FIXED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 DEAD+LIVE LOAD MEMBER LOAD 1 2 UNI GY -16.4 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KD 1.0 ALL K_T 1.0 ALL KSB 1.0 ALL
KZB 0.90 ALL KZV 0.90 ALL K_ZC 1.05 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================== 2 ST DFL_NO1_10X16_BM FAIL CL.5.5.5/6.5.6 1.066 1 0.00 T 0.00 49.20 3.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 3000.000 LEY = 3000.000 LUZ = 3000.000 LUY = 3000.000mm | | | | KD = 1.000 KH = 1.000 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 1.000 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 0.900 | | KZV = 0.900 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.050 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) | | Pu = 0.000 | | Tu = 0.000 | | Muy = 0.000 |
242 STAAD.Pro
| Muz = 49.200 | | V = -49.200 | | SLENDERNESS_Y = 4.511 | | SLENDERNESS_Z = 2.158 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 0.000 | | PZ = 0.000 | | T = 0.000 | | MY = 79.800 | | MZ = 79.732 | | V = 46.170 | | SLENDERNESS = 50.000 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|
Verification Problem: 6
Objective:- To determine the capacity of a Canadian Sawn section in axial tension. Design Code: - Canadian wood design code (CSA:086-01) Reference:- Example 2, page 158, Canadian Wood Design Manual, 2001 Given:- Dry service condition, Untreated Comparison: Solution Design Strength in Tension (kN) 185 184.338 -0.357 %
STAAD PLANE EXAMPLE FOR DIMENSIONAL LUMBER SAWN_ LUMBER_TENSION.STD START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 08-JUN-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT FEET POUND JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 16.4042 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC DFL_NO1_6X8_BM E 1.728E+006 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 25 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT METER KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL DFL_NO1_6X8_BM MEMB 1 UNIT FEET POUND MEMBER PROPERTY TIMBER CANADIAN 1 TABLE ST DFL_NO1_6X8_BM SUPPORTS 1 PINNED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 DEAD+LIVE LOAD JOINT LOAD 2 FY 144 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK
244 STAAD.Pro
PARAMETER CODE TIMBER CANADIAN KH 1.1 ALL KSC 0.91 ALL K_ZC 1.05 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
*********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) MEMBER TABLE RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION
========================================================= 1 ST DFL_NO1_6X8_BM PASS CL.5.5.10/6.5.12 0.781 1 144.00 T 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | LEZ = 5000.000 LEY = 5000.000 LUZ = 5000.000 LUY = 5000.000mm | | | | KD = 1.000 KH = 1.100 KT = 1.000 KSB = 1.000 KSV = 1.000 | | KSC = 0.910 K_SCP = 1.000 KSE = 1.000 KST = 1.000 KZB = 1.000 | | KZV = 1.000 KZT = 1.000 KZCP = 1.000 K_ZC = 1.050 CHIX = 1.000 | | CV = 1.000 KN = 1.000 | | | | ACTUAL LOADS : (KN-m) |
| Pu = 0.000 | | Tu = -144.000 | | Muy = 0.000 | | Muz = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | | ALLOWABLE CAPACITIES OF THE SECTION: (KN-m) | | PY = 0.000 | | PZ = 0.000 | | T = 184.338 | | MY = 0.000 | | MZ = 0.000 | | V = 0.000 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|
246 STAAD.Pro
Section 4
Chinese Codes
248 STAAD.Pro
For Beams Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, Tee, and Trapezoidal) For Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)
will be done accordingly. In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 350 mm diameter. The third set numbers in the above example represents a T-shape with 750 mm flange width, 200 width, 400 mm overall depth and 100 mm flange depth (See section 6.20.2). The program will determine whether the section is rectangular, flanged or circular and the beam or column design.
250 STAAD.Pro
Description
BEAM DESIGN A value of 1.0 means the effect of axial force will be taken into account for beam design. COLUMN DESIGN A value of 1.0 means the column is unbraced about major axis. A value of 2.0 means the column is unbraced about minor axis. A value of 3.0 means the column is unbraced about both axis.
CLEAR
25 mm 40 mm
For beam members. For column members Total depth to be used for design. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
DEPTH
YD
ELZ
1.0
ELY
1.0
Parameter Name FC
Description
FYMAIN
210 N/mm2
FYSEC
210 N/mm2
Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. Maximum main reinforcement bar size.
MAXMAIN
60 mm
MAXSEC
12 mm
MINMAIN
10 mm
MINSEC
8 mm
RATIO
4.0
REINF
0.0
RFACE
4.0
A value of 4.0 means longitudinal reinforcement in column is arranged equally along 4 faces. A value of 2.0 invokes 2 faced distribution about major axis. A value of 3.0 invokes 2 faced distribution about minor axis.
252 STAAD.Pro
Description
BEAM DESIGN: 0.0 = , output consists of reinforcement details at START, MIDDLE and END. 1.0 = critical moments are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2.0 = required steel for intermediate sections defined by NSECTION are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. COLUMN DESIGN: 0.0 = reinforcement details are printed. 1.0 = column interaction analysis results are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2.0 = a schematic interaction diagram and intermediate interaction values are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output 9.0 = details of section capacity calculations.
Default Value ZD
Description
Width to be used for design. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
254 STAAD.Pro
consideration), user has the choice of printing reinforcements provided by STAAD at 11 equally spaced sections from which the final detail drawing can be prepared.
| 0.00 -25.68 1.23 4 | 400.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 27.97 1.23 4 | 0.00 -16.05 1.23 4 | 800.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 25.12 1.23 4 | 0.00 -7.17 1.23 4 | 1200.0 | 0.00 0.97 0.49 5 | 21.11 1.23 4 | 0.00 -0.14 1.32 6 | 1600.0 | 0.00 6.77 1.23 4 | 15.93 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 2000.0 | 0.00 11.06 1.23 4 | 9.59 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 2400.0 | 0.00 13.04 1.23 4 | 2.08 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 2800.0 | 0.00 12.45 1.23 4 | -5.43 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 3200.0 | 0.00 9.55 1.23 4 | -11.77 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 3600.0 | 0.00 4.73 1.23 4 | -16.95 1.23 4 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | 4000.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 4 | -25.48 1.23 4 | 0.00 -17.36 1.23 4 | ---------------------------------------------------------------------------SUMMARY OF REINF. AREA (Sq.mm) ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
256 STAAD.Pro
SECTION 0.0 mm 1000.0 mm 2000.0 mm 3000.0 mm 4000.0 mm ---------------------------------------------------------------------------TOP 259.04 161.29 0.00 0.00 176.31 REINF. (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) BOTTOM 0.00 160.78 160.78 160.78 0.00 REINF. (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) (Sq. mm) ---------------------------------------------------------------------------SUMMARY OF PROVIDED REINF. AREA ---------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION 0.0 mm 1000.0 mm 2000.0 mm 3000.0 mm 4000.0 mm ---------------------------------------------------------------------------TOP 4-10 3-10 2-10 2-10 3-10 REINF. 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) BOTTOM 2-12 2-12 2-12 2-12 2-12 REINF. 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) 1 layer(s) SHEAR 2 legged 8 2 legged 8 2 legged 8 2 legged 8 2 legged 8 REINF. @ 100 mm c/c @ 100 mm c/c @ 100 mm c/c @ 100 mm c/c @ 100 mm c/c ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
=====================================================
258 STAAD.Pro
DESIGN AXIAL FORCE (Pu) : 62.0 About Z About Y INITIAL MOMENTS : 2.21 32.29 MOMENTS DUE TO MINIMUM ECC. : 1.24 1.24 SLENDERNESS RATIOS : 12.00 12.00 MOMENTS DUE TO SLENDERNESS EFFECT : 1.12 1.12 MOMENT REDUCTION FACTORS : 1.00 1.00 ADDITION MOMENTS (Maz and May) : 1.12 1.12 TOTAL DESIGN MOMENTS : 3.32 33.40 REQD. STEEL AREA : 1822.71 Sq.mm. MAIN REINFORCEMENT : Provide 17 - 12 dia. (3.92%, 1922.65 Sq.mm.) (Equally distributed) TIE REINFORCEMENT : Provide 8 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 190 mm c/c SECTION CAPACITY (KNS-MET) -------------------------Puz : 992.70 Muz1 : 36.87 Muy1 : 36.87 INTERACTION RATIO: 1.00
=====================================================
260 STAAD.Pro
using the User Table facility. For more information on these facilities, refer to the STAAD Program Technical Reference manual.
I Shapes
I shaped sections are designated in the following way.
1 TO 5 15 16 TABLE ST I22B
H Shapes
H shaped sections are designated in the following way.
6 TO 8 TABLE ST HW250X250
T Shapes
T shaped sections are designated in the following way.
24 25 33 TO 36 TABLE ST TM244X300
Channels
Channels are specified in the following way.
262 STAAD.Pro
29 30 TABLE ST CH25A
Double Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without a spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel.
11 TABLE D CH22B 17 TABLE D CH40C SP 0.15
In the above set of commands, member 11 is a back-to-back double channel CH22B with no spacing in between. Member 17 is a double channel CH40C with a spacing of 0.15 length units between the channels.
Angles
Two types of specifications may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
19 TABLE ST L100X100X7
Two types of specifications may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
27 TABLE RA L40X25X3
The above section signifies an angle with legs of length 40mm and 25mm and a leg thickness of 3 mm. This specification may be used when the local Z axis corresponds to the z-z axis specified in Chapter 2. If the local Y axis corresponds to the z-z axis, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) may be used.
Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by means of input of the words SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose.
22 TABLE LD L56X36X3
In the second method, tubes are specified by their dimensions. For example,
13 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0.15 WT 0.8 DT 0.6
is a tube that has a height of 0.6 length units, width of 0.6 length units, and a wall thickness of 0.15 length units.
In the second method, pipe sections may be provided by specifying the word PIPE followed by the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
9 10 14 18 23 26 TABLE ST PIPE OD 0.6 ID 0.55
specifies a pipe with outside diameter of 0.6 length units and inside diameter of .55 length units. Sample File Containing Chinese Shapes
264 STAAD.Pro
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 04-AUG-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 4 0 0; 3 9 0 0; 4 0 0 4; 5 4 0 4; 6 0 0 8; 7 4 0 8; 8 9 0 8; 9 0 3.5 0; 10 4 3.5 0; 11 9 3.5 0; 12 0 3.5 4; 13 4 3.5 4; 14 0 3.5 8; 15 4 3.5 8; 16 9 3.5 8; 17 0 7 0; 18 4 7 0; 19 9 7 0; 20 0 7 4; 21 4 7 4; 22 0 7 8; 23 4 7 8; 24 9 7 8; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 9; 2 2 10; 3 3 11; 4 4 12; 5 5 13; 6 6 14; 7 7 15; 8 8 16; 9 9 17; 10 10 18; 11 11 19; 12 12 20; 13 13 21; 14 14 22; 15 15 23; 16 16 24; 17 9 10; 18 10 11; 19 12 13; 20 14 15; 21 15 16; 22 17 18; 23 18 19; 24 20 21; 25 22 23; 26 23 24; 27 9 12; 28 12 14; 29 10 13; 30 13 15; 31 11 16; 32 17 20; 33 20 22; 34 18 21; 35 21 23; 36 19 24; MEMBER PROPERTY CHINESE *I SHAPES 1 TO 5 15 16 TABLE ST I22B *H SHAPES 6 TO 8 TABLE ST HW250X250 *T SHAPES 24 25 33 TO 36 TABLE ST TM244X300 *CHANNELS 29 30 TABLE ST CH25A *DOUBLE CHANNELS 11 TABLE D CH22B 17 TABLE D CH40C SP 0.15 *ANGLES 19 TABLE ST L100X100X7
*DOUBLE ANGLES 27 TABLE RA L40X25X3 22 TABLE LD L56X36X3 32 TABLE SD L45X28X4 20 TABLE LD L56X36X3 SP 0.15 28 TABLE SD L56X36X4 SP 0.15 *TUBES 12 TABLE ST TUB100603.0 13 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0.15 WT 0.8 DT 0.6 *PIPES 21 31 TABLE ST PIP203X6.5 9 10 14 18 23 26 TABLE ST PIPE OD 0.6 ID 0.55 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH
266 STAAD.Pro
The allowable stress for members in compression is determined according to Table 3.4.1-1. Compressive resistance is a function of the slenderness of the crosssection (Kl/r ratio) and the user may control the slenderness value by modifying parameters such as KY, LY, KZ and LZ. The provisions of Section 5 are used to check the adequacy of sections in compression. Allowable stress for Bending and Shear Sections subjected to bending moments and shear forces are to be designed according to the provisions of section 4. The permissible bending compressive and tensile stresses are dependent on such factors as outstanding legs and thickness of flanges, unsupported length of the compression flange (UNL, defaults to member length) etc. Shear capacities are calculated according to Table 3.4.1-1 and Section 4 and are a function of web depth, web thickness etc. Users may use a value of 1.0 or 2.0 for the TRACK parameter to obtain a listing of the bending and shear capacities. Allowable stress for Combined Loading For members experiencing combined loading (axial force, bending and shear), applicable interaction formulas are checked at different locations of the member for all modeled loading situations. The procedure of Section 5 is implemented for combined axial load and bending.
Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 4B.1 - Chinese Steel Design GBJ 50017-2003 Parameters Parameter Name Default Value Definition Code Reference Notes
Design Code to follow. CODE CHINESE See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. -
BEAM
Beam parameter
0 = Perform design at ends and those locations specified in the section command. 1 = Perform design at ends and 1/12th section locations along member length.
150
Allowable KL/r value in compression Maximum allowable depth Minimum required depth
100 cm 0 cm
268 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Definition
Code Reference
Notes
The Following values represent the various grades of steel. Q235 -1 Q345 -2 Q390 -3 Q420 -4 KY 1 K value in local Yaxis, usually minor axis K value in local Zaxis, usually major axis Length in local Y axis for slenderness value KL/r Length in local Z axis for slenderness value KL/r Flag for controlling slenderness check -
GRADE
Grade of steel
Clause 3.4.1
KZ
LY
Default is selected beam's length Default is selected beam's length 0 = Check for slenderness.
LZ
MAIN
Chinese Codes - Steel Design Per GBJ 50017-2003 Parameter Name NSF Default Value 1 Definition Code Reference Notes
Net section factor for tension members Permissible ratio of actual to allowable stress Plasticity adaptation factor Y direction Plasticity adaptation factor Z direction Overall Stability factor for Y direction Overall Stability factor for Z direction -
RATIO
PFY
1.2
PFZ
1.05
SBY
SBZ
Stability factor for axial compression members shall be selected from appendix C based on its slenderness ratio, yield strength, classification of the section in Table 5.1.2-1 and Table 5.1.22
SFY
AppendixC
270 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Definition
Code Reference
Notes
SFZ
AppendixC
Stability factor for axial compression members shall be selected from appendix C based on its slenderness ratio, yield strength, classification of the section in Table 5.1.2-1 and Table 5.1.22 0 = Suppress critical member stress.
TENSION
300
TRACK
Track parameter
at every twelfth point along the beam, and the maximum moment about the major axis is used. When no sections are specified and the BEAM parameter is set to zero (default), design will be based on member start and end forces. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for further information on this feature.
Example
Sample Input data for Chinese Code Steel Design
UNIT METER PARAMETER CODE CHINESE NSF 0.85 ALL GRADE 3.0 MEMBER 7 KY 1.2 MEMBER 3 4 RATIO 0.9 ALL TRACK 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE AL
272 STAAD.Pro
Section 5
European Codes
274 STAAD.Pro
The current version of EC2 implemented in STAAD adheres to the factors and rules provided in EC2 and has not been modified by any National Application Documents.
5A.5 Columns
Columns are designed for axial compressive loads and possible moments at the ends of the member. If a particular load case causes tension in the column being designed that load case is ignored, the design proceeds with a warning message given to that affect. All active load cases will be considered in the design and reinforcements are assumed symmetrically arranged in the cross section. The maximum reinforcement calculated after all design load cases have been considered is then reported as the critical required area of reinforcement. Slender columns are also covered in the design process, the program will make due allowance for the additional moment that has to be considered in the design.
276 STAAD.Pro
Note: Sway type structures are not directly covered in the current implementation of EC2. This effect, however, can be accounted for by the PDELTA analysis option.
5A.6 Beams
Beams are designed for flexure, shear and torsion. For all these actions active load cases are scanned to create appropriate envelopes for the design process. Maximum torsional moment is also identified and incorporated in the design.
5A.7 Slabs
Slabs can only be designed for if finite elements are used to represent them in the model of the structure. In the main the design follows the same procedure as for flexure except that shear forces are assumed to be resisted without the provision of shear reinforcements. In cases where this may not be the case users must ensure that necessary checks are carried out. The output for the slab design refers to longitudinal reinforcements, which coincides with the local x direction of the element, and, transverse reinforcement, which coincides with the local y direction of the element. Also, reference is made to 'TOP' and BOTT' reinforcement which relates to the element's 'TOP' and 'BOTTOM' as determined from the connectivity of the element. This may not coincide with the slab's actual top and bottom and, if desired, you must ensure this through the numbering scheme of the elements. The design of the slab considers a fixed bar size of 16mm in both directions with the longitudinal bar being the layer closest to the slab exterior faces. Refer to Figure 1.21 in Section 1.61. of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information.
278 STAAD.Pro
Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 5A.1 - Concrete Design EC2 Parameters Parameter Name FYMAIN Default Value *460 N/mm2 Description
Yield Stress for main reinforcement (For slabs, it is for reinforcement in both directions) Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement. Applicable to shear bars in beams Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter. Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Face of support location at start of beam. (Only applicable for shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending ) Face of support location at end of beam.
FYSEC
*460N/mm2
FC MINMAIN
* 30N/mm2 8mm
MINSEC
8mm
CLEAR
* 20mm
MAXMAIN
50mm
SFACE
*0.0
EFACE
*0.0
European Codes - Concrete Design Per Eurocode EC2 Parameter Name Default Value Description
Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. TRACK 0.0 0.0 = Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1.0 = For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2.0 = Output of TRACK 1.0 List of design sag/hog moments and corresponding required steel area at each section of member MMAG NSECTION 1.0 10 Factor by which column design moments are magnified Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 20. Width of concrete member. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Depth of concrete member. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. 0.0 = Column braced in both directions. 1.0 = Column unbraced about local Z direction only
WIDTH
*ZD
DEPTH
*YD
BRACE
0.0
280 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
2.0 = Column unbraced about local Y direction only 3.0 = Column unbraced in both Y and Z directions ELY ELZ SRA 1.0 1.0 0.0 Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calculate Wood & Armer moments for design. A = Skew angle considered in Wood & Armer equations where A is the angle in degrees. SERV 0.0 0.0 = No serviceability check performed. 1.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were continuous. 2.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were simply supported. 3.0 = Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were cantilever beams. * Provided in current unit system
282 STAAD.Pro
Or
PARAMETERS CODE EURO
procedure to either code-check or select suitable members of an analyzed structure. The main steps in performing a design operation are: 1. Selecting the applicable load cases to be considered in the design process. 2. Providing appropriate Parameter values if different from the default values. 3. Specify whether to perform code-checking and/or member selection. These operations can be repeated by the user any number of times depending on the design requirements. The Parameters referred to above provide the user with the ability to allocate specific design properties to individual members or member groups considered in the design operation.
284 STAAD.Pro
5B.2(A) AnalysisMethodology
Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations.
Material coefficients for steel in STAAD take the following default values unless replaced by users numerical values provided in the input file. Modulus of Elasticity, E = 205000 N/mm2 Shear Modulus, G = E/2(1+ ) Poissons Ratio, = 0.3 Unit weight, = 76.8 KN/m3 The magnitude of design loads is dependent on , the partial safety factor for the f action under consideration. In STAAD the user is allowed total control in providing applicable values for the factors and their use in various load combinations.
286 STAAD.Pro
accordance with the code. The main requirement for a beam is to have sufficient cross-section resistance to the applied bending moment and shear force. The possibility of lateral-torsional buckling is also taken into consideration when the full length of the member has not been laterally restrained. The bending capacity is primarily a function of the section type and the material yield strength and is determined according to Cl. 5.4.5 of the code. The shear capacity and the corresponding shear checks are done as per section 5.4.6 of the code. There are four classes of cross-sections defined in EC3. Class 1 and 2 sections can both attain full capacity with the exception that the class 2 sections cannot sustain sufficient rotation required for plastic analysis of the model. Hence the full plastic section modulus is used in the design calculations. Class 3 sections, due to local buckling, cannot develop plastic moment capacity and the yield stress is limited to the extreme compression fibre of the section. The elastic section modulus is used to determine the moment capacity for class 3 sections. Class 4 sections do suffer from local buckling and explicit allowance must be made for the reduction in section properties before the moment capacity can be determined. Further, because of interaction between shear force and bending moment, the moment resistance of the cross-section may be reduced. This, however, does not occur unless the value of applied shear forces exceeds 50% of the plastic shear capacity of the section. In such cases the web is assumed to resist the applied shear force as well as contributing towards the moment resistance of the cross-section. As mentioned in the previous section, the design of class 4 sections is limited to WIDE FLANGE, TEE, SINGLE CHANNEL, SINGLE ANGLE, and RECTANGULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS. The effective section properties are worked out as described in Cl. 5.3.5 of the code. Beams are also checked for lateral-torsional buckling according to section 5.5.2 of the code. The buckling capacity is dependent on the section type as well as the unrestrained length, restraint conditions and type of applied loading. The lateral torsional buckling checks involves the calculation of the Elastic critical moment, Mcr, which is calculated in STAAD as per the method given in Annex F of the code. In the presence of a shear force, beams are also checked for shear as per section 5.4.6 of the code. In cases where the members are subject to combined bending and shear, the combined bending and shear checks are done in STAAD as per clause 5.4.7 of the code.
288 STAAD.Pro
is fixed by the connection and should be specified using the LEG parameter, see section 5B.6 for more information on the LEG parameter. The effective length in the a-a axis is taken as LY * KY and the effective length in the b-b axis as LZ * KZ. The following diagram shows the axes for angles which have been defined with either an ST or RA specification and is connected by its longer leg (i.e., a-a axis is parallel to the longer leg).
Figure 5.2 - Single angle sections A) STangle & USERtable angles and B) RAangle
compression fibre stress and calculating an effective applied moment for the section. The checks are done as per Cl. 5.5.3 of the code. In case of a combined axial compressive load and bending moment, the member will be checked as per the rules in section 5.5.4 of the code. The presence of large shear force can also reduce the bending resistance of the section under consideration. If the shear load is large enough to cause a reduction in bending resistance, then the reduction due to shear has to be taken into account before calculating the effect of the axial load on the bending resistance of the section. If the member is subject to a combined shear, axial load and bending moment then the section capacity checks will be done as per Cl. 5.4.9 of the code. As stated in the previous section, DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 does not specifically deal with single angle, double angles, double channels or Tee sections and does give a method to work out the slenderness of such members. In these cases, the EC3 DD design module of STAAD.Pro uses the methods specified in BS 59501:2000 to calculate the slenderness of these members. Cl. 4.7.10 of BS 59501:2000 is used in the current version of the EC3 DD design module. Please refer to the note in section 5B.5.2 for St and RA angle specifications. Please note that laced or battened compression members are not dealt within the current version of EC3 DD design module in STAAD.Pro.
290 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 3 Parameter to control the number of sections to checked along the length of a beam: 0. Check sections with end forces only 1. Check at location of maximum Mz along beam 2. Check sections with end forces and forces at location of BEAM1.0 check. 3. Check at every 1/13th point along the beam and report the maximum Refer to Note 2 below. CAN 0 Member will be considered as a cantilever type member for deflection checks. 0 indicates that member will not be treated as a cantilever member 1 indicates that the member will be treated as a cantilever member
European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3 Parameter Name CMM 1.0 Indicates type of loading on member. Valid values range from 1 to 6. Refer to Table 5B.2 for more information on its use. CMN 1.0 Indicates the level of EndRestraint. 1.0 = No fixity 0.5 = Full fixity 0.7 = One end free and other end fixed DMAX 100.0 cm Maximum allowable depth for the member. DMIN 0 Minimum required depth for the member. DFF None (Mandatory for deflection check) DJ1 Start Joint of member Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length". DJ2 End Joint of member Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length". FU Ultimate tensile strength of Deflection limit Default Value Description
292 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
steel GB1 1.1 Partial safety factor used in buckling checks for compression members GM0 1.1 Corresponds to the
m0
factor
factor
factor
in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 KY KZ LEG 1.0 1.0 0.0 K factor in local y axis. K factor in local z axis. Connection type Refer to Note 1 below. LVV Maximum of Lyy and Lzz (Lyy is a term used by BS5950) LY Member Length Compression length in local y axis, Slenderness ratio = (KY)*(LY)/(Ryy) LZ Member Length Compression length in local z axis, Slenderness ratio = (KZ)*(LZ)/(Rzz) Buckling length for angle about its principle axis
European Codes - Steel Design Per Eurocode 3 Parameter Name PY Yield Strength The yield strength default value is set based on the default value of the "SGR" parameter. NSF 1.0 Net tension factor for tension capacity calculation. RATIO 1 Permissible ratio of loading to capacity. SBLT 0.0 Indicates if the section is rolled or built-up. 0.0 = Rolled 1.0 = Built-up SGR 0.0 Steel grade as per table 3.1 in EC3. 0.0 = Fe 360 1.0 = Fe 430 2.0 = Fe 510 TRACK 0 Controls the level of detail of output. 0 = minimum 1 = intermediate 2 = maximum 4 = perform a deflection check Default Value Description
294 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
See note 3 below. UNF 1.0 Unsupported buckling length as a factor of the beam length UNL Member Length Unrestraint length of member used in calculating the lateraltorsional resistance moment of the member. ZIV 0.8 Specifies a reduction factor for vectoral effects to be used in axial tension checks [Cl 5.5.3(2)] Notes: 1. LEG (Ref: Table 25 BS5950) The slenderness of single and double angle, channel and tee sections are specified in BS 5950 table 25 depending on the connection provided at the end of the member (Refer to section 5B.5(A).2). To define the appropriate connection, a LEG parameter should be assigned to the member. The following table indicates the value of the LEG parameter required to match the BS5950 connection definition:
Table 5B.2 - LEG Parameter values Clause Bold Configuration (a) - 2 bolts Leg LEG Parameter 1.0 3.0 0.0 2.0 3.0 7.0 2.0 6.0 1.0 5.0 0.0 4.0 1.0 0.0
(b) - 1 bolts
(a) - 2 bolts
(b) - 1 bolts
(c) - 2 bolts
(d) - 1 bolts
4.7.10.4 Channels
296 STAAD.Pro
Clause
Bold Configuration
Leg
For single angles, the slenderness is calculated for the geometric axes, a-a and b-b as well as the weak v-v axis. The effective lengths of the geometric axes are defined as: La = KY * KY Lb = KZ * LZ The slenderness calculated for the v-v axis is then used to calculate the compression strength pc for the weaker principal axis (z-z for ST angles or yy for RA specified angles). The maximum slenderness of the a-a and b-b axes is used to calculate the compression strength pc for the stronger principal axis. Alternatively for single angles where the connection is not known or Table 25 is not appropriate, by setting the LEG parameter to 10, slenderness is calculated for the two principal axes y-y and z-z only. The LVV parameter is not used. For double angles, the LVV parameter is available to comply with note 5 in table 25. In addition, if using double angles from user tables, (Refer to Section 1.7.3 of the Technical Reference Manual) an eleventh value, rvv, should be supplied at the end of the ten existing values corresponding to the radius of gyration of the single angle making up the pair. 2. BEAM Ensure that this parameter is set to either 1 or 2 while performing code checking for members susceptible to Lateral - Torsional Buckling.
Table 5B.3 - Values for the CMM Parameter CMM Value 1 Loading and Support Conditions
3. Checking beam deflection With the TRACK parameter set to 4, the members included in a CHECK CODE command will be checked for the local axis deflection rather than for the stress capacity using the current LOAD LIST. If both stress capacity and deflection checks are required, then 2 parameter blocks with code checks are required, one with a TRACK 4 command and one with a TRACK 0, 1, or 2, thus:
LOAD LIST 1 TO 10 PARAMETER 1 CODE EN 1993 TRACK 2 ALL
298 STAAD.Pro
CHECK CODE MEMBER 1 *************************** LOAD LIST 100 TO 110 PARAMETER 2 TRACK 4 ALL DFF 300 MEMB 1 DJ1 1 MEMB 1 DJ2 4 MEMB 1 CODE MEMB 1
Note: While both sets of code checks will be reported in the output file, only the last code check results are reported in the GUI.
5B.7(A) CodeChecking
The purpose of code checking is to ascertain whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate. The adequacy is checked as per DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992. Code checking is done using the forces and moments at specific sections of the members. When code checking is selected, the program calculates and prints whether the members have passed or failed the checks; the critical condition ; the value of the ratio of the critical condition (overstressed for value more than 1.0 or any other specified RATIO value); the governing load case, and the location (distance from the start of the member of forces in the member where the critical condition occurs). Code checking can be done with any type of steel section listed in Section 2B.4 or any of the user defined sections as described in Section 1.7.3 of the Technical Reference Manual, with two exceptions; GENERAL and ISECTION. The EC3 DD design module does not consider these sections or PRISMATIC sections in its design process. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.
5B.8(A) MemberSelection
STAAD is capable of performing design operations on specified members. Once an analysis has been performed, the program can select the most economical section, i.e., the lightest section, which fulfills the code requirements for the specified member. The section selected will be of the same type section as originally designated for the member being designed. Member selection can also be constrained by the parameters DMAX and DMIN, which limits the maximum and minimum depth of the members. Member selection can be performed with all the types of steel sections with the same limitations as defined in section 5B.7(A) Code Checking. Selection of members, whose properties are originally input from a user created table, will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on members whose section properties are input as prismatic or as the limitations specified in section 5.B.7(A).
5B.9(A) TabulatedResultsofSteelDesign
For code checking or member selection, the program produces the results in a tabulated fashion. The items in the output table are explained as follows: a. MEMBER refers to the member number for which the design is performed. b. TABLE refers to steel section name, which has been checked against the steel code or has been selected. c. RESULTS prints whether the member has PASSED or FAILED. If the RESULT is FAIL, there will be an asterisk (*) mark on front of the member. d. CRITICAL COND refers to the clause in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 code which governs the design. e. RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f. LOADING provides the load case number, which governed the design. g. FX, MY, and MZ provide the axial force, moment in local Y-axis and the moment in local z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the
300 STAAD.Pro
member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX, MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern. Note: For a TRACK 2 output, the module will also report all the relevant clause checks that have been performed and will also indicate the critical ratio and the load case that caused the critical ratio as well as the corresponding forces that were used for the respective checks. A TRACK 2 output will also include the various design data used for the calculations such as the section modulii, section class, section capacity etc.
ultimate limit states philosophy that is common to modern standards. The objective of this method of design is to ensure that possibility of failure is reduced to a negligible level. This is achieved through application of safety factors to both the applied loads and the material properties. The code also provides guidelines on the global methods of analysis to be used for calculating internal member forces and moments. STAAD uses the elastic method of analysis which may be used in all cases. Also there are three types of framing referred to in EC3. These are Simple, Continuous, and Semi-continuous which reflect the ability of the joints to developing moments under a specific loading condition. In STAAD only Simple and Continuous joint types can be assumed when carrying out global analysis.
302 STAAD.Pro
Material coefficients for steel in STAAD take the following default values unless replaced by users numerical values provided in the input file. Modulus of Elasticity, E = 205000 N/mm2 Shear Modulus, G = E/2(1+ ) Poissons Ratio, = 0.3 Unit weight, = 76.8 KN/m3 The magnitude of design loads is dependent on , the partial safety factor for the f action under consideration. In STAAD the user is allowed total control in providing applicable values for the factors and their use in various load combinations.
wide flange tee single channel single angle rectangular hollow sections circular hollow sections
Also built-up user sections that are class 4 sections are not dealt with in the current version of EC3 design in STAAD.Pro. The design of laced and battened members is not considered in the current version of EC3 (EN 1993) design module in STAAD.Pro.
304 STAAD.Pro
The following sections describe the salient features of the design approach. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the characteristic stresses or capacities. Member selection is done on the basis of selecting the most economic section on the basis of the least weight criteria. It is generally assumed that you (the engineer) will take care of the detailing requirements, such as the provision of stiffeners, and check the local effects like flange buckling, web crippling, etc. Note: The design of class 4 (slender) sections is limited to WIDE FLANGE, TEE, SINGLE CHANNEL, SINGLE ANGLE, and RECTANGULAR & CIRCULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS. The effective section properties are evaluated as described in Cl. 6.2.2.5 of the code. You are allowed complete control over the design process through the use of the parameters listed in Table 5B.3. Default values of parameters will yield reasonable results in most circumstances. However, you should control the design and verify results through the use of the design parameters.
Compression members will be checked for axial capacity of the cross section in addition to lateral buckling/stability. The cross section capacity will be checked as given in section 6.2.4 of the code. Lateral stability of a pure compression member will be checked as per the method given in Cl. 6.3 of the code. The compression member stability will be verified as:
Where N
b,Rd
is the design buckling resistance given by: for Class 1, 2, or 3 cross-sections for Class 4 cross-sections
Where: is the reduction factor as given in section 6.3.12 of the code. The buckling curves used to evaluate the reduction factor are selected from Table 6.2 of the code based on the cross section type and the steel grade. Note: Only the five grades of steel given in table 6.2 will be used when selecting the buckling curve. The steel grade used for this selection is based on the SGR design input parameter (See Section 5B.(6)B). Even if you have specified a custom yield strength (using the PY parameter), the choice of a buckling curve will be based on the value of SGR parameter. Compression members that are susceptible to torsional or torsional flexural buckling are checked for these modes of failure as well. The non-dimensional slenderness for these members is evaluated per Cl. 6.3.1.4 of the EN 1993 T code. The maximum slenderness among the flexural buckling slenderness, torsional slenderness, and torsional-flexural slenderness is used to evaluate the reduction factor, , for such members. The elastic torsional buckling load, N , cr,T and the elastic torsional-flexural buckling load, N , are evaluated based on the cr,TF method given in the NCCI SN001a-EN-EU: Critical axial load for torsional and flexural torsional buckling modes (unless otherwise specified by a particular National Annex). EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not specifically deal with single angle, double angles, double channels, or Tee sections and does not provide a method to work out the
306 STAAD.Pro
slenderness of such members. In these cases, the EC3 (EN 1993) design module of STAAD.Pro uses the methods specified in BS 5950-1:2000 to calculate the slenderness of these members. Cl. 4.7.10 and Table 25 of BS 5950-1:2000 are used in the current version of the Eurocode 3 design module.
RAangle
Where M
c,Rd
is the is the design resistance given by: for class 1 and 2 cross-sections for class 3 cross-sections for class 4 cross-sections
Cross sectional bending capacity checks will be done for both major and minor axis bending moments. Members subject to major axis bending will also be checked for Lateral Torsional Buckling resistance as per Section 6.3.2 of the code. The design buckling resistance moment M will be calculated as:
b,Rd
Where: is the reduction factor for lateral torsional buckling. This reduction LT factor is evaluated per Cl. 6.3.2.2 or Cl 6.3.2.3 of the EN 1993 code depending on the section type. For I sections, the program will by default use Cl. 6.3.2.3 to evalute and for all other sections the LT program will resort to Cl 6.3.2.2. However, if a particular National Annex has been specified, the program will check if the National Annex expands on Cl.6.3.2.3 (Table 6.5) to include sections other than I sections. If so, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 for the cross-section(s) included in Cl. 6.2.2.3 (or Table 6.5). For all other cases the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2. Note: You have the option to choose the clause to be used to calculate through the MTH design parameter. Setting MTH to 0 LT (default value) will cause the program to choose Cl.6.3.2.3 for I Sections and Cl 6.2.3.2 for all other section types. As mentioned above, if the National Annex expands on Cl. 6.3.2.3 to include
308 STAAD.Pro
sections other than I Sections, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 by default.
The non-dimensional slenderness (used to evaluate ) for both the above LT LT cases is evaluated as:
Where: M is the elastic critical moment for lateral torsional buckling. EN 1993cr 1-1 does not however specify a method to work out M . Hence, the cr program will make use of the method specified in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1 to work out M by default.
cr
Note: The method specified in Annex F will be used only when the raw EN 1993-1-1:2005 code is used without any National Annex. If a National Annex has been specified, the calculation of M (and ) cr LT will be done based on the specific National Annex. (See "5B.(C) European Codes - National Annexes to Eurocode 3 [EN 1993-11:2005]" on page 343 for specific details). If the National Annex does not specify a particular method or specify a reference document, the program will use the NCCI document SN-003a-ENEU for doubly symmetric sections and SN030a-EN-EU for monosymmetric sections that are symmetric about their weak axis. For all other sections types the program will use Annex F of DD ENV 19931-1 to calculate Mcr.
Where: V
c,Rd
Av is the shear area and is worked out for the various section types as given in Cl. 6.2.6(3) of the code.
General
Eurocode 3 (EN 1993-1-1:2005) gives very limited guidance for the analysis and design of torsion members. While both elastic and plastic analyses are permitted generally, the design analysis methods for torsion discussed within EC3 are primarily based on elastic methods. Also, only the first yield design resistance is specifically discussed for torsion members. Furthermore, there is no guidance on section classification nor on how to allow for the effects of local buckling on the design resistance for combined torsional effects. EC3 also does not specifically deal with members subject to combined bending and torsion and loosely states that the yield criteria (Eqn 6.1 in the code) can be used for elastic verification. The method used by STAAD.Pro is therefore based on the SCI publication P057: Design of members subject to combined bending and torsion. Though this publication is based on the British standard BS 5950-1, the principles from this document are applied in the context of Eurocode 3. Note: At the time this feature has been implemented in STAAD.Pro, SCI are in the process of updating document P057 to be in accordance with Eurocode 3. Hence this method might be subject to modifications subject to the publication of a newer version of P057. The NCCI document SN007b-EN-EU: Torsion will also be referenced where appropriate.
Code Basis
Torsion design in EC3 is given in Cl. 6.2.7 of EN 1993-1-1:2005. Therefore, this clause is used primarily for this implementation.
310 STAAD.Pro
EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not deal with members subject to the combined effects of torsion and lateral torsional buckling. However, EN 1993-1-6 considers such a condition in Appendix A. Therefore, STAAD.pro uses Appendix A of EN 1993-1-6 to check for members subject to combined torsion and LTB. The following clauses from EC3 are then considered:
l
Note: STAAD.Pro does, however, use this clause (6.2.7) to report the output for all torsion checks. Also any distortional deformations and any amplification in the torsional or shear stresses due to distortions will be neglected by the program.
Clause 6.2.7(1)
States that for members subject to torsion, the design torsional moment T Ed at each cross section should satisfy: T
Ed
/R
Rd
1.0
Where: T
Rd
This is the primary condition that will need to be satisfied for members subject to torsion. The method for working out the torsional resistance T , Rd for the various cases is dealt in the following sections.
l
Cl. 6.2.7(9)
States that: For combined shear force and torsional moment, the plastic shear resistance accounting for torsional effects should be reduced from
pl,Rd
to V V
Ed
pl,T,Rd
/V
pl,T,Rd
The code also gives means to evaluate V in equations 6.26 to 6.28. pl,T,Rd These equations, however, only deal with I/H sections, Channel sections, and structural hollow sections (RHS, SHS, CHS). Therefore, the application of Cl. 6.2.7(9) is only performed for these section profiles.
l
Cl 6.2.7(5)
States that the yield criteria given in Cl. 6.2.1(5) of EN 1993-1-1:2005 may be used for elastic verification. STAAD.Pro evaluates the stresses due to the various actions on the cross section and applies this yield criterion.
The program allows for two types of checks for members subject to torsion for EC3 design: I. Basic Stress Check: This method is intended to be a simplified stress check for torsional effects. This method will produce the output corresponding to Cl. 6.2.7(5) of EN 1993-1-1. II. Detailed Checks: This method will perform a full torsional analysis of the member. All four of the clause checks mentioned earlier will be performed. The details of these checks are as described below. You have the option to choose the method to be used for a specific member or group of members. This will be facilitated by setting the value of the TORSION design parameter to one of the following values: TORSION value 0 Description (Default)Include basic stress checks, only if member is subject to torsion. Include torsion (Basic stress check excluding warping effects). Include torsion (Detailed checks including warping effects). Ignore all torsion checks
1 2 3
312 STAAD.Pro
The TORSION parameter will have a value of zero (0) by default. This will cause the program to trigger the torsion checks only if the member is subject to torsional moments. For this default setting, the program will ignore torsion checks if there is no torsional moment in the member. Setting the value of the TORSION parameter to three (3) will cause the program to ignore all torsional moments. The detailed output (i.e., TRACK 2) will indicate that torsion has been ignored for that particular member. The details of setting the values to one (1) or two (2) and the corresponding checks performed are as described below. Note: If the TORSION parameter is set to 1 or 2, the program will perform the appropriate checks even if the member is not subject to torsional moments. In such cases, the program will perform the checks with a value of zero for the torsional moment.
Where:
x,Ed z,Ed
Ed
Note: Since transverse stresses are very small under normal loading conditions (excluding hydrostatic forces), the term will be negligible and hence is taken as zero.
x,Ed
= +
x
bz
+
y
by
= F /A + M /Z + M /Z
x x z z y z z y
Ed
Where: T is the torsion at the particular section along the length of the member J is the torsion constant t is the thickness of the web/flange V is the shear force Q is the statical moment about the relevant axis I is the second moment of area about the relevant axis The stress check as per equation 6.1 is performed at various stress points of a cross section as shown in figures below: Shape Doubly symmetric wide flange profile Section Sketch
314 STAAD.Pro
Section Sketch
The resultant ratio will be reported under Cl. 6.2.7(5) in the detailed design output.
316 STAAD.Pro
The pure torsional (St. Venants) moment (T The warping torsional moment(T Therefore, T
Ed w,Ed
) and
=T
t,Ed
+T
w,Ed
= GJ = EH
[Ref SCI pub. P057] Where: and are the first and third derivates of twist ( ), respectively, and depend on the end conditions and loading. These are evaluated from the equations in Annex B of P057 and are based the specified CMT parameter. Note: Although the equation given the NCCI document SN007b-EN-EU can be used to evaluate T , the NCCI does not give the eqn. to evaluate . wrd Therefore, Annex B of P057 is used. The torsional resistance of the section is also considered as the sum of the pure torsion resistance and the warping torsion resistance. The pure torsion resistance (T ) and the warping torsional resistance (T ) are evaluated as:
t,Rd w,Rd
=2A t
c
max
max
J/t
J is the torsion const t is the max thickness. T Where: b is the width of the section t is the thickness of the flange for I- sections; minimum of flange or web thickness channel sections The check according to Cl 6.2.7(1) will then be performed to ensure that the following conditions are satisfied: T T T
t,Ed w,Ed Ed w,Rd
= (f /
y
m0
) t b2 / 6
/T
t,Rd
1 1
/T
w,Rd
/T
Rd
When torsion is present, along with the shear force, the design shear resistance will be reduced to V , where V is evaluated as follows:
pl,T,Rd pl,T,Rd
i. For I or H Sections:
318 STAAD.Pro
Where
t,Ed
is the shear stress due to direct (St. Venants) torsion and is the shear stress due to warping torsion.
t,Ed
w,Ed
and
w,Ed
The shear stresses due to warping can be ignored as they will be insignificant and hence:
t,Ed
=T
Ed
/(2A t)
c
A is the area delimited by the mean perimeter and t is the thickness of the cross section
w,Ed
ii. For Open sections [I, H, Channel] sections: For I and H sections, the web will not be subject to warping stresses and therefore warping shear can be ignored ( =0).
w,Ed
= Gt
G is the shear modulus is a function depending on the end condition and loading(T). This will be taken from section 6 and Annex B of P057. Note: Although the maximum stress is at the thickest section of the profile, the program uses the web thickness for this clause (since the shear capacity is based on the web area) unless the load is parallel to the flanges, in which case the flange thickness is used. For channel sections that are free to warp at the supports and, thus, are not subject to warping stresses: The warping shear stress is evaluated as:
w,Ed
= ES / t
w
[Ref SCI pub. P057] Where: E is the elastic modulus, S is the warping statistical moment and
w
is a function depending on the end condition and loading(T). This will be taken from section 6 and Annex B of P057. t is the thickness of the element.
320 STAAD.Pro
For members subject to bending and torsion, the stresses are evaluated as follows: Direct bending stress (major axis): Direct bending stress (minor axis):
bz by
=M /Z
z
z y
=M /Z
y ns
Direct stress due to warping: w = EW Direct stress due to twist (min. axis):
byt c
=M /Z
yt
Direct stress due to axial load (if any): = P/ A Where: M is the major axis moment & My is the minor axis moment.
z
is the differential function based on twist (ref P057 Annex B. & Table 6) W
ns yt
M = M (see Appendix B of P057 to evaluate ) Shear stresses due to torsion and/or warping is evaluated as described above for Clause 6.2.7(9). Check for yield (capacity checks) is then done according to Eqn 6.1 of EN 1993-11:2005, as described for the Basic Stress Check (TORSION = 1):
Clause EC-3:6 App A Check for combined Torsion and Lateral Torsional buckling
The interaction check due to the combined effects of bending (including lateral torsional buckling) and torsion will be checked using Annex A of EN 1993-1-6: 2007. Note that this interaction equation does not include the effects of any axial load. Warning: At present, SCI advises that no significant work has been published for this case and work is still ongoing. So at present is advisable not to allow for torsion in a member with large axial load. Members subject to combined bending and torsion will be checked to satisfy:
Where: C is the equivalent uniform moment factor for bending about the z-z mz axis, according to EN 1993-1-1 Table B.3.
M and M are the design values of the maximum moment about y,Ed z,Ed the y-y and z-z axis, respectively. M and M are the characteristic values of the resistance moment y,Rk z,Rk of the cross-section about it y-y and z-z axis, respectively, from EN 1993-1-1, Table 6.7. M is the elastic critical lateral-torsional buckling moment about the y,cr y-y axis. T
w,Ed
T is the characteristic value of the warping torsional resistance w,Rk moment. is the reduction factor for lateral torsional buckling according to LT 6.3.2 of EN 1993-1-1. Note: For all of the above checks the effective length of the member to be used for torsion can be set by using the EFT design parameter.
322 STAAD.Pro
Note: The program uses the parameter ELB (See Section 5B.6(B)) to override the Cl.6.2.9 checks for combined axial load and bending case. When specfied as 1, the program uses the more general equation 6.2 of EN 1993-1-1, instead.
resistance of the section. The EN 1993 design module in STAAD takes such a scenario into account and performs the necessary checks as per Cl. 6.3.3 of the code. Generally, EC3 requires checking cross-section resistance for local capacity and also checking the overall buckling capacity of the member. In the case of members subject to axial tension and bending, there is provision to take the stabilizing effect of the tension load into consideration. This is achieved by modifying the extreme compression fibre stress and calculating an effective applied moment for the section. The checks are done as per Cl. 6.2.9 of the code. In case of a combined axial compressive load and bending moment, the member is checked per the rules in section 6.3.3 of the code. The program checks to ensure that both the interaction equations 6.61 and 6.62 of the code are satisfied. The interaction factors kzz, kyy, kzy & kyz will be evaluated using Annex B of EN 1993-1-1 by default. Hence for the EN 1993-1-1 code in STAAD.Pro (without National Annexes), uses Annex B. The choice between using Annex A and Annex B will be based on the choice specified by a particular National Annex, if used. If the National Annex itself gives a choice between Annex A and Annex B, the program uses Annex B to evaluate the interaction factors. Note: EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not specifically deal with single angle, double angles, double channels or Tee sections and does give a method to work out the slenderness of such members. In these cases, the Eurocode 3 (EN 1993-11) design module of STAAD.Pro uses the methods specified in BS 5950-1:2000 to calculate the slenderness of these members. Cl. 4.7.10 of BS 5950-1:2000 is used in the current version of the EC3 design module. Please refer to Section 5B.5.2 for ST and RA angle specifications.
Note: Laced or battened compression members are not dealt within the current version of EC3 (EN 1993) design module in STAAD.Pro.
324 STAAD.Pro
Depending on the model being designed, you may have to change some or all of the parameter default values. Some parameters are unit dependent and when altered, the n setting must be compatible with the active unit specification. Table 5B.1 (B) lists all the relevant EC3 parameters together with description and default values. Table 5B.4 - Steel Design Parameters EC3 EN Parameter Name CODE Default Value Must be specified as EN 1993-11:2005 to invoke design per Eurocode 3:2005 (EN 1993). Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. ALH 0.5 The ratio of the distance of the point torque (from the start of the member) to the length of the member. The default value of 0.5 represents torque acting at the mid-span of a symmetrically loaded member. Values can range from 0 to 1. ALPHA 1.0 Used to input a user defined value for the factor in equation 6.41 for combined bending and axial force checks. BEAM 3 Parameter to control the number of sections to checked along the length of a beam: 0. Check sections with end Description
5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name Default Value forces only 1. Check at location of maximum Mz along beam 2. Check sections with end forces and forces at location of BEAM1.0 check. 3. Check at every 1/13th point along the beam and report the maximum BETA 1.0 Used to input a user defined value for the factor in equation 6.41 for combined bending and axial force checks. C1 1.132 Corresponds to the C1 factor to be used to calculate Elastic critical moment M as per Clause 6.3.2.2
cr
Description
C2
0.459
Corresponds to the C2 factor to be used to calculate Elastic critical moment M as per Clause 6.3.2.2
cr
C3
Corresponds to the C3 factor to be used to calculate Elastic critical moment M as per Clause 6.3.2.2
cr
CAN
Member will be considered as a cantilever type member for deflection checks. 0 indicates that member will not be
326 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
treated as a cantilever member 1 indicates that the member will be treated as a cantilever member CMM 1.0 Indicates type of loading and support conditions on member. Can take a value from 1 to 8. Refer to Table 5B1.4(B) for more information on its use. CMN 1.0 Indicates the level of EndRestraint. 1.0 = No fixity 0.5 = Full fixity 0.7 = One end free and other end fixed CMT 1 Used to indicate the loading and support condition for torsion. Can take a value of 1-7. Refer to table 5B1.5(B) for more information DFF None for deflection "Deflection Length" / Maxm.
5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name Default Value check, TRACK 4.0) DJ1 Start Joint of member Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" . See Note 1 below. DJ2 End Joint of member Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length". See Note 1 below. DMAX 100.0 cm Maximum allowable depth for the member. DMIN 0 Minimum required depth for the member. EFT Member Length Effective length for torsion. A value of 0 defaults to the member length. ELB 0 Used to specify the method for combined axial load + bending checks 0. Uses Cl. 6.2.9 of EN 1993-11:2005 1. Uses Cl. 6.2.1(7) - Eqn. 6.2 of EN 1993-1-1:2005 ESTIFF 0 (For use with the Dutch NA only) Method for checking columns forming part of (non)/buttressed framework: Description
328 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
0. Checks per Cl 12.3.1.2.3 of NEN 6770: Section 1 1. Checks per Cl 12.3.1.2.3 of NEN 6770: Section 2 FU GM0 0 1.1 Ultimate tensile strength of steel. Corresponds to the EN 1993-1-1:2005 GM1 1.1 Corresponds to the EN 1993-1-1:2005 GM2 1.1 Corresponds to the EN 1993-1-1:2005 GST 0 Used to specify the section type to be used for designing a General Section from the user table. The member will be considered as the specified type with the user defined properties. The available options and corresponding values are as below: 0. I-Section 1. Single Channel 2. Rectangular Hollow Section 3. Circular Hollow Section 4. Angle Section 5. Tee Section
m2 m1 m0
factor in
factor in
factor in
5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name Default Value Note: This parameter will be ignored if it has been assigned to any section other than a General Section. KC 1.0 Corresponds to the correction factor as per Table 6.6 of EN 1993-11:2005. Program will calculate kc automatically if this parameter is set to 0. KY KZ LEG 1.0 1.0 0 K factor in local y axis. K factor in local z axis. Slenderness values for angles as determined from BS 5950-2000 Table 25. See "2B.6 Design Parameters" on page 90 LVV Max. value Leg length for Lvv (length about vof Lyy v- aces of single angle section), as per Lyy. Used for slenderness calculations. LY Member Length Compression length in local y axis, Slenderness ratio = (KY)*(LY)/(Ryy) LZ Member Length Compression length in local z axis, Slenderness ratio = (KZ)*(LZ)/(Rzz) Description
330 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name MU
Default Value 0
Description
To be used with CMM values of 7 and 8. See Table 5B1.4(B). Currently valid only with the French NA.
MTH
Used to select the clause to be used to calculate the LTB reduction factor, . The available options
LT
and corresponding values are as below: 0. Use default method based on section type (default) 1. Use Cl.6.3.2.2 2. Use Cl.6.3.2.3 By default, the program will use Cl 6.3.2.3 for rolled & built-up Isections and Cl. 6.3.2.2 for all other sections. If, however, the specified National Annex expands on Cl. 6.3.2.3 to include other section types (e.g., the UK NA), the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 by default for that particular section type. See "5B.(C) European Codes National Annexes to Eurocode 3 [EN 1993-1-1:2005]" on page 343 for additional details on NAdocuments.
5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name NA Default Value 0 Choice of National Annex to be used for EC3 design. (see 5B1.2(B) for more information) NSF 1.0 Net tension factor for tension capacity calculation. PLG 0 To be used to determine whether to include the additional interaction checks as per CL. NA.20(2) and NA.20(3) of the Polish National Annex. Note: This parameter will be applicable only to the Polish NA PY Yield Strength The yield strength default value is set based on the default value of the SGR parameter. RATIO 1 Permissible ratio of loading to capacity. SBLT 0.0 Indicates if the section is rolled or built-up. 0.0 = Rolled 1.0 = Built-up SGR 0 Steel grade as in table 3.1 of EN 1993-1-1:2005 Description
332 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
0.0 - indicates S 235 grade steel 1.0 - indicates S 275 grade steel 2.0 - indicates S 355 grade steel 3.0 - indicates S 420 grade steel 4.0 - indicates S 460 grade steel Note: As EN 1993-1-1:2005 does not provide a buckling curve in table 6.2 for grade S 450 steel (in Table 3.1 of EN 1993-1-1:2005), the program will use the same buckling curves as for grade S 460 when calculating the buckling resistance as per clause 6.3. STIFF Member Length or depth of beam, whichever is greater Distance between transverse stiffener plates, used to prevent web shear buckling. If not specified or if a value of 0 is provided, the program will assume the web is unstiffened.
5B.5(B).4.2 Detailed stress check Parameter Name TOM Default Value 0 Total torsion for design used for torsion checks. TORSION 0 Method to be used for a specific member or group of members: 0. Perform basic torsion checks if member is subject to torsion. 1. Perform basic stress check (Ignore warping effects). 2. Perform detailed checks (including warping effects). 3. Ignore all torsion checks Note: For options 1 or 2, the program will perform the torsion related checked even if torsional moment is absent and will use a value of zero for the torsional moment. TRACK 0 Specify level of detail in output. 0. Summary of results only. 1. Summary with member capacities. 2. Detailed results. 3. Deflection check results. Description
334 STAAD.Pro
Default Value 1
Description
UNL
Member Length
Unrestraint length of member used in calculating the lateral-torsional resistance moment of the member.
ZG
+Section Depth/2
Note: For Tee sections, ZG will have a default value of (+Flange thickness/2) Notes: 1. CAN, DJ1, and DJ2 Deflection a. When performing the deflection check, you can choose between two methods. The first method, defined by a value 0 for the CAN parameter, is based on the local displacement. Local displacement is described in Section 5.44 of the Technical Reference Manual. If the CAN parameter is set to 1, the check will be based on cantilever style deflection. Let (DX1, DY1, DZ1) represent the nodal displacements (in global axes) at the node defined by DJ1 (or in the absence of DJ1, the start node of the member). Similarly, (DX2, DY2, DZ2) represent the deflection values at DJ2 or the end node of the member. Compute Delta = SQRT((DX2 - DX1)2 + (DY2 - DY1)2 + (DZ2 - DZ1)2) Compute Length = distance between DJ1 & DJ2 or, between start node and end node, as the case may be. Then, if CAN is specified a value 1, dff = L/Delta Ratio due to deflection = DFF/dff
b. If CAN = 0, deflection length is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the Deflection Length will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the Deflection Length may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.
c. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. d. It is important to note that unless a DFF value is specified, STAAD will not perform a deflection check. This is in accordance with the fact that there is no default value for DFF (see Table 2B.1). e. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design. 2. NA Parameter The values for NA parameter are as follows:
336 STAAD.Pro
Table 5B.5 - Table 5B1.2(B) - Numerical Code for Eurocode National Annex NAValue 0 Country Uses the base EN 1993-1-1:2005 code. The default values specified in En 1993-1-1:2005 will be used for the partial safety factors and various parameter values where applicable (default). United Kingdom (British NA) Uses the BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of Eurocode 3 along with the UK National Annex. Netherlands (Dutch NA) Uses the NEN EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of the code. The Dutch National Annex [NEN-EN 1993-11/NB] has been added in this module. Please note that the Dutch National requires additional checks as per NEN 6770 and NEN 6771 which will also be performed during design checks with this parameter value 3 Norway (Norwegian NA) Uses the NS-EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of the code. The Norwegian National Annexe [ NS-EN 1993-11:2005/Na 2008] has been added to this implementation. France (French NA) Uses the Annexe Nationale a la NF EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of the code along with the French National Annex.. Finland (Finnish NA) - Uses the SFS EN 1993-1-1:2005 version of Eurocode 3 along with the Finnish National Annex. Poland (Polish NA) - Uses the PN EN 1993-11:2005 version of Eurocode 3 along with the Polish National Annex.
3. CMM Parameter The values of CMM for various loading and support conditions are as given below: Table 5B.6 - Values for the CMM Parameter CMM Value 1 Loading and Support Conditions
varying end moments and central point load 4. Checking beam deflection
338 STAAD.Pro
With the TRACK parameter set to 4, the members included in a BEAM CHECK command will be checked for the local axis deflection rather than for the stress capacity using the current LOAD LIST. If both stress capacity and deflection checks are required, then 2 parameter blocks with code checks are required, one with a TRACK 4 command and one with a TRACK 0, 1 or 2, thus:
LOAD LIST 1 TO 10 PARAMETER 1 CODE EN 1993 TRACK 2 ALL CODE CHECK MEMBER 1 *************************** LOAD LIST 100 TO 110 PARAMETER 2 TRACK 4 ALL DFF 300 MEMB 1 DJ1 1 MEMB 1 DJ2 4 MEMB 1 CHECK CODE MEMB 1
Note: While both sets of code checks will be reported in the output file, only the last code check results are reported in the STAAD.Pro graphical interface. 5. CMT Parameter The values of CMM for various loading and support conditions are as given below:
Table 5B.7 - Loading and Support Conditions represented by CMT Parameter Values CMT Value 1 Description Diagram
(Default) : Concentrated Torque at Ends. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping fixed Concentrated Torque along length of member. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping free Concentrated Torque along length of member. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping fixed Uniform Torque in member. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping free Uniform Torque in member. Ends Torsion fixed and Warping fixed Concentrated Torque in cantilever. End Torsion fixed and Warping fixed Uniform Torque in cantilever. End Torsion fixed and Warping fixed
Note: For CMT = 2 and CMT = 3, you have the option of specifying the distance at which the concentrated torque acts, measured from the start of the member. This can be done by using the ALH design parameter. The ALH parameter indicates the ratio of the distance of the point torque
340 STAAD.Pro
(from the start of the member) to the length of the member. This parameter will have a default value of 0.5 (i.e., the torque acts at the center of the span) and will accept values ranging from 0 to 1.
5B.7(B) CodeChecking
The purpose of code checking is to ascertain whether the provided section properties of the members are adequate. The adequacy is checked as per EN 19931-1:2005 and a corresponding National Annex (if specified). Code checking is done using the forces and moments at specific sections of the members. When code checking is selected, the program calculates and prints whether the members have passed or failed the checks; the critical condition; the value of the ratio of the critical condition (overstressed for value more than 1.0 or any other specified RATIO value); the governing load case, and the location (distance from the start of the member of forces in the member where the critical condition occurs). Code checking can be done with any type of steel section listed in Section 2B.4 or any of the user defined sections as described in Section 1.7.3 of the Technical Reference Manual, with the exception of ISECTION. ISECTION has been currently excluded since the option of Tapered section design is currently not supported in the EC3 module. The EC3 (EN 1993) design module does not consider these sections or PRISMATIC sections in its design process. Note: Checks for slender sections to EN 1993-1-1 are limited to I-SECTIONS, TEE, SINGLE CHANNEL, SINGLE ANGLE and CIRCULAR & RECTANGULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS. Code checking for GENERAL sections can be also done using the EN1993 module. The program will design GENERAL sections as I sections by default. However, you are given the option to choose a section type to be considered while designing the member. Refer to the description of the GST design parameter in Section 5B.6 (B) for details.
i.e., the lightest section, which fulfills the code requirements for the specified member. The section selected will be of the same type section as originally designated for the member being designed. Member selection can also be constrained by the parameters DMAX and DMIN, which limits the maximum and minimum depth of the members. Member selection can be performed with all the types of steel sections with the same limitations as defined in Section 5B.7(B) - Code Checking. Selection of members, whose properties are originally input from a user created table, will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on members whose section properties are input as prismatic or as the limitations specified in Section 5.B.7(B)
5B.9(B) TabulatedResultsofSteelDesign
For code checking or member selection, the program produces the results in a tabulated fashion. The items in the output table are explained as follows: a. MEMBER refers to the member number for which the design is performed. b. TABLE refers to steel section name, which has been checked against the steel code or has been selected. c. RESULTS prints whether the member has PASSED or FAILED. If the RESULT is FAIL, there will be an asterisk (*) mark on front of the member. d. CRITICAL CONDrefers to the clause in EN 1993-1-1:2005 code which governs the design. e. RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f. LOADING provides the load case number, which governed the design. g. FX, MY, and MZprovide the axial force, moment in local Y-axis and the moment in local z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX, MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern.
342 STAAD.Pro
Note: For a TRACK 2 output, the module will also report all the relevant clause checks that have been performed and will also indicate the critical ratio and the load case that caused the critical ratio as well as the corresponding forces that were used for the respective checks. A TRACK 2 output will also include the various design data used for the calculations such as the section modulii, section class, section capacity etc. If an NA parameter (other than 0) has been specified and if the particular National Annex requires additional checks outside those specified in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (e.g., The Dutch National Annex), the respective NA clauses and any associated code clauses will be listed along with the critical ratios and the forces that were used for these clause checks.
Description
The parameter NA sets the default material gamma factors and any additionalchanges outlined in the country specific National Annex such as specific equations ormethods. The output file printout has been updated to indicate which National Annex (if any) hasbeen used in a code check / select process. (For all TRACK settings) Note: This Eurocode 3 design code is secured using the 'Eurocode Design' code pack.
General Format
The format of the EN 1993-1-1:2005 National Annex is as follows:
CODE EN 1993
NA
f1
{Code parameters: See Eurocode 3 parameters} Where: f1 represents the number designation for a specific country's National Annex: Table 5B.8 - Numerical Code for Eurocode National Annex NAValue 0 Country None. This value represents using the base code only, with no national annex changes or additions (default). United Kingdom (British NA) Netherlands (Dutch NA) Norway (Norwegian NA) France (French NA) Finland (Finnish NA) Poland (Polish NA)
1 2 3 4 5 6
344 STAAD.Pro
4. Select the NAparameter in the list box. 5. Select the option corresponding to the National Annex document you want to use . 6. Click Add. This will insert the following commands into the STAAD input file: CODE EN 1993-1-1:2005 NA 8 Refer to EC3 steel design for additional information on steel design per EC3. A design performed to the new Eurocode 3 National Annex is displayed in the outputfile (*.ANL) with the following header, in addition to the base EC3 output.
Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that require additional clauses from the Dutch National Annex (hereafter referred to as D-NA) are:
l
6.1 General 6.2.8 Bending and shear 6.2.10 Bending shear and axial force 6.3 Buckling resistance of members 6.3.1.3 Slenderness for flexural buckling 6.3.1.4 Slenderness for torsional and torsional-flexural buckling 6.3.2.2 Lateral torsional buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3 Lateral torsional buckling curves for rolled sections or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.4 Simplified assessment methods for beams 6.3.3 Members in bending and axial compression
Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the UK-NA.
Note: The local axis convention in the Dutch codes is: Y major axis & Z minor axis (as opposed to the convention followed in STAAD.Pro).
346 STAAD.Pro
Table 10: Provides interaction checks for bending about the major axis (All necessary terms and formulae are described below):
l
Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a1 x Npl;d check equation 11.3.1 Check #2 If Vz;s;d 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a1 x Npl;d check equation 11.3.2 Check #3 If Vz;s;d > 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a2 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-3 Check #4 If Vz;s;d > 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a2 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-4
Where: Vz;s;d= Actual Shear force in the section along Z- axis Vz;pl;d= Shear capacity of section along Z - axis = Aw x fy;d / 3 - See fig below for Aw ; fy;d = yield stress
Figure 5.5 - Definition of A
w
Aw = A - 2 (bf - tw - 2r) tf Ns;d= Axial force in the section Npl;d= Axial capacity of section = A x fy;d My;s;d= Bending moment about major axis
348 STAAD.Pro
My;pl;d= Plastic moment capacity of section = fy;d x Wy;pl Wy;pl = Plastic section modulus a1 = = min( A-2bfx tf)/A , 0.5)- used in tables 10 & 11 a2 = = see eqn 11.3-10- used in tables 10 & 11 Mv;y;ud= see eqn 11.3.12 N;v;u;d= see eqn 11.3-13 Table 11: Provides interaction formulae for bending about the minor axis
l
Check #1 If Vy;s;d 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d 1.0 x a1 x Npl;d check equation 11.3-5 Check #2 If Vy;s;d 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d > 1.0 x a1 x Npl;d check equation 11.3-6 Check #3 If Vy;s;d > 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d 1.0 x a1 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-7 Check #4 If Vy;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 1.0 x a1 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-8
Where: Vy;s;d= Actual Shear force in the section along Y- axis Vy;pl;d= Shear capacity of section along Y - axis = Aw x fy;d / 3 - See fig below for Aw ; fy;d = yield stress
Mv;z;u;d = q x Mz;pld = q x fy;d x Wpl;z;d (Wpl;z;d = plastic section modulus about minor axis) & q as per eqn 11.3-14 Nv;u;d = N;pl;d 2(1-q)bf x tf x fy;d
Clause 11.3.1.3 ( NEN 6770) : Class 1 and Class 2 Square and rectangular hollow sections
This clause requires class 1 and class 2 square and rectangular tube profiles to satisfy the interaction equations in Table 13.
Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a3 x Npl;d check equation 11.3.22 Check #2 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a3 x Npl;d check equation 11.3.23 Check #3 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a4 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-24 Check #4 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a4 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-25
Where Vz;s;d= Actual Shear force in the section along Z- axis Vz;pl;d= Shear capacity of section along Z axis [ b breadth and h = height of section ; A= area of section]
Clause 11.3.1.2 (NEN 6770): Class 1 and class 2 circular hollow (CHS) profiles
Class 1 and class 2 sections with circular hollow profiles should satisfy the interaction equations given in table 12.
350 STAAD.Pro
Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d check equation 11.3.17 Check #2 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d check equation 11.3.18.
See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to derive Vz;s;d Vz;pl;d = Shear capacity of CHS sections
See equations 11.3-19 and 11.3-20 to evaluate Mv;y;u;d and N;v;u;d. To check for these conditions about the y axis, substitute the index z in the above equations with y (should be the same of CHS sections).
Clause 11.3.2.1 : Class 1 and class2 I-sections with biaxial bending + shear + axial force
The formula to evaluate M;N;v;y;u;d and M;N;v;z;u;d are to be taken from tables 14 and 15 of NEN 6770 respectively. Checks for table 14:
l
Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a1 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.32 Check #2 If Vz;s;d 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a1 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.33 Check #3 If Vz;s;d > 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a2 x Nv;u;d use equation 11.3-34 Check #4 If Vz;s;d > 0.5 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a2 x Nv;u;d use equation 11.3-35
See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to evaluate Vz;s;d, My;pl;d, Npl;d, Mv;y;ud, N;v;u;d, a1 ,a2 and Vz;pl;d. Checks for table 15:
l
Check #1 If Vy;s;d 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d 1.0 x a1 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.36 Check #2 If Vy;s;d 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d > 1.0 x a1 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.37 Check #3 If Vy;s;d > 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d 1.0 x a1 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-38 Check #4 If Vy;s;d > 0.25 Vy;pl;d and Ns;d > 1.0 x a1 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-39
See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to evaluate Vy;s;d, Mz;pl;d, Npl;d, Mv;z;ud, N;v;u;d, a1 ,a2 and Vy;pl;d. See table 16 for 1, 1, 0 and 1 use in tables 14 and 15.
Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d use equation 11.3.44 Check #2 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d use equation 11.3.45.
See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to evaluate Vz;pl;d, My;pl;d, and Npl;d use in equations 11.3.44 & 11.3.45. For values to be used for 1, 2, 1 and 2 in this case refer to table 18 of NEN 6770.
352 STAAD.Pro
Clause 11.3.2.3 : Class 1 and class2 Rectangular and square hollow tubes
The formula to evaluate M;N;v;y;u;d and M;N;v;z;u;d (to be used in equation 113-31, see description of clause 11.3.2 above) are to be taken from table 19 of NEN 6770.
l
Check #1 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a3 x Npl;d use equation 11.3-48 Check #2 If Vz;s;d 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a3 x Npl;d use equation 11.3.49 Check #3 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d 0.5 x a4 x Nv;u;d use equation 11.3-50 Check #4 If Vz;s;d > 0.25 Vz;pl;d and Ns;d > 0.5 x a4 x Nv;u;d check equation 11.3-51
See "5B.1(C) EC3 NA Dutch National Annex" on page 345 of this document for equations to evaluate Vz;pl;d, My;pl;d, Npl;d, Mv;y;ud, N;v;u;d, a3, a4 and Vz;pl;d to be used in the above equations. For values to be used for 1, 2, 1 and 2 in this case refer to table 20 of NEN 6770. To check for these conditions about the y axis, substitute the index z in the above equations with y.
1. Case 1: -If M;y;s;d / MN;y;f;u;d 1 check equation 11.2-7 ( given below) V Where V
z;s;d z;s;d
/V
z;u;d
V is the shear capacity in the Z direction for ultimate limit z;u;d state. For an I section,
Where Aw,ef = effective web area as given in section 10.2.4.2.3 . MN;y;f;u;d is the moment capacity about the Y axis for the effective section. = ( fyW,eff) 2. Case 2: If M;y;s;d / MN;y;f;u;d > 1 and M;y;s;d / M;y;f;u;d 1 check equation 11.2-13 (given below):
Where: N
c;u;d
= Af
y;d
354 STAAD.Pro
A = area of section f
y;d E;
This value of slenderness is to be used to calculate the modification factors used in section 6.3 of EC-3.
Where N
c;u;d
= Af
y;d
A = area of section f
y;d
E;tk
Where: N
c;s;d
356 STAAD.Pro
C;u;d
Clause 6.3.2.3 Lateral torsional buckling curves for rolled sections or equivalent welded sections
The D-NA states that: 1. The values for the #. Imperfection factor LT0 = 0.4 (to be used in equation 6.57 of EC-3) #. = 0.75(to be used in equation 6.57 of EC-3)
These are the default values used in the current implementation in STAAD.Pro. 2. The buckling curves shall be selected as per table 6.5. Again this is what is being used in the current implementation of EC3 (BS) in STAAD.Pro. 3. The reduction factor, f, is given by F = 1 0.5(1-kc)[1-2x (LT -0.8)^2]. And Kc to be determined from table 6.6. The current implementation of STAAD.Pro conservatively uses a value of f = 1.0. This implementation use a new parameter KC to identify the moment distribution as given in table 6.6, thus determining the value of the correction factor kc.
ESTIFF = 0 (default) Column part of a buttressed framework Selecting this value will internally perform the checks as per section 1 of clause
358 STAAD.Pro
12.3.1.2.3
l
ESTIFF = 1 (default) Column is not part of a buttressed framework Selecting this value will internally perform the checks as per section 2 of clause 12.3.1.2.3
These checks are described below: 1. For columns in buttressed frameworks the buckling length is to be taken based on either
l
The following conditions should also be satisfied: If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d < 0.15, no additional checks are required If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d 0.15 and the steel grade is S235 or S 275 then
Where N N
c;s;d pl;d
Where N N
c;s;d pl;d
2. For columns that are not part of buttressed frameworks the following additional checks need to be done: If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d < 0.15, no additional checks are required
If Nc;s;d/ Npl;d 0.15 and the steel grade is S235 or S 275 then
Where N N
c;s;d pl;d
Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that require additional clauses from the Norwegian National Annex are:
Section 6.1(1)
The partial safety factors will use the following values: Resistance of cross-sections - M0 = 1.05 Resistance of members to instability - M1 = 1.05 Resistance of cross sections to tension - M2 = 1.25 This implementation will set the default values of the GM0, GM1 and GM2 parameters in the design module to the values as: GM0 = 1.05, GM1 = 1.05 and GM2 = 1.25. (Note: When NA 3 has been specified)
360 STAAD.Pro
The user will be allowed to override these default values and set custom values to these parameters. If any of these parameters have been specified by the user as 0, this implementation will ignore the user specified value (i.e., 0) and use the default values as given above. The design functions in STAAD.Pro will set these values as the default values for the French-NA. The user is still however allowed to modify these factors using the parameters in the design input. These values will also need to be reported in the design output. Note: The GB1 parameter that is being used for compression checks in builds preceding this release (STAAD.Pro 2007 build 06) has been removed as this parameter is no longer required in EN 1993-1-1:2005. Hence any legacy files that use GB1 parameter will indicate an error message and the user will need to substitute GB1 with GM1 in line with EN 1993-1-1:2005.
Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the Norwegian -NA.
Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 that have been dealt with in the UK National Annex (hereafter referred to as the UK-NA) are:
l
6.1(1) General 6.3.2.2 Lateral Torsional Buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3(1) Lateral Torsional buckling curves for rolled or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor calculations 6.3.2.4(1)B Slenderness limit c0
6.3.2.4(2)B Modification factor kfl 6.3.3 Method for calculation interaction factors for members in combined bending and compression Annex B Members in bending and axial compression 6.3.1.4 Slenderness for torsional and torsional- flexural buckling
Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the UK-NA.
Warning: The GB1 parameter that is being used for compression checks in builds preceding this release (STAAD.Pro 2007 build 06) has been removed as
362 STAAD.Pro
this parameter is no longer required in EN 1993-1-1:2005. Hence any legacy files that use GB1 parameter will indicate an error message and the user will need to substitute GB1 with GM1 in line with EN 1993-1-1:2005.
Clause 6.3.2.2 Elastic critical moment and imperfection factors for LTB checks
The UK-NA recommends the use of Table 6.3 and 6.4 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 to calculate the imperfection factors for Lateral Torsional Buckling (LTB) checks. The calculation of the LTB reduction factor X , requires the calculation of the LT Elastic Critical Buckling Moment, Mcr. The UK National Annex does not specify a particular method to calculate Mcr. Hence the calculation of Mcr has been based on the following NCCI documents: 1. SN003a-EN-EU Elastic critical moment for Lateral torsional Buckling: This document provides a method to calculate Mcr specifically for doubly symmetric sections only. Hence only doubly symmetric sections will be considered for this method in the proposed implementation. The equation to evaluate Mcr is given in the NCCI as
C1 and C2 are factors that depend on the end conditions and the loading conditions of the member. The NCCI provides values for C1 and C2 for the different cases as given in the tables below:
364 STAAD.Pro
The implementation of EC3 in STAAD.Pro accounts for the loading condition and the bending moment diagram through the CMM parameter. The first two loading conditions mentioned above and its variants can be dealt with by using the existing values of the CMM parameter (i.e., 1 to 6). Hence the appropriate values from this NCCI will be used for C1 and C2 coefficients depending on the value of CMM specified. The default value of CMM is 1, which considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. The user will also have the option to specify specific values for C1 & C2 using the new C1 and C2 parameters in the design input mode. However for cases with end moments and transverse loading, the NCCI provides graphs to evaluate the C1 and C2 coefficients. It does not however, provide a set of equations for these graphs. However the end moments and transverse loading condition cannot be currently specified in the design input. Hence this implementation will introduce two new values for the CMM parameter viz. CMM 7:Member with varying end moments and uniform loading. CMM 8: Member with varying end moments and central point load. For these two conditions, the UK National Annex (nor the NCCI) does not provide equations to evaluate C1 and C2. Hence in STAAD.Pro the user will have to use the new C1 & C2 parameters to input the required values for C1 & C2 to be used in calculating Mcr. For values of 7 or 8 for the CMM parameter, the program will issue a warning if C1 and C2 have not been specified. Note: If the NA parameter has not been specified, the program obtains the values of C1 and C2 from Annex F of DD ENV version of 1993-11:1992. 2. SN030a-EN-EU Mono-symmetrical uniform members under bending and axial compression: This document provides a method to evaluate the elastic critical moment (Mcr) for uniform mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the weak axis. Hence for this implementation the elastic critical moment for TeeSections will be worked out using the method in this NCCI.
Note: Though this method could also be applicable to mono-symmetric builtup sections, STAAD.Pro currently does not have a means to specify/identify a mono-symmetric built-up section. Hence this implementation will use this method only for Tee-Sections. In any case, the actual LTB capacity will still be worked out as per BS 5950-1 as in the current EC3 implementation. The equation to evaluate Mcr for mono symmetric sections is given as :
The factors C1, C2 and C3 are dependent on the end conditions and loading criteria. This implementation will consider C1, C2 and C3 as given in the tables below:
The CMM parameter (see section (i) above) specified during design input will determine the values of C1, C2 and C3. The default value of CMM is 1, which
366 STAAD.Pro
considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. This NCCI does not however consider the end moments and transverse loading condition. The user however can use the new C1, C2 and C3 parameters to input the required values for C1, C2 and C3 to be used in calculating Mcr. As described in section (i) above, the user must use C1, C2 and C3 parameters along with CMM values of 7 and 8. Both the NCCI documents mentioned above assume that the member under consideration is free to rotate on plan and that there are no warping restraints for the member ( k = kw = 1.0). The current implementation of EC3 in STAAD takes into account of the end conditions using the CMN parameter. A value of K = kw =1 is indicated by a value of CMN = 1.0 in the design input. Hence the above methods will be used only for members which are free to rotate on plan and which have no warping restraints, i.e., CMN = 1.0. For members with partial or end fixities (ie, CMN = 0.5 or CMN = 0.7), the proposed implementation will fall back on to the method and coefficients in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 Annex F. For all cases that are not dealt with by the National Annex (or the NCCI documents) the proposed implementation will use the method as per the DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 code. The term zg in the equation to calculate Mcr refers to the distance between the point of application of load on the cross section in relation to the shear center of the cross section. The value of zg is considered positive if the load acts towards the shear center and is negative if it acts away from the shear center. By default, the program will assume that the load acts towards the shear center at a distance equal to (Depth of section/2) from the shear center. The user will be allowed to modify this value by using the new ZG parameter. Specifying a value of ZG = 0 in the design input would indicate that the load acts exactly at the shear center of the section so that the term zg in the equation will have a value of zero.
The values specified in the UK-NA are: For rolled sections and hot-rolled & cold formed hollow sections: LT,0 = 0.4 = 0.75 For welded sections: LT,0 = 0.2 = 1.00 The current implementation of STAAD.Pro uses the buckling curves based on Table 6.5 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. The UK-NA specifies different limits and buckling curves to be used in this clause as given below:
This table again does not specify which buckling curve is to be used in case of welded doubly symmetric sections with h/b 3.1 and welded non-doubly symmetric sections. Hence for these cases the new implementation will still use the method specified in the base code as per clause 6.3.2.2(2).
Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 (EN 1993-1-1:2005), both give equations to evaluate the LTB reduction factor to be used in eqn. 6.55 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005.
LT
Cl. 6.3.2.2 uses tables 6.3 and 6.4 to choose the buckling curve and the imperfection factors to be used for calculating . Table 6.4 specifies the choice of LT buckling curves for Rolled I Sections, Welded I Sections and Any other
368 STAAD.Pro
sections. Cl 6.3.2.3 on the other hand uses tables 6.5 and 6.3 to choose the buckling curves and imperfection factors. Table 6.5 however only deals with Rolled I Sections and Welded I Sections. Cl. 6.3.2.2 states Unless otherwise specified, see 6.3.2.3, for bending members of constant cross section the value of should be determined from.... Hence in the LT implementation of EC3 (and the UK Annex) in STAAD.Pro, by default the program will consider clause Cl. 6.3.2.3 to evaluate . For any case that is not dealt with LT by Cl. 6.3.2.3, the program will consider Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT
Cl. 6.3.2.3 in the UK National Annex states that Table 6.5 in BS EN 1993-1-1:2005 should be replaced with the table given in the NA (See section 4.3 of this document). Hence for all cases dealt with by the table in the UK NA, this implementation will choose the buckling curves from the UK National Annex. For any case that is not dealt with by the table in the UK NA, the program will use the method given in Cl. 6.3.2.2 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. Hence for the following cross sections the program will use the Table in the UK NA for choosing a buckling curve for LTB checks (when the UK NA has been specified):
l
Rolled doubly symmetric I & H Sections Rolled doubly symmetric hollow sections (SHS, RHS, CHS) Angle Sections Any other rolled section Welded doubly symmetric sections with h/b < 3.1
For the following cross sections, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 of BS EN 1993-11:2005 to evaluate LT
l
For any other type of cross section that is not dealt with by the National Annex or Cl.6.3.2.3, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate LT . In any case the Elastic critical moment Mcr (used to evaluate the non dimensional slenderness) will be worked out as given in section 4.2 of this document. Since the UK National Annex uses the NCCIs mentioned in the sections above, this implementation will only consider end restraint conditions corresponding to the CMN parameter=1.0 (See section 4.2 above). For all other cases of the CMN parameter values, this implementation will use the method specified in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992.
Note: If a National Annex has not been specified (i.e., NA parameter in the design input = 0), the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 only in the case of Rolled or welded I & H Sections. For all other cases, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. Also, I sections with plates will be treated as built-up sections only if the section has been explicitly specified as a built-up section (i.e., SBLT parameter = 1.0 in design input).
370 STAAD.Pro
These values are for an end restraint factor of k=1 (ie CMN=1.0). Hence for all other values of CMN (ie 0.7 or 0.5) this implementation will use the values of C1 from DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 Annex F.
The program will use a default value of 1.0 for kc. However the user can also input a custom value of kc by setting the design parameter KC to the desired value. The user can also get the program to calculate the value of kc automatically by setting the value of the KC parameter in the design input to 0. This will cause the program to evaluate a value of C1 corresponding to the end conditions and the Bending moment of the member and in turn calculate kc as given in the NA. To evaluate C1, the program will use the NCCI documents mentioned in section 4.2 of this document.
372 STAAD.Pro
STAAD.pro uses the method in Annex B. However for non-doubly symmetric sections, the UK NA gives the option of using Annex B with some modifications as given in the NA. (Cl. NA-3.2 of the UK NA). The UK NA requires additional checks to be done to check for the maximum allowable values of and X to be used in equations 6.61 and 6.62 of BS EN 19931-1:2005. As per the UK NA, for non-doubly symmetric sections, the slenderness about the weak axis (y in STAAD) and the corresponding reduction factor y should be taken as the values from the highest values of slenderness () among the flexural buckling slenderness (y), torsional slenderness ( ) and torsional-flexural T slenderness ( ) as given in Clauses 6.3.1.3 and 6.3.1.4 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. TF Hence for non-doubly symmetric sections the program will calculate the critical non-dimensional slenderness as:
y = max
is calculated as =
T T
Ncr = min (N
CrT
,N
crTF
).
The UK NA or EC3 does not however specify a method to evaluate NCrT or NcrTF. Hence this implementation will use the method specified in the NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU: Critical axial load for torsional and flexural torsional buckling modes to calculate these. See section 4.9 below for details. Note: The UK National Annex or EC3 does not deal with angle sections in specific and hence this implementation will use the method used in the current EC3 implementation to deal with slenderness of angle sections. In the current implementation this is done as per cl 4.7.10 of BS 5950. This proposed implementation will still use the same method for single and double angle sections to evaluate the slenderness. Clause NA 3.2 of the UK NA also requires that Where the section is not an I Section or a hollow section and is a class1 or class 2 section, it will be treated as a class 3 section for the purposes of this clause. Hence for all Class 1 or Class 2 cross sections that are NOT I, H, SHS, RHS or CHS sections, the elastic properties will be used for the purposes of 6.3.3 checks.
where, iy and iz are the radius of gyration about the Y-Y (weak axis) and Z-Z (strong axis) respectively. The critical axial load for Torsional-Flexural buckling is worked out as:
374 STAAD.Pro
Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that have been dealt with in the French National Annex (hereafter referred to as FR-NA) and that are relevant to the proposed implementation are:
l
3.2.1(1) Material properties 6.1(1) General 6.3.2.2 Lateral Torsional Buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3(1) Lateral Torsional buckling curves for rolled or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor calculations 6.3.2.4(1)B Slenderness limit c0 6.3.2.4(2)B Modification factor kfl 6.3.3 Method for calculation interaction factors for members in combined bending and compression Annex A Members in bending and axial compression 6.3.1.4 Slenderness for torsional and torsional- flexural buckling
Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the French-NA.
This new table replaces Table 3.1 in NF EN 1993-1-1:2005. Table 3.1 NF excludes steel grades from standards EN 10210-1 and EN 10219-1 that are given in EC-3. STAAD.Pro uses the steel grades and values from the table given in the National Annex (i.e., - Table 3.1 NF). Table 3.1 NF is similar to table 3.1 in EC3, apart from the fu values for S 355 and S355 W grade steel.
If you specify a steel grade that is not given in the Annex Table 3.1 (NF) but is present in Table 3.1 of EN 1993-1-1:2005, this implementation will use the values from Table 3.1 of EN 1993-1-1:2005. The appropriate yield strength used (fy) will be shown in the design output file.
376 STAAD.Pro
Resistance of cross-sections - M0 = 1.0 Resistance of members to instability - M1 = 1.0 Resistance of cross sections to tension - M2 = 1.25
STAAD.Pro sets the default values of the GM0, GM1 and GM2 parameters in the design module to the values as: GM0 = 1.0 GM1 = 1.0 GM2 = 1.25 Note: When NA 4 has been specified. You may override these default values and set custom values to these parameters. Note: If any of these parameters have been specified by the user as 0, STAAD.Pro will ignore the specified value and use the default values as given above.
Warning: The GB1 parameter (which, in fact was common to the base EC-3 and was a reminiscent of the previous DD ENV implementation of EC-3) has been removed. Hence any legacy STAAD files that have the GB1 Parameter defined will need to be revised to take out this parameter as it is no longer valid as per the latest EN1993.
Clause 6.3.2.2 Elastic critical moment and imperfection factors for LTB checks
The French NA recommends the use of Table 6.3 and 6.4 of NF EN 1993-1-1:2005 to calculate the imperfection factors for Lateral Torsional Buckling (LTB) checks.
The calculation of the LTB reduction factor LT, requires the calculation of the Elastic Critical Buckling Moment, Mcr. The French NA gives a method to evaluate Mcr in its Annex MCR. This implementation will make use of this method to evaluate Mcr. Annex MCR however deals with the calculation of Mcr for doubly symmetric sections. Hence this implementation will use this method only for doubly symmetric sections. For mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the minor axis (i.e Tee sections) this implementation will use the method from the NCCI document SN030a-EN-EU as given in the section below. For any other type of section that is not dealt with by the Annex, this implementation will use the method and tables given in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992. 1. Annex MCR This document provides a method to calculate Mcr specifically for doubly symmetric sections only. Hence only doubly symmetric sections will be considered for this method in this implementation. The equation to evaluate Mcr is given as :
C1 and C2 are factors that depend on the end conditions and the loading conditions. The NCCI provides values for C1 and C2 for the different cases as given in Table1 and Table 2 of the Annex. Table 1 deals with the condition of a simply supported member with end moments and the value of C1 is determined by the end moment ratio (Refer to the NA for details). Clause 3.2 of the National Annex however gives a formula to evaluate C1 as :
This formula however does not match the values given in Table 1 of the NA. Hence this implementation will use the values of C1 from Table 1 if the end moment ration () is exactly equal to the values of in the table. For all other cases this implementation will calculate the value of C1 from equation (6) in the Annex.
378 STAAD.Pro
The value of C2 will be determined from Table 2 of the Annex based on the loading and end conditions (i.e the CMM parameter in STAAD). The user will also have the option to specify specific values for C1 & C2 using the new C1 and C2 parameters in the design input mode. The French NA considers three separate loading conditions:
l
Members with end moments Members with transverse loading Members with end moments and transverse loading.
The first two cases and its variants can be defined using with the existing CMM parameter values in STAAD.Pro. However the third condition cannot be currently specified in the design input. Hence this implementation will introduce two new values for CMM viz. CMM 7:Member with varying end moments and uniform loading. CMM 8: Member with varying end moments and central point load. The load to moment ratio () will then be used in the calculations will then be used to calculate C1 and C2 as given in section 3.5 of Annex MCR (See Annex MCR in the NA for details). This implementation will also introduce a new parameter MU to be specified when using CMM = 7 or 8. The load to moment ratio () to be used in the calculations is to be input using the new MU parameter. This implementation will require that for the French National Annex if CMM = 7 or 8 has been specified, the user should also either specify a value for MU or input the values for C1 and C2 using the C1 and/or C2 parameters directly. Note: The new parameter MU will currently be applicable only in the context of the French NA. 2. SN030a-EN-EU Mono-symmetrical uniform members under bending and axial compression: This document provides a method to evaluate the elastic critical moment (Mcr) for uniform mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the weak axis. Hence for this implementation the elastic critical moment for TeeSections will be worked out using the method in this NCCI.
Note: Though this method could also be applicable to mono-symmetric built-up sections, STAAD.Pro currently does not have a means to specify/identify a mono-symmetric built-up section. Hence this implementation will use this method only for Tee-Sections. The equation to evaluate Mcr for mono symmetric sections is given as :
The factors C1, C2 and C3 are dependent on the end conditions and loading criteria. This implementation will consider C1, C2 and C3 as given in the tables below:
The CMM parameter specified during design input will determine the values of C1, C2 and C3. The default value of CMM is 0, which considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. This NCCI does not
380 STAAD.Pro
however consider the end moments and transverse loading condition. The user however can use the new C1, C2 and C3 parameters to input the required values for C1, C2 and C3 to be used in calculating Mcr. Note: If MU as well as C1, C2 and C3 have been specified, the program will ignore MU and use the user input values of C1, C2 and C3. The current implementation of EC3 in STAAD.Pro obtains these values from Annex F of DD ENV version of 1993-1-1:1992. Also, the NCCI document and Annex MCR of the FR-NA assume that the member under consideration is free to rotate on plan and that there are no warping restraints for the member( k = kw=1 .i.e., CMN parameter =1.0). Hence the above methods will be used only for members which are free to rotate on plan and which have no warping restraints. For members with partial or end fixities (ie, CMN = 0.5 or CMN = 0.7), this implementation will fall back on to the method and coefficients in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992. For all cases that are not dealt with by the National Annex (or the NCCI documents) this implementation will use the method as per the DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 code. The term zg in the equation to calculate Mcr refers to the distance between the point of application of load on the cross section in relation to the shear center of the cross section. The value of zg is considered positive, if the load acts towards the shear center and is negative if it acts away from the shear center. By default, the program will assume that the load acts towards the shear center at a distance equal to (Depth of section/2) from the shear center. The use will be allowed to modify this value by using the ZG parameter. Specifying a value of ZG = 0 in the design input would indicate that the load acts exactly at the shear center of the section so that the term zg in the equation will have a value of zero. Note: There is a separate method specified in the NCCI document SN006aEN-EU to calculate Mcr for cantilever beams. Again this document does not give any specific formulae to evaluate the coefficients. Hence, this has not been implemented in STAAD.Pro.
and
LT
Since EN 1993-1-1:2005 limits the value of LT0 to 0.4, this implementation will only allow a maximum value of 0.4 for .
LT0
And for all sections use = 1.0 These equations and factors are then applied to equation 6.57 of NF EN 1993-1-1 to evaluate the Lateral Torsional Buckling reduction factor .
LT
382 STAAD.Pro
The French Annex specifies that the modification factor is applicable only to members that are free to rotate on plan (i.e., CMN =1.0). Hence for all other values of CMN, this implementation will ignore f and hence will use = .
LT,mod LT
where, iy and iz are the radius of gyration about the Y-Y (weak axis) and Z-Z (strong axis) respectively. The critical axial load for Torsional-Flexural buckling is worked out as:
384 STAAD.Pro
Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that have been dealt with in the Finnish National Annex (hereafter referred to as SFS-NA) and that are relevant to the proposed implementation are:
l
3.2.1(1) Material properties 6.1(1) General 6.3.2.2 Lateral Torsional Buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3(1) Lateral Torsional buckling curves for rolled or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor calculations 6.3.2.4(1) B Slenderness limit c0 6.3.2.4(2) B Modification factor kfl 6.3.3 Method for calculation interaction factors for members in combined bending and compression Annex B Members in bending and axial compression
Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the Finnish-NA.
The Finnish National Annex states in Cl. 3.1(2) that, apart from the steel grades specified in Table 3.1 of SFS EN 1993-1-1, the following steel grades can also be used:
l
Steel grades S315MC, S355MC, S420MC and S460MC according to SFS-EN 10149-2 Steel grades S260NC, S315NC, S355NC and S420NC according to SFS-EN 10149-3
These grades of steel can be specified by using the PY(Yield Strength) and FU (Ultimate Strength)parameters in STAAD.Pro. Set these parameters to the respective values as given in SFS-EN 10149-2/3 for the steel grades specified above. The choice of the buckling curve to be used is based on the value of the SGR parameter specified. The output will include the appropriate yield strength used for design.
Resistance of cross-sections - M0 = 1.0 Resistance of members to instability - M1 = 1.0 Resistance of cross sections to tension - M2 = 1.25
STAAD.Pro sets the default values of the GM0, GM1 and GM2 parameters in the design module to the values as: GM0 = 1.0 GM1 = 1.0 GM2 = 1.25 Note: When NA 5 has been specified. You may override these default values and set custom values to these parameters. These parameters are reported in the design output.
386 STAAD.Pro
Note: If any of these parameters have been specified by the user as 0, STAAD.Pro will ignore the specified value and use the default values as given above.
Clause 6.3.2.2 Elastic critical moment and imperfection factors for LTB checks
The Finnish NA recommends the use of Table 6.3 and 6.4 of SFS EN 1993-11:2005 to calculate the imperfection factors for Lateral Torsional Buckling (LTB) checks. The calculation of the LTB reduction factor XLT, requires the calculation of the Elastic Critical Buckling Moment, Mcr. The Finnish National Annex does not specify a particular method to calculate Mcr. Hence the calculation of Mcr has been based on the following NCCI documents: 1. SN003a-EN-EU Elastic critical moment for Lateral torsional Buckling: This document provides a method to calculate Mcr specifically for doubly symmetric sections only. Hence only doubly symmetric sections will be considered for this method. The equation to evaluate Mcr is given in the NCCI as:
C1 and C2 are factors that depend on the end conditions and the loading conditions of the member. The NCCI provides values for C1 and C2 for the different cases as given in the tables below:
Table 5B.9 - Values of C for 1 end moment loading (for k=1) +1,00 +0,75 +0,50 +0,25 0,00 -0,25 -0,50 -0,75 C
1
Members with end moments Members with transverse loading Members with end moments and transverse loading.
STAAD.Pro accounts for the loading condition and the bending moment diagram through the CMM parameter. 2. SN030a-EN-EU Mono-symmetrical uniform members under bending and axial compression: This document provides a method to evaluate the elastic critical moment (Mcr) for uniform mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the weak axis. Hence, the elastic critical moment for Tee-Sections will be worked out using the method in this NCCI. Note: Though this method could also be applicable to mono-symmetric built-up sections, STAAD.Pro currently does not have a means to specify/identify a mono-symmetric built-up section. Hence this implementation will use this method only for Tee-Sections. The equation to evaluate Mcr for mono symmetric sections is given as :
388 STAAD.Pro
The factors C1, C2 and C3 are dependent on the end conditions and loading criteria. This implementation will consider C1, C2 and C3 as given in the tables below:
The CMM parameter specified during design input will determine the values of C1, C2 and C3. The default value of CMM is 0, which considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. This NCCI does not however consider the end moments and transverse loading condition. The user however can use the new C1, C2 and C3 parameters to input the required values for C1, C2 and C3 to be used in calculating Mcr. Note: If MU as well as C1, C2 and C3 have been specified, the program will ignore MU and use the user input values of C1, C2 and C3. STAAD.Pro obtains these values from Annex F of DD ENV version of 1993-1-1:1992.
Both the NCCI documents mentioned above assume that the member under consideration is free to rotate on plan and that there are no warping restraints for the member ( k = kw = 1.0). STAAD.Pro takes into account of the end conditions using the CMN parameter for EC3. A value of K = kw =1 is indicated by a value of CMN = 1.0 in the design input. Hence the above methods will be used only for members which are free to rotate on plan and which have no warping restraints (i.e., CMN = 1.0). For members with partial or end fixities (i.e., CMN = 0.5 or CMN = 0.7), this implementation will fall back on to the method and coefficients in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 Annex F. For all cases that are not dealt with by the National Annex (or the NCCI documents) this implementation will use the method as per the DD ENV 1993-11:1992 code. The term zg in the equation to calculate Mcr refers to the distance between the point of application of load on the cross section in relation to the shear center of the cross section. The value of zg is considered positive, if the load acts towards the shear center and is negative if it acts away from the shear center. By default, the program will assume that the load acts towards the shear center at a distance equal to (Depth of section/2) from the shear center. The use will be allowed to modify this value by using the ZG parameter. Specifying a value of ZG = 0 in the design input would indicate that the load acts exactly at the shear center of the section so that the term zg in the equation will have a value of zero. Note: There is a separate method specified in the NCCI document SN006aEN-EU to calculate Mcr for cantilever beams. Again this document does not give any specific formulae to evaluate the coefficients. Hence, this has not been implemented in STAAD.Pro.
390 STAAD.Pro
LT0
The Finnish NA specifies the following limits for choosing the buckling curves: Table 5B.10 - Selection of lateral torsional buckling curve for cross sectiosn using equation (6.57) Cross-section (constant cross-section) Rolled double symmetric I- and H- sections and hot finished hollow sections. Limits Buckling Curve h/b 2 2< h/b <3.1 Welded double symmetric I- section and H- sections and cold-formed hollow sections h/b 2 2< h/b < 3.1 The NA says that for all other cases the rules given in Cl 6.3.2.2 should be used. Hence even for rolled or welded doubly symmetric sections with h/b ratio 3.1, this implementation will resort to checks as per clause 6.3.2.2. These equations and factors are then applied to equation 6.57 of SFS-EN 1993-1-1 to evaluate the Lateral Torsional Buckling reduction factor .
LT
b c
c d
Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 Calculation of LTB Reduction factor, LT as per Finnish NA
Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 (EN 1993-1-1:2005), both give equations to evaluate the LTB reduction factor to be used in eqn. 6.55 of SFS EN 1993-1-1:2005.
LT
Cl. 6.3.2.2 uses tables 6.3 and 6.4 to choose the buckling curve and the imperfection factors to be used for calculating . Table 6.4 specifies the choice of LT buckling curves for Rolled I Sections, Welded I Sections and Any other sections. Cl 6.3.2.3 on the other hand uses tables 6.5 and 6.3 to choose the
buckling curves and imperfection factors. Table 6.5 however only deals with Rolled I Sections and Welded I Sections. Cl. 6.3.2.2 states Unless otherwise specified, see 6.3.2.3, for bending members of constant cross section the value of should be determined from.... Hence in LT the implementation of EC3 (and the Finnish Annex) in STAAD.Pro: by default the program will consider clause Cl. 6.3.2.3 to evaluate . For any case that is not LT dealt with by Cl. 6.3.2.3, the program will consider Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT
Cl. 6.3.2.3 in the Finnish National Annex gives equations to evaluate the imperfection factors to be used for various section types. (See above). Hence for all cases dealt with by the equations in the Finnish NA, this implementation will use Cl 6.3.2.3 to evaluate .
LT
For any other type of cross section that is not dealt with by the National Annex or Cl.6.3.2.3, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT
In any case, the elastic critical moment,Mcr, (used to evaluate the non dimensional slenderness) will be worked out as given above. Since this implementation uses the NCCIs mentioned in the sections above, only end restraint conditions corresponding to the CMN parameter=1.0 (See section above) will be considered. For all other cases of the CMN parameter values, this implementation will use the method specified in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992. Note: If a National Annex has not been specified (i.e., NA parameter in the design input = 0), the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 only in the case of Rolled or welded I & H Sections. For all other cases, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. Also, I sections with plates will be treated as built-up sections only if the section has been explicitly specified as a built-up section (i.e., SBLT parameter = 1.0 in design input).
392 STAAD.Pro
Hence this clause will be ignored for the Finnish National Annex.
where, iy and iz are the radius of gyration about the Y-Y (weak axis) and Z-Z (strong axis) respectively. The critical axial load for Torsional-Flexural buckling is worked out as:
The program will only consider Channel Sections and Tee- sections while working out the critical torsional and Flexural Torsional buckling loads as per Cl 6.3.1.4. For details on these equations, refer to the NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU.
Description
The clauses/sections in EN 1993-1-1:2005 (hereafter referred to as EC-3) that have been dealt with in the Polish National Annex (hereafter referred to as PN-NA) and that are relevant to the proposed implementation are:
l
3.2.1(1) Material properties 6.1(1) General 6.3.2.2 Lateral Torsional Buckling curves General case 6.3.2.3(1) Lateral Torsional buckling curves for rolled or equivalent welded sections 6.3.2.3(2) Modification factor calculations 6.3.3 Method for calculation interaction factors for members in combined bending and compression Annex B Members in bending and axial compression
394 STAAD.Pro
Note: Refer to the basic code (EC3) for a description of these clauses. The sections below refer to the corresponding clauses in the Polish-NA.
Resistance of cross-sections - M0 = 1.0 Resistance of members to instability - M1 = 1.0 Resistance of cross sections to tension - M2 = minimum of 1.1 or 0.9 x fu/fy
STAAD.Pro sets the default values of the GM0, GM1 and GM2 parameters in the design module to the values as: GM0 = 1.0 GM1 = 1.0 Note: When NA 6 has been specified. STAAD.Pro determines the value for GM2 based on the value of the SGR design parameter or the fy and/or fu values specified using the PY and FU design parameters. If any of these parameters have not been specified, the program will use the SGR parameter to determine fy or fu and use them to evaluate GM2. Thus, GM2 is taken as the minimum of:
l
Where:
fu is the ultimate steel strength fy is the yield strength of steel You may override these default values and set custom values to these parameters. These parameters are reported in the design output. Note: If any of these parameters have been specified by the user as 0, STAAD.Pro will ignore the specified value and use the default values as given above.
Clause 6.3.2.2 Elastic critical moment and imperfection factors for LTB checks
The Polish NA recommends the use of Table 6.3 and 6.4 of PN EN 1993-1-1:2005 to calculate the imperfection factors for Lateral Torsional Buckling (LTB) checks. The calculation of the LTB reduction factor XLT, requires the calculation of the Elastic Critical Buckling Moment, Mcr. The Polish National Annex does not specify a particular method to calculate Mcr. Hence the calculation of Mcr has been based on the following NCCI documents: 1. SN003a-EN-EU Elastic critical moment for Lateral torsional Buckling: This document provides a method to calculate Mcr specifically for doubly symmetric sections only. Hence only doubly symmetric sections will be considered for this method. The equation to evaluate Mcr is given in the NCCI as:
C1 and C2 are factors that depend on the end conditions and the loading conditions of the member. The NCCI provides values for C1 and C2 for the different cases as given in the tables below:
396 STAAD.Pro
Table 5B.11 - Values of C for 1 end moment loading (for k=1) +1,00 +0,75 +0,50 +0,25 0,00 -0,25 -0,50 -0,75 C
1
Members with end moments Members with transverse loading Members with end moments and transverse loading.
STAAD.Pro accounts for the loading condition and the bending moment diagram through the CMM parameter. 2. SN030a-EN-EU Mono-symmetrical uniform members under bending and axial compression: This document provides a method to evaluate the elastic critical moment (Mcr) for uniform mono symmetric sections that are symmetric about the weak axis. Hence, the elastic critical moment for Tee-Sections will be evaluated using the method in this NCCI. Note: Though this method could also be applicable to mono-symmetric built-up sections, STAAD.Pro currently does not have a means to specify/identify a mono-symmetric built-up section. Hence this implementation will use this method only for Tee-Sections. The equation to evaluate Mcr for mono symmetric sections is given as :
The factors C1, C2 and C3 are dependent on the end conditions and loading criteria. This implementation will consider C1, C2 and C3 as given in the tables below:
The CMM parameter specified during design input will determine the values of C1, C2 and C3. The default value of CMM is 0, which considers the member as a pin ended member with UDL along its span. This NCCI does not however consider the end moments and transverse loading condition. The user however can use the new C1, C2 and C3 parameters to input the required values for C1, C2 and C3 to be used in calculating Mcr. Note: If MU as well as C1, C2 and C3 have been specified, the program will ignore MU and use the user input values of C1, C2 and C3.
398 STAAD.Pro
Both the NCCI documents mentioned above assume that the member under consideration is free to rotate on plan and that there are no warping restraints for the member ( k = kw = 1.0). STAAD.Pro takes into account of the end conditions using the CMN parameter for EC3. A value of K = kw =1 is indicated by a value of CMN = 1.0 in the design input. Hence the above methods will be used only for members which are free to rotate on plan and which have no warping restraints (i.e., CMN = 1.0). For members with partial or end fixities (i.e., CMN = 0.5 or CMN = 0.7), this implementation will fall back on to the method and coefficients in DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 Annex F. For all cases that are not dealt with by the National Annex (or the NCCI documents) this implementation will use the method as per the DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992 code. The term zg in the equation to calculate Mcr refers to the distance between the point of application of load on the cross section in relation to the shear center of the cross section. The value of zg is considered positive, if the load acts towards the shear center and is negative if it acts away from the shear center. By default, the program will assume that the load acts towards the shear center at a distance equal to (Depth of section/2) from the shear center. The use will be allowed to modify this value by using the ZG parameter. Specifying a value of ZG = 0 in the design input would indicate that the load acts exactly at the shear center of the section so that the term zg in the equation will have a value of zero. Note: There is a separate method specified in the NCCI document SN006aEN-EU to calculate Mcr for cantilever beams. Again this document does not give any specific formulae to evaluate the coefficients. Hence, this has not been implemented in STAAD.Pro.
LT0
The Polish NA specifies the use of uses table 6.5 to work out the buckling curves for use in Cl. 6.3.2.3. Hence table 6.5 in PN-EN 1993-1-1 will be used for this. These equations and factors are then applied to equation 6.57 of PN-EN 1993-1-1 to evaluate the Lateral Torsional Buckling reduction factor .
LT
Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 Calculation of LTB Reduction factor, as per Polish NA
LT
Clauses 6.3.2.2 and 6.3.2.3 (EN 1993-1-1:2005) both give equations to evaluate the LTB reduction factor to be used in eqn. 6.55 of PN EN 1993-1-1:2005.
LT
Cl. 6.3.2.2 uses tables 6.3 and 6.4 to choose the buckling curve and the imperfection factors to be used for calculating . Table 6.4 specifies the choice of LT buckling curves for Rolled I Sections, Welded I Sections and Any other sections. Cl 6.3.2.3 on the other hand uses tables 6.5 and 6.3 to choose the buckling curves and imperfection factors. Table 6.5 however only deals with Rolled I Sections and Welded I Sections. Cl. 6.3.2.2 states Unless otherwise specified, see 6.3.2.3, for bending members of constant cross section the value of should be determined from.... Hence in LT the implementation of EC3 (and the Polish Annex) in STAAD.Pro: by default the program will consider clause Cl. 6.3.2.3 to evaluate . For any case that is not LT dealt with by Cl. 6.3.2.3, the program will consider Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT
Cl. 6.3.2.3 in the Polish National Annex gives equations to evaluate the imperfection factors to be used for various section types. (See above). Hence for all cases dealt with by the equations in the Polish NA, this implementation will use Cl 6.3.2.3 to evaluate .
LT
For any other type of cross section that is not dealt with by the National Annex or Cl.6.3.2.3, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 to evaluate .
LT
In any case, the elastic critical moment,Mcr, (used to evaluate the non dimensional slenderness) will be evaluated as given above. Since this implementation uses the NCCIs mentioned in the sections above, only end restraint conditions corresponding to the CMN parameter=1.0 (See section above) will be considered. For all other cases of the CMN parameter values, this implementation will use the method specified in Annex F of DD ENV 1993-1-1:1992.
400 STAAD.Pro
Note: If a National Annex has not been specified (i.e., NA parameter in the design input = 0), the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.3 only in the case of Rolled or welded I & H Sections. For all other cases, the program will use Cl. 6.3.2.2 of BS EN 1993-1-1:2005. Also, I sections with plates will be treated as built-up sections only if the section has been explicitly specified as a built-up section (i.e., SBLT parameter = 1.0 in design input).
PLG = 0 (default) : Ignore additional Cl. 6.3.3 checks PLG = 1 : Include additional Cl. 6.3.3 checks.
If the value of the PLG parameter is set to 1, the following two checks will be performed as per Cl. NA.20.(2) and NA.20(3) respectively:
m /
y
LT
+ C mz m with 1- (I = y or z)
0
- LTB factor
C - moment factor from table B 3 of PN EN 1993-1-1, -correction factor (estimation of maximum reduction) and will 0 be worked out as: = 0,1 + 0,2 (w 1), przy czym w = W /W , 0 i i pl,i el,i or = 0,1 in case of class 3 and 4 sections.
0
l
Cl. NA.20.(3): This condition will only be checked for circular hollow sections. n/ + [(k m )2 + (C
i ii i mj
where: k - the interaction factor from table B.1 of PN-EN 1993-1-1 and n, m, Cmj are as above. If the PLG parameter has been set to 1, the maximum among the following ratios will be taken as being critical for Cl 6.3.3: 6.3.3: Eqn6.61 6.3.3: Eqn6.62 NA.20(2) and NA.20(3) If however PLG has been set to 0 or not specified at all, the program will ignore the last two checks in the list above.
402 STAAD.Pro
where, iy and iz are the radius of gyration about the Y-Y (weak axis) and Z-Z (strong axis) respectively. The critical axial load for Torsional-Flexural buckling is evaluated as:
The program will only consider Channel Sections and Tee- sections while working out the critical torsional and Flexural Torsional buckling loads as per Cl 6.3.1.4. For details on these equations, refer to the NCCI document SN001a-EN-EU.
404 STAAD.Pro
Determination of Factors
A. Kmod Modification factor taking into account of Load-duration (LDC) and Moisture-content (Service Class - SCL). Reference Table 3.1 of EC-5-2004. For Solid Timber, the values are incorporated in the program. B. Partial factor for Material Property values. Reference Table 2.3 of EC-5m 2004. For Solid Timber, the value of = 1.3 is incorporated in the program.
m
C. Kh Size Factor. For members, subjected to tension, whose maximum c/s dimension is less than the reference width in tension the characteristic strength in tension (ft0k) is to be increased by the factor Kh.
406 STAAD.Pro
For members, subjected to bending, whose depth is less than reference depth in bending, the characteristic strength in bending (fmk) is to be increased by the factor Kh. As per clause 3.2(3) of EC 5- 2004, for rectangular solid timber with a characteristic timber density 700 kg/m3 the reference depth in bending k or the reference width (maximum cross-sectional dimension) is 150 mm. The value of Kh = Minimum of {(150/h) 0.2 and 1.3) for such solid timber is incorporated in the software. Please refer clause numbers 3.3 and 3.4 for the value of Kh for Glued laminated timber and Laminated veener lumber respectively. D. KC90 Factor taking into account the load configuration, possibility of splitting and degree of compressive deformation. For members, subjected to compression, perpendicular to the direction of grain alignment, this factor should be taken into account. Default value of 1 is used in STAAD.Pro. User may override the value. Please refer clause 6.1.5 of EC-5-2004 in this regard. E. Km Factor considering re-distribution of bending stress in cross section. For members, subjected to bending, this factor is taken into account for stress checking. For rectangular section the value of Km is 0.7, and this value is incorporated in STAAD.Pro. User may override the value. Please refer clause 6.1.6 of EC-5-2004 in this regard. F. Kshape Factor depending on shape of cross section. For members, subjected to torsional force, design torsional stress should be less than equal design shear strength multiplied by the factor Kshape. This factor is determined by STAAD.Pro internally using the guidelines of clause 6.1.8 of EC-5-2004.
Description Design tensile stress parallel (at zero degree) to grain alignment. Design tensile stress perpendicular (at 90 degrees) to grain alignment. Design compressive stress parallel to grain alignment. Design compressive stress perpendicular to grain alignment. Design bending stress about zz axis. Design bending stress about yy axis. Design shear stress. Design torsional stress. Design tensile strength - parallel to the grain alignment. Design tensile strength - perpendicular to the grain alignment. Design compressive strength - parallel to the grain alignment. Design compressive strength - perpendicular to the grain alignment. Design bending strength - about zz-axis. Design bending strength - about yy-axis. Design shear strength about yy axis. Permissible ratio of stresses as input using the RATIOparameter. The default value is 1.
t90d
S S S S S
c0d
c90d mzd
myd vd
S F F F F F F
tor_d t0d
t90d c0d
RATIO
l ,l l ,l E G
Slenderness ratios corresponding to bending about zz axis. Slenderness ratios corresponding to bending about yy axis. Fifth percentile value of modulus of elasticity parallel to grain. Fifth percentile value of shear modulus parallel to grain. Second moment of area about the strong z-axis. Second moment of area about the weak y-axis. Torsional moment of inertia. Characteristic bending strength. Width and depth of beam.
I I I f
z y
tor
mk
b, h
408 STAAD.Pro
Equations for Characteristic Values of Timber Species as per Annex-A of EN 338:2003 The following equations were used to determine the characteristic values: For a particular Timber Strength Class (TSC), the following characteristic strength values are required to compute the other related characteristic values. i. Bending Strength f
m,k 0, mean
Property
Symbol
1. Tensile Strength parallel to grain 2. Tensile Strength perpendicular to grain 3. Compressive Strength parallel to grain 4. Compressive Strength perpendicular to grain 5. Shear Strength 6. Modulus of Elasticity parallel to grain 7. Mean Modulus of Elasticity perpendicular to grain 8. Mean Shear Modulus 9. Shear Modulus
f f
t,0,k
0.6 * f
m,k
t,90,k c,0,k
f f
c,90,k
0.007*r
0.0015*r
f E E
v,k
0,05
Minimum of {3.8 and 0.8)} (0.2*f m,k 0.67* 0.84* E E 0,mean 0,mean E /30 E /15
0,mean 0,mean
0,mean
/16
0,05
/16
The values of the characteristic strengths computed using the above equations, may differ with the tabulated values in Table-1 of EN 338:2003. However, in all such cases, the values obtained from the provided equations are treated as actual and is used by the program, as the values of Table-1 are based on these equations.
The member resistance in timber structure is calculated in STAAD according to the procedures outlined in EC5. This depends on several factors such as cross sectional properties, different load and material factors, timber strength class, load duration class, service class and so on. The methodology adopted in STAAD for calculating the member resistance is explained here.
/F
t0d
RATIO
If the direction of applied axial tension is perpendicular to the direction of timber grain alignment, the following formula should be checked: S
t90d
/F
t90d
RATIO
/F
c0d
RATIO
410 STAAD.Pro
If the direction of applied axial compression is perpendicular to the direction of timber grain alignment, the following formula should be checked per Equation 6.3 of EC-5 2004: S
t0d
/(F
t0d
Kc90) RATIO
mzd
mzd
myd myd
/F /F
myd myd
) RATIO ) RATIO
Km(S
mzd
/F
) +(S
RATIO
/(KshapeF
tor_d
) RATIO
t0d t0d
t0d t0d
mzd
mzd
myd myd
/F /F
myd myd
) RATIO ) RATIO
) +Km(S
mzd
/F
) +(S
c0d c0d
c0d c0d
mzd
mzd
myd myd
/F /F
myd myd
) RATIO ) RATIO
)2 +Km(S
mzd
/F
) +(S
Stability check
A. Column Stability check The relative slenderness ratios should be calculated per Equations 6.21 and 6.22 of EC-5 2004. Note: In STAAD z-z axis is the strong axis. = /(S
z y
rel,z rel,y
c0k
/E
0,05
)1/2 )1/2
= /(S
c0k
/E
0,05
If both and are less than or equal to 0.3 the following conditions rel,z rel,y should be satisfied: (S (S
c0d c0d
/F /F
c0d c0d
)2 +(S
mzd
/F
mzd
) +Km(S
mzd
myd myd
/F /F
myd myd
) RATIO ) RATIO
)2 +Km(S
mzd
/F
) +(S
In other cases, the conditions in Equations 6.23 and 6.24 of EC-5 2004 should be satisfied. Note: In STAAD z-z axis is the strong axis. S S /(KczF ) +(S /F ) +Km(S
mzd
c0d c0d
c0d
mzd
mzd
myd
/F
myd
) RATIO ) RATIO
/(KcyF
c0d
) +Km(S
mzd
/F
) +(S
myd
/F
myd
412 STAAD.Pro
rel,z
)2]1/2} )2]1/2}
rel,z
rel,y
- 0.3) +(
)2] )2]
Ky = 0.5[1 + (
- 0.3) +(
rel,y
The value of incorporated in the software is the one for solid timber (i.e., c 0.2). B. Beam Stability check If members are subjected to only a moment about the strong axis z, the stresses should satisfy Equation 6.33 of EC-5 2004: S
mzd
/(KcritF
mzd
) RATIO
Where a combination of moment about the strong z-axis and compressive force exists, the stresses should satisfy Equation 6.35 of EC-5 2004 (ref. to Equations 6.32 and 6.34 of the same): [S Where: Kcrit = 1.0 when
rel,m mzd
/(KcritF
mzd
)] 2 +S
c0d
/(KczF
c0d
) RATIO
rel,m
1.4
= (f
mk
/S
m,crit
= (E
0,05 y
I G
0,05 tor
)1/2/(l W )
ef z
= 0.78b2E
0,05
/(hl )
ef
Depending on the model being designed, the user may have to change some or all of the parameter default values. Some parameters are unit dependent and when altered, the new setting must be compatible with the active unit specification. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 5C.2 - Timber Design EC 5: Part 1-1 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Must be specified as TIMBER EC5 Design Code to follow. See section 5.51.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. ALPHA 0.0 Angle of inclination of load to the grain alignment. (Ref. Cl.6.1.1, Cl.6.1.2, Cl.6.1.3, Cl.6.1.4)
l
Description
414 STAAD.Pro
Description
Deflection Length / Max. Allowable Net Final Local Deflection. In this case, deflection check will be performed, if both the parameters SERV and DFF are present with specific values. For appropriate range of values, please refer Cl.7.2 (Table 7.2)
DJ1
Start node number for a physical member under consideration for Deflection Check.
DJ2
End node number for a physical member under consideration for Deflection Check.
European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1 Parameter Name KC90 Default Value 1.0 Factor taking into account the load configuration, possibility of splitting and degree of compressive deformation. (Ref. Cl.6.1.5(2))
l
Description
Other than the default value, user may specify any value within the range, depending on load-position, load-dispersion, contact length at support locations etc.
KLEF
Effective Length Factor to check Lateral Torsional Buckling. (Ref. Table 6.1) Span of the beam depending on the support conditions and load configurations. The user will put the appropriate value from the Table 6.1. Required only for MTYP has a value of 1 (Beam).
416 STAAD.Pro
Description
Effective Length Factor for Local-y-axis. (Ref. Cl.6.3.2), for the computation of the relative slenderness ratios. Effective Length Factor for Local-z-axis. (Ref. Cl.6.3.2), for the computation of the relative slenderness ratios. Load Duration Class (Ref. Cl.2.3.1.2), required to get the K-MOD value from Table 3.1. 1. Permanent action 2. Long term action 3. Medium term action 4. Short term action 5. Instantaneous action
KLZ
LDC
European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1 Parameter Name MTYP Default Value 0 Member Type: Beam/Column. (Ref. Cl.6.3.2, Cl.6.3.3) 0. Not defined by the user checks both clauses (Default). 1. Beam Member 2. Column Member This information is required to find which stability check will be performed as per the Cl 6.3 according to the Member Type. RATIO SCL 1.0 3 Permissible ratio of actual to allowable value. Service Class (Ref. Cl.2.3.1.3) 1. = Class 1, Moisture content <= 12% 2. = Class 2, Moisture content <= 20% 3. = Class 3, Moisture content > 20% Description
418 STAAD.Pro
Description
Defines the load case numbers those are to be considered for serviceability (deflection) check.
l
The list of this parameter must contain only the valid load-case numbers.
If this parameter is not provided, then in-spite of the presence of the parameter DFF the deflection check will NOT be performed.
TRACK
Degree/Level of Details of design output results. 1. Print the design output at the minimal detail level 2. Print the design output at the intermediate detail level 3. Print the design output that the maximum detail level
European Codes - Timber Design Per EC 5: Part 1-1 Parameter Name TSC Default Value 6 (C24) Timber Strength Class (Ref. Reference EN338 2003) Softwood: 1 = C14, 2 = C16, 3 = C18, 4 = C20, 5 = C22, 6 = C24, 7 = C27, 8 = C30, 9 = C35, 10 = C40, 11 = C45, 12 = C50. Hardwood: 13 = D30, 14 = D35, 15 = D40, 16 = D50, 17 = D60, 18 = D70. This TSC definition will calculate the corresponding characteristic strength values using the equations as given in BSEN-338, Annex - A. Description
Problem
A Timber Column of length 1.0 meter, having c/s dimension of 73 mm X 198 mm, is subjected to an axial compressive force of 50.0 kN. Design the member for the ultimate limit state. Material properties: Timber class: C24 Service classes: Class 2, moisture content 20% Load duration classes: Medium-term
420 STAAD.Pro
Cross section properties: Length of the member is 1 m. Rectangular cross section, b = 73 mm, h = 198 mm, Effective cross sectional area A = 14,454 mm, Radius of gyration of cross section about y-axis r = 21 mm,
y
Solution
Characteristic material properties for timber: Modification factor Kmod = 0.80 from table 3.1 Material factors f
c0k m
c0d
Compression parallel to the grain: S = (1000xF )/A = (1000x50.000)/14454 = 3.46N/mm < 12.92N/mm c0d x (F )
c0d
/F
c0d
= (1000/21) = 47.62
y
0,mean =
1.1031 kN/m2
= 0.67E
0,mean
= 0.739 kN/m2
= /(f
z y
c0k
/E
0,05
= /(f
c0k
/E
0,05
Since, S S
rel,y
c0d c0d
/(KczF
) +(S
mzd
/F
mzd
) +Km(S
mzd
myd
/F
myd
) RATIO ) RATIO
/(KcyF
c0d
) +Km(S
mzd
/F
) +(S
myd
/F
myd
Where: Kz = 0.5[1 + ( - 0.3) +( )2] = 0.50[1 +0.2(0.298 - 0.3) c rel,z rel,z +(0.298)2] = 0.541 Ky = 0.5[1 + ( - 0.3) +( )2] = 0.50[1 +0.2(0.809 - 0.3) c rel,y rel,y +(0.809)2] = 0.878 Kcz = 1/{K +[(K )2 - ( )2]1/2} = 1/{0.541 +[(0.541)2 - (0.298)2]1/2}= z z rel,z 1.008 Kcy = 1/{K +[(K )2 - ( )2]1/2} = 1/{0.878 +[(0.878)2 - (0.809)2]1/2} y zy rel,y = 0.820 For Rectangular cross section Km = 0.70. The member is subjected to Compression only, so actual bending stress is zero. S /(KczF ) +(S /F ) +Km(S /F ) = 3.46/(1.00812.92) c0d c0d mzd mzd myd myd +0.0 +0.0 = 0.268 +0.0 + 0.0 = 0.266 S /(KcyF ) +Km(S /F ) +(S /F ) = 3.46 /(0.82012.92) c0d c0d mzd mzd myd myd +0.0 +0.0 = 0.326 ++0.0 + 0.0 = 0.326 Hence the critical ratio is 0.326 < 1.0 and the section is safe.
422 STAAD.Pro
Comparison
Table 5C.3 - EC 5: Part 1-1 Verification Problem 1 Source Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Critical Ratio (Cl. 6.3.2) 0.326 0.327 Negligible
Input File
The following file is included AS C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\EUR\EC5 VER 1.STD.
STAAD SPACE INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 1.0 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC WOOD E 1.10316E+007 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 0.00231749 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL CONSTANTS MATERIAL WOOD MEMB 1 MEMBER PROPERTY 1 PRIS YD 0.198 ZD 0.073 SUPPORTS
1 FIXED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -50 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER EC5 ALPHA 0 ALL LDC 3 ALL SCL 2 ALL TSC 6 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Output
The member checking part of the output file:
STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (EC5 ) *********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 PRIS ZD = 0.073 YD = 0.198 PASS CL.6.3.2 0.327 1 50.00 C 0.00 0.00 0.0000 |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | AX = 0.01 IY = 0.00 IZ = 0.00 | | LEZ = 1.00 LEY = 1.00 | | | METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCA-
424 STAAD.Pro
| ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (NEW MMS) | | FBY = 14.769 FBZ = 14.769 | | FC = 12.859 | | ACTUAL STRESSES : (NEW MMS) | | fby = 0.000 fbz = 0.000 | | fc = 3.459 | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------|
Problem
A Timber Column of length 1.0 meter, having c/s dimension of 73 mm X 198 mm, is subjected to an axial compressive force of 5.0 kN and moments of 2.0 kN.m and 1.0 kN.m about its major and minor axes respectively. Design the member for the ultimate limit state. Material properties: Timber Strength Class: C24 Service classes: Class 2, moisture content <=20% Load duration: Medium-term Cross section properties: Length of the member is 1 m. Rectangular cross section, b = 73 mm, h = 198 mm, Effective cross sectional area A = 14454 mm, Radius of gyration of cross section about y-axis r = 21 mm,
y
Solution
Characteristic material properties for timber: Modification factor Kmod = 0.80 from table 3.1 Material factors f
c0k m
E F f
0,05
c0d
= (Kmodf
myk
F f
myd
/ = (0.80x24.00)/1.30 = 14.77N/mm
m
mzk
mzd
/ = (0.80x24.00)/1.30 = 14.77N/mm
m
M = 2.000 kNm
z
M = 1.000 kNm
y
= (1000/21) = 47.62
y
rel,z rel,y
= /(f
z y
c0k
/E
0,05
= /(f
c0k
/E
0,05
Since, is greater than 0.3, following conditions should be satisfied [Cl rel,y 6.3.2.3]: S S
c0d c0d
/(KczF
c0d
) +(S
mzd
/F
mzd
) +Km(S
mzd
myd
/F
myd
) RATIO ) RATIO
/(KcyF
c0d
) +Km(S
mzd
/F
) +(S
myd
/F
myd
Where:
426 STAAD.Pro
Kz = 0.5[1 + ( - 0.3) +( )2] = 0.50[1 +0.2(0.298 - 0.3) c rel,z rel,z +(0.298)2] = 0.541 Ky = 0.5[1 + ( - 0.3) +( )2] = 0.50[1 +0.2(0.809 - 0.3) c rel,y rel,y +(0.809)2] = 0.878 Kcz = 1/{K +[(K )2 - ( )2]1/2} = 1/{0.541 +[(0.541)2 - (0.298)2]1/2}= z z rel,z 1.008 Kcy = 1/{K +[(K )2 - ( )2]1/2} = 1/{0.878 +[(0.878)2 - (0.809)2]1/2} y zy rel,y = 0.820 For Rectangular cross section Km = 0.70. S S S
c0d
mzd myd
Combined stress ratio: S /(KczF ) +(S /F ) +Km(S /F ) = 0.35/(1.00812.92) c0d c0d mzd mzd myd myd +4.19/14.77 +0.70(5.69/14.77) = 0.027 +0.283 +0.269 = 0.266 S /(KcyF ) +Km(S /F ) +(S /F ) = 0.35 /(0.82012.92) c0d c0d mzd mzd myd myd +0.70(4.19/14.77) +5.69/14.77 = 0.033 +0.385 +0.198 = 0.616 Hence the critical ratio is 0.616 < 1.0 and the section is safe.
Comparison
Table 5C.4 - EC 5: Part 1-1 Verification Problem 2 Source Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Critical Ratio (Cl. 6.3.2) 0.616 0.616 None
Input File
The following file is included AS C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\EUR\EC5 VER 2.STD.
STAAD SPACE INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 1 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC WOOD E 1.10316E+007 POISSON 0.15 DENSITY 0.00231749 ALPHA 5.5E-006 END DEFINE MATERIAL CONSTANTS MATERIAL WOOD MEMB 1 MEMBER PROPERTY 1 PRIS YD 0.198 ZD 0.073 SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FY -5.0 MX 1.0 MZ 2.0 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE TIMBER EC5 ALPHA 0 ALL LDC 3 ALL SCL 2 ALL TSC 6 ALL
428 STAAD.Pro
Output
The member checking part of the output file:
STAAD.Pro CODE CHECKING - (EC5 ) *********************** ALL UNITS ARE - KN MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 PRIS ZD = 0.073 YD = 0.198 PASS CL.6.3.2 0.616 1 5.00 C 1.00 -2.00 0.0000 |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | AX = 0.01 IY = 0.00 IZ = 0.00 | | LEZ = 1.00 LEY = 1.00 | | | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (NEW MMS) | | FBY = 14.769 FBZ = 14.769 | | FC = 12.859 | | ACTUAL STRESSES : (NEW MMS) | | fby = 5.686 fbz = 4.193 | | fc = 0.346 | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| METE (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCA-
430 STAAD.Pro
Section 6
Egyptian Codes
432 STAAD.Pro
Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.
434 STAAD.Pro
program. Two-legged stirrups are provided to take care of the balance shear forces acting on these sections. The following represents a sample Beam Design Output:
436 STAAD.Pro
438 STAAD.Pro
440 STAAD.Pro
Compressive Stress
Allowable compressive stress on the gross section of axially loaded compression members shall not exceed the permissible stress calculated based on the following formula: (Clause: 2.6.4)
442 STAAD.Pro
= l/r = Slenderness ratio of the member, ratio of the effective length to appropriate radius of gyration
bt
or F
bc
= 0.64f
bt
= 0.58F
y bc
I. Compression flange is braced laterally at intervals exceeding L , the allowable u bending stress in compression F will be taken as follows.
bc
i. For shallow thick flanged sections, where approximately t L /(b d) > 4 f u f the lateral tensional buckling stress is governed by the torsion strength given by: F
ltb1
= [800/(L
ud
/A )]C 0.58F
f b
ii. For Deep flanged sections, where approximately t L /(b d) > 4 the f u f lateral torsional buckling stress governed by the buckling strength given by: a. When L /r 84(C /F )1/2, then
u T b y u T b y y
F b. When
1tb2
= 0.58F
84(C /F )1/2 b y
F Where:
1tb2
L = Effective laterally unsupported length of compression u flange. k = Effective length factor r = radius of gyration about minor axis of a section T compressing the compression web area (in cms) b = Compression flange width
f
d = Total depth C = Coefficient depending on the type of load and support b conditions as given in table 2.2 I. Compression on extreme fibers of channels bent about their major axis F
ltb
Where: F F f
bt bc
= Bending stress in tension = Bending stress in compression = Yield stress of steel, in MPa
= 0.35F
Where: q
all
444 STAAD.Pro
Where:
ca c
,f
bcy
= Actual Bending stress about x and y-axes respectively. = Allowable compressive bending stress, clause 2.6.5
bcx Ex m
,F
bcy
F ,F
Ey
compression members will be checked against a maximum value of 180 and tension members will be checked against a maximum value of 300
446 STAAD.Pro
Egyptian Codes - Steel Design Per Egyptian Code # 205 Table 6B.1 - Egyptian Steel Design Code #205 Parameters Parameter Name CB Default Value Member length Description Coefficient depending on the type of load and conditions as g. Location of section force calculations: 0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by the SECTION command. 1.0 = calculate section forces at twelfth points along the beam, design at each intermediate location and report the critical location where ratio is maximum. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway Cm value in local y & z axes
BEAM
3.0
448 STAAD.Pro
Default Value None (Mandatory for deflection check) 100.0 cm. 0.0 cm. 250 MPA (36.25 KSI)
Description "Deflection Length" / Maxm. allowable local deflection Maximum allowable depth. Minimum allowable depth. Yield strength of steel.
MAIN
Allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for compression members. Net section factor for tension members. Used to search for the lightest section for the profile(s) specified for member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Sidesway 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis. 1.0 = No sidesway
NSF PROFILE
1.0 -
RATIO
1.0
SSY
0.0
Egyptian Codes - Steel Design Per Egyptian Code # 205 Parameter Name SSZ TMAIN Default Value 0.0 300 (Tension Memb) Description Same as above except in local z-axis. Allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for tension members. Design for weld: 1 = Weld for Closed sections 2 = Weld for Open sections WMIN WSTR 0.4 Fyld Minimum welding thickness. Absolute welding stress.
WELD
450 STAAD.Pro
Section 7
French Codes
452 STAAD.Pro
Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
CLEAR
* 20 mm YD
Clearance of reinforcing bar. Value is automatically set to 20 mm for C35 and higher. Depth of concrete member. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
DEPTH
French Codes - ConcreteDesign per B.A.E.L Parameter Default Name Value EFACE *0.0 Description
Face of Support Location at end of beam. Note: Both SFACE and EFACE are input as positive numbers.
Concrete Yield Stress. Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. Maximum main reinforcement bar size. (8mm - 60mm). Minimum main reinforcement bar size. (8mm - 60mm). Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. (8mm - 60mm). A factor by which the design moments will be magnified. Face of support location at start of beam. Only considers shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending. Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moments for beam design. Critical Moment will not be printed out with beam design report. A value of 1.0 will mean a print out. Width of the concrete member. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
NSECTION
10
TRACK
0.0
WIDTH
ZD
454 STAAD.Pro
* These values must be provided in the units currently being used for input.
In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 300 mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with a 300 mm diameter. Note that area (AX) is not provided for these members. If shear areas (AY & AZ) are to be considered in analysis, the user may provide them along with YD and ZD. Also note that moments of inertia may be provided, but if not provided, the program will calculate values from YD and ZD.
456 STAAD.Pro
square, rectangular, and circular sections. For rectangular and square sections, the reinforcement is always assumed to be equally distributed on each side. That means the total number of bars will always be a multiple of four (4). This may cause slightly conservative results in some cases. Example of Input Data for Column Design:
UNIT NEWTON MMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE BAEL FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEMB 2 TO 6 MMAG 1.5 MEMB 4 5 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 DESIGN COLUMN 2 TO 6 END CONCRETE DESIGN
458 STAAD.Pro
of axial compression resistance and flexural resistance of members. Slenderness calculations are made and overall geometric stability is checked for all members.
460 STAAD.Pro
Table 7B.1 - French Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value FRENCH Description
Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BEAM
0.0
0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by SECTION command. 1.0 = calculate moments at tenth points long the beam, and use maximum Mz for design.
C1
1.0
Parameter used in clause 5.21 in the calculation of M(D), the critical twisting moment and as shown in CM 66 Addendum 80, table 5, usual range from 0.71 to 4.10 Parameter used in clause 5.21 in the calculation of M(D), the critical twisting moment and as shown in CM 66 Addendum 80, table 5, usual range from 0.0 to 1.56 "Deflection Length" divided by the Maximum allowable local deflection
C2
1.0
DFF
DJ1
Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1)
DJ2
End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for calmember culation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1)
French Codes - SteelDesign per the French Code Parameter Name DMAX DMIN FYLD KY Default Value 100.0 cm. 0.0 cm. 250.0 MPa 1.0 Description
Maximum allowable depth (used in member selection). Minimum allowable depth (used in member selection). Yield strength of steel. K value for axial compression buckling about local Y-axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K value for axial compression buckling about local Z-axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio about Y-axis for axial compression. Length to calculate slenderness ratio about Z-axis for axial compression. Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of actual load effect and design strength.
KZ
1.0
LY
LZ
NSF RATIO
462 STAAD.Pro
Description
Controls the sections to try during a SELECT process. 0.0 = Try every section of the same type as original 1.0 = Try only those sections with a similar name as original, e.g., if the original is an HEA 100, then only HEA sections will be selected, even if there are HEMs in the same table.
TRACK
0.0
0.0 = Suppress printing of all design strengths. 1.0 = Print all design strengths.
UNF UNL
Same as above provided as a fraction of member length. Unsupported length of compression flange for calculating moment resistance.
*For angles, if the original section is an equal angle, then the selected section will be an equal angle and vice versa for unequal angles.
Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.
Specify the members and the load cases to be considered in the design. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection. Specify design parameter values, if different from the default values.
These operations may be repeated by the user any number of times depending upon the design requirements. Currently STAAD supports steel design of wide flange, S, M, HP shapes, angle, double angle, channel, double channel, beams with cover plate, composite beams and code checking of prismatic properties.
464 STAAD.Pro
IPE Shapes
These shapes are designated in the following way.
10 15 TA ST IPE140 20 TO 30 TA ST IPEA120 33 36 TO 46 BY 2 TA ST IPER180
HE shapes
HE shapes are specified as follows.
3 5 TA ST HEA120A 7 10 TA ST HEM140 13 14 TA ST HEB100
IPN Shapes
The designation for the IPN shapes is similar to that for the IPE shapes.
25 TO 35 TA ST IPN200 23 56 TA ST IPN380
T Shapes
Tee sections are not input by their actual designations, but instead by referring to the I beam shapes from which they are cut. For example,
1 5 TA T IPE140 2 8 TA T HEM120
U Channels
Shown below is the syntax for assigning 4 different names of channel sections.
1 TO 5 TA ST UAP100 6 TO 10 TA ST UPN220 11 TO 15 TA ST UPN240A 16 TO 20 TA ST UAP250A
466 STAAD.Pro
Double U Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without a spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel.
11 TA D UAP150 17 TA D UAP250A SP 0.5
In the above set of commands, member 11 is a back-to-back double channel UAP150 with no spacing in between. Member 17 is a double channel UAP250A with a spacing of 0.5 length units between the channels.
Angles
Two types of specification may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
16 20 TA ST L30X30X2.7
The above section signifies an angle with legs of length 30mm and a leg thickness of 2.7mm. This specification may be used when the local Z axis corresponds to the z-z axis specified in Chapter 2. If the local Y axis corresponds to the z-z axis, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) should be used instead of ST.
17 21 TA RA L25X25X4 22 24 TA RA L100X100X6.5
Note that if the leg thickness is a round number such as 4.0, only the number 4 appears in the section name, the decimal part is not part of the section name.
Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by means of input of the words SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose.
33 35 TA SD L30X20X4 SP 0.6 37 39 TA LD L80X40X6
43 TO 47 TA LD L80X80X6.5 SP 0.75
Members 64 and 78 are tubes with a depth of 50mm, width of 25mm and a wall thickness of 2.7mm. Members 66 and 73 are tubes with a depth of 200mm, width of 100mm and a wall thickness of 8.0mm. Unlike angles, the ".0" in the thickness is part of the section name. Tubes can also be input by their dimensions instead of by their table designations. For example,
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5
is a tube that has a depth of 8 length units, width of 6 length units, and a wall thickness of 0.5 length units. Only code checking, no member selection, will be performed for TUBE sections specified in this way.
Members 8 to 28 are pipes 42.4mm in dia, having a wall thickness of 2.6mm. Members 3, 64 and 78 are pipes 219.1mm in dia, having a wall thickness of 12.5mm. Circular hollow sections may also be provided by specifying the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
468 STAAD.Pro
specifies a pipe with outside dia. of 25 length units and inside dia. of 20 length units. Only code checking, no member selection will be performed if this type of specification is used.
SAMPLE FILE CONTAINING FRENCH SHAPES STAAD SPACE UNIT METER KN JOINT COORD 1 0 0 0 15 140 0 0 MEMB INCI 1 1 2 14 UNIT CM MEMBER PROPERTIES FRENCH * IPE SHAPES 1 TA ST IPEA120 * IPN SHAPES 2 TA ST IPN380 *HE SHAPES 3 TA ST HEA200 * T SHAPES 4 TA T HEM120 * U CHANNELS 5 TA ST UAP100 * DOUBLE U CHANNELS 6 TA D UAP150SP 0.5 * ANGLES 7 TA ST L30X30X2.7 * REVERSE ANGLES 8 TA RA L25X25X4
* DOUBLE ANGLES - SHORT LEGS BACK * TO BACK 9 TA SD L30X20X4 SP 0.25 * DOUBLE ANGLES - LONG LEGS BACK * TO BACK 10 TA LD L80X40X6 SP 0.75 * TUBES (RECTANGULAR OR SQUARE * HOLLOW SECTIONS) 11 TA ST TUB50252.7 * TUBES (RECTANGULAR OR SQUARE * HOLLOW SECTIONS) 12 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5 * PIPES (CIRCULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS) 13 TA ST PIP422.6 * PIPES (CIRCULAR HOLLOW SECTIONS) 14 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0 PRINT MEMB PROP FINI
470 STAAD.Pro
Section 8
German Codes
472 STAAD.Pro
For Beams Prismatic (Rectangular & Square) For Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)
In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250 mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 350 mm diameter. It is absolutely imperative that the user not provide the cross section area (AX) as an input.
474 STAAD.Pro
active load cases at each of the above mentioned sections. Each of these sections is designed to resist these critical sagging and hogging moments. Currently, design of singly reinforced sections only is permitted. If the section dimensions are inadequate as a singly reinforced section, such a message will be printed in the output. Flexural design of beams is performed in two passes. In the first pass, effective depths of the sections are determined with the assumption of single layer of assumed reinforcement and reinforcement requirements are calculated. After the preliminary design, reinforcing bars are chosen from the internal database in single or multiple layers. The entire flexural design is performed again in a second pass taking into account the changed effective depths of sections calculated on the basis of reinforcement provided after the preliminary design. Final provisions of flexural reinforcements are made then. Efforts have been made to meet the guideline for the curtailment of reinforcements as per the DIN code. Although exact curtailment lengths are not mentioned explicitly in the design output (finally which will be more or less guided by the detailer taking into account of other practical considerations), the user has the choice of printing reinforcements provided by STAAD at 13 equally spaced sections from which the final detailed drawing can be prepared.
FYSEC 415 ALL FC 35 ALL CLEAR 25 MEM 2 TO 6 MAXMAIN 40 MEMB 2 TO 6 TRACK 1.0 MEMB 2 TO 9 DESIGN BEAM 2 TO 9 END CONCRETE DESIGN
476 STAAD.Pro
FYMAINYield stress for all reinforcing steel FCConcrete grade CLEARDistance from the outer surface of the element to the edge of the bar. This is considered the same on both top and bottom surfaces of the element. SRAParameter which denotes the angle of direction of the required transverse reinforcement relative to the direction of the longitudinal reinforcement for the calculation of BAUMANN design forces.
The other parameters shown in Table 8A.1 are not applicable to slab design.
BAUMANN equations
If the default value of zero is used, the design will be based on Mx and My forces which are obtained from the STAAD analysis. The SRA parameter (Set Reinforcement Angle) can be manipulated to introduce resolved BAUMANN forces into the design replacing the pure Mx and My moments. These new design moments allow the Mxy moment to be considered when designing the section, resolved as an axial force. Orthogonal or skew reinforcement may be considered. If SRA is set to -500, an orthogonal layout will be assumed. If however a skew is to be considered, an angle is given in degrees measured from the local element X axis anticlockwise (positive). The resulting Mx* and My* moments are calculated and shown in the design format.
The design of the slab considers a fixed bar size of 10 mm in the longitudinal direction and 8 mm in the transverse. The longitudinal bar is the layer closest to the slab exterior face.
Must be specified as DIN1045. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
CLEAR
25 mm
Clear cover for reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter. Depth of concrete member. The default value is provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.
DEPTH
YD
478 STAAD.Pro
Description
Face of support location at end of beam, measured from the end joint. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.
Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength
420 N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcement (For slabs, it is 500 N/mm2 for both directions) 420 N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a. Applicable to shear and torsion reinforcement in beams 50 mm Maximum required reinforcement bar size. Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 14 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Applicable to shear and torsion reinforcement in beams. Factor by which column design moments are magnified for column design
FYSEC
MAXMAIN
MINMAIN
16 mm
MINSEC
8 mm
MMAG
1.0
German Codes - ConcreteDesign Per DIN 1045 Parameter Name NSECTION Default Value 10 Description
Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 20. Face of support location at start of beam, measured from the start joint. (Only applicable for shear use MEMBER OFFSET for bending) 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy -slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout considering Mxy A = Skew angle considered in BAUMANN equations. A is the angle in degrees.
SFACE
0.0
SRA
0.0
TRACK
0.0
Level of detail in output 0. Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. 1. For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2. For beams gives area of steel required at intermediate sections. (see NSECTION)
WIDTH
ZD
480 STAAD.Pro
8B.2 AnalysisMethodology
Elastic analysis method is used to obtain the forces and moments for design. Analysis is done for the primary and combination loading conditions provided by the user. The user is allowed complete flexibility in providing loading specifications and in using appropriate load factors to create necessary loading situations. Depending upon the analysis requirements, regular stiffness analysis or P-Delta analysis may be specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results.
properties may also be specified using the User Table facility. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.
IPE Shapes
These shapes are designated in the following way:
20 TO 30 TA ST IPEA120 33 36 TO 46 BY 2 TA ST IPER140
HE Shapes
The designation for HE shapes is similar to that for IPE shapes.
25 TO 35 TA ST HEB300 23 56 TA ST HEA160
I Shapes
I shapes are identified by the depth of the section. The following example illustrates the designation.
482 STAAD.Pro
T Shapes
Tee sections are not input by their actual designations, but instead by referring to the I beam shapes from which they are cut. For example,
1 5 TA T HEA220 2 8 TA T IPE120
U Channels
The example below provides the command for identifying two channel sections. The former (U70X40) has a depth of 70mm and a flange width of 40mm. The latter (U260) has a depth of 260mm.
11 TA D U70X40 27 TA D U260
Double Channels
Back-to-back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel, e.g., D U180. The spacing between the double channels is provided following the expression SP.
11 TA D U180 27 TA D U280 SP 0.5 (INDICATES 2 CHANNELS BACK-TO-BACK SPACED AT 0.5 LENGTH UNITS)
Angles
Two types of specifications may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle section is specified as follows:
16 20 TA ST L20X20X2.5
The above section signifies an angle with legs of length 20mm and a leg thickness of 2.5mm. The above specification may be used when the local z-axis corresponds to the Z-Z axis specified in Chapter 2. If the local y-axis corresponds to the Z-Z axis, type specification "RA" (reverse angle) may be used.
17 21 TA RA L40X20X5
Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by using the word SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose. Spacing between the angles is provided by using the word SP and the spacing value following the section name.
14 TO 20 TA SD L40X20X4 SP 0.5 21 TO 27 TA LD L40X20X4 SP 0.5
Circular hollow sections may also be provided by specifying the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0
specifies a pipe with outside dia. of 25 and inside dia. of 20 in current length units. Only code checking and no member selection will be performed if this type of specification is used.
484 STAAD.Pro
is the specification for a tube having sides of 100mm x 60mm and the wall thickness of 3.6mm. Tubes, like pipes can also be input by their dimensions (Height, Width and Thickness) instead of by their table designations.
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5
is a tube that has a height of 8, a width of 6, and a wall thickness of 0.5 in current length units. Only code checking and no member selection will be performed for TUBE sections specified this way.
SAMPLE INPUT FILE CONTAINING GERMAN SHAPES STAAD SPACE UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0 15 140 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2 14 UNIT CM MEMBER PROPERTIES GERMAN * IPE SHAPES 1 TA ST IPEA120 * HE SHAPES 2 TA ST HEB300 * I SHAPES 3 TA ST I200 * T SHAPES
4 TA T HEA220 * U CHANNELS 5 TA ST U70X40 * DOUBLE U CHANNELS 6 TA D U260 * ANGLES 7 TA ST L20X20X2.5 * REVERSE ANGLES 8 TA RA L40X20X5 * DOUBLE ANGLES - LONG LEGS BACK TO BACK 9 TA LD L40X20X4 SP 0.5 * DOUBLE ANGLES - SHORT LEGS BACK TO BACK 10 TA SD L40X20X4 SP 0.5 * PIPES 11 TA ST PIP602.9 * PIPES 12 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0 ID 20.0 * TUBES 13 TA ST TUB100603.6 * TUBES 14 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 WT 0.5 * PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH
486 STAAD.Pro
sectional properties, slenderness factors, unsupported width to thickness ratios and so on. Explained here is the procedure adopted in STAAD for calculating such capacities.
8B.6Combined Loading
For members experiencing combined loading (axial force, bending, and shear), applicable interaction formulas are checked at different locations of the member for all modeled loading situations. Members subjected to axial force and bending are checked using the criteria of DIN 18800 (Part 1) - Section 6.1.6. In addition, for members with axial loads and bending, the criteria of DIN 18800(Part 2) - Sections 3.4 and 3.5 are used.
Must be specified as DIN18800. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BEAM
0.0
Number of sections to be checked per member: 0. Design only for end sections. 1. Check at location of maximum MZ along member. 2. Check ends plus location of beam 1.0 check. 3. Check at every 1/13th of the member length and report the maximum.
CB
Beam coefficient n, defined in Table 9: If Cb = 0, program will use n = 2.5 for rolled sections and 2.0 for welded sections.
488 STAAD.Pro
Description
Moment factor, Zeta, defined in Table 10: 1. fixed ended member with constant moment, Zeta = 1.0 2. pin ended member with UDL, Zeta = 1.12 3. pin ended member with central point load, Zeta = 1.35 4. fixed ended member, Zeta calculated from end moments.
1.0 m 0.0 m 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 240 N/sq.mm 1.0 1.0 0.0
Maximum allowable depth during member selection Minimum required depth during member selection K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Length in local y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Length in local z-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Strength of steel. Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of actual to allowable stresses Control of sections to try during a SELECT process:
German Codes - SteelDesign Per the DIN Code Parameter Name Default Value Description
0. Try every section of the same type as the original. 1. Try only those with a similar name. SBLT 0 Specify section as either rolled or built-up: 0. Rolled 1. Built-up SGR 0.0 Grade of steel: 0. St 37-2 1. St 52-3 2. St E 355 TRACK 0.0 Level of detail in output file: 0. Output summary of results 1. Output summary of results plus member capacities 2. Output detailed results UNF UNL 1.0 Member Length Same as above provided as a factor of actual member length. Unrestrained member length in lateral torsional buckling checks.
490 STAAD.Pro
axis is used. When no sections are specified and the BEAM parameter is set to zero (default), design will be based on member start and end forces. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.
492 STAAD.Pro
Section 9
Indian Codes
494 STAAD.Pro
For Beams Prismatic (Rectangular & Square), T-Beams, and L-shapes For Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)
will be done accordingly. In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 350 mm diameter. The third set numbers in the above example represents a T-shape with 750 mm flange width, 200 width, 400 mm overall depth and 100 mm flange depth (See section 6.20.2). The program will determine whether the section is rectangular, flanged or circular and the beam or column design.
may be changed to suit the particular design being performed. Table 9A.1 of this manual contains a complete list of the available parameters and their default values. It is necessary to declare length and force units as Millimeter and Newton before performing the concrete design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 9A.1 - Indian Concrete Design IS456 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as INDIAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BRACING
0.0
Beam Design: A value of 1.0 means the effect of axial force will be taken into account for beam design. Column Design: correspond to the terms "Braced" and "Unbraced" described in Notes 1, 2, and 3 of Clause 39.7.1 of IS456:2000. 1. The column is unbraced about major axis. 2. The column is unbraced about minor axis. 3. The column is unbraced about both axis.
496 STAAD.Pro
Default Value 25 mm 40 mm
Description
For beam members. For column members Total depth to be used for design. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam. The parameter can also be used to check against shear at any point from the end of the member. Note: Both SFACE and EFACE are input as positive numbers.
DEPTH
YD
EFACE
0.0
ELZ
1.0
Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about major axis. See Note b below. Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about minor axis. See Note b below. Perform shear check against enhanced shear strength as per Cl. 40.5 of IS456:2000.
l
ELY
1.0
ENSH
0.0
ENSH = 1.0 means ordinary shear check to be performed ( no enhancement of shear strength at sections close to support) For ENSH = a positive value(say x ), shear strength will be enhanced up to a distance x from the start of the member. This is used only
Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456 Parameter Name Default Value Description
when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. (Refer note )
l
For ENSH = a negative value(say y), shear strength will be enhanced up to a distance y from the end of the member. This is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts.(Refer note)
If default value (0.0) is used the program will calculate Length to Overall Depth ratio. If this ratio is greater than 2.5, shear strength will be enhanced at sections (<2d) close to support otherwise ordinary shear check will be performed. FC FYMAIN FYSEC MINMAIN MAXMAIN MINSEC MAXSEC RATIO 30 N/mm2 Concrete Yield Stress.
415 N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. 415 N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. 10 mm 60 mm 8 mm 12 mm 4.0 Minimum main reinforcement bar size. Maximum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Maximum secondary reinforcement bar size. Maximum percentage of
498 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
longitudinal reinforcement in columns. REINF RENSH 0.0 0.0 Tied column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral reinforcement. Distance of the start or end point of the member from its nearest support. This parameter is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. (Refer note) 2. Two faced distribution about major axis. 3. Two faced distribution about minor axis. 4. Longitudinal reinforcement in column is arranged equally along 4 faces. SFACE 0.0 Face of support location at start of beam. It is used to check against shear at the face of the support in beam design. The parameter can also be used to check against shear at any point from the start of the member. Minimum clear distance between main reinforcing bars in beam and column. For column center to center distance between main bars cannot exceed 300 mm.
RFACE
4.0
SPSMAIN
25 mm
Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456 Parameter Name TORSION Default Value 0.0 Description
TRACK
0.0
Beam Design: 0. output consists of reinforcement details at START, MIDDLE, and END. 1. critical moments are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2. required steel for intermediate sections defined by NSECTION are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. Column Design: 0. reinforcement details are printed. 1. column interaction analysis results are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2. a schematic interaction diagram and intermediate interaction values are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. 9. the details of section capacity calculations are printed.
ULY
1.0
Ratio of unsupported length to actual length of column about minor axis. See Note c below.
500 STAAD.Pro
Description
Ratio of unsupported length to actual length of column about major axis. See Note c below. Width to be used for design. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
WIDTH
ZD
Notes
a. You may specify reinforcing bar combinations through the BARCOMBINATIONcommand. Refer to Section 9A.8 for details. b. ELY and ELZ parameters are used to calculate effective length of column to find whether it is a short or long column. Please refer CL 25.1.2 of IS456:2000. In CL 25.1.2 of IS456:2000, you will find two term, l and l , which STAAD ex ey calculates as:
l
l = ELZ multiplied by the member length (distance between the two ex nodes of the member) l = ELY multiplied by the member length (distance between the two ey nodes of the member)
For the term "D" in CL 25.1.2 of IS456:2000, STAAD uses the YD dimension of the column. For the term "b" in CL 25.1.2 of IS456:2000, STAAD uses the ZD dimension of the column. c. ULY and ULZ parameters are used to calculate unsupported length of column to find minimum eccentricity. Please refer CL 25.4 of IS456:2000. In CL 25.4 of IS456:2000, you will find an expression "unsupported length of column". This term is calculated as
l
ULZ multiplied by the member length for the Z axis ULY multiplied by the member length for the Y axis
d. The value of the ENSH parameter (other than 0.0 and 1.0) is used only when
the span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. When this condition occurs, the RENSH parameter is also to be used.
The span of the beam is subdivided four parts, each of length L meter. The shear strength will be enhanced up to X meter from both supports. The input should be the following: Steps: 1. ENSH L MEMB 1 => Shear strength will be enhanced throughout the length of the member 1, positive sign indicates length measured from start of the member 2. ENSH (X-L) MEMB 2 => Shear strength will be enhanced up to a length (X-L) of the member 2, length measured from the start of the member 3. ENSH L MEMB 4 => Shear strength will be enhanced throughout the length of the member 4, negative sign indicates length measured from end of the member 4. ENSH (X-L) MEMB 3 => Shear strength will be enhanced up to a length (X-L) of the member 3, length measured from the end of the member 5. RENSH L MEMB 2 3 => Nearest support lies at a distance L from both the members 2 and 3. 6. DESIGN BEAM 1 TO 4=> This will enhance the shear strength up to length X from both ends of the beam consisting of members 1 to 4 and gives spacing accordingly. At section = y1 from start of member 1 av = y1 At section = y2 from the start of member 2 av = y2+L At section = y3 from the end of member 3 av = y3+L At section = y4 from end of member 4 av = y4
502 STAAD.Pro
where tc, enhanced = 2dtc/av At section 0.0, av becomes zero. Thus enhanced shear strength will become infinity. However for any section shear stress cannot exceed tc, max. Hence enhanced shear strength is limited to a maximum value of tc, max.
the P-delta analysis based on the deflections. Loads can be combined prior to analysis using the REPEATLOADcommand.
Note: You must specify the appropriate load factors (e.g., 1.5 for dead load, etc.) as STAAD does not factor the loads automatically.
504 STAAD.Pro
reinforcements provided by STAAD at 11 equally spaced sections from which the final detail drawing can be prepared.
DESIGN LOAD SUMMARY (KN MET) --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION |FLEXURE (Maxm. Sagging/Hogging moments)| SHEAR (in mm) | P MZ MX Load Case | VY MX Load Case --------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 60.61 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 533.3 | 0.00 29.63 0.00 1 | 50.51 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 1066.7 | 0.00 53.88 0.00 1 | 40.41 0.00 1
| 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 1600.0 | 0.00 72.73 0.00 1 | 30.31 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 2133.3 | 0.00 86.20 0.00 1 | 20.20 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 2666.7 | 0.00 94.28 0.00 1 | 10.10 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 3200.0 | 0.00 96.98 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 3733.3 | 0.00 94.28 0.00 1 | -10.10 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 4266.7 | 0.00 86.20 0.00 1 | -20.20 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 4800.0 | 0.00 72.73 0.00 1 | -30.31 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 5333.3 | 0.00 53.88 0.00 1 | -40.41 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 5866.7 | 0.00 29.63 0.00 1 | -50.51 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 6400.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | -60.61 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------SUMMARY OF REINF. AREA (Sq.mm) --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION | TOP | BOTTOM | STIRRUPS (in mm) | Reqd./Provided reinf. | Reqd./Provided reinf. | (2 legged) --------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 0.00/ 981.75( 2-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 533.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 237.32/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 1066.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 450.84/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 1600.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 632.82/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 2133.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 773.83/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm
506 STAAD.Pro
2666.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 863.91/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 3200.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 894.99/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 3733.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 863.91/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 4266.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 773.83/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 4800.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 632.82/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 5333.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 450.84/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 5866.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 237.32/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 6400.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 0.00/ 981.75( 2-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
M20 Fe415 (Main) Fe250 (Sec.) LENGTH: 3000.0 mm CROSS SECTION: 400.0 mm X 600.0 mm COVER: 40.0 mm ** GUIDING LOAD CASE: 1 END JOINT: 1 SHORT COLUMN DESIGN FORCES (KNS-MET) ----------------------DESIGN AXIAL FORCE (Pu)
About Y INITIAL MOMENTS : 120.00 MOMENTS DUE TO MINIMUM ECC. : 40.00 SLENDERNESS RATIOS : MOMENTS DUE TO SLENDERNESS EFFECT : MOMENT REDUCTION FACTORS : ADDITION MOMENTS (Maz and May) : TOTAL DESIGN MOMENTS : 120.00 REQD. STEEL AREA : 3587.44 Sq.mm. REQD. CONCRETE AREA: 236412.56 Sq.mm. MAIN REINFORCEMENT : Provide 32 - 12 dia. (1.51%, 3619.11 Sq.mm.) (Equally distributed) TIE REINFORCEMENT : Provide 8 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 190 mm c/c SECTION CAPACITY BASED ON REINFORCEMENT REQUIRED (KNS-MET) ---------------------------------------------------------Puz : 3244.31 Muz1 : 269.59 Muy1 : 168.42 INTERACTION RATIO: 0.98 (as per Cl. 39.6, IS456:2000) SECTION CAPACITY BASED ON REINFORCEMENT PROVIDED (KNS-MET) ---------------------------------------------------------WORST LOAD CASE: 1 END JOINT: 1 Puz : 3253.88 Muz : 271.48 Muy : 170.09 IR: 0.96 ============================================================================
508 STAAD.Pro
Note: The bar sizes should be specified in the order of increasing size (i.e., MD2 bar diameter should be greater than MD1 bar diameter). The beam length is divided into three parts, two at its ends and one at span. Ld gives the development length to be provided at the two ends of each section. The typical output for bar combination is shown below:
OUTPUT FOR BAR COMBINATION --------------------------------------------------------------------------| M A I N R E I N F O R C E M E N T | --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION | 0.0- 1600.0 | 1600.0- 4800.0 | 4800.06400.0 | | mm | mm | mm | --------------------------------------------------------------------------TOP | 2-16 | 2-16 | 2-16 | | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | Ast Reqd| 0.00 | 0.00 | 0.00 | Prov| 402.29 | 402.29 | 402.29 | Ld (mm) | 752.2 | 1175.3 | 752.2 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------BOTTOM | 4-16 | 2-16 + 2-25 | 4-16 | | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | Ast Reqd| 632.82 | 894.99 | 632.82 | Prov| 804.57 | 1384.43 | 804.57 | Ld (mm) | 752.2 | 1175.3 | 752.2 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------============================================================================
The design is performed for in-plane shear, in-plane & out-of-plane bending, and out-of-plane shear. The wall has to be modeled using STAADs Surface elements (Refer to Section 5.13.3 of the Technical Reference Manual). The use of the Surface element enables the designer to treat the entire wall as one entity. It greatly simplifies the modeling of the wall and adds clarity to the analysis and design output. The results are presented in the context of the entire wall rather than individual finite elements thereby allowing users to quickly locate required information. The program reports shear wall design results for each load case/combination for the specified number of sections given in the SURFACE DIVISION command (default value is 10) command. The shear wall is designed at these horizontal sections. The output includes the required horizontal and vertical distributed reinforcing, the concentrated (in-plane bending) edge reinforcing and the link required for out-of-plane shear. Refer to Section 5.54 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional details on shear wall design.
General Format
START SHEARWALL DESIGN CODE INDIAN FYMAIN f1 FC f2 HMIN f3 HMAX f4 VMIN f5 VMAX f6 EMIN f7 EMAX f8 LMIN f9 LMAX f10 CLEAR f11
510 STAAD.Pro
TWOLAYERED f12 KSLENDER f13 DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST shearwall-list END The following table explains the parameters used in the shear wall design. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 9A.2 - Shear Wall Design Parameters Parameter Name CLEAR EMAX Default Value 25 mm 36 Description
Clear concrete cover, in current units. Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge zones (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars located in edge zones (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Yield strength of steel, in current units. Compressive strength of concrete, in current units. Minimum size of
EMIN
FYMAIN FC
HMIN
Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS456 Parameter Name Default Value Description
horizontal reinforcing bars (range 6 mm 36 mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. HMAX 36 Maximum size of horizontal reinforcing bars (range 6 mm 36 mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Slenderness factor for finding effective height. Maximum size of links (range 6mm 16mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of links (range 6mm 16mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Reinforcement placement mode: 0. single layer, each direction 1. two layers, each direction
KSLENDER LMAX
1.0 16
LMIN
TWOLAYERED
512 STAAD.Pro
Default Value 36
Description
Maximum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar. Minimum size of vertical reinforcing bars (range 6mm 36mm). If input is 6 (integer number) the program will assume 6 mm diameter bar.
VMIN
The following example illustrates the input for the definition of shear wall and design of the wall.
Example
. . SET DIVISION 12 SURFACE INCIDENCES 2 5 37 34 SUR 1 19 16 65 68 SUR 2 11 15 186 165 SUR 3 10 6 138 159 SUR 4 . . . SURFACE PROPERTY 1 TO 4 THI 18 SUPPORTS
1 7 14 20 PINNED 2 TO 5 GEN PIN 6 TO 10 GEN PIN 11 TO 15 GEN PIN 19 TO 16 GEN PIN . . . SURFACE CONSTANTS E 2.17185E+007 POISSON 0.17 DENSITY 23.5616 ALPHA 1E-005 . . START SHEARWALL DES CODE INDIAN UNIT NEW MMS FC 25 FYMAIN 415 TWO 1 VMIN 12 HMIN 12 EMIN 12 DESIGN SHEA LIST 1 TO 4 END
514 STAAD.Pro
Notes
1. Command SET DIVISION 12 indicates that the surface boundary node-tonode segments will be subdivided into 12 fragments prior to finite element mesh generation. 2. Four surfaces are defined by the SURFACE INCIDENCES command. 3. The SUPPORTS command includes the new support generation routine. For instance, the line 2 to 5 gen pin assigns pinned supports to all nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As the node-to-node distances were previously subdivided by the SET DIVISION 12 command, there will be an additional 11 nodes between nodes 2 and 5. As a result, all 13 nodes will be assigned pinned supports. Please note that the additional 11 nodes are not individually accessible to the user. They are created by the program to enable the finite element mesh generation and to allow application of boundary constraints. 4. Surface thickness and material constants are specified by the SURFACE PROPERTY and SURFACE CONSTANTS, respectively. 5. The shear wall design commands are listed between lines START SHEARWALL DES and END. The CODE command selects the design code that will be the basis for the design. For Indian code the parameter is INDIAN. The DESIGN SHEARWALL LIST command is followed by a list of previously defined Surface elements intended as shear walls and/or shear wall components.
Technical Overview
The program implements provisions of section 32 of IS 456-2000 and relevant provisions as referenced therein, for all active load cases. The following steps are performed for each of the horizontal sections of the wall.
Design for in-plane bending and vertical load (denoted by Mz & Fy in the shear wall force output)
Walls when subjected to combined in-plane horizontal and vertical forces produce in-plane bending in conjunction with vertical load. According to clause no. 32.3.1, in-plane bending may be neglected in case a horizontal cross section of the wall is always under compression due combined effect of horizontal and vertical loads. Otherwise, the section is checked for combined vertical load and in-plane moment as column with axial load and uni-axial bending. For this purpose, the depth is taken as 0.8 x horizontal length of wall and breadth is the thickness of the wall. The reinforcement is concentrated at both ends (edges) of the wall. The edge reinforcement is assumed to be distributed over a length of 0.2 times horizontal length on each side. Minimum reinforcements are according to clause no. 32.5.(a). Maximum 4% reinforcement is allowed.
Design for in-plane shear (denoted by Fxy in the shear wall force output)
By default, the program does not design only at the critical section but at all the horizontal sections. By suitable use of the surface division command, design at critical section as per clause no. 32.4.1 can be performed. The design for in-plane shear is done as per clause no. 32.4. The nominal shear stress is calculated as per clause no. 32.4.2 and it is checked with the maximum allowable shear stress as per clause no. 32.4.2.1. The design shear strength of concrete is calculated as per clause no. 32.4.3. Design of shear reinforcement is done as per clause no. 32.4.4. Minimum reinforcements are as per clause no. 32.5.
Design for vertical load and out-of-plane vertical bending (denoted by Fy and My respectively in the shear wall force output)
Apart from the in-plane bending and horizontal shear force, the wall is also subjected to out-of-plane bending in the vertical and horizontal directions. The part of the wall which is not having edge reinforcements (i.e., a zone of depth 0.6 x Length of the wall), is designed again as column under axial load (i.e., vertical load) and out-of-plane vertical bending. The minimum reinforcements and maximum allowable spacings of reinforcements are as per clause no. 32.5
516 STAAD.Pro
Design for out-of-plane horizontal bending (denoted by Mx in the shear wall force output)
The horizontal reinforcement which is already provided for in-plane shear is checked against out-of-plane horizontal bending. The wall is assumed as a slab for this purpose.
Design for out-of-plane shears (denoted by Qx and Qy in the shear wall force output)
The out-of-plane shear arises from out-of-plane loading. The nominal shear stresses are calculated as per clause no. 40.1. Maximum allowable shear stresses are as per table 20. For shear force in the vertical direction, shear strength of concrete section is calculated as per section 4.1 of SP 16 : 1980 considering vertical reinforcement as tension reinforcement. Similarly, for shear force in the horizontal direction, shear strength of concrete section is calculated considering horizontal reinforcement as tension reinforcement. Shear reinforcements in the form of links are computed as per the provisions of clause no. 40.4.
Description
Shear walls modeled in STAAD.Pro may include an unlimited number of openings. Due to the presence of openings, the wall may be comprise of different wall panels of varying types. 1. Shear wall set-up Definition of a shear wall starts with a specification of the surface element perimeter nodes, meshing divisions along node-to-node segments, opening(s) corner coordinates, and meshing divisions of four edges of the opening(s).
SURFACE INCIDENCE n1, ..., ni SURFACE s DIVISION sd1, ..., sdj RECOPENING x1 y1 z1 x2 y2 z2 x3 y3 z3 x4 y4 z4 DIVISION od1, ..., odk Where: n1, , ni node numbers on the perimeter of the shear wall, s surface ordinal number, sd1, , sdj number of divisions for each of the node-to-node distance on the surface perimeter, x1 y1 z1 () coordinates of the corners of the opening, od1, , odk divisions along edges of the opening. Note: If the sd1, , sdj or the od1, , odk list does not include all node-to-node segments, or if any of the numbers listed equals zero, then the corresponding division number is set to the default value (=10, or as previously input by the SET DIVISION command). Default locations for stress/force output, design, and design output are set as follows: SURFACE DIVISION X xd SURFACE DIVISION Y yd Where: xd number of divisions along X axis, yd number of divisions along Y axis. Note: xd and yd represent default numbers of divisions for each edge of the surface where output is requested. The output is provided for sections located between division segments. For example, if the number of divisions = 2, then the output will be produced for only one section (at the center of the edge). 2. Stress/force output printing
518 STAAD.Pro
Values of internal forces may be printed out for any user-defined section of the wall. The general format of the command is as follows: PRINT SURFACE FORCE (ALONG ) (AT a) (BETWEEN d1, d2) LIST s1, ,si Where: local axis of the surface element (X or Y), a distance along the axis from start of the member to the full cross-section of the wall, d1, d2 coordinates in the direction orthogonal to , delineating a fragment of the full cross-section for which the output is desired. ** s1, ,si list of surfaces for output generation ** The range currently is taken in terms of local axis. If the local axis is directed away from the surface, the negative range is to be entered. Note: If command ALONG is omitted, direction Y (default) is assumed. If command AT is omitted, output is provided for all sections along the specified (or default) edge. Number of sections will be determined from the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values. If the BETWEEN command is omitted, the output is generated based on full cross-section width. 3. Definition of wall panels Input syntax for panel definition is as follows: START PANEL DEFINITION SURFACE i PANEL j ptype x1 y1 z1 x2 y2 z2 x3 y3 z3 x4 y4 z4 END PANEL DEFINITION Where: i = ordinal surface number, j = ordinal panel number,
ptype = panel type, one of: WALL, COLUMN, BEAM x1 y1 z1 () = coordinates of the corners of the panel, 4. Shear wall design The program implements different provisions of design of walls as per code BS 8110. General syntax of the design command is as follows: START SHEARWALL DESIGN () DESIGN SHEARWALL (AT f2) LIST s ENDSHEARWALL DESIGN Note: If the command AT is omitted, the design proceeds for all cross sections of the wall or panels, as applicable, defined by the SURFACE DIVISION X or SURFACE DIVISION Y input values. a. No panel definition. Design is performed for the specified horizontal full cross-section, located at a distance c from the origin of the local coordinates system. If opening is found then reinforcement is provided along sides of openings. The area of horizontal and vertical bars provided along edges of openings is equal to that of the respective interrupted bars. b. Panels have been defined. Only wall panel design is supported in Indian code.
520 STAAD.Pro
For Beams: Prismatic (Rectangular & Square) and T-shape For Columns:Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)
Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Table 9A1.1 - Indian Concrete Design IS 13920 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as IS13920 Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BRACING
0.0
Beam Design 1.0 = the effect of axial force will be taken into account for beam design. Column Design Correspond to the terms "Braced" and "Unbraced" described in Notes 1, 2, and 3 of Clause 39.7.1 of IS456:2000. 1.0 = the column is unbraced about major axis. 2.0 = the column is unbraced about minor axis. 3.0 = the column is unbraced about both axis.
DEPTH
YD
Total depth to be used for design. This value defaults to YD (depth of section in Y direction) as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES. For beam members.
CLEAR
25 mm
522 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value 40 mm
Description
For column members Default value means there will be no member combination. 1.0 = no printout of sectional force and critical load for combined member in the output. 2.0 = printout of sectional force for combined member in the output. 3.0 = printout of both sectional force and critical load for combined member in the output. ***
COMBINE
0.0
EFACE
0.0
Face of support location at end of beam. The parameter can also be used to check against shear at any point from the end of the member. Note: Both SFACE and EFACE are input as positive numbers.*
Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about major axis. Ratio of effective length to actual length of column about minor axis. Perform shear check against enhanced shear strength as per Cl. 40.5 of IS456:2000.
Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Parameter Name Default Value Description
1.0 = ordinary shear check to be performed ( no enhancement of shear strength at sections close to support) a positive value(say x ) = shear strength will be enhanced up to a distance x from the start of the member. This is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. (Refer note after Table 8A.1 ) a negative value(say y) = shear strength will be enhanced up to a distance y from the end of the member. This is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts.(Refer note after Table 8A.1) 0.0 = the program will calculate Length to Overall Depth ratio. If this ratio is greater than 2.5, shear strength will be enhanced at sections (<2d) close to support otherwise ordinary shear check will be performed.
524 STAAD.Pro
Description
Equivalent u.d.l on span of the beam. This load value must be the unfactored load on span. During design the load value is multiplied by a factor 1.2. If no u.d.l is defined factored shear force due to gravity load on span will be taken as zero. No elastic or plastic moment will be calculated. Shear design will be performed based on analysis result.(Refer note)
415 N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. 415 N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel. 30 N/mm2 None Concrete Yield Stress. Gravity load number to be considered for calculating equivalent u.d.l on span of the beam, in case no EUDL is mentioned in the input. This loadcase can be any static loadcase containing MEMBER LOAD on the beam which includes UNI, CON, LIN and TRAP member loading. CMOM member loading is considered only when it is specified in local direction. FLOOR LOAD is also considered. The load can be primary or combination load. For combination load only load numbers included in load combination is considered. The load factors are ignored.
Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Parameter Name Default Value Description
Internally the unfactored load is multiplied by a factor 1.2 during design. If both EUDL and GLD parameters are mentioned in the input mentioned EUDL will be considered in design Note: No dynamic (Response spectrum, 1893, Time History) and moving load cases are considered. CMOM member loading in global direction is not considered. UMOM member loading is not considered. HLINK Spacing of longitudinal bars measured to the outer face Longer dimension of the rectangular confining hoop measured to its outer face. It shall not exceed 300 mm as per Cl. 7.4.8. If the HLINK value as provided in the input file does not satisfy the clause the value will be internally assumed as the default one. This parameter is valid for rectangular column. Default value calculates elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam at its ends. 1.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments
IPLM
0.0
526 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
of resistance of beam to be ignored at start node of beam. This implies no support exists at start node. -1.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be considered at start node of beam. . This implies support exists at start node. 2.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be ignored at end node of beam. This implies no support exists at end node. -2.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be considered at end node of beam. . This implies support exists at end node. ** IMB 0.0 Default value calculates elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam at its ends. 1.0 = calculation of
Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Parameter Name Default Value Description
elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be ignored at both ends of beam. This implies no support exist at either end of the member. -1.0 = calculation of elastic/plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be considered at both ends of beam. This implies support exist at both ends of the member.** MINMAIN MAXMAIN MINSEC MAXSEC PLASTIC 10 mm 60 mm 8 mm 12 mm 0.0 Minimum main reinforcement bar size. Maximum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Maximum secondary reinforcement bar size. Default value calculates elastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam at its ends. 1.0 = plastic hogging and sagging moments of resistance of beam to be calculated at its ends.
528 STAAD.Pro
Description
Maximum percentage of longitudinal reinforcement in columns. 0.0 = Tied column (default) 1.0 = spiral reinforcement
REINF
0.0
RENSH
0.0
Distance of the start or end point of the member from its nearest support. This parameter is used only when a span of a beam is subdivided into two or more parts. Refer note after Table 9A.1
RFACE
4.0
4.0 = longitudinal reinforcement in column is arranged equally along four faces. 2.0 invokes two faced distribution about major axis. 3.0 invokes two faced distribution about minor axis.
SFACE
0.0
Face of support location at start of beam. It is used to check against shear at the face of the support in beam design. The parameter can also be used to check against shear at any point from the start of the member.* Note: Both SFACE and EFACE are input as positive numbers.*
SPSMAIN
25 mm
Minimum clear distance between main reinforcing bars in beam and column. For column center to
Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 Parameter Name Default Value Description
center distance between main bars cannot exceed 300 mm. TORISION 0.0 0.0 = torsion to be considered in beam design. 1.0 = torsion to be neglected in beam design. TRACK 0.0 Beam Design: 0.0 = output consists of reinforcement details at START, MIDDLE and END. 1.0 = critical moments are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2.0 = required steel for intermediate sections defined by NSECTION are printed in addition to TRACK 1.0 output. Column Design: 0.0 = reinforcement details are printed. 1.0 = column interaction analysis results are printed in addition to TRACK 0.0 output. 2.0 = a schematic interaction diagram and intermediate interaction values are printed in
530 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
addition to TRACK 1.0 output. ULY 1.0 Ratio of unsupported length to actual length of column about minor axis. Ratio of unsupported length to actual length of column about major axis. Width to be used for design. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
ULZ
1.0
WIDTH
ZD
Bar combination has been introduced for detailing. Please refer section 9A1.6 for details. * EFACE and SFACE command is not valid for member combination. ** IPLM and IMB commands are not valid for member combination. These commands are ignored for members forming physical member. *** The purpose of COMBINE command is the following: 1. If a beam spanning between two supports is subdivided into many subbeams this parameter will combine them into one member. It can also be used to combine members to form one continuous beam spanning over more than two supports. 2. When two or more members are combined during design plastic or elastic moments will be calculated at the column supports. At all the intermediate nodes (if any) this calculation will be ignored. Note: Please note that the program only recognizes column at right angle to the beam. Inclined column support is ignored. 3. It will calculate sectional forces at 13 sections along the length of the combined member. 4. It will calculate critical loads (similar to that of Design Load Summary) for all
active load cases during design. Beams will be combined only when DESIGN BEAM command is issued. The following lines should be satisfied during combination of members: 1. Members to be combined should have same sectional properties if any single span between two column supports of a continuous beam is subdivided into several members. 2. Members to be combined should have same constants (E, Poi ratio, alpha, density, and beta angle) 3. Members to be combined should lie in one straight line. 4. Members to be combined should be continuous. 5. Vertical members (i.e., columns) cannot be combined. 6. Same member cannot be used more than once to form two different combined members. 7. The maximum number of members that can be combined into one member is 299. Note: Sectional forces and critical load for combined member output will only be available when all the members combined are successfully designed in both flexure and shear. ENSH and RENSH parameters will have to be provided (as and when necessary) even if physical member has been formed.
Example
The following lines show a standard example for design to be performed in IS 13920.
STAAD SPACE UNIT METER MTON JOINT COORDINATES ..
532 STAAD.Pro
MEMBER INCIDENCES .. MEMBER PROPERTY INDIAN .. CONSTANTS . SUPPORTS . DEFINE 1893 LOAD ZONE 0.05 I 1 K 1 B 1 SELFWEIGHT JOINT WEIGHT . LOAD 1 SEISMIC LOAD IN X DIR 1893 LOAD X 1 LOAD 2 SEISMIC LOAD IN Z DIR 1893 LOAD Z 1 LOAD 3 DL MEMBER LOAD UNI GY -5 LOAD 4 LL MEMBER LOAD . UNI GY -3 LOAD COMB 5 1.5(DL+LL) 3 1.5 4 1.5 LOAD COMB 6 1.2(DL+LL+SLX) 1 1.2 3 1.2 4 1.2 LOAD COMB 7 1.2(DL+LL-SLX) 1 1.2 3 1.2 4 -1.2 LOAD COMB 8 1.2(DL+LL+SLZ)
2 1.2 3 1.2 4 1.2 LOAD COMB 9 1.2(DL+LL-SLZ) 2 1.2 3 1.2 4 -1.2 PDELTA ANALYSIS LOAD LIST 5 TO 9 START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE IS13920 UNIT MMS NEWTON FYMAIN 415 ALL FC 20 ALL MINMAIN 12 ALL MAXMAIN 25 ALL TRACK 2.0 ALL *** UNFACTORED GRAVITY LOAD ON MEMBERS 110 TO 112 IS 8 T/M (DL+LL) I.E., 78.46 NEW/MM EUDL 78.46 MEMB 110 TO 112 ** MEMBERS TO BE COMBINED INTO ONE PHYSICAL MEMBER COMBINE 3.0 MEMB 110 TO 112 *** PLASTIC MOMENT CONSIDERED PLASTIC 1.0 MEMB 110 TO 112 DESIGN BEAM 110 TO 112 DESIGN COLUMN END CONCRETE DESIGN FINISH
534 STAAD.Pro
For design to be performed as per IS:13920 the width of the member shall not be less than 200mm(Clause 6.1.3). Also the member shall preferably have a width-to depth ratio of more than 0.3 (Clause 6.1.2). The factored axial stress on the member should not exceed 0.1fck (Clause 6.1.1) for all active load cases. If it exceeds allowable axial stress no design will be performed.
= 0.24fck/fy
The maximum steel ratio on any face, at any section, is given by (Clause 6.2.2)
max
= 0.025
4. The positive steel ratio at a joint face must be at least equal to half the negative steel at that face. (Clause 6.2.3) 5. The steel provided at each of the top and bottom face, at any section, shall at least be equal to one-fourth of the maximum negative moment steel provided at the face of either joint. (Clause 6.2.4)
The following criteria are satisfied while performing design for shear as per Cl. 6.3.5 of IS-13920: The spacing of vertical hoops over a length of 2d at either end of the beam shall not exceed a. d/4 b. 8 times the diameter of the longitudinal bars In no case this spacing is less than 100 mm. The spacing calculated from above, if less than that calculated from IS 456 consideration is provided.
DESIGN LOAD SUMMARY (KN MET) --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION |FLEXURE (Maxm. Sagging/Hogging moments)| SHEAR (in mm) | P MZ MX Load Case | VY MX Load Case --------------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 60.61 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 533.3 | 0.00 29.63 0.00 1 | 50.51 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 1066.7 | 0.00 53.88 0.00 1 | 40.41 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 | 1600.0 | 0.00 72.73 0.00 1 | 30.31 0.00 1 | 0.00 0.00 0.00 1 |
536 STAAD.Pro
2133.3 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 2666.7 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 3200.0 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 3733.3 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 4266.7 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 4800.0 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 5333.3 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 5866.7 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 6400.0 | 0.00 1 | 0.00 *** DESIGN SHEAR FORCE
86.20 0.00 94.28 0.00 96.98 0.00 94.28 0.00 86.20 0.00 72.73 0.00 53.88 0.00 29.63 0.00 0.00
0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00 0.00
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
| | | | | | | | | | | | | | | | |
20.20
0.00
10.10
0.00
0.00
0.00
-10.10
0.00
-20.20
0.00
-30.31
0.00
-40.41
0.00
-50.51
0.00
-60.61
0.00
6400.0 IS
13920 NOTE : MOMENT OF RESISTANCE IS CALCULATED BASED ON THE AREA OF STEEL PROVIDED. IF AREA OF STEEL PROVIDED IS MUCH HIGHER COMPARED TO AREA OF STEEL REQUIRED MOMENT OF RESISTANCE WILL INCREASE WHICH MAY INCREASE DESIGN SHEAR FORCE. --------------------------------------------------------------------------STAAD SPACE -- PAGE NO. 7 0.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 0.00/ 981.75( 2-25 )| 8 @ 100 mm 533.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 281.26/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 1066.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 450.84/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 1600.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 632.82/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm
2133.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 773.83/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 2666.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 863.91/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 3200.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 894.99/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 3733.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 863.91/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 4266.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 773.83/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 4800.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 632.82/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 5333.3 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 450.84/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 5866.7 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 281.26/1472.62( 3-25 )| 8 @ 180 mm 6400.0 | 0.00/ 402.12( 2-16 )| 0.00/ 981.75( 2-25 )| 8 @ 100 mm ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
The minimum grade of concrete shall preferably be M20. (Clause 5.2) Steel reinforcements of grade Fe415 or less only shall be used. (Clause 5.3) The minimum dimension of column member shall not be less than 200 mm. For columns having unsupported length exceeding 4m, the shortest dimension of column shall not be less than 300 mm. (Clause 7.1.2) The ratio of the shortest cross-sectional dimension to the perpendicular dimension shall preferably be not less than 0.4. (Clause 7.1.3) The spacing of hoops shall not exceed half the least lateral dimension of the column, except where special confining reinforcement is provided. (Clause 7.3.3) Special confining reinforcement shall be provided over a length l from each o joint face, towards mid span, and on either side of any section, where
538 STAAD.Pro
flexural yielding may occur. The length l shall not be less than a) larger o lateral dimension of the member at the section where yielding occurs, b) 1/6 of clear span of the member, and c) 450 mm. (Clause 7.4.1)
l
The spacing of hoops used as special confining reinforcement shall not exceed of minimum member dimension but need not be less than 75 mm nor more than 100 mm. (Clause 7.4.6) The area of cross-section of hoops provided are checked against the provisions for minimum area of cross-section of the bar forming rectangular, circular or spiral hoops, to be used as special confining reinforcement. (Clause 7.4.7 and 7.4.8)
MOMENTS DUE TO SLENDERNESS EFFECT : - MOMENT REDUCTION FACTORS : - ADDITION MOMENTS (Maz and May) : - TOTAL DESIGN MOMENTS : 4.53 146.28 ** GUIDING LOAD CASE: 5 Along Z Along Y DESIGN SHEAR FORCES : 43.31 76.08 REQD. STEEL AREA : 3313.56 Sq.mm. MAIN REINFORCEMENT : Provide 12 - 20 dia. (2.69%, 3769.91 Sq.mm.) (Equally distributed) CONFINING REINFORCEMENT : Provide 10 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 85 mm c/c over a length 500.0 mm from each joint face towards midspan as per Cl. 7.4.6 of IS-13920. TIE REINFORCEMENT : Provide 10 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 175 mm c/c SECTION CAPACITY (KNS-MET) -------------------------Puz : 2261.52 Muz1 : 178.71 Muy1 : 150.75 INTERACTION RATIO: 1.00 (as per Cl. 39.6, IS456:2000) ============================================================================ ********************END OF COLUMN DESIGN RESULTS********************
540 STAAD.Pro
ENDBAR COMBINATION Note: The bar sizes should be specified in the order of increasing size (i.e., MD2 bar diameter should be greater than MD1 bar diameter). The beam length is divided into three parts, two at its ends and one at span. Ld gives the development length to be provided at the two ends of each section. The typical output for bar combination is shown below:
OUTPUT FOR BAR COMBINATION --------------------------------------------------------------------------| M A I N R E I N F O R C E M E N T | --------------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION | 0.0- 1600.0 | 1600.0- 4800.0 | 4800.06400.0 | | mm | mm | mm | --------------------------------------------------------------------------TOP | 2-16 | 2-16 | 2-16 | | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | Ast Reqd| 0.00 | 0.00 | 0.00 | Prov| 402.29 | 402.29 | 402.29 | Ld (mm) | 752.2 | 1175.3 | 752.2 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------BOTTOM | 4-16 | 2-16 + 2-25 | 4-16 | | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | in 1 layer(s) | Ast Reqd| 632.82 | 894.99 | 632.82 | Prov| 804.57 | 1384.43 | 804.57 | Ld (mm) | 752.2 | 1175.3 | 752.2 | --------------------------------------------------------------------------============================================================================
Verification Example
Sample example showing calculation of design shear force as per Clause 6.3.3
Figure 9.1 - Example problem
542 STAAD.Pro
Calculation of Moment Of Resistances Based On Area Of Steel Provided Sagging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu, as = Hogging Moment Of Resistance of End A Micah = Sagging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu, bs = Hogging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mob = Calculation of shear force due to the formation of a plastic hinge at both ends of the beam plus the factored gravity load on the span.
Figure 9.2 - Sway to right
0.87 * fy * Ast_Bot_A * d * ( 1 - Ast_Bot_A * fy / b * d * fck) 0.87 * fy * Ast_Top_A * d * ( 1 - Ast_Top_A * fy / b * d * fck) 0.87 * fy * Ast_Bot_B * d * ( 1 - Ast_Bot_B * fy / b * d * fck)
FIG1: SWAY TO RIGHT Vur,a = Vur,b = Va - 1.4 [ ( Mu,as + Mu,bh ) / L ] = Va + 1.4 [ ( Mu,as + Mu,bh ) / L ] =
Figure 9.3 - Sway to left
-10137.69104 N 41337.69104 N
Vul,a =
Indian Codes - Concrete Design per IS13920 ] = Vul,b = Va - 1.4 [ ( Mu,ah + Mu,bs ) / L ] - 22202.14022 N =
Design Shear Force At End A, Vu,a = Max ( Va,anl, Vur,a, Vul,a) 53402.14022
Design Shear Force At End B, Vu,b = Max ( Vb,anl, Vur,b, Vul,b) 41337.69104
544 STAAD.Pro
Calculation of Moment Of Resistances Based On Area Of Steel Provided Sagging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu,as = Hogging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu,ah = Sagging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu,bs = Hogging Moment Of Resistance of End A Mu,bh = 0.87 * fy * Ast_Bot_A * d * ( 1 - Ast_Bot_A * fy / b * d * fck) 0.87 * fy * Ast_Top_A * d * ( 1 - Ast_Top_A * fy / b * d * fck) 0.87 * fy * Ast_Bot_B * d * ( 1 - Ast_Bot_B * fy / b * d * fck) = 48452983 N = 32940364.5 N = 32940364.5 N 63326721.3 N
Calculation of shear force due to the formation of a plastic hinge at both ends of the beam plus the factored gravity load on the span.
Figure 9.4 - Sway to right
Vur,a = Vur,b =
-40463.862 N 63863.862 N
Vul,a =
42444.3402 N
Vul,b =
-15144.34 N
546 STAAD.Pro
Specify the members and the load cases to be considered in the design. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection. Specify design parameter values, if different from the default values. Specify whether to perform member selection by optimization.
These operations may be repeated by the user any number of times depending upon the design requirements. The entire ISI steel section table is supported. Section 9B.13 describes the specification of steel sections.
structural members using design loads and forces, allowable stresses, and design limitations for the appropriate material under service conditions. It would not be possible to describe every aspect of IS:800 in this manual. This section, however, will discuss the salient features of the allowable stresses specified by IS:800 and implemented in STAAD. Appropriate sections of IS:800 will be referenced during the discussion of various types of allowable stresses.
l
Tensile Stress
The allowable tensile stress, as calculated in STAAD as per IS:800 is described below. The permissible stress in axial tension, in MPa on the net effective area of the at sections shall not exceed
at
= 0.6f
Compressive Stress
Allowable compressive stress on the gross section of axially loaded compression members shall not exceed 0.6f nor the permissible stress s calculated based on y ac the following equation (per Clause: 5.1.1):
ac
= 0.6{( f
cc
Where:
ac
548 STAAD.Pro
E = Modulus of elasticity of steel, 2 X 105 Mpa =l/r = Slenderness ratio of the member, ratio of the effective length to appropriate radius of gyration n = A factor assumed as 1.4.
or
bc
= 0.66 f
Where: f
bt bc
= Bending stress in tension = Bending stress in compression = Yield stress of steel, in MPa
For an I-beam or channel with equal flanges bent about the axis of maximum strength (z-z axis), the maximum bending compressive stress on the extreme fibre calculated on the effective section shall not exceed the values of maximum permissible bending compressive stress. The maximum permissible bending compressive stress shall be obtained by the following formula: (Clause: 6.2.2)
n = A factor assumed as 1.4. f = Elastic critical stress in bending, calculated by the following cb formula:
Where:
in MPa
k = a coefficient to allow for reduction in thickness or breadth of 1 flanges between points of effective lateral restraint and depends on y, the ratio of the total area of both flanges at the point of least bending moment to the corresponding area at the point of greatest bending moment between such points of restraint. k = a coefficient to allow for the inequality of flanges, and 2 depends on w, the ratio of the moment of inertia of the compression flange alone to that of the sum of the moment of the flanges each calculated about its own axis parallel to the y-yaxis of the girder, at the point of maximum bending moment. 1 =effective length of compression flange r = radius of gyration of the section about its axis of y minimum strength (y-y axis) T = mean thickness of the compression flange, is equal to the area of horizontal portion of flange divided by width. D = overall depth of beam c ,c =respectively the lesser and greater distances from the section 1 2 neutral axis to the extreme fibres.
550 STAAD.Pro
compression are required to satisfy the equation of Section 7.1.1.(a) for intermediate points, and equation of Section 7.1.1.(b) for support points. For combined axial tension and bending the equation of Section 7.1.2. is required to be satisfied. Cm coefficients are calculated according to the specifications of Section 7.1.3. information regarding occurrence of sidesway can be provided through the use of parameters SSY and SSZ. In the absence of any user provided information, sidesway will be assumed.
Must be specified as INDIAN Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BEAM
3.0
0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by the SECTION command.
Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984 Parameter Name Default Value Description
1.0 = calculate section forces at twelfth points along the beam, design at each intermediate location and report the critical location where ratio is maximum. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway Cm value in local y & z axes
DFF
None "Deflection Length" / (Mandatory for Maxm. allowable local deflection check) deflection Start Joint of member Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1) Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note 1) Maximum allowable depth. Minimum allowable depth. Yield strength of steel.
DJ1
DJ2
KY KZ
1.0 1.0
K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis.
552 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name LY
Default Value
Description
Member Length
Length in local y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Same as above except in local z-axis (major). Allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for compression members. Net section factor for tension members. Used to search for the lightest section for the profile(s) specified for member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis. 1.0 = No sidesway
LZ MAIN
NSF PROFILE
1.0 -
RATIO
1.0
SSY
0.0
SSZ TMAIN
Same as above except in local z-axis. Allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for tension members. 0.0 = Suppress critical member stresses
TRACK
Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984 Parameter Name Default Value Description
1.0 = Print all critical member stresses 2.0 = Print expanded output. If there is deflection check it will also print the governing load case number for deflection check whenever critical condition for design is not DEFLECTION. (see fig.8B.1) UNF 1.0 Same as above provided as a fraction of actual member length. Unsupported length for calculating allowable bending stress.
UNL
Member Length
Notes
a. "Deflection Length" is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the "Deflection Length" will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the "Deflection Length" may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.
554 STAAD.Pro
b. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. c. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design.
(like bracing or strut, etc.), it is wise to declare it as a truss member rather than as a regular frame member with both ends pinned.
556 STAAD.Pro
The process of MEMBER SELECTION may be controlled using the parameters listed in Table 9B.1. It may be noted that the parameters DMAX and DMIN may be used to specify member depth constraints for selection. If PROFILE parameter is provided, the search for the lightest section is restricted to that profile. Up to three (3) profiles may be provided for any member with a section being selected from each one. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.
g. FX, MY and MZ provide the axial force, moment in local y-axis and moment in local z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX,MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern. i. If the parameter TRACK is set to 1.0, the program will block out part of the table and will print allowable bending stresses in compression (FCY & FCZ) and tension (FTY & FTZ), allowable axial stress in compression (FA), and allowable shear stress (FV). When the parameter TRACK is set to 2.0 for all members parameter code values are as shown in the following example.
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( v1.0 ******************************************** |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN CM UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ----------- | |MEMBER 7 * | INDIAN SECTIONS | | AX = 85.0 | | * | ST ISWB400 | | --Z AY = 34.4 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 34.7 | | IS-800 * =============================== ===|=== SY = 138.8 | | * SZ = 1171.3 | | * |<---LENGTH (ME= 3.00 --->| RY = 4.0 | |************* RZ = 16.6 | | | | 112.1( KN-METR) | |PARAMETER |L1 STRESSES | |IN NEWT MM | IN NEWT MM| |--------------- + ------------| | KL/R-Y= 74.2 | FA = 150.0 | IS-800)
558 STAAD.Pro
| KL/R-Z= 18.1 + 1.0 | | UNL = 3000.0 | 139.9 | | C = 400.0 + 165.0 | | CMY = 0.60 | 165.0 | | CMZ = 0.40 + 165.0 | | FYLD = 249.9 | L3 95.7 | | NSF = 0.9 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| 0.0 | | DFF = 0.0 90.5 100.0 | | dff = 0.0 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE 17.1 | | (WITH LOAD NO.) | | | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY ( KN-METR) | | ------------------------| | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y Z | | | | VALUE -23.9 60.6 0.0 0.0 | | LOCATION 0.0 3.0 0.0 0.0 | | LOADING 3 1 0 0 | | |
fa
MOMENT-
112.1 0.0 1
|**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY ( KN-METR) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION |
| | | | | | |* *|
|**************************************************************************|
Note: In case of two identical beams, the heavier beam is designated with an A on the end (e.g., ISHB400 A, etc.).
1 TO 5 TA ST ISHB400A
560 STAAD.Pro
10 TO 20 BY 2 TA ST ISMC125 12 TA ST ISLC300
Double Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name will specify a double channel (e.g., D ISJC125, D ISMC75, etc.).
21 22 24 TA D ISLC225
At present there is no standard way to define the local y and z axes for an angle section. The standard section has local axis system as illustrated in Fig.2.4 of this manual. The standard angle is specified as:
51 52 53 TA ST ISA60X60X6
This specification has the local z-axis (i.e., the minor axis corresponding to the V-V axis specified in the steel tables. Many engineers are familiar with a convention used by some other programs in which the local y-axis is the minor axis. STAAD provides for this convention by accepting the command:
54 55 56 TA RA ISA50X30X6
Double Angles
Short leg back-to-back or long leg back-to-back double angles can be specified by inputting the word SD or LD, respectively, in front of the angle size. In case of an equal angle either LD or SD will serve the purpose. For example,
14 TO 20 TA LD ISA50X30X5 SP 1.5 23 27 TA SD ISA75X50X6
specifies a 213 mm dia. pipe with 3.2 mm wall thickness Circular pipe sections can also be specified by providing the outside and inside diameters of the section. For example,
1 TO 9 TA ST PIPE OD 25.0ID 20.0
specifies a pipe with outside dia. of 25 and inside dia. of 20 in current length units Only code checking and no member selection will be performed if this type of specification is used.
562 STAAD.Pro
For example,
15 TO 25 TA ST TUB 160808
Tubes, like pipes, can also be input by their dimensions (Height, Width and Thickness) and not by any table designations.
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5
is a tube that has a height of 8, a width of 6, and a wall thickness of 0.5. Note: Only code checking and no member selection is performed for TUBE sections specified this way.
A. Plate and angle girder symbol. B. Web plate width in mm. C. Web plate thickness in mm. D. Flange angle, A X BX t, all in mm. Table 9B.2 - Flange angle key Symbol A B C E E. Flange plate width in mm. F. Flange plate thickness in mm. Angle 150X150X18 200X100X15 200X150X18 200X200X18
Single Joist with Channels and Plates on the Flanges to be Used as Girders
All single joist with channel and plates on the flanges to be used as girders are available as listed in ISI section handbook. The following example with explanations will be helpful in understanding the input procedure.
A. Joist Designation IW450 = ISWB450 B. Top flange channel designation: 350 = ISMC350 C. Constant (always X).
564 STAAD.Pro
D. Top flange plate thickness in mm. Note: D = 0 for no plate. E. Bottom flange plate thickness in mm. Note: The heavier ISWB600 has been omitted, since the lighter ISWB600 is more efficient.
Table 9B.3 - Parameters used in Indian Lacing or Batten steel member design. Parameter Name CTYPE Default Value 1 Description
Type of joining 1. implies single lacing with riveted connection 2. implies double lacing with riveted connection
Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS800:1984 Parameter Name Default Value Description
3. implies single lacing with welded connection 4. implies double lacing with welded connection 5. implies batten with riveted connection 6. implies batten with welded connection COG 0.0 mm Center of gravity of the channel. This parameter is used when member properties are defined through user provided table using GENERAL option. Nominal diameter of rivet Used when member properties are defined through user provided table using GENERAL option. 0. double channel back-to-back. 1. double channel face-to-face. EDIST 32 mm Edge Distance. (Rivetted Connection) 25 mm (Welded Connection) FVB FYB SPA 100 N/mm2 300 N/mm2 0.0 mm Allowable shear stress in rivet Allowable bearing stress in rivet Spacing between double channels. This parameter is used when member properties are defined through user provided table using
DBL DCFR
20 mm 0.0
566 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
GENERAL option. THETA 50 degree Angle of inclination of lacing bars. It should lie between 40 degree and 70 degree. Minimum thickness of weld Allowable welding stress
WMIN WSTR
6 mm 108 N/mm2
568 STAAD.Pro
Tensile Stress
The allowable tensile stress, as calculated in STAAD as per IS:802 is described below. The estimated tensile stresses on the net effective sectional area in various members, multiplied by the appropriate factor of safety shall not exceed minimum guaranteed yield stress of the material.
Thus, the permissible stress in axial tension, in MPa on the net effective area of at the sections shall not exceed
at
=F
Compressive Stress
The estimated compressive stresses in various members multiplied by the appropriate factor of safety shall not exceed the value given by the formulae described below. I. Condition: when (b/t) [ (b/t)
c lim
= 210/F ]:
y
ii. When KL/r > C , the allowable compressive stress is (in N/mm2) F =
a c 2E/(KL/r)2 lim
The equations in condition 1 shall be used, substituting for F the value F y cr given by: F
cr
= F [1.677 - 0.677(b/t)/(b/t)
y y
lim
The equations in condition 1 shall be used, substituting for F the value F y cr given by: F Where: F = allowable unit stress in compression, Mpa
a y cr
= 65,550/(b/t)
F = minimum guaranteed yield stress of the material, Mpa K = restraint factor, L = unbraced length of the compression member in cm, and
570 STAAD.Pro
R = appropriate radius of gyration in cm. E = modulus of elasticity of steel in N/mm2 KL/r = largest effective slenderness ratio of any unbraced segment of the member, b = distance from edge of the fillet to the extreme fibre in mm, and t = thickness of flange in mm. Note: The maximum permissible value of b/t for any type of steel shall not exceed 25.
Compression Member
Table 9C.1 - Slenderness ratio limits of compression members Type of Member Slenderness Limit 120
Leg Members, ground wire peak member and lower members of cross arms in compression Other members carrying computed stress Redundant members and those carrying nominal stresses
200 250
Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802 Table 9C.2 - Compression slenderness ratio calculation depending on ELA parameter ELA Value 1 2 Type of Member Calculation of KL/r L/r L/r
Leg sections or joint members bolted at connections in both faces Members with concentric loading at both ends of the unsupported panel with values of L/r up to and including 120 Member with concentric loading at one end and normal eccentricities at the other end of the unsupported panel for value of L/r up to and including 120 Members with normal framing eccentricities at both ends of the unsupported panel for values of L/r up to and including 120 Member unrestrained against rotation at both ends of the unsupported panel for value of L/r from 120 to 200 Members partially restrained against rotation at one end of the unsupported panel for values of L/r over 120 and up to and including 225 Members partially restrained against rotation at both ends of the unsupported panel for values of L/r over 120 and up to and including 250
30 + 0.75L/r
60 + 0.5L/r
L/r
28.6 + 0.762L/r
46.2 + 0.615L/r
If the value for ELA is given in the input for any particular member is such that condition for L/r ratio to fall within the specified range is not satisfied, STAAD goes on by the usual way of finding slenderness ratio using KL/r formula.
572 STAAD.Pro
Tension Members
Slenderness ratio KL/r of a member carrying axial tension only, shall not exceed 400.
1. Thickness of the member (maximum of web and flange thicknesses) is checked against minimum allowable thickness, depending upon whether the member is painted or galvanised. 2. If the minimum thickness criterion is fulfilled, the program determines whether the member is under compression or tension for the loadcase under consideration. Depending upon whether the member is under tension or compression the slenderness ratio of the member is calculated. This calculated ratio is checked against allowable slenderness ratio. 3. If the slenderness criterion is fulfilled check against allowable stress is performed. Allowable axial and tensile stresses are calculated. If the member is under tension and there is no user defined net section factor (NSF), the net section factor is calculated by the program itself (Refer Section 8C.10). Actual axial stress in the member is calculated. The ratio for actual stress to allowable stress, if less than 1.0 or user defined value, the member has passed the check. 4. Number of bolts required for the critical loadcase is calculated.
574 STAAD.Pro
|---------------------| | L/R-Y = 40.5 188.4 | | L/R-Z = 87.9 80.7 | | KL/R = 87.9 436.0 | | FYLD = 250.0 218.0 | | GALVA = 0.0 | | C = 1.0 | | LEG = 1.0 | | ELA = 1.0 | | NSF = 1.0 | | |
-----FA fa = =
FYB = FVB =
|**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY ( KN-METR) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS COMPRESSION 0.428 1 | | 137.13 C 0.0 0.0 0.00 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------|
Using TRACK 9.0 also adds the following set of calculation details:
DETAILS OF CALCULATION
576 STAAD.Pro
---------------------CHECK FOR MINIMUM THICKNESS --------------------------TYPE : PAINTED MIN. ALLOWABLE THICKNESS : 6.0 MM ACTUAL THICKNESS : 8.0 MM RESULT : PASS CHECK FOR SLENDERNESS RATIO --------------------------VALUE OF L/r : 87.94 EQN. USED TO FIND KL/r : L/r ACTUAL VALUE OF KL/r : 87.94 ALLOWABLE KL/r : 120.00 RESULT : PASS CALCULATION OF ALLOWABLE STRESS --------------------------------CRITICAL CONDITION : COMPRESSION Cc : sqrt(2*3.14159265*3.14159265*E : 127.53 b : LENGTH OF LEG - WEB THICKNESS - ROOT RADIUS : 125.0 - 8.0 9.0 : 108.0 MM (b/t)lim : 210/sqrt(fy) : 13.28 (b/t)cal : 13.50 (b/t)cal > (b/t)lim (b/t)lim (modified) : 378/sqrt(fy) : 23.91 (b/t)cal <= (b/t)lim (modified) AND KL/r <= Cc Fcr : (1.677 - (0.677*(b/t)cal/(b/t)lim))*fy : 247.18 MPA ALLOWABLE AXIAL COMP. STRESS : (1-0.5*(KL/r/Cc)*(KL/r/Cc))*Fcr : 188.41 MPA CHECK AGAINST PERMISSIBLE STRESS -------------------------------LOAD NO. : 1 DESIGN AXIAL FORCE : 137131.16 N ACTUAL AXIAL COMP. STRESS : 137131.16 / 1700.0 : 80.67 MPA RESULT : PASS EXAMPLE PROBLEM NO.1 -- PAGE NO. 24 BOLTING ------BOLT DIA : 12 MM SHEARING CAP : 24.66 KN BEARING CAP : 41.86 KN BOLT CAP : 24.66 KN NO. OF BOLTS REQD. : 6 ************** END OF TABULATED RESULT OF DESIGN **************
This parameter indicates whether user has defined the net section factor or the program will calculate it. 0. Use specified NSF value 1. Net section factor will be calculated.
DANGLE
0.0
This parameter indicates how the pair of angles are connected to each other. This is required to find whether the angle is in single or double shear and the net section factor. 0. Double angle placed back-toback and connected to each side of a gusset plate 1. Pair of angle placed back-toback connected by only one leg of each angle to the same side of a gusset plate
DBL
12 mm
Diameter of bolt for calculation of number of bolts and net section factor. Maximum allowable depth. Minimum allowable depth. This parameter indicates what type
578 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
of end conditions is to be used. Refer Section 9C.3. FVB FYB FYLD GUSSET 218 MPA 436 MPA 250 MPA 5 mm Allowable shear stress in bolt Allowable bearing stress in bolt Yield Strength of steel Thickness of gusset plate. Minimum of the thicknesses of the gusset plate and the leg is used for calculation of the capacity of bolt in bearing KY KZ LEG 1.0 1.0 1.0 K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. This parameter is meant for plain angles. 0. The angle is connected by shorter leg 1. The angle is connected by longer leg LY LZ MAIN Member Length Member Length 1.0 Unbraced length in local z-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Unbraced length in local z-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Type of member to find allowable Kl/r for slenderness calculations for members. 1. Leg, Ground wire peak and lower members of cross arms
Indian Codes - Steel Design per IS802 Parameter Name Default Value Description
in compression (KL/r = 120) 2. Members carrying computed stress (KL/r = 200) 3. Redundant members and members carrying nominal stresses (KL/r = 250) 4. Tension members (KL/r = 400) 10. Do not perform KL/r check Any value greater than 10.0 indicates user defined allowable KL/r ratio. For this case KY and KZ values are must to find actual KL/r ratio of the member. NSF NHL 1.0 0.0 mm Net section factor for tension members Deduction for holes. Default value is one bolt width plus 1.5 mm. If the area of holes cut by any straight, diagonal or zigzag line across the member is different from the default value, this parameter is to be defined. TRACK 0.0 Level of output detail: 0. Suppress critical member stresses 1. Print all critical member stresses 2. Print expanded output. 9. Print design calculations along with expanded output
580 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
For a channel section, net section factor is taken to be 1.0. For an angle section, it is the ratio of the net effective area, A , to the gross net area, where: a. Single angle connected by only one leg A Where: A = net cross-sectional area of the connected leg
1 2 1 net
=A +A K
1 2
The area of a leg of an angle = Thickness of angle x (length of leg 0.5x thickness of leg) b. Pair of angles placed back-to-back connected by only one leg of each angle to the same side of a gusset plate A Where: A = net cross-sectional area of the connected leg
1 2 1 net
=A +A K
1 2
The area of a leg of an angle = Thickness of angle x (length of leg 0.5x thickness of leg)
c. Double angles placed back-to-back and connected to each side of a gusset plate A
net
Given
End Condition = Members with normal framing eccentricities at both ends of the unsupported panel for values of L/r up to and including 120 Diameter of the bolt = 16 mm 582 STAAD.Pro
STAADInput File
This input file is included with the program as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\IND\EXAMP28.STD.
STAAD TRUSS INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 3 0 3; 2 1.2 27 1.2; 3 2.8 3 2.8; 4 2.6 6 2.6; 5 2.4 9 2.4; 6 2.2 12 2.2; 7 2 15 2; 8 1.8 18 1.8; 9 1.6 21 1.6; 10 1.4 24 1.4; 11 -3 0 3; 12 -1.2 27 1.2; 13 -2.8 3 2.8; 14 -2.6 6 2.6; 15 -2.4 9 2.4; 16 -2.2 12 2.2; 17 -2 15 2; 18 -1.8 18 1.8; 19 -1.6 21 1.6; 20 -1.4 24 1.4; 21 3 0 -3; 22 1.2 27 -1.2; 23 2.8 3 -2.8; 24 2.6 6 -2.6; 25 2.4 9 -2.4; 26 2.2 12 -2.2; 27 2 15 -2; 28 1.8 18 -1.8; 29 1.6 21 -1.6; 30 1.4 24 1.4; 31 -3 0 -3; 32 -1.2 27 -1.2; 33 -2.8 3 -2.8; 34 -2.6 6 -2.6; 35 -2.4 9 2.4; 36 -2.2 12 -2.2; 37 -2 15 -2; 38 -1.8 18 -1.8; 39 -1.6 21 -1.6; 40 -1.4 24 -1.4; 41 1.2 30 1.2; 42 -1.2 30 1.2; 43 1.2 30 -1.2; 44 -1.2 30 -1.2; 45 4.2 27 1.2; 46 7.2 27 1.2; 47 4.2 30 1.2; 48 4.2 27 -1.2; 49 7.2 27 -1.2; 50 4.2 30 -1.2; 51 -4.2 27 1.2; 52 -7.2 27 1.2; 53 -4.2 30 1.2; 54 -4.2 27 -1.2; 55 -7.2 27 -1.2; 56 -4.2 30 -1.2; 57 1.2 33 1.2; 58 -1.2 33 1.2; 59 1.2 33 -1.2; 60 -1.2 33 -1.2; 61 0 35 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 3; 2 3 4; 3 4 5; 4 5 6; 5 6 7; 6 7 8; 7 8 9; 8 9 10; 9 10 2; 10 11 13;
11 13 14; 12 14 15; 13 15 16; 14 16 17; 15 17 18; 16 18 19; 17 19 20; 18 20 12; 19 13 3; 20 14 4; 21 15 5; 22 16 6; 23 17 7; 24 18 8; 25 19 9; 26 20 10; 27 12 2; 28 11 3; 29 1 13; 30 13 4; 31 3 14; 32 14 5; 33 15 4; 34 15 6; 35 16 5; 36 16 7; 37 17 6; 38 17 8; 39 18 7; 40 18 9; 41 19 8; 42 19 10; 43 20 9; 44 20 2; 45 12 10; 46 21 23; 47 23 24; 48 24 25; 49 25 26; 50 26 27; 51 27 28; 52 28 29; 53 29 30; 54 30 22; 55 3 23; 56 4 24; 57 5 25; 58 6 26; 59 7 27; 60 8 28; 61 9 29; 62 10 30; 63 2 22; 64 1 23; 65 21 3; 66 3 24; 67 23 4; 68 4 25; 69 5 24; 70 5 26; 71 6 25; 72 6 27; 73 7 26; 74 7 28; 75 8 27; 76 8 29; 77 9 28; 78 9 30; 79 10 29; 80 10 22; 81 2 30; 82 31 33; 83 33 34; 84 34 35; 85 35 36; 86 36 37; 87 37 38; 88 38 39; 89 39 40; 90 40 32; 91 23 33; 92 24 34; 93 25 35; 94 26 36; 95 27 37; 96 28 38; 97 29 39; 98 30 40; 99 22 32; 100 21 33; 101 31 23; 102 23 34; 103 33 24; 104 24 35; 105 25 34; 106 25 36; 107 26 35; 108 26 37; 109 27 36; 110 27 38; 111 28 37; 112 28 39; 113 29 38; 114 29 40; 115 30 39; 116 30 32; 117 22 40; 118 33 13; 119 34 14; 120 35 15; 121 36 16; 122 37 17; 123 38 18; 124 39 19; 125 40 20; 126 32 12; 127 31 13; 128 11 33; 129 33 14; 130 13 34; 131 34 15; 132 35 14; 133 35 16; 134 36 15; 135 36 17; 136 37 16; 137 37 18; 138 38 17; 139 38 19; 140 39 18; 141 39 20; 142 40 19; 143 40 12; 144 32 20; 145 32 44; 146 12 42; 147 2 41;
584 STAAD.Pro
148 22 43; 149 42 41; 150 41 43; 151 43 44; 152 44 42; 153 12 41; 154 42 2; 155 22 41; 156 43 2; 157 43 32; 158 44 22; 159 12 44; 160 32 42; 161 41 47; 162 47 45; 163 45 2; 164 47 46; 165 46 45; 166 41 45; 167 43 50; 168 50 48; 169 48 22; 170 50 49; 171 49 48; 172 43 48; 173 47 50; 174 46 49; 175 45 48; 176 41 50; 177 50 46; 178 43 47; 179 47 49; 180 22 50; 181 2 47; 182 22 45; 183 2 48; 184 47 48; 185 50 45; 186 45 49; 187 48 46; 188 42 53; 189 53 51; 190 51 12; 191 53 52; 192 52 51; 193 42 51; 194 44 56; 195 56 54; 196 54 32; 197 56 55; 198 55 54; 199 44 54; 200 53 56; 201 52 55; 202 51 54; 203 42 56; 204 56 52; 205 44 53; 206 53 55; 207 32 56; 208 12 53; 209 32 51; 210 12 54; 211 53 54; 212 56 51; 213 51 55; 214 54 52; 215 44 60; 216 42 58; 217 41 57; 218 43 59; 219 60 59; 220 59 57; 221 57 58; 222 58 60; 223 44 58; 224 42 60; 225 42 57; 226 41 58; 227 44 59; 228 43 60; 229 43 57; 230 41 59; 231 60 57; 232 59 58; 235 33 3; 236 13 23; 237 34 4; 238 14 24; 239 35 5; 240 15 25; 241 36 6; 242 16 26; 243 37 7; 244 17 27; 245 38 8; 246 18 28; 247 39 9; 248 19 29; 249 40 10; 250 20 30; 251 32 2; 252 22 12; 253 44 41; 254 43 42; 255 60 61; 256 58 61; 257 57 61; 258 59 61; MEMBER PROPERTY INDIAN 1 TO 18 46 TO 54 82 TO 90 145 TO 148 215 TO 218 TA LD ISA200X150X18 SP 0.01 19 TO 26 28 TO 45 55 TO 62 64 TO 81 91 TO 98 100 TO 125 127 TO 144 155 156 159 160 223 224 229 230 235 TO 250 TA ST ISA150X150X10
27 63 99 126 149 TO 154 157 158 161 TO 214 219 TO 222 225 TO 228 231 232 251 252 TO 258 TA ST ISA80X50X6 CONSTANTS E 2.05E+008 ALL POISSON 0.3 ALL DENSITY 76.8195 ALL ALPHA 6.5E-006 ALL SUPPORTS 1 11 21 31 FIXED UNIT METER KG LOAD 1 VERT SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 61 FX 732 46 49 52 55 FX 153 61 FX 1280 FY -1016 FZ 160 46 49 52 55 FX 9006 FY -7844 FZ 1968 2 12 22 32 FX 4503 FY -3937 FZ 1968 LOAD 2 GWBC SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 61 FX 549 46 49 52 55 FX 1148 61 FX 515 FY -762 FZ 2342 46 49 52 55 FX 6755 FY -5906 2 12 22 32 FX 3378 FY -2953 LOAD 3 LEFT PCBC SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD
586 STAAD.Pro
61 FX 549 46 49 52 55 FX 1148 61 FX 960 FY -762 46 49 FX 6755 FY -5906 52 55 FX 4211 FY -4551 FZ 13293 2 12 22 32 FX 3378 FY -2953 LOAD 4 RIGHT PCBC SELFWEIGHT Y -1 JOINT LOAD 61 FX 549 46 49 52 55 FX 1148 61 FX 960 FY -762 52 55 FX 6755 FY -5906 46 49 FX 4211 FY -4551 FZ 13293 2 12 22 32 FX 3378 FY -2953 PERFORM ANALYSIS UNIT NEW MMS PARAMETER CODE IS802 LY 2800 MEMB 28 LZ 2800 MEMB 28 MAIN 1.0 MEMB 1 ELA 4 MEMB 1 CNSF 1.0 MEMB 28 DBL 16 ALL GUSSET 8 ALL TRACK 9 ALL CHECK CODE MEMB 1 28 FINISH
Output
A portion of the output for the TRACK9.0 member code check follows:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( v1.0 ******************************************** |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN CM UNIT | | * |=============================| ==||== ----------- | |MEMBER 1 * | INDIAN SECTIONS | || AX = 120.0 | | * | LD ISA200X150X18 | || --Z AY = 48.0 | |DESIGN CODE * | | || AZ = 36.0 | | IS-802 * |-----------------------------| || SY = 297.3 | | * SZ = 350.6 | | * |<---LENGTH (ME= 3.01 --->| RY = 6.2 | |************* RZ = 6.3 | | | | | |PARAMETER BOLTING STRESSES | |IN NEWT MM IN NEWT MM| |--------------------------------------| | L/R-Y = 48.6 BOLT DIA = 16 MM FA = 195.1 | | L/R-Z = 47.7 BOLT CAP = 55.81 KN fa = 145.2 | | KL/R = 84.3 # BOLT = 32 FYB = 436.0 | | FYLD = 250.0 FVB = 218.0 | | GALVA = 0.0 | | C = 1.0 | IS-802)
588 STAAD.Pro
= = =
|**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY ( KN-METR) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS COMPRESSION 0.744 1 | | 1742.26 C 0.0 0.0 0.00 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 5 DETAILS OF CALCULATION ---------------------CHECK FOR MINIMUM THICKNESS --------------------------TYPE : PAINTED MIN. ALLOWABLE THICKNESS : 6.0 MM ACTUAL THICKNESS : 18.0 MM RESULT : PASS CHECK FOR SLENDERNESS RATIO --------------------------VALUE OF L/r : 48.63 EQN. USED TO FIND KL/r : 60.0 + 0.5*L/r ACTUAL VALUE OF KL/r : 84.31 ALLOWABLE KL/r : 120.00
RESULT : PASS CALCULATION OF ALLOWABLE STRESS --------------------------------CRITICAL CONDITION : COMPRESSION Cc : sqrt(2*3.14159265*3.14159265*E : 127.24 b : LENGTH OF LEG - WEB THICKNESS - ROOT RADIUS : 200.0 - 18.0 - 15.0 : 167.0 MM (b/t)lim : 210/sqrt(fy) : 13.28 (b/t)cal : 9.28 (b/t)cal <= (b/t)lim AND KL/r <= Cc ALLOWABLE AXIAL COMP. STRESS : (1-0.5*(KL/r/Cc)*(KL/r/Cc))*fy : 195.07 MPA CHECK AGAINST PERMISSIBLE STRESS -------------------------------LOAD NO. : 1 DESIGN AXIAL FORCE : 1742259.75 N ACTUAL AXIAL COMP. STRESS :1742259.75 / 12000.0 : 145.19 MPA RESULT : PASS STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 6 BOLTING ------BOLT DIA : 16 MM SHEARING CAP : 87.66 KN BEARING CAP : 55.81 KN BOLT CAP : 55.81 KN NO. OF BOLTS REQD. : 32 STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 7 STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( IS-802) v1.0 ******************************************** |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN CM UNIT | | * |=============================| ==| |== ----------- | |MEMBER 28 * | INDIAN SECTIONS | | | AX = 29.2 | | * | ST ISA150X150X10 | | | --Z AY = 10.0 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | | AZ = 10.0 | | IS-802 * =============================== ==| |== SY = 95.7 | | * SZ = 44.8 |
590 STAAD.Pro
| * |<---LENGTH (ME= 6.53 --->| 5.9 | |************* 3.0 | | | | | |PARAMETER BOLTING STRESSES | |IN NEWT MM NEWT MM| |--------------------------------| | L/R-Y = 47.5 BOLT DIA = 16 MM 249.9 | | L/R-Z = 94.0 BOLT CAP = 43.83 KN 48.5 | | KL/R = 94.0 # BOLT = 3 436.0 | | FYLD = 250.0 218.0 | | GALVA = 0.0 | | C = 1.0 | | LEG = 1.0 | | ELA = 1.0 | | NSF = 0.8 | | |
RY = RZ =
IN ------FA fa = =
FYB = FVB =
|**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY ( KN-METR) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS TENSION 0.194 3 | | 112.86 T 0.0 0.0 6.53 |
|* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |-------------------------------------------------------------------------| STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 8 DETAILS OF CALCULATION ---------------------CHECK FOR MINIMUM THICKNESS --------------------------TYPE : PAINTED MIN. ALLOWABLE THICKNESS : 6.0 MM ACTUAL THICKNESS : 10.0 MM RESULT : PASS CHECK FOR SLENDERNESS RATIO --------------------------VALUE OF L/r : 93.96 EQN. USED TO FIND KL/r : K*L/r ACTUAL VALUE OF KL/r : 93.96 ALLOWABLE KL/r : 400.00 RESULT : PASS CALCULATION OF ALLOWABLE STRESS --------------------------------CRITICAL CONDITION : TENSION ALLOWABLE AXIAL TENSILE STRESS : 249.94 MPA CHECK AGAINST PERMISSIBLE STRESS -------------------------------LOAD NO. : 3 DESIGN AXIAL FORCE : 112855.91 N ACTUAL AXIAL TENSILE STRESS : 112855.91 / ( 2920.0*0.797 ) : 48.51 MPA RESULT : PASS BOLTING ------BOLT DIA : 16 MM SHEARING CAP : 43.83 KN BEARING CAP : 55.81 KN BOLT CAP : 43.83 KN NO. OF BOLTS REQD. : 3 STAAD TRUSS -- PAGE NO. 9 ************** END OF TABULATED RESULT OF DESIGN **************
592 STAAD.Pro
Channel with Lips Channel without Lips Angle without Lips Z with Lips Hat
Shape selection may be done using the member property pages of the graphical user interface (GUI) or by specifying the section designation symbol in the input file. The properties listed in the tables are gross section properties. STAAD.Pro uses unreduced section properties in the structure analysis stage. Both unreduced and effective section properties are used in the design stage, as applicable.
Clause 6.6.3, Maximum Effective Slenderness Ratio for members in Compression Clause 5.2.3, Maximum Flat Width Ratios for Elements in Compression Clause 5.2.4, Maximum Section Depths.
The program will check member strength in accordance with Clause 6 of the Standard as follows:
Members in tension
Resistance is calculated in accordance with Clauses 6.1
Clause 6.4.1 Shear stress in webs, Clause 6.4.2 Bending stress in webs Clause 6.4.3 Combined Bending and Shear in Webs.
Members in compression
Resistance calculations are based on Clauses:
l
Clause 6.2 Compression on flat unstiffened element, Clause 6.6.1.1 Shapes not subject to torsional-flexural buckling, Clause 6.6.1.2 Singly-symmetric sections and nonsymmetrical shapes of open cross section or intermittently fastened singly-symmetrical components of built-up shapes having Q = 1.0 which may be subject to torsional-flexural buckling, Clause 6.6.1.3 Singly-symmetric sections and nonsymmetrical shapes or intermittently fastened singly-symmetrical components of built-up shapes having Q < 1.0 which may be subject to torsional-flexural buckling, Clause 6.8 Cylindrical Tubular Sections.
594 STAAD.Pro
All clauses for members in compression Clause 6.3 Laterally Unsupported Members, Clause 6.7.1 Doubly-symmetric shapes or Shapes not subjected to torsional or torsional-flexural buckling Clause 6.7.2. Singly-symmetric shapes or Intermittently fastened singly-symmetric components of built-up shapes having Q=1.0 which may be subjected to torsional-flexural buckling Clause 6.7.3. Singly-symmetric shapes or Intermittently fastened singly-symmetric components of built-up shapes having Q<1.0 which may be subjected to torsional-flexural buckling.
Code Checking
The program compares the resistance of members with the applied load effects, in accordance with IS:801-1975. Code checking is carried out for locations specified by the user via the SECTION command or the BEAM parameter. The results are presented in a form of a PASS/FAIL identifier and a RATIO of load effect to resistance for each member checked. The user may choose the degree of detail in the output data by setting the TRACK parameter. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.
Member Selection
The user may request that the program search the cold formed steel shapes database (IS standard sections) for alternative members that pass the code check and meet the least weight criterion. In addition, a minimum and/or maximum acceptable depth of the member may be specified. The program will then evaluate all database sections of the type initially specified (i.e., channel, angle, etc.) and, if a suitable replacement is found, presents design results for that section. If no section satisfying the depth restrictions or lighter than the initial one can be found, the program leaves the member unchanged, regardless of whether it passes the code check or not.
Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.
Must be specified as IS801 Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
1.0 BEAM
When this parameter is set to 0. the 13 location check is not conducted, and instead, checking is done only at the locations specified by the SECTION command (See STAAD manual for details. For TRUSS members only start and end locations are designed. 1. the adequacy of the member is determined by checking a total of 13 equally spaced locations along the length of the member.
596 STAAD.Pro
Description
Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending . See IS:801-1975, 6.7. y Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0. Coefficient of equivalent uniform bending . See IS:801-1975, 6.7. z Used for Combined axial load and bending design. Values range from 0.4 to 1.0. Specifies whether the cold work of forming strengthening effect should be included in resistance computation. See IS:801-1975, 6.1.1 0. effect should not be included 1. effect should be included
CMZ
1.0
CWY
0.85
FLX
Specifies whether torsionalflexural buckling restraint is provided or is not necessary for the member. See IS:801-1975, 6.6.1 0. Section not subject to torsional flexural buckling 1. Section subject to torsional flexural buckling
FU
FYLD
353.04 MPa
(3600.0
Indian Codes - Design per Indian Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name Default Value kg/cm2) KX 1.0 Effective length factor for torsional buckling. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall buckling about the local Y-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length factor for overall buckling in the local Z-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Unbraced length for twisting. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for Description
KY
1.0
KZ
1.0
LX
Member length
598 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
twisting for determining the capacity in axial compression. LY Member length Effective length for overall buckling in the local Y-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. Effective length for overall buckling in the local Z-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a member completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the capacity in axial compression. 0 Check slenderness ratio 0 Do not check slenderness ratio NSF DMAX 1.0 2540.0 cm. RATIO STIFF 1.0 Member Length Net section factor for tension members Maximum allowable depth, in the current units. Permissible ratio of actual to allowable stresses Spacing of shear stiffeners for stiffened flat webs, in current units.
LZ
Member length
MAIN
Indian Codes - Design per Indian Cold Formed Steel Code Parameter Name TRACK 0 Default Value Description
This parameter is used to control the level of detail in which the design output is reported in the output file. The allowable values are: 0. Prints only the member number, section name, ratio, and PASS/FAIL status. 1. Prints the design summary in addition to that printed by TRACK 0 2. Prints member and material properties in addition to that printed by TRACK 1.
TSA
Specifies whether webs of flexural members are adequately stiffened to satisfy the requirements of IS:801-1975, 5.2.4. 0. Do not comply with 5.2.4 1. Comply with 5.2.4
600 STAAD.Pro
Section 10
Japanese Codes
602 STAAD.Pro
For Beams Prismatic (Rectangular andSquare) For Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular)
In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450 mm depth and 250 mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with a 350 mm diameter.
Warning: It is absolutely imperative that you do not provide the cross section area (AX) as an input.
604 STAAD.Pro
a. Beams are designed for MZ only. The moment MY is not considered in flexure design b. MMAG parameter can be used to increase design moment c. 1.4 cm. is added to the clear cover to take stirrup size into consideration for flexure design. d. STAAD beam design procedure is based on the local practice and considering the fact that Japan is a high seismic zone area.
606 STAAD.Pro
Pcap, Mycap and Mzcap and solve the interaction equation again and this process continues until the eqn. is satisfied or the column fails as Pt exceeds its maximum limit. 8. If biaxial design is not requested program assumes that interaction equation is satisfied (if uniaxial design is performed successfully). 9. If the interaction equation is satisfied program determines bar size and calculates no. of bars and details output is written. Example
UNIT KGS CMS START CONCRETE DESIGN CODE JAPAN FYMAIN SRR295 ALL FC 210 ALL CLEAR 2.5 MEMB 2 TO 6 DESIGN COLUMN 2 TO 6 END CONCRETE DESIGN
608 STAAD.Pro
bar. This is considered the same on both top and bottom surfaces of the element. 4. MINMAIN Minimum required size of longitudinal/transverse reinforcing bar The other parameters shown in Table 10A.1 are not applicable to slab or wall design.
Must be specified as JAPAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BIAXIAL
0.0
Value to define biaxial or uniaxial design type for Column 0. uniaxial design only 1. design for biaxial moments
CLEAR
Japanese Codes - ConcreteDesign Per 1991 AIJ Parameter Name DEPTH Default Value YD Description
Depth of concrete member. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam. (Note: Both SFACE & EFACE are input as positive numbers). Compressive Strength of Concrete. Steel grade. Acceptable values for steel grade and their associated yield stress values are shown in the following table. Program automatically calculates yield stress value depending on design load type (permanent or temporary). Same as FYMAIN except this is for secondary steel. Value to define design load type 0. Permanent Loading 1. Temporary Loading
EFACE
0.0
FC FYMAIN
FYSEC LONG
SR235 0.0
Maximum main reinforcement bar size Maximum secondary reinforcement bar size. Minimum main reinforcement bar size. Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size. Design moment magnification factor Number of equally-spaced sections
610 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
to be considered in finding critical moments for beam design. REINF SFACE SMAG TORSION 0.0 0.0 1.0 0.0 Tied Column. A value of 1.0 will mean spiral. Face of support location at start of beam. Design shear magnification factor Value to request for torsion design for beam 0. torsion design not needed 1. torsion design needed TRACK 0.0 Beam Design: 0. Critical section design results. 1. Five section design results & design forces. 2. 12 section design results & design forces. Column Design: 1. Detail design results for critical load case only. 2. Design results for minimum P, maximum P, maximum MZ and maximum MY among all load cases for both ends. WIDTH ZD Width of concrete member. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
Japanese Codes - ConcreteDesign Per 1991 AIJ Table 10A.2 - Table of permissible Steel Grades and associated Yield Stresses for FYMAIN and FYSEC parameters Steel Grade Long Term Loading Tension &Compression 1600 Shear Reinforcement 1600 Short Term Loading Tension &Compression 2400 Shear Reinforcement 2400
SR235 SRR235 SDR235 SR295 SRR295 SD295A SD295B SDR295 SDR345 SD345 SD390
1600 2000
2000 2000
3000 3000
3000 3000
2000 2000
3500 4000
3500 4000
612 STAAD.Pro
Specify the geometry and loads and perform the analysis. Specify the design parameter values if different from the default values. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection.
10B.3(A) MemberPropertySpecifications
For specification of member properties of standard Japanese steel shapes, the steel section library available in STAAD may be used. The next section describes the syntax of commands used to assign properties from the built-in steel table. Members properties may also be specified using the User Table facility. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.
I shapes
I shapes are specified in the following way:
Note: While specifying the web thickness, the portion after the decimal point should be excluded.
1 TO 9 TA ST I300X150X11 12 TO 15 TA ST I350X150X9
614 STAAD.Pro
H shapes
H shapes are specified as follows:
Note: While specifying the web thickness, the portion after the decimal point should be excluded.
1 TO 8 TA ST H200X100X4 13 TO 17 TA ST H350X350X12
T shapes
T shapes are specified as follows:
Note: While specifying the web thickness, the portion after the decimal point should be excluded.
20 TO 25 TA ST T250X19
Channels
Channel sections are specified as follows.
25 TO 34 TA ST C125X65X6 46 TO 49 TA ST C200X90X8
Double Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without a spacing in between them, are available. The letter D in front of the section name is used to specify a double channel.
17 TO 27 TA D C300X90X10 45 TO 76 TA D C250X90X11 SP 2.0
In the above commands, members 17 to 27 are a back-to-back double channel C300X90X10 with no spacing in between. Members 45 to 76 are a double channel C250X90X11 with a spacing of 2 length units.
Angles
Two types of specification may be used to describe an angle. The standard angle specification is as follows.
The letter L (signifying that the section is an angle) is followed by the length of the legs and then the thickness of the leg, all in millimetres. The word ST signifies that the section is a STandard angle meaning that the major principal axis coincides with the local YY axis specified in Chapter 1 of Section 1.5.2 of the User's Manual.
616 STAAD.Pro
1 4 TA ST L150X90X9
If the minor principal axis coincides with the local YY axis specified in Chapter 2 of the User's Manual, the word RA (Reverse Angle) should be used instead of ST as shown below.
7 TO 23 TA RA L90X75X9
Double angles
Short leg back-to-back and long leg back-to-back double angles may be specified by using the words SD or LD in front of the angle size. In the case of an equal angle, either SD or LD will serve the purpose. The spacing between the angles may be specified by using the word SP after the angle size followed by the value of the spacing.
8 TO 25 TA SD L100X65X7 SP 2.0 36 TO 45 TA LD L300X90X11 SP 3.0
The first example indicates a short legs back-to-back double angle comprised of 100X65X7 angles separated by 2 length units. The latter is a long legs back-to-back double angle comprised of 300X90X11 angles separated by 3 length units.
Tubes
Tube names are input by their dimensions. For example,
6 TA ST TUBE DT 8.0 WT 6.0 TH 0.5
is a tube that has a height of 8 length units, width of 6 length units and a wall thickness of 0.5 length units. Only code checking, no member selection can be performed on TUBE sections.
specifies a pipe with outside diameter of 25 length units and an inside diameter of 20 length units. Only code checking, no member selection, can be performed on PIPE sections. Sample Input file containing Japanese shapes
STAAD SPACE UNIT KIP FEET JOINT COORD 1 0 0 0 12 11 0 0 MEMB INCIDENCE 1 1 2 11 UNIT INCH MEMBER PROPERTY JAPANESE * H-SHAPE 1 TA ST H200X100X4 * I SHAPE 2 TA ST I250X125X10 * T SHAPE 3 TA ST T200X19 * CHANNEL 4 TA ST C125X65X6 * DOUBLE CHANNEL 5 TA D C200X90X8 * REGULAR ANGLE 6 TA ST L100X75X7 * REVERSE ANGLE 7 TA RA L90X75X9 * DOUBLE ANGLE - LONG LEG BACK TO BACK 8 TA LD L125X75X7 SP 2.0 * DOUBLE ANGLE - SHORT LEG BACK TO BACK 9 TA SD L300X90X11 SP 1.5
618 STAAD.Pro
* TUBE 10 TA ST TUBE DT 3.0 WT 2.5 TH 0.25 * PIPE 11 TA ST PIPE OD 3.0 ID 2.5 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH
Design Capabilities
All types of available shapes like H-Shape, I-Shape, L-Shapes, CHANNEL, PIPE, TUBE, Prismatic section etc. can be used as member property and STAAD will automatically adopt the design procedure for that particular shape if Steel Design is requested. STEEL TABLE available within STAAD or UPTABLE facility can be used for member property.
Methodology
For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as required by AIJ specifications. The design procedure consist of following three steps. 1. Calculation of sectional properties The program extract sectional properties like sectional area ( A ), Moment of Inertia about Y axis and Z axis ( Iyy, Izz) from in-built Japanese Steel Table
and calculates Zz, Zy, iy, iz using appropriate formula. For calculation of i ( radius of gyration needed for bending ), program calculates moment of inertia ( Ii )and sectional area ( Ai ) for 1/6th section and then uses following formula: i = (I /A )
i i
Note: The above mentioned procedure for calculation of i is applicable for I shape, H shape and Channel sections. 2. Calculation of actual and allowable stresses Allowable stresses for structural steel under permanent loading shall be determined on the basis of the values of F given in the following table. Table 10B.1 - Table: Values of F (N/mm2) Steel for Construction Structures Thickness SN400 SNR400 SN490 SNR490 Steel for General Structures Steel for Welded
SM
STKN400 STKN490
SSC400 t 40 40< t 100 235 215 325 295 235 215 275 255 375 235 215 325 295
Note: In checking members for temporary loading be the combination of stresses described in Chap.3, allowable stresses specified in this chapter may be increases by 50% Program calculates actual and allowable stresses by following methods:
620 STAAD.Pro
NSF = Net Section Factor for tension Actual compressive stress ( F ) = Force / A
C
= F / 1.5 (For Permanent Case) = F ( For Temporary Case ) Allowable compressive stress (f ) = {1 - 0.4x(/2)} x F/v when
c
where: = (2E/(.6 x F)) =F v = 3/2 + 2/3x(/2) ii. Bending Stress: Actual bending stress for My for compression (F
bcy
)=M /Z
y
cy
)=M /Z
z
cz
)=M /Z
y
ty
)=M /Z
z
tz
cy ty
,Z
cz
)=f
= 900/ (lb x h / A ) For Temporary case, f Where: C = 1.75 - 1.05 (M2 / M1) +0.3 (M2 / M1)2 Allowable bending stress for M , f
y z bty bcz
= 1.5 x (f
bcz
=f =f
btz
bcz
Note: The parameter CB can be used to specify a value for C directly. iii. Shear Stress Actual shear stresses are calculated by the following formula: q =Q /A
y y ww
622 STAAD.Pro
User provided RATIO value (default 1.0) is used for checking design requirements The following conditions are checked to meet the AIJ specifications. For all the conditions calculated value should not be more than the value of RATIO. If for any condition value exceeds RATIO , program gives the message that the section fails. 1. Checking design requirements: User provided RATIO value (default 1.0) is used for checking design requirements The following conditions are checked to meet the AIJ specifications. For all the conditions calculated value should not be more than the value of RATIO. If for any condition value exceeds RATIO, program gives the message that the section fails. Conditions: i. Axial tensile stress ratio = F / f
T t C c
iv. Combined compression & bending ratio = (F v. Combined tension & bending ratio = (F +F
T
btz
+F
bty
-F ) / f
C t
btz
+F
bty
)/f /f
vi. Combined tension & bending ratio = F vii. Shear stress ratio for q = q / f
y z y z s s
bcz bcz
/f
+F
bcy bcy
- F /f
T t
ix. von Mises stress ratio (if the von Mises stresses were set to be checked)= f /(k f )
m t
Note: This output format is available only when the BEAMparameter value is 0 and the TRACK parameter value is 3. If section command is not used design information will be printed for two ends only. If Member Truss option is used no Shear Design information will be printed. Example:
SECTION 0.0 0.25 0.5 0.75 1.0 ALL PARAMETER CODE JAPANESE 2002 BEAM 0.0 ALL TMP 0.0 MEMB 1 TO 4 TMP 1.0 MEMB 5 TO 8 TRACK 3 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
624 STAAD.Pro
Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ Parameter Name Default Value Description
2002 to invoke the AIJ 2002. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 0.0 Locations of design: 0. Design only for end moments or those at locations specified by the SECTION command. 1. Calculate moments at twelfth points along the beam, and use the maximum Mz location for design. CB 0 C value from the AIJ code. See "10B.5(A) Member Capacities" on page 619 Bending Stress for how C is calculated and applied. Use 0.0 to direct the program to calculated Cb. Any other value be used in lieu of the program calculated value. DFF None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member "Deflection Length" / Maxm. allowable local deflection
DJ1
Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note a)
DJ2
End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for member calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note a)
626 STAAD.Pro
Default Value 100 cm 0.0 cm 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 235 MPA 0.0
Description
Maximum allowable depth for member. Minimum allowable depth for member. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Length in local y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Same as above except in z-axis Yield strength of steel in Megapascal. Check for slenderness: 0. Perform check for slenderness 1. Suppress slenderness check
MISES
Option to include check for von Mises stresses 0. Do not include check. 1. Perform Von Mises stress check.
Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Sidesway: 0. Sidesway in local y-axis.
Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ Parameter Name Default Value Description
1. No sidesway SSZ TMAIN 0.0 400 Same as above except in local zaxis. Allowable Slenderness Limit for Tension Member 1.0 = suppress slenderness check . Any value greater than 1 = Allowable KL/r in tension. TMP 0 Loading condition: 0. Permanent Loading 1. Temporary Loading TRACK 0.0 Level of output detail: 0. = Suppress critical member stresses 1. = Print all critical member stresses 2. = Print expanded output 3. = Print maximum details. Note: Only produces results when BEAM0 is used. 4. = Perform and print deflection check. UNL UNF Member Length 1.0 Unsupported length for calculating allowable bending stress. Same as above provided as a fraction of actual member length.
628 STAAD.Pro
Notes
a. "Deflection Length" is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the "Deflection Length" will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the "Deflection Length" may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.
b. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. c. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design.
at every twelfth point along the beam, and the maximum moment about the major axis is used. When no sections are specified and the BEAM parameter is set to zero (default), design will be based on the forces at the start and end joints of the member. The code checking output labels the members as PASSed or FAILed. In addition, the critical condition, governing load case, location (distance from start joint) and magnitudes of the governing forces and moments are also printed. Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command.
630 STAAD.Pro
F = Axial force
x
M = Torsional moment
x
I = Torsional constant
x
k = Loading duration factor, as specified by the TMPparameter (1.0 for permanent and 1.5 for temporary). In the STRESSES output category, stress value of (numerator of the von Mises stress equation) is output as the value of fm. Along with slenderness ratios, stresses, and deflections, von Mises stress equation is checked. When its left-hand side yields the maximum ratio value, it is printed as RATIO and VON MISES is printed as CRITICAL COND.
632 STAAD.Pro
Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceedance of the allowable stresses or capacities and the most economical section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program also checks the slenderness requirements and the stability criteria. Users are recommended to adopt the following steps in performing the steel design:
l
Specify the geometry and loads and perform the analysis. Specify the design parameter values if different from the default values. Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection.
The method for calculating allowable bending stress was updated for the AIJ 2005 from the AIJ 2002 code. All other allowable limit states, analysis and design methods, etc., remain unchanged. Refer to the AIJ 2002 documentation for additional details.
Design Capabilities
All types of available shapes like H-Shape, I-Shape, L-Shapes, CHANNEL, PIPE, TUBE, Prismatic section etc. can be used as member property and STAAD will automatically adopt the design procedure for that particular shape if Steel Design is requested. STEEL TABLE available within STAAD or UPTABLE facility can be used for member property.
Methodology
For steel design, STAAD compares the actual stresses with the allowable stresses as required by AIJ specifications. The design procedure consist of following three
steps. 1. Calculation of sectional properties The program extract sectional properties like sectional area ( A ), Moment of Inertia about Y axis and Z axis ( I , I ) from in-built Japanese Steel Table yy zz and calculates Z , Z , i , i using appropriate formula. For calculation of i ( z y y z radius of gyration needed for bending ), program calculates moment of inertia ( I )and sectional area ( A ) for 1/6th section and then uses following i i formula: i = (I /A )
i i
Note: The above mentioned procedure for calculation of i is applicable for I shape, H shape and Channel sections. 2. Calculation of actual and allowable stresses Program calculates actual and allowable stresses by following methods: i. Axial Stress: Actual tensile stresses ( F ) = Force / ( A x NSF ),
T
NSF = Net Section Factor for tension Actual compressive stress ( F ) = Force / A
C
= F / 1.5 (For Permanent Case) = F ( For Temporary Case ) Allowable compressive stress (f ) = {1 - .4x(/2)} x F/v when
c
634 STAAD.Pro
v = 3/2 + 2/3x(/2) ii. Bending Stress: Actual bending stress for My for compression: (F
bcy
)=M /Z
y
cy
)=M /Z
z
cz
)=M /Z
y
ty
)=M /Z
z
tz
,Z
cz
)=f
t z
When < ,
p b e b
When < ,
e b b
Where:
bcz
= 1.5 x (f
bcz
C = 1.75 - 1.05 (M2 / M1) +0.3 (M2 / M1)2 Allowable bending stress for M , f
y z bty
=f =f
btz
bcz
Note: The parameter CB can be used to specify a value for C directly. iii. Shear Stress Actual shear stresses are calculated by the following formula: q =Q /A
y y ww
3. Checking design requirements: User provided RATIO value (default 1.0) is used for checking design requirements: The following conditions are checked to meet the AIJ specifications. For all the conditions calculated value should not be more than the value of RATIO. If for any condition value exceeds RATIO, program gives the message that the section fails. Conditions:
636 STAAD.Pro
t C c C c bcz bcz C t
iii. Combined compression & bending ratio = F / f +F iv. Combined compression & bending ratio = (F v. Combined tension & bending ratio = (F +F
T btz
/f
+F
t
bcy bcy
/f
+F
bty
-F ) / f
btz
+F
bty
)/f /f
vi. Combined tension & bending ratio = F vii. Shear stress ratio for q = q / f
y z y z s s
bcz bcz
/f
+F
bcy bcy
- F /f
T t
ix. von Mises stress ratio (if the von Mises stresses were set to be checked)= f /(k f )
m t
Note: All other member capacities (axial tension, axial compression, and shear) are calculated as for AIJ 2002. See "10B.5(A) Member Capacities" on page 619
Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ Table 10B.3 - Japanese Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as JAPANESE 2005 to invoke the AIJ 2005. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BEAM
0.0
0.0 = design only for end moments or those at locations specified by the SECTION command. 1.0 = calculate moments at twelfth points along the beam, and use the maximum Mz location for design.
CB
C value from the AIJ code. See "10B.5(A) Member Capacities" on page 619 Bending Stress for how C is calculated and applied. Use 0.0 to direct the program to calculated Cb. Any other value be used in lieu of the program calculated value.
DFF
DJ1
Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note a)
638 STAAD.Pro
Default Value
Description
End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for member calculation of "Deflection Length" (See Note a) 100 cm 0.0 cm 235 MPA 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 0.0 Maximum allowable depth for member. Minimum allowable depth for member. Yield strength of steel in Megapascal. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Length in local y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Same as above except in z-axis 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check
MISES
Option to include check for von Mises stresses 0 = Do not include check. 1 = Perform Von Mises stress check.
Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis.
Japanese Codes - SteelDesign Per 2005 AIJ Parameter Name Default Value Description
1.0 = No sidesway SSZ TMAIN 0.0 400 Same as above except in local zaxis. Allowable Slenderness Limit for Tension Member 1.0 = suppress slenderness check . Any value greater than 1 = Allowable KL/r in tension. TMP 0 0 = Permanent Loading 1 = Temporary Loading TRACK 0.0 Level of output detail: 0. = Suppress critical member stresses 1. = Print all critical member stresses 2. = Print expanded output 3. = Print maximum details. Note: Only produces results when BEAM0 is used. 4. = Perform and print deflection check. UNF UNL 1.0 Member Length Same as above provided as a fraction of actual member length. Unsupported length for calculating allowable bending stress.
640 STAAD.Pro
Notes
a. "Deflection Length" is defined as the length that is used for calculation of local deflections within a member. It may be noted that for most cases the "Deflection Length" will be equal to the length of the member. However, in some situations, the "Deflection Length" may be different. A straight line joining DJ1 and DJ2 is used as the reference line from which local deflections are measured. For example, refer to the figure below where a beam has been modeled using four joints and three members. The Deflection Length for all three members will be equal to the total length of the beam in this case. The parameters DJ1 and DJ2 should be used to model this situation. Thus, for all three members here, DJ1 should be 1 and DJ2 should be 4.
b. If DJ1 and DJ2 are not used, "Deflection Length" will default to the member length and local deflections will be measured from original member line. c. The above parameters may be used in conjunction with other available parameters for steel design.
editions of AIJ), indicates that the left-hand side in the equation should be less than unity. These checks are performed at locations indicated by the BEAMparameter. The default is set that this check is not performed. The MISESparameter must be set to 1 to initiate the checks. Note: As with other design checks, the unity check value can be modified by use of the RATIO parameter. The von Mises stresses are evaluated and checked as follows:
F = Axial force
x
M = Torsional moment
x
I = Torsional constant
x
642 STAAD.Pro
k = Loading duration factor, as specified by the TMPparameter (1.0 for permanent and 1.5 for temporary). In the STRESSES output category, stress value of (numerator of the von Mises stress equation) is output as the value of fm. Along with slenderness ratios, stresses, and deflections, von Mises stress equation is checked. When its left-hand side yields the maximum ratio value, it is printed as RATIO and VON MISES is printed as CRITICAL COND.
Type
Static analysis, 3D beam element.
Reference
Problem
A cantilever beam of length 2 meter is subjected to a permanent joint load of 3 kN in the Y direction and 2 kN in the Z direction as well as a 0.008 kNm torque applied at the end. Axial tension of 10 kN is also applied to the member. An H100x50x5 section is used from the Japanese steel tables.
Given
Section properties D = 100 mm
x
I = 15,000 mm4
x
Z = 2I /D = 215000/100 = 300 mm3, Z = 5920 mm3, Z = 37400 x x x y z mm3 The maximum of the left hand side of the von Mises stress equation apparently occurs at the fixed end of the beam. Section forces at the fixed end are ass follow: 10.0 kN (Tension) 6.0 kNm (Bending-Y) 6.0 kNm (Bending-Z) 3.0 kN (Shear-Y) 2.0 kN (Shear-Z) -0.008 kNm (Torsion Member Length L = 2 m, Unbraced length = 100mm. Material FYLD = 300 MPa E = 2.05E+05 MPa G = E/2.6 MPa
Solution
From these section forces, and at the section of the fixed end are calculated x xy as follows:
644 STAAD.Pro
=(
Since f = FYLD/1.5 = 300.0 MPa/15 = 200.0 N/mm2 and k = 1 for permanent t loading, Ratio = 146.26/(200.0 1) = 0.731 < 1, So OK.
Comparison
Table 10B.4 - Comparison of results for a AIJ 2005 verification problem Hand Calculation von Mises Stress (f )
m
Comments
146.26 N/mm2
None
DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.05E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY JAPANESE 1 TABLE ST H100X50X5 UNIT MMS KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED UNIT METER KN LOAD 1 LC1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX 10 FY 3 FZ 2 MX 0.008 PERFORM ANALYSIS LOAD LIST 1 PRINT MEMBER FORCES LIST 1 PARAMETER 1 CODE JAPANESE 2005 TMP 0 ALL UNL 0.002 ALL MISES 1 ALL TRACK 2 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL CHECK CODE ALL
646 STAAD.Pro
FINISH
Output
The TRACK 2.0 output portion is as follows:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( AIJ 2005) ******************************************** |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN CM UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ------------ | |MEMBER 1 * | JAPANESE SECTIONS | | AX = 11.85 | | * | ST H100X50X5 | | --Z AY = 5.00 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 4.67 | | AIJ-2005 * =============================== ===|=== ZY = 5.92 | | * ZZ = 37.40 | | * |<---LENGTH (ME= 0.30 --->| iY = 1.12 | |************* iZ = 3.97 | | ZX = 0.30 | | 0.90(KN-MET) | |PARAMETER |L1 STRESSES | |IN N MM | L1 L1 IN N MM| |--------------- + L1 L1 -------------| | KL/R-Y= 26.8 | L1 FA = 189.5 | | KL/R-Z= 7.6 + L1 fa = 8.4 | | UNL = 2.5 | L1 L1 FCZ = 200.0 | | CB = 1.75 + FTZ = 200.0 | | CMY = 0.85 | L1 L1 FCY = 200.0 | | CMZ = 0.85 + L1 L1 FTY = 200.0 | | FYLD = 300.0 | L0 fbz = 24.1 | | NSF = 1.00 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| fby = 101.4 | | DFF = 0.0 -0.05 FV = 115.5 | | dff = 0.0 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE fv = 6.0 | | (WITH LOAD NO.) FT = 200.0 | | fm = 146.3 | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY (KN-MET) Sx = 133.9 | | ------------------------Tou = 34.0 | | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y MOMENT-Z | | | | VALUE -10.00 3.00 2.00 0.60 0.90 | | LOCATION 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 0.000 | | LOADING 1 1 1 1 1 | | | |**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY (KN-MET) *| |* -------------*| |* *|
648 STAAD.Pro
Section 11
Mexican Codes
650 STAAD.Pro
Columns Prismatic (Rectangular, Square, and Circular) Beams Prismatic (Rectangular & Square), Trapezoidal, and T-shapes Walls Finite element with a specified thickness
Figure 11.1 - Concrete shape nomenclature for beams and columns
13 TO 79 PRISM YD 40. ZD 20. IZ 53333 IY 13333 11 13 PR YD 20. 14 TO 16 PRIS YD 24. ZD 48. YB 18. ZB 12. 17 TO 19 PR YD 24. ZD 18. ZB 12.
In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (40 cm depth and 20 cm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 20 cm diameter. Note that no area (AX) is provided for these members. For concrete design, this property must not be provided. If shear areas and moments of inertias are not provided, the program calculates these values from YD and ZD. Notice that in the above example the IZ and IY values provided are actually 50% of the values calculated using YD and ZD. This is a conventional practice which takes into consideration revised section parameters due to cracking of section. Note that the third and the fourth set of members in the above example represent a T-shape and a TRAPEZOIDAL shape respectively. Depending on the properties (YD, ZD, YB, ZB, etc.) provided, the program will determine whether the section is rectangular, trapezoidal or T-shaped and the BEAM design will be done accordingly.
652 STAAD.Pro
Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 11A.1 - Mexican Concrete Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Parameters
Must be specified as MEXICAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BTP
Bar type to use: 0. IMPERIAL (No 3 to 18) 1. METRIC (4.2 to 60mm) 2. MEXICAN (No 2 to 18)
CCL
Concrete class according to 1.4.1d) to define Modulus of Elasticity 1. Class 1 Concrete 2. Class 2 Concrete
CFB
FALSE
Cold formed Barclassification to define development multipliers according to table 3.1 NTC
l
3 cm 3 cm 3 cm 2 cm
Clear cover for bottom reinforcement Clear cover for side reinforcement Clear cover for top reinforcement Maximum diameter of aggregate, in current units.
Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987 Parameter Name DCP Default Value TRUE Parameters
DEPTH
YD
Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
l
DIM
TRUE
FALSE: Not precautions taken - Section reduction to section 1.5 NTC Concrete TRUE: Precautions are taken to assure dimensions
DSD
TRUE
Ductile frames in accordance with Section 5 of the code. Some design conditions are considered (not including, for the time being, geometric or confinement ones)
l
EFACE
Face to support location of end of beam. If specified, for shear force at start is computed at a distance of EFACE+d from the start joint of the member. Positive number.
654 STAAD.Pro
Parameters
200 Kg/cm2 Compressive Strength of Concrete 4,200 Kg/cm2 4,200 Kg/cm2 0 Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel Yield Stress for secondary (stirrup) reinforcing steel Part of the longitudinal steel considered to reduce shear. 0 (zero) is conservative. Value between 1 and 0. Light Concrete to define development multipliers according to table 3.1 NTC
l
LTC
FALSE
Maximum main reinforcement bar size (Number 2 -18) Minimum main reinforcement bar size (Number 2 -18) Minimum secondary reinforcement bar size(Number 2 -18) Moment magnification factor for columns, about My.
Mexican Codes - Concrete Design Per MEX NTC 1987 Parameter Name MMZ MOE NSECTION Default Value 1.0 198,000 Kg/cm2 12 Parameters
Moment magnification factor for columns, about Mz. Concrete modulus of elasticiy. Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moments for beam design Stirrups angle with the axis of the element Slab beared perimeter. To calculate min steel required according to 2.1.2 Tied Column. A value of 1 will mean spiral. Face to support location of start of beam. If specified, for shear force at start is computed at a distance of SFACE+d from the start joint of the member. Positive number Beam needed for torsional equilibrium Cl.2.1.6a) 2nd paragraph
l
PHI PSS
90 degrees TRUE
REINF SFACE
0 0
TEQ
FALSE
656 STAAD.Pro
Default Value 0
Parameters
Beam Design 0. Critical Moment will not be printed out with beam design report. 1. Will mean a print out. 2. Will print out required steel areas for all intermediate sections specified by NSECTION. Column Design 0. Will print out detailed design results. 1. Will mean a print out column interation analysis results in addition to TRACK 0 output. 2. will print out a schematic interaction diagram and intermediate interaction values in addition to all of the above.
WIDTH
ZD
Width of concrete member, in current units. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES
* These values must be provided in the current unit system being used. Note: When using metric bars for design, provide values for these parameters in actual mm units instead of the barnumber. The following metric bar sizes are available: 4.2mm, 6 mm, 8 mm, 10 mm, 12 mm, 16 mm, 20 mm, 25 mm, 32 mm, 40 mm, 50 mm and 60 mm.
658 STAAD.Pro
which they are provided are calculated. Stirrups due to geometric conditions are assumed to be 2-legged, due to design conditions could be 2 or 4-legged.
Output
Level Serial number of bar level which may contain one or more bar group Height Height of bar level from the bottom of the beam Bar Info Reinforcement bar information specifying number of bars and bar size From Distance from the start of the beam to the start of the reinforcement bar To Distance from the start of the beam to the end of the reinforcement bar Anchor (STA/END) States whether anchorage, either hook or continuation, is needed at the start (STA) or at the end (END). Row Actually required flexural reinforcement (As/bd) where b = width of cross section (ZD for a rectangular or square section) and d = effective depth of cross section (YD minus the distance from extreme tension fiber to the centroid of main reinforcement). ROWMN Minimum required flexural reinforcement (Amin/bd) ROWMX
Maximum required flexural reinforcement (Amax/bd) Spacing Distance between centers of adjacent bars of main reinforcement Vu Factored shear force at section Vc Nominal shear strength provided by concrete Vs Nominal shear strength provided by shear reinforcement Tu Factored torsional moment at section Tc Nominal torsional moment strength provided by concrete Ts Nominal torsional moment strength provided by torsion reinforcement ACTUAL OUTPUT FROM DESIGN ===================================================================== BEAM NO. 1 DESIGN RESULTS - FLEXURE PER CODE NTC FOR THE DESIGN AND CONSTRUCTION OF CONCRETE STRUCTURES,DDF LEN - 525.00(cm) FY - 4200. FC - 250. SIZE - 30.00 X 80.00(cm) LEVEL HEIGHT BAR INFO FROM TO ANCHOR (cm) (cm) (cm) STA END ____________________________________________________ _________________ 1 4. 8 - -NUM, 5 0. 39. YES NO 1 4. 1 - -NUM, 4 0. 39. 2 8. 3 - -NUM, 5 0. 39. YES NO
660 STAAD.Pro
|----------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL MOMENT=5978000.50 Kg cm AT 0.00 (cm)LOAD 1| | REQD STEEL= 24.41 (cm2)ROW=0.0109 ROWMX=0.0190 ROWMN=0.0026 | | REQD COMP STEEL= 0.00 (cm2) | | MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 24.14/ 3.18/ 3.45 (cm) | | COMP MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 0.00/ 0.00/ 0.00 (cm) | | BASIC/REQD. DEVELOPMENT LENGTH = 40.07/ 39.08(cm) | |----------------------------------------------------------------| Cracked Moment of Inertia Iz at above location = 1015658.4 cm^4 3 77. 10 - -NUM, 4 0. 45. YES NO 4 73. 9 - -NUM, 4 0. 45. YES NO |----------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL MOMENT=5978000.50 Kg cm AT 0.00 (cm)LOAD 1| | REQD STEEL= 24.17 (cm2)ROW=0.0107 ROWMX=0.0190 ROWMN=0.0026 | | REQD COMP STEEL= 0.00 (cm2) | | MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 24.46/ 2.54/ 2.72 (cm) | | COMP MAX/MIN/ACTUAL BAR SPACING= 0.00/ 0.00/ 0.00 (cm) | | BASIC/REQD. DEVELOPMENT LENGTH = 32.00/ 44.81(cm) | |----------------------------------------------------------------| Cracked Moment of Inertia Iz at above location = 1008728.7 cm^4 REQUIRED REINF. STEEL SUMMARY :
------------------------------SECTION REINF STEEL(+VE/-VE) MOMENTS(+VE/-VE) LOAD(+VE/VE) ( CM ) (SQ. CM ) (KG -CM ) 0.00 24.67/ 24.67 5978000./ 5978000.50 0/ 0 525.00 24.67/ 24.67 5978000./ 5978000.50 0/ 0 B E A M N O. 1 D E S I G N R E S U L T S SHEAR AT START SUPPORT - Vu=41850.00 Kg Vc= 6074.49 Kg Vs=44719.39 Kg Tu= 0.00 Kg cm Tc= 0.00 Kg cm Ts= 0.00 Kg cm LOAD 0 NO STIRRUPS ARE REQUIRED FOR TORSION. REINFORCEMENT IS REQUIRED FOR SHEAR. PROVIDE NUM. 2.5 2-LEGGED STIRRUPS AT 7.(cm) C/C FOR 176.(cm) ADDITIONAL LONGITUDINAL STEEL REQD. FOR TORSIONAL RESISTANCE = 0.00 (cm2) AT END SUPPORT - Vu=37450.00 Kg Vc= 6074.49 Kg Vs=39219.39 Kg Tu= 0.00 Kg cm Tc= 0.00 Kg cm Ts= 0.00 Kg cm LOAD 0 NO STIRRUPS ARE REQUIRED FOR TORSION. REINFORCEMENT IS REQUIRED FOR SHEAR. PROVIDE NUM. 2.5 2-LEGGED STIRRUPS AT 8.(cm) C/C FOR 176.(cm) ADDITIONAL LONGITUDINAL STEEL REQD. FOR TORSIONAL RESISTANCE = 0.00 (cm2)
662 STAAD.Pro
) +(M /M
nz
zcap
Where = 1.24. If the column is subjected to uniaxial moment: = 1 6. If the Interaction equation is satisfied, find an arrangement with available bar
sizes, find the uniaxial capacities and solve the interaction equation again. If the equation is satisfied now, the reinforcement details are written tothe output file. 7. If the interaction equation is not satisfied, the assumed reinforcement is increased (ensuring that it is under 6% or 4% respectively)and steps 2 to 6 are repeated. By the moment to check shear and torsion for columns the sections have to be checked as beams and the most strict of both shear and torsion reinforcement adopted.
P0 = Maximum allowable pure axial load on the column (moment zero). Pnmax = Maximum allowable axial load on the column. P_bal = Axial load capacity of balanced strain condition. M_bal = Uniaxial moment capacity of balanced strain condition. E_bal = M_bal / P_bal = Eccentricity of balanced strain condition. M0 = Moment capacity at zero axial load. P_tens = Maximum permissible tensile load on the column. Des. Pn = Pu/FR where FR is the Strength Reduction Factor and Pu is the axial load for the critical load case. Des.Mnx = Mux*MMAGx/FR where FR is the Strength Reduction Factor and Mu is the bending moment for the appropriate axis for the critical load case. Mu = (Mux.Mmagx)+ (Muy.Mmagy) e/h = (Mn/Pn)/h where h is the length of the column
664 STAAD.Pro
================================================== COLUMN NO. 1 DESIGN PER - AXIAL + BENDING FY -4200.0 FC - 294.1 Kg/cm2 CIRC SIZE 100.0(cm)DIAMETER AREA OF STEEL REQUIRED = 128.506 BAR CONFIGURATION REINF PCT. LOAD LOCATION PHI ---------------------------------------------------------46 - NUMBER 6 1.669 1 END 0.700 (EQUALLY SPACED) TRACK=1 generates the following additional output: COLUMN INTERACTION: MOMENT ABOUT Z/Y -AXIS (Kg-cm ) -------------------------------------------------------P0 Pn max P-bal. M-bal. e-bal.(cm) 2095196.38 2095196.38 727411.12 29235398.00 40.2 M0 P-tens. Des.Pn 'Des.Mn e/h 20606994.00 -550620.00 0.00 20000000.00 NaN -------------------------------------------------------TRACK=2 generates the following output in addition to all the above: Pn Mn Pn Mn | 1934027.38 5373253.50 967013.69 27278232.00
P0 |* 1772858.50 11408365.00 805844.75 28658428.00 | * 1611689.50 16296947.00 644675.81 29473708.00 Pn,max|__* 1450520.62 20083028.00 483506.84 28901764.00 | * 1289351.62 23117562.00 322337.91 27205616.00 Pn | * 1128182.62 25462606.00 161168.95 24433192.00 NOMINAL| * AXIAL| * COMPRESSION| * Pb|-------*Mb | * ___________|____*_______ | * M0 Mn, | * BENDING P-tens|* MOMENT
666 STAAD.Pro
ELEMENT DESIGN SUMMARY ---------------------ELEMENT LONG. REINF MOM-X /LOAD TRANS. REINF MOM-Y /LOAD (SQ.CM/M ) (T -M /M ) (SQ.CM/M ) (T -M /M ) 1 TOP : Longitudinal direction - Only minimum steel required. 1 BOTT: Transverse direction - Only minimum steel required. 1 TOP : 2.239 0.00 / 0 3.252 983.00 / 1 BOTT: 3.758 983.00 / 1 1.684 0.00 / 0 1 SHEAR CAPACITY 3794.73 Kg ***PASS***
668 STAAD.Pro
On the left side of the inequality, the required strength is the summation of the various load effects, Q , multiplied by their respective load factors, Y . The design i i strength, on the right side, is the nominal strength or resistance, R , multiplied by n a resistance factor, FR. In the STAAD implementation of the Mexican Standards, it is assumed that the user will use appropriate load factors and create the load combinations necessary for analysis. The design portion of the program will take into consideration the load effects (forces and moments) obtained from analysis. In calculation of resistances of various elements (beams, columns etc.), resistance (nominal strength) and applicable resistance factor will be automatically considered.
670 STAAD.Pro
section class. STAAD is capable of determining the section classification for the standard shapes and design accordingly.
In addition to the compression resistance criterion, compression members are required to satisfy slenderness limitations which are a function of the nature of use of the member (main load resisting component, bracing member, etc.). In both the member selection and code checking process, STAAD immediately does a slenderness check on appropriate members before continuing with other procedures for determining the adequacy of a given member.
672 STAAD.Pro
Note: The local X axis goes into the page; the Global Y axis is vertical upwards; the shaded area indicates area under compression; the area not shaded indicates area under tension. Stress areas due to bending about Z axis (MZ)
674 STAAD.Pro
Table 11B.1 - Design Parameters According to Mexican NTC Standards - Steel Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as MEXICAN. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
KX KY KZ LX LY
K value for flexural-torsional buckling K value in local Y axis- Usually minor axis K value in local Z axis- Usually major axis Length for flexural-torsional buckling Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Z axis. Minimum Yield strength of steel Ultimate tensile strength of steel Net section factor for tension members Unsupported length (L) of the top* flange for calculating flexural strength . Will be used only if compression is in the top flange.
LZ
Member length
Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code Parameter Name UNB Default Value Description
Member length
Unsupported length (L) of the bottom* flange for calculating flexural strength . Will be used only if compression is in the bottom flange. Spacing of stiffeners for beams for shear design Coefficient C defined per section 3.3.2.2. If Cb is set to 0.0 it will be calculated by the program according to LRFD USA (CbMex=1/CbUSA). Any other value will be directly used in the design. 0 = Suppress all design strengths 1 = Print all design strengths 2 = Print expanded design output
STIFF Cb y Cby
Member length 1
TRACK
Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Permissible ratio of actual load effect and design strength 0: Design at ends and those locations specified by SECTION command. 1: Design at ends and at every y cada 1/12th point along member length
Rigid_to_ H_Loads
TRUE
676 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
( shear walls, wind trusses or bracing rigid elements ) that restrict lateral displacements and allow to disregard slenderness effects. IRREG 0 Variable defined for the whole structure indicating if it is regular or irregular according to section 3.4 of the NTC. IRREG=1 for columns being part of irregular structures. I_NO_OXIG 0 Defined for I shapes or tubes Curve Definition according to NTC.3.2.2.1a) I_NO_OXIG.= 0 implies n=1.4 laminated I shapes, tubes or built up with 3 or 4 welded plates obtained from wider plates cuts with oxygen. I_NO_OXIG.= 1 implies n=1 I shapes, tubes or built up with 3 or 4 welded plates n is defined by the program IMAIN_MEM 0 IMAIN_MEM=0 MAIN MEMBER IMAIN_MEM=1 Secondary and wind trusses Ccomb 1 Cfactor for combined forces when there are transverse
Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code Parameter Name Default Value Description
loads in the members. Section 3.4.3.3.ii NTC Ccomb=1 If members ends are restricted angularly. Ccomb=0.85 If members ends DUCTILE_ SEISMIC _ DESIGN TRUE are not restricted angularly. DUCTILE FRAMES ACCORDING TO SECTION 11. Main design conditions are considered (not including, at the moment, geometric ones) K value for flexural-torsional buckling K value in local Y axis- Usually minor axis K value in local Z axis- Usually major axis Length for flexural-torsional buckling Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Z axis. Minimum Yield strength of steel Ultimate tensile strength of steel
KX KY KZ LX LY
LZ
Member length
FYLD FU
678 STAAD.Pro
Default Value
Description
1 Member length
Net section factor for tension members Unsupported length (L) of the top* flange for calculating flexural strength . Will be used only if compression is in the top flange. Unsupported length (L) of the bottom* flange for calculating flexural strength . Will be used only if compression is in the bottom flange. Spacing of stiffeners for beams for shear design Coefficient C defined per section 3.3.2.2. If Cb is set to 0.0 it will be calculated by the program according to LRFD USA (CbMex=1/CbUSA). Any other value will be directly 0 = Supress all design strengths used in the design. 1 = Print all design strengths 2 = Print expanded design output
UNB
Member length
STIFF Cb y Cby
Member length 1
TRACK
Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Permissible ratio of actual load effect and design strength 0: Design at ends and those locations specified by International Design Codes Manual 679
Mexican Codes - Steel Design Per Mexican Code Parameter Name Default Value Description
SECTION command. 1: Design at ends and at every y cada 1/12th point along member length Rigid_to_ H_Loads TRUE Defines if the structure has elements to bear the wind load ( shear walls, wind trusses or bracing rigid elements ) that restrict lateral displacements and allow to disregard slenderness effects. Variable defined for the whole structure indicating if it is regular or irregular according to section 3.4 of the NTC. IRREG=1 for columns being part of irregular structures. I_NO_OXIG 0 Defined for I shapes or tubes Curve Definition according to NTC.3.2.2.1a) I_NO_OXIG.= 0 implies n=1.4 laminated I shapes, tubes or built up with 3 or 4 welded plates obtained from wider
IRREG
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
3 or 4 welded plates
n is defined by the program IMAIN_MEM 0 IMAIN_MEM=0 MAIN MEMBER IMAIN_MEM=1 Secondary and wind trusses Ccomb 1 Cfactor for combined forces when there are transverse loads in the members. Section 3.4.3.3.ii NTC Ccomb=1 If members ends are restricted angularly. Ccomb=0.85 If members ends DUCTILE_ SEISMIC _ DESIGN TRUE are not restricted angularly. DUCTILE FRAMES ACCORDING TO SECTION 11. Main design conditions are considered (not including, at the moment, geometric ones)
* Top and Bottom represent the positive and negative side of the local Y axis (local Z axis if SET Z UP is used. For deflection check, parameters DFF, DJ1 and DJ2 from Table 2.1 may be used. All requirements remain the same.
Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.
682 STAAD.Pro
Section 12
Russian Codes
684 STAAD.Pro
brittle, plastic or other type of failure, loss by structure of stable form or position, fatigue failure, failure due to the action of load actions and unfavorable environmental effects.
Analysis according to the second group of limit states is performed to avoid the following phenomena:
l
excessive and long-term opening of cracks if they are allowed according to service conditions, excessive displacements.
Analysis of structures for the first group of limit states is performed with the use of the maximum (design) loads and actions. Analysis of structures for the second group of limit states is made in accordance with the operational (normative) loads and actions. Ratio between design and normative loads is called reliability coefficient for loads which is determined according to SNiP 2.01.07.-85 Loads and actions. Reliability coefficient for destination according to SNiP 2.01.07.-85 shall be n considered in determination of loads and their combinations. Program STAAD.Pro makes it possible to calculate reinforcement for concrete members according to codes of many countries round the World and Russian Code SNiP 2.03.01-84* inclusive. Algorithms for calculation of reinforcement of concrete linear (beams, columns) and 2D (two dimensional) (slabs, walls, shells) members
are incorporated in program STAAD.Pro. Not only Code SNiP 2.03.01-84* but also the Guide for design of plain concrete and reinforced concrete structures from normal weight and lightweight concrete (to SNiP 2.03.01-84) have been used in creation of these algorithms. It is possible using program STAAD.Pro to calculate reinforcement for beams of rectangular or T section and for columns of rectangular or circular section (Fig.1).
Figure 12A.1 - Notation of dimensions for rectangular, circular and T sections Flange of T-shape beams may be situated at the top zone of the section if the angle BETA=0, or at the bottom zone of the section, if BETA=180.
686 STAAD.Pro
41TO100 THICKNESS0.14 101TO252 THICKNESS0.16 * FLANGE OF T BEAMS IS LOCATED AT THE BOTTOM ZONE OF CROSS-SECTION BETA180.MEMB23TO40 COMMANDS FOR CALCULATION OF REINFORCEMENT ARE LOCATED IN THE INPUT DATA FILE AFTER THE COMMAND OF ANALYSIS AND AS A RULE, AFTER OUTPUT COMMANDS TO PRINT RESULTS OF CALCULATION.
Example:
* COMMAND OF ANALYSIS PERFORMANALYSIS . .* OUTPUT COMMAND TO PRINT RESULTS OF CALCULATION (ACCORDING TO USERS JUDGMENT) . *COMMAND OF LOADING AND THEIR COMBINATIONS CONSIDERED IN DESIGN LOADLIST15TO9 *COMMAND TO START REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION PROCEDURE STARTCONCRETEDESIGN CODERUSSIAN .* LIST OF PARAMETERS BEING USED IN REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION . . BCL20.MEMB17TO22 CL10.04MEMB1TO40 DD210.MEMB23TO40 CRA 0.036MEMB41TO252 .
. . * COMMAND OF BEAM REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION DESIGNBEAM23TO40 * COMMAND OF COLUMN REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION DESIGNCOLUMN1TO22 * COMMAND OF CALCULATION 2D ELEMENTS (SLABS, WALLS, SHELLS) DESIGNELEMENT41TO 252 * COMMAND OF INTERRUPTION REINFORCEMENT CALCULATION ENDCONCRETEDESIGN
In tables 1, 2 and 3 information about parameters used for calculation of reinforcement for beams, columns and 2D (two dimensional) members is presented. Values of parameters do not depend on UNIT command. In the file of input data only such parameters have to be taken, the values of which differ from determined in the program. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 12A.1 - Names of parameters for Concrete design according to Russian Code - 2.03.01-84* for beams. No. Parameter Default name Value 1 2 NLT RCL 1 3 Description
RCL = 1, if class of reinforcement is A-I; RCL = 2, if class of reinforcement is A-II; RCL = 3, if class of
688 STAAD.Pro
Description
reinforcement is A-III;
l
RCL = 33, if class of reinforcement is A-IIIb; RCL = 4, if class of reinforcement is A-IV; RCL = 5, if class of reinforcement is A-V; RCL = 6, if class of reinforcement is A-VI; RCL = 7, if class of reinforcement is A-VII; RCL = 77, if class of reinforcement is K-7; RCL = 8, if class of reinforcement is B-II; RCL = 9, if class of reinforcement is Bp-II; RCL = 10, if class of reinforcement is Bp-I; RCL = 19, if class of reinforcement is K-19
RCL
Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default name Value Description
European Grade:
l
USM
1.
4 5
UB2 DD1
0.9 16.
Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars in beam tension zone Diameter of shear reinforcement bars for beam; Compression class of concrete Compression Class of concrete.
l
6 7 7
10 = B10; 15 = B15 20 = B20; 25 = B25; 30 = B30; 35 = B35; 40 = B40; 45 = B45; 50 = B50; 55 = B55; 60 = B60; 8.10 = C8/10
690 STAAD.Pro
Description
12.15 = C12/15; 16.20 = C16/20 25.30 = C25/30 30.37 = C30/37 35.45 = C35/45 40.50 = C50/50 45.55 = C45/55 50.60 = C50/60 60.75 = C60/75 70.85 = C70/85 80.95 = C80/95 90.105 = C90/105
UBM
1.
TEM
0.
TEM=0, for natural hardening conditions; TEM=1, for steam hardening conditions
10
CL1
0.05
Distance from top/bottom fiber of beam cross section to the center of longitudinal reinforcement bar; Distance from left/right side of beam cross section to the center of longitudinal reinforcement bar Ultimate width of short-term crack Ultimate width of long-term crack
11
CL2
0.05
12 13
WST WLT
0.4 0.3
Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default name Value 14 SSE 0 Description
SSE=0, if calculation of reinforcement amount must be carried out according to the requirements of load carrying capacity (the first limit state); SSE=1, if calculation of reinforcement amount must be carried out according to the cracking requirements (the second limit state)
15
RSH
RSH = 1, if class of reinforcement is A-I; RSH = 2, if class of reinforcement is A-II; RSH = 3, if class of reinforcement is A-III; RSH = 33, if class of reinforcement is A-IIIb; RSH = 4, if class of reinforcement is A-IV; RSH = 5, if class of reinforcement is A-V; RSH = 6, if class of reinforcement is A-VI; RSH = 7, if class of reinforcement is A-VII;
692 STAAD.Pro
Description
RSH = 77, if class of reinforcement is K-7; RSH = 8, if class of reinforcement is B-II; RSH = 9, if class of reinforcement is Bp-II; RSH = 10, if class of reinforcement is Bp-I; RSH = 19, if class of reinforcement is K-19
15
RSH
European grade:
l
16
FWT
ZD
Design width of beam top flange. Use for beam design only with default value provided as ZD in member properties. Design width of beam bottom flange. Use for beam design only with default value provided as ZB
17
FWB
ZB
Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default name Value Description
in member properties. 18 DEP YD Design depth of beam section. Use for beam design only with default value provided as YD in member properties. Face of support location at the start of the beam. Use for beam design only. Face of support location at the end of the beam. Use for beam design only. Number of equally-spaced sections for beam design. Use for beam design only. Upper limit is equal to 20.
19
SFA
0.
20
EFA
0.
21
NSE
13
Table 12A.2 - Names of parameters for Concrete design according to Russian Code 2.03.01-84* for columns No. Parameter Default Name Value 1 2 NLT RCL 1 3 Description
European Grade:
694 STAAD.Pro
Description
USM
1.
4 5 6 7
Minimum diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars for column Maximum diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars for column Compression class of concrete:
l
10 = B10; 15 = B15 20 = B20; 25 = B25; 30 = B30; 35 = B35; 40 = B40; 45 = B45; 50 = B50; 55 = B55; 60 = B60; 8.10 = C8/10 12.15 = C12/15; 16.20 = C16/20 25.30 = C25/30
Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default Name Value
l
Description
30.37 = C30/37 35.45 = C35/45 40.50 = C50/50 45.55 = C45/55 50.60 = C50/60 60.75 = C60/75 70.85 = C70/85 80.95 = C80/95 90.105 = C90/105
UBM
1.
TEM
0.
TEM=0, for natural hardening conditions; TEM=1, for steam hardening conditions
10
CL1
0.05
Distance from edge of column cross section to the center of longitudinal reinforcement bar Column's length coefficient to evaluate slenderness effect in local Y axis Column's length coefficient to evaluate slenderness effect in local Z axis Class of shear reinforcement: Russian Grade:
11
ELY
1.
12
ELZ
1.
13
RSH
1.
696 STAAD.Pro
Description
European grade:
l
Table 12A.3 - Names of parameters for Concrete design according to Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) for slabs and/or walls No. Parameter Default Name Value 1 2 NLT RCL 1 3 Description
European Grade:
l
11 = S240; 12 = S400;
Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default Name Value
l
Description
13 = S500;
USM
1.
4 5
UB2 SDX
0.9 16.
Diameter of reinforcing bars located in the first local (X) direction of slab/wall Diameter of reinforcing bars located in the second local (Y) direction of slab/wall Compression class of concrete:
l
SDY
16.
BCL
15.
10 = B10; 15 = B15 20 = B20; 25 = B25; 30 = B30; 35 = B35; 40 = B40; 45 = B45; 50 = B50; 55 = B55; 60 = B60; 8.10 = C8/10 12.15 = C12/15; 16.20 = C16/20 25.30 = C25/30 30.37 = C30/37
698 STAAD.Pro
Description
35.45 = C35/45 40.50 = C50/50 45.55 = C45/55 50.60 = C50/60 60.75 = C60/75 70.85 = C70/85 80.95 = C80/95 90.105 = C90/105
UBM
1.
TEM
0.
TEM=0, for natural hardening conditions; TEM=1, for steam hardening conditions
10
CL
0.05
Distance from top/bottom face of slab/wall element to the center of longitudinal reinforcing bars located in first local (X) direction. (Main thickness of top/bottom concrete cover for slab/wall element) Distance from top/bottom face of slab/wall element to the center of transverse reinforcing bars located in second local (Y) direction (Secondary thickness of top/bottom concrete cover for slab/wall)
11
CRA
0.05
Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default Name Value 12 13 14 WST WLT STA 0.4 0.3 0 Description
Ultimate width of short-term crack Ultimate width of long-term crack Parameter of limit state for slab/wall design:
l
STA=0, if calculation of nonsymmetrical reinforcement must be carried out according to the requirements of load carrying capacity (the first limit state); STA=1, if calculation of symmetrical reinforcement must be carried out according to the requirements of load carrying capacity (the first limit state); STA=2, if calculation of nonsymmetrical reinforcement must be carried according to the cracking requirements (the second limit state); STA=3, if calculation of symmetrical reinforcement must be carried according to the cracking requirements (the second limit state)
15
SELX
0.
700 STAAD.Pro
Description
Design length of wall member to evaluate slenderness effect in local Y axis Design parameter of slab/wall reinforcement:
l
17
MMA
MMA=0, if reinforcement calculation must be applied by stresses in local axis; MMA=1, if reinforcement calculation must be applied by principal stresses
18
MMB
MMB=0, if the effect of additional eccentricity is not taken into account; MMB=1, if the effect of additional eccentricity is taken into account
19
RSH
1.
European grade:
l
11 = S240;
Russian Codes - Concrete Design Per Russian Code (SNiP 2.03.01-84*) No. Parameter Default Name Value
l
Description
12 = S400; 13 = S500;
12A.3 Beams
Reinforcement for beams of rectangular and T cross-section can be calculated. In calculation of longitudinal reinforcement bending moment about local axis and torsional moments are considered, but influence of longitudinal forces and bending moments in relation to local axis is ignored. In calculation of transverse reinforcement shear forces parallel to local axis and torsional moments are taken into account. Reinforcement for beams can be calculated either from conditions of strength or from conditions of open crack width limitation (see parameter SSE). Parameters SFA and FA are considered only in calculation of transverse reinforcement. In general case calculation of reinforcement for beams is carried out two times according to strength conditions and according to conditions of open crack width limitation. In reinforcement calculations from conditions of strength design values of load have to be taken and in calculations from conditions of crack width limitation characteristic (normative) load values are used. Both calculations can be carried out in one session with the use multiple analysis possibility of the program STAAD.Pro. In most cases calculation of reinforcement is carried out with account only of a part of loadings. In such cases command LOAD LIST is used, in which numbers of loads considered in calculation are indicated. Number of permanent and longterm loads equal to parameter NLT must be included into the list of considered loads. It has to be noted, that values of parameters DD1 and DD2 have influence not only on the width of opened crack but also in some cases, on design and normative reinforcement resistances. Parameter BCL can be equal to any value of concrete compression strength class given in SNiP 2.03.01-84* and to any intermediate value as well.
702 STAAD.Pro
It should be remembered, that accuracy of results of calculation of transverse reinforcement increases with the value of parameter NSE. Parameters SFA and FA are considered only in calculations of transverse reinforcement. Beam 1 is shown in Figure 2 with rigid intervals the lengths of which are: at the start of the beam 0.3m and at the end 0.2m. In modeling of the beam the following command can be used.
MEMBER OFFSET 1 START 0.3 0 0 1 END -0.2 0 0
Figure 12A.2 - Diagram of a beam with rigid intervals When command MEMBER OFFSET is used forces corresponding to the beam the length of which is equal to the distance between points a and b are calculated and then used in calculation of reinforcement. In such case it is necessary to take into account default values of parameters SFA and FA equal to zero. When command MEMBER OFFSET is not used forces corresponding to the beam the length of which is equal to the distance between points 10 and 11 are calculated and then used in calculation of reinforcement. In this case it is necessary to consider values of parameters SFA=0.3 and FA=0,2 in reinforcement calculation. In both cases calculated quantity of transverse reinforcement will be the same. Calculated quantity of longitudinal reinforcement in the second case will be greater. For beam the following output is generated:
l
beam number;
distance from resultant of forces acting in bottom/top reinforcement to bottom/top edge of the section;
l
distance from the side edge of cross-section of the beam web to the centroid of longitudinal bars located at this edge;
l l
In nine columns of the first table the following results are presented: Table 12A.4 - Beam design output 1 Result Section Description distance of the section from the start of the beam, cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement in the bottom zone of cross-section of the beam, if angle BETA=0, or in the top zone, if
As-
704 STAAD.Pro
* Opened crack width is presented only in the case when calculation is performed according to conditions limiting opened crack width. In ten columns of second table the following results are presented: Table 12A.5 - Beam design output 2 Result Section Qsw Asw Q T Load N. Description distance of the section from the start of the beam, mm intensity of transverse reinforcement, kN/m cross-sectional area of transverse bars, sq.cm, if their step is 10, 15, 20, 25 or 30 cm value of shear force parallel to the local axis, kN value of torsional moment, kNm number of loading version, determining intensity of transverse reinforcement An example of output of calculation results is presented below. BEAM NO. 23 DESIGN RESULTS (by limitation of crack width) Length - 6000 mm. Section: BF1= 550 mm, B= 200 mm, HF1=220 mm, H=450 mm. Distance from top/bottom surface of beam to center of longitudinal reinforcement - 40 mm. Distance from side surface of beam to center of longitudinal reinforcement - 30 mm. Concrete class - 25.0 (Rb=13.05 MPa; Rbt=0.94 MPa; Gb2=0.9). Class of longitudinal reinforcement - -III (Rs=365.0 MPa; Rsc=365.0 MPa). Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars D=16 mm. Class of shear reinforcement - -I (Rsw=175.0 MPa). Diameter of shear reinforcement bars Dw=10 mm. L O N G I T U D I N A L R E I N F O R C E M E N T
SectionAs-As+ Moments(-/+)Load.N.(-/+) Acrc1 Acrc2 mm sq.cm kNm mm mm --------------------------------------------------------------------0. 500. 1000. 1500. 2000. 2500. 3000. 3500. 4000. 4500. 5000. 5500. 6000. 10.92 4.74 1.13 1.13 1.13 0.41 0.41 1.13 6.41 9.24 -152. / 2. -60. / 0. -5. / 17. -8. / 75. -11. / 115. -14. / 139. -18. / 144. -21. / 132. -24. / 103. -27. / 56. -39. / 9. 124. 16.89 0.41 226. S H E A R R E I N F O R C E M E N T SectionQswAsw, cm^2, if Sw= Q T Load / 0. 5 / 0 0.155 0.078 / 0. 6 / 4 0.237 0.121 5 / 0 0.294 0.157 4 / 6 0.000 0.000 4 / 6 0.295 0.147 4 / 6 0.298 0.149 4 / 6 0.271 0.134 4 / 6 0.263 0.127 4 / 6 0.277 0.130 4 / 6 0.296 0.129 4 / 6 0.299 0.093 5 / 3 0.293 0.157 5 / 0 0.271 0.142
1.13 11.53 1.19 12.16 1.41 10.86 1.63 1.95 3.23 0.74 8.28 4.54 0.58 0.41
mmkN/m10cm15cm20cm25cm30cmkN kNm N. 2.15 2.87 0. 251.3 1.44 2.15 2.87 500. 251.3 1.44 1.50 1.99 1000. 174.5 1.00 0.55 0.73 1500. 63.9 0.36 Minimum detailing 3.59 4.31 203.9 0.0 6 3.59 4.31 168.9 0.0 6 2.49 2.99 133.9 0.0 6 0.91 1.09 98.9 0.0 6 -
706 STAAD.Pro
2000. requirements ! Minimum detailing 2500. requirements ! Minimum detailing 3000. requirements ! Minimum detailing 3500. requirements ! Minimum detailing 4000. requirements ! 95.0 4500. 0.55 2.08 2.77 5000. 242.5 1.39 2.59 3.46 5500. 302.5 1.73 2.59 3.46 6000. 302.5 1.73 4.32 5.19 216.1 0.0 5 4.32 5.19 187.7 0.0 5 3.46 4.16 152.7 0.0 5 0.82 1.09 1.37 1.64 117.7 0.0 5
63.9 0.0 6 28.9 0.0 6 12.7 0.0 5 47.7 0.0 5 82.7 0.0 5
Here Minimum detailing requirements! means that reinforcement is not required according to calculation.
12A.4 Columns
Reinforcement for columns of rectangular or circular cross-section can be calculated. Flexibility of columns can be evaluated in two ways. In the case of usual analysis (command PERFORM ANALYSIS) flexibility is assessed by parameters ELY and ELZ, values of which should conform with recommendation of the Code SNiP 2.03.01-84*. If P-DELTA (analysis according to deformed diagram) or NONLINEAR (nonlinear geometry) analysis is performed, values of parameters ELY and ELZ should be close to zero, for example ELY = ELZ=0.01. Longitudinal reinforcement for columns is calculated only from condition of strength. Longitudinal forces and bending moments in relation to local axes and are taken into account in longitudinal reinforcement calculations. For rectangular columns the following output is generated:
distance of centroid of each longitudinal bar from the nearest edge of the cross-section;
l l
concrete class; longitudinal reinforcement class; range of longitudinal reinforcement bar diameters assumed in calculation; diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars obtained in calculation; total quantity of longitudinal bars; quantity of longitudinal bars at each cross-section edge, directed parallel to ;
In nine columns of the table under the heading LONGITUDINAL REINFORCEMENT the following output is presented: Table 12A.6 - Column design output 1 Result Section Astot Asy Asz Percent Nx, Mz, My distance of the section from the start of the column, mm total cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement, sq.cm cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement bars at each edge of section, directed parallel to the local axis directed parallel to the local axis , sq.cm , sq.cm cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement bars at each edge of section, reinforcement percentage in the section respective values of longitudinal force and bending moments in relation to the local axes and reinforcement Load.N. reinforcement An example of output of calculation results is presented below. 708 STAAD.Pro , determining cross-sectional area of longitudinal
COLUMN NO. 97 DESIGN RESULTS (rectangular section) Length - 4000 mm. Section: B= 350 mm, H=350 mm. Distance from edge of column cross section to center of each longitudinal reinforcement bar - 40 mm. Concrete class - 25.0 (Rb=13.05 Pa; Gb2=0.9). Class of longitudinal reinforcement - -III (Rs=365.0 Pa; Rsc=365.0 Pa). Diameter range of longitudinal reinforcement bars: Dmin=16 mm . . . Dmax=32 mm Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars from calculation d=20 mm. Total number of reinforcement bars Ntot=6. Number of longitudinal bars at each section edge parallel to the local Y axis Nyy =2. Number of longitudinal bars at each section edge parallel to the local Z axis Nzz =3. L O N G I T U D I N A L R E I N F O R C E M E N T Section Astot Asy Asz Percent Nx m 0. 4000. sq.cm 16.42 15.35 sq.cm 3.01 3.01 sq.cm 6.20 5.67 % 1.34 1.25 kN 285.5 397.3
Load N 6 5
Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars, total quantity of longitudinal bars as well as quantity of longitudinal bars at each edge of the section obtained from calculation should be considered as recommendation. In this case arrangement of reinforcement in the section depends on the orientation of the local axes and is as follows:
Calculated values of reinforcement cross-sectional areas are presented in the table and they may differ from recommended on the lower side. When it is not possible according to detailing provisions to arrange in the column longitudinal reinforcement determined from calculation additional message is derived. For columns of circular section the following output is generated:
l
column number; column length and diameter of cross-section; distance of centroid of each longitudinal bar to the edge of cross-section; longitudinal reinforcement class;
diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars obtained from calculation; quantity of longitudinal bars.
In seven columns of the table under the heading LONGITUDINAL REINFORCEMENT the following results are presented: Section distance of the section from the start of the column, mm Astot Per cent Nx, respective values of longitudinal force and bending moments in , determining cross-sectional area Mz, My relation to local axis and of longitudinal reinforcement N. longitudinal reinforcement total cross-sectional area of longitudinal reinforcement, sq.cm percentage of longitudinal reinforcement
710 STAAD.Pro
An example of output of calculation results for a column of circular section is presented below. COLUMN NO. 80 DESIGN RESULTS (circular section) Length - 4000 mm. Diameter: D= 350 mm. Distance from edge of column cross section to center of each longitudinal reinforcement bar - 50 mm. Concrete class - 20.0 (Rb=10.35 Pa; Gb2=0.9). Class of longitudinal reinforcement - -III (Rs=365.0 Pa; Rsc=365.0 Pa). Diameter range of longitudinal reinforcement bars: Dmin=16 mm . . . Dmax=32 mm Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars from calculation D=20 mm. Total number of reinforcement bars Ntot =7. L O N G I T U D I N A L R E I N F O R C E M E N T Section Astot Percent Nx Mz My m 0. 4000. sq.cm 17.96 21.86 % 1.87 2.27 kN 195.1 195.1 kNm 59.8 80.2 kNm 0.0 0.0
Load N 5 5
Diameter of longitudinal reinforcement bars, total quantity of longitudinal bars as well as quantity of longitudinal bars at each edge of the section should be considered as recommendation. Arrangement of reinforcement in section in this case is shown below:
Calculated cross-sectional areas of reinforcement presented in the table may differ from recommended on the lower side.
When according to detailing provisions it is not possible to arrange in the column longitudinal reinforcement obtained from calculation additional message is derived.
An example of output of calculation results is presented bellow. SLAB/WALL DESIGN RESULTS (by stresses in local axes for limitation of crack width) Element Asx Mx Nx Load.N. Asy sq.cm/m kNm/m kN/m (X) sq.cm/m
My kNm/m
Ny kN/m
Load N. (Y)
712 STAAD.Pro
1 3 1 3 1 3
1 3 1 3 1 3
Table 12A.7 - Slab design output Result Element Description number of finite element, TOP - top zone of member, BOT bottom zone of member (top zone of member is determined by positive direction of local axis -see Fig.2) intensity of reinforcing in the first direction (parallel to the local axis Mx Nx Load N.(X) Asy My Ny Load N.(Y) ), sq.cm/m , distributed bending moment in respect to the local axis kNm/m
Asx
distributed longitudinal force directed parallel to the axis , kNm/m number of loading version, determining intensity of reinforcing in the first direction intensity of reinforcing in the second direction (parallel to the local axis ), sq.cm/m distributed bending moment in respect to the local axis kNm/m distributed longitudinal force directed parallel to the local axis kN/m number of loading version, determining intensity of reinforcing in the second direction
714 STAAD.Pro
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)
12B.1 General
Design Code SNiP Steel Structures as majority of modern codes is based on the method of limit states. The following groups of limit states are defined in the Code. The first group is concerned with losses of general shape and stability, failure, qualitative changes in configuration of structure. Appearance of nonallowable residual deformations, displacements, yielding of materials or opening of cracks.
l
The second group is concerned with states of structures making worse normal their service or reducing durability due to not allowable deflections, deviations, settlements, vibrations, etc.
l
Analysis of structures for the first limit state is performed using the maximum (design) loads and actions, which can cause failure of structures. Analysis of structures for the second limit state is performed using service (normative) loads and actions. Relation between design and normative loads is referred to as coefficient of load reliability, which is defined in SNiP 2.01.07.- 85 Loads and Actions. Coefficient of reliability for destination GAMA n according to SNiP 2.01.07.- 85 shall be taken in to account determining loads or their combinations. In this version of the program only members from rolled, tube and roll-formed assortment sections and also from compound such as double angles of T-type sections, double channels are presented. Design of other members of compound section will be presented in other versions of the program. Economy of selected section is indicated by ratio (RATIO) /R y presented in y c calculation results. A section is economical when said ratio equals to 0,9 0,95.
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Table 12B.1 - Typical Sections for Russian Steel Design Section Section Type Designation form
I-beam (GOST 8239-89) Regular I-beam (GOST 26020-83) Broad-flanged I-beam (GOST 26020-83) Column I-beam (GOST 26020-83) Channel (GOST 8240-89)
ST L100x100x7 RA L100x100x7
ST L125x80x10 RA L125x80x10
ST TUB160x120x3 or
716 STAAD.Pro
Section
Section Type
Designation form
Table 12B.2 - Compound Sections for Russian Steel Design Section Section Type Designation form D C14 SP 0.01 (SP clear distance between channel walls) Double equal legs angles LD L100x100x7 SP 0.01 (SP clear distance between angle walls) Double unequal legs angles with long legs back to back LD L125x80x10 SP 0.01 (SP clear distance between angle walls) Double unequal legs angles with short legs back to back SD L125x80x10 SP 0.01 (SP clear
Double channels
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Section Section Type Designation form distance between angle walls) Tee with flange at the top Note: Flange of Tee beam is at the top part of cross-section if beta angle = 0, or at the bottom part if beta angle = 180. T I12 T B1-10 T SH1-23 T K1-20
Example
UNITS METER MEMBER PROPERTY RUSSIAN * I-BEAM 1 TO 6 TABLE ST B1-10 * CHANNEL 7 TO 11 TABLE ST C14 * UNEQUAL LEGS ANGLE 12 TO 30 TABLE RA L125X80X10 * ROUND ASSORTMENT PIPE 31 TO 46 TABLE ST PIP102X5.5 * ROUND PIPE OF CROSS-SECTIONAL DIMENSIONS DEFINED BY CLIENT 47 TO 60 TABLE ST PIPE OD 0.102 ID 0.055 * SQUARE TUBE FROM ASSORTMENT 61 TO 68 TABLE ST TUB120X120X3
718 STAAD.Pro
* RECTANGULAR TUBE OF CROSS-SECTIONAL DIMENSION DEFINED BY CLIENT 69 TO 95 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0.003 WT 0.12 DT 0.16 * DOUBLE CHANNEL (DISTANCE BETWEEN WALLS 10 ) 96 TO 103 TABLE D C14 SP 0.01 * DOUBLE UNEQUAL LEGS ANGLES WITH SHORT LEGS BACK-TOBACK (DISTANCE BETWEEN WALLS 10 ) 104 TO 105 TABLE SD L125X80X10 SP 0.01 * MEMBER OF TEE SECTION 106 TO 126 TABLE T SH1-23 * FLANGE OF T-BEAMS AT THE BOTTOM OF CROSS-SECTION BETA 180. MEMB 116 TO 126 * ORIENTATION OF THE LOCAL ANGLE AXES IN RELATION TO THE GLOBAL AXES OF THE STRUCTURE BETA RANGLE MEMB 12 TO 30 COMMANDS OF OUTPUT DATA FOR CHECK AND SELECTION OF SECTIONS ARE LOCATED AFTER COMMANDS OF ANALYSIS AND, AS A RULE, AFTER OUTPUT COMMAND TO PRINT RESULTS OF CALCULATION.
Example
* COMMAND OF ANALYSIS PERFORM ANALYSIS * COMMAND OF LOADINGS AND THEIR COMBINATIONS CONSIDERED IN DESIGN LOAD LIST 1 5 TO 9
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)
* COMMAND TO START DESIGN ACCORDING TO RUSSIAN CODE PARAMETER CODE RUSSIAN * LIST OF PARAMETERS USED IN CHECKING AND SELECTING BEAM 1. ALL
Obligatory parameter
LY 4. MEMB 1 TO 4 LZ 4. MEM 1 TO 4 MAIN 1. ALL SGR 3. ALL SBLT 0 ALL * PARAMETER OF OUTPUT AMOUNT OF INFORMATION ON CALCULATION RESULTS TRACK 2. ALL . * COMMAND TO START SECTION CHECK PROCEDURE CHECK CODE ALL * COMMAND TO START SECTION SELECTION PROCEDURE SELECT ALL . * COMMAND OF OUTPUT TO PRINT CONTENT OF ASSORTMENT TABLES PRINT ENTIRE TABLE * COMMAND OF OUTPUT TO PRINT SUMMARY OF STEEL ACCORDING TO SECTIONS STEEL TAKE OFF * COMMAND OF OUTPUT TO PRINT SUMMARY OF STEEL ACCORDING TO MEMBERS AND SECTIONS STEEL MEMBER TAKE OFF
720 STAAD.Pro
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)
General stability of member subjected to bending in one plane are calculated in accordance with clause 5.15 of SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*, and subjected to bending in two planes in accordance with Guide to design of steel structures (to SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*). Coefficient value is determined according to appendix 7 of b SNiP 2.01.07.- 81*. Additional data about load (concentrated or distributed), numbers of bracing restrains of compression flanges, location of applied load are required. For closed sections it is assumed that coefficient = 1.0.
b
Simply supported (non-continuous) beams can be calculated in elastic as well as in elastic-plastic state according to requirements of clause 5.18 of SNiP 2.01.07.81*. Calculation can be selected by specification of structure in input data. Stiffness of flexural members is verified comparing input value of deflection limit (through parameter DFF) with maximum displacement of a section of flexural member allowing for load reliability coefficient, which is specified, in input data. Limit values of deflection are determined in accordance with SNiP 2.01.07.- 85 Loads and Actions. Addition chapter 10. Deflections and displacements. Verification of deflection is performed only in the case of review (CHECK) problem.
722 STAAD.Pro
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Table 12B.3 - Parameters for Steel design according to Russian Code (SNiP II 23 81*, edition 1990) Parameter Default Name Value Description Member design parameter:
l
BEAM = 0, Design members for forces at their ends or at the sections defined by SECTION command; BEAM = 1, Calculate the major axis moment Mz at 13 points along the beam and design beam at the location of maximum Mz; BEAM = 2, Same as BEAM=1, but additional checks are carried out at beam ends and at critical inter mediate section; BEAM = 3, Calculate forces at 13 points and perform design checks at all locations including the ends
BEAM
1
l
724 STAAD.Pro
MM = 0, if slenderness is suppressed; MM = 2, if ultimate slenderness value is "150"; MM = 2, if ultimate slenderness value is "200"; MM = 3, if ultimate slenderness value is "250"; MM = 4, if ultimate slenderness value is "300"; MM = 5, if ultimate slenderness value is "350"; MM = 6, if ultimate slenderness value is "400
MM
0
l
Set slenderness limit value not equal to "0" for design with evaluation of buckling effect
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Parameter Default Name Value
MN = 0, if slenderness is suppressed; MN = 1, if slenderness limit value is "120"; MN = 2, if slenderness limit value is "210-60a"; MN = 3, if slenderness limit value is "220-40a"; MN = 4, if slenderness limit value is "220"; MN = 5, if slenderness limit value is "180-60a"; MN = 6, if slenderness limit value is "210-60a"; MN = 7, if slenderness limit value is "210-60a"; MN = 8, if slenderness limit value is "200"; MN = 9, if slenderness limit value is "150";
CMN
Set slenderness limit value not equal to "0" for design with evaluation of buckling effect
726 STAAD.Pro
DFF
0.
Default value 0 is valid if design is applied without deflection limitation. Set for deflection check only
DMAX 1. [m] DMIN 0. [m] GAMC1 GAMC2 KY KZ 1.0 1.0 1.0 1.0 Specific service condition coefficient for buckling design Specific service condition coefficient for strength design Coefficient of effective length in respect to local axis Y (in plane XZ) Coefficient of effective length in respect to local axis Z (in plane XY) Type and position of loading on beam:
l
LEG = 1, for loading concentrated in the middle span; LEG = 2, for loading concentrated in the quarter of the span; LEG = 3, for loading concentrated at the end of bracket; LEG = 4, for loading uniformly distributed on beam; LEG = 5, for loading uniformly distributed on bracket
LEG
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Parameter Default Name Value LY [m] LZ [m]
Description
Effective length in respect to local axis Y Member (in plane XZ) length Default is selected member's length Effective length in respect to local axis Z Member (in plane XY) length Default is selected member's length Standard of steel grade (GOST):
l
MAIN = 1, if Standard of steel grade is GOST27772-88; MAIN = 2, if Standard of steel grade is GOST10705-80; MAIN = 3, if Standard of steel grade is GOST10706-76; MAIN = 4, if Standard of steel grade is GOST8731-87; MAIN = 5, if Standard of steel grade is TY14-3-567-76
MAIN
NSF
1.0
Net section factor for tension members or web section area weakening factor for bending members Design steel strength (yield strength):
PY 0 [MPa]
If parameters MAIN according to Standard of steel grade (GOST) and by SGR according to Steel grade (STAL) are not defined Ratio between design and characteristic loads values
RATIO
1.0
728 STAAD.Pro
SBLT = 0, if beam not fixed; SBLT = 1, one restraint in the middle of the span; SBLT = 2, 3, etc. number of uniformly spaced lateral supports along the span
SBLT
SGR
TB
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999) Parameter Default Name Value
TRACK = 0, for suppressed output information; TRACK = 1, for extended output information; TRACK = 2, for advanced output information
TRACK
Design steel strength (ultimate strength): UNL 0 [MPa] If parameters MAIN according to Standard of steel grade (GOST) and by SGR according to Steel grade (STAL) are not defined
Table 12B.4 - Steel types for design of steel structures according to SNiP 2.01.07.-81* (table 51 and 51a) SGR Value 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 Steel Parameter MAIN 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 GOST GOST 27772-88 For members* GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F GT, F F
730 STAAD.Pro
SGR Value 10 11 12 13 14
Parameter MAIN 1 1 1 1 2
GOST
2 15 BSt3ps 3
Tube GOST 10706-76* GOST 10705-80* Tube 3 GOST 10706-76* GOST 873187 Tube
2 16 BSt3sp
17 18
20
16G2F 5
TY 14-3-567Tube 76
*GT members from sheet and roll-formed tubes F rolled section steel
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)
Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command. Output of selection and check results are given in suppressed, extended and advanced forms. Form of output results depends on value of parameter TRACK. Results are presented in tables. Three versions of output results are possible: suppressed results according the critical strength condition (TRACK=0), extended - results according to all check conditions (TRACK=1) and advanced complete information on results of member design (TRACK=2). In tables of results common data for all TRACKs are indicated: (TRACK=2). In tables of results common data for all TRACKs are indicated: number of member; type and number of cross-section; result obtained (ACCEPTED requirements are met, FAILURE are not met); abbreviated name of normative document (code, standard) (SNiP); number of check clause; safety of strength (ratio between design and normative values); number of the most unfavorable loading; value of longitudinal force acting in the member with subscript indicating its direction (C compression, P tension); bending moments in relation to local member axes Z and Y; distance to section, in which the most unfavorable combination of forces acts.
732 STAAD.Pro
======================================================================== 1 I60 PASS SNiP- 5.18 0.68 1 0.000E+00 -4.650E+02 0.000E+00 3.000E+00
Material characteristics: Steel; Design resistance; Elasticity modulus; Section characteristics: Length of member; Section area; Net area; Inertia moment (second moment of area) (I); Section modulus (W); First moment of area (S); Radius of gyration; Effective length; Slenderness; Results are presented in two columns, Z and Y respectively. Design forces:
Russian Codes - Steel Design Per Russian Code SNiP 2.23-81* (Edition 1999)
Signs + and - indicate direction of acting longitudinal force, bending moments and shear forces in accordance with sign rules assumed in program STAAD. Check results in advanced form are presented with values of intermediate parameters by formulas in analytical and numerical expression with indication of SNiP clause.
======================================================================== MEMBER CROSS RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ SECTION NO. FX MZ MY LOCATION ======================================================================== 1 I60 PASS SNiP- 5.18 0.68 1 0.000E+00 -4.650E+02 0.000E+00 3.000E+00 1 I60 PASS SNiP- DISPL 0.36 1 0.000E+00 -4.650E+02 0.000E+00 3.000E+00 MATERIAL DATA Steel =C245 Modulus of elasticity = 206.E+06 KPA Design Strength (Ry) = 240.E+03 KPA SECTION PROPERTIES (units - m) Member Length = 6.00E+00 Gross Area = 1.38E-02 Net Area = 1.38E-02 z-axis y-axis Moment of inertia (I) : 768.E-06 173.E-07 Section modulus (W) : 256.E-05 182.E-06 First moment of area (S) : 149.E-05 156.E-06 Radius of gyration (i) : 236.E-03 354.E-04 Effective Length : 600.E-02 600.E-02 Slenderness : 0.00E+00 0.00E+00 DESIGN DATA (units -kN,m)SNiP II-23-81*/1998 Axial force : 0.00E+00 z-axis y-axis Moments : -465.E+00 0.00E+00 Shear force : 0.00E+00 500.E-02 CRITICAL CONDITIONS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK F.(39) M/(C1*Wmin)=-465.0E+00/ 1.12E+00* 2.56E-03= 162.1E+03 F.(41) Q/(H*T)= 500.0E-02/ 6.00E-01* 1.20E-02= 694.E+00 RY*GAMAC= 240.0E+03 ACTUAL SECTION DISPLACEMENT = 1.094E-02 M MAXIMUM MEMBER DEFLECTION = 1.094E-02 M Loading No. 1 ULTIMATE ALLOWABLE DEFLECTION VALUE = 3.000E-02 M
Conventional notations assumed in presentation of results: +, -, /, *,**, SQRT, their respective meanings (i.e., addition, subtraction, division,
734 STAAD.Pro
multiplication, raising to the second power (squared), and square root). Conventional notations of stresses, coefficients and characteristics of steel resistance comply with accepted in the SNiP standard. Only Greek letters are changed by their names (e.g., , -GAMAC; -ALPHA; -BETA, -ETA, -PHI, etc.).
c
736 STAAD.Pro
Section 13
738 STAAD.Pro
Must be specified as SABS0100. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BRACE
0.0
South African Codes - Concrete Design Per SABS-0100-1 Parameter Name Default Value Description
1. Column braced about local Y direction only 2. Column unbraced about local Z direction only 3. Column unbraced in both Y and Z directions CLB CLS CLT DEPTH 20mm 20mm 20mm YD Clear Cover for outermost bottom reinforcement Clear Cover for outermost side reinforcement Clear Cover for outermost top reinforcement Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength, in current units.
450 N/mm2 Yield Stress for main reinforcement, in current units. 450N/mm2 Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a, in current units. Applicable to shear bars in beams Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above.
MAXMAIN
50mm
740 STAAD.Pro
Description
Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 28 32 36 40 50 60 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Output detail 0. Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1. For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2. Output of TRACK 1.0 List of design sag/hog moments and corresponding required steel area at each section of member
MINSEC
8mm
TRACK
0.0
WIDTH
ZD
Width of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.
*RECTANGULAR COLUMN 300MM WIDE X 450MM DEEP 1 3 TO 7 9 PRISM YD 450. ZD 300. *CIRCULAR COLUMN 300MM DIAMETER 11 13 PR YD 300. * T-SECTION - FLANGE 1000.X 200.(YD-YB) * - STEM 250(THICK) X 350.(DEEP) 14 PRISM YD 550. ZD 1000. YB 350. ZB 250.
In the above input, the first set of members are rectangular (450mm depth x 300mm width) and the second set of members, with only depth and no width provided, will be assumed to be circular with 300mm diameter. Note that area (AX) is not provided for these members. If shear area areas (AY & AZ ) are to be considered in analysis, the user may provide them along with YD and ZD. Also note that if moments of inertias are not provided, the program will calculate them from YD and ZD. Finally a T section can be considered by using the third definition above.
742 STAAD.Pro
-------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION |FLEXURE (Maxm. Sagging/Hogging moments)| SHEAR (in mm) | MZ Load Case MX Load Case | VY P Load Case -------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 135.75 5 -3.44 5 | 152.06 50.62 4 | -295.92 4 | 625.0 | 189.16 5 -3.43 5 | 133.95 48.87 4 | -236.52 4 | 1250.0 | 231.25 5 -3.41 5 | 115.84 47.12 4 | -188.44 4 | 1875.0 | 262.01 5 -3.40 5 | 97.73 45.37 4 | -151.68 4 | 2500.0 | 281.46 5 -3.39 5 | 79.61 43.63 4 | -126.24 4 | 3125.0 | 289.59 5 -3.37 5 | 61.50 41.88 4 | -112.12 4 | 3750.0 | 286.39 5 -3.36 4 | -62.13 40.13 5 | -109.32 4 | 4375.0 | 271.88 5 -3.37 4 | -80.25 41.88 5 | -117.84 4 | 5000.0 | 246.05 5 -3.39 4 | -98.36 43.63 5 | -137.68 4 | 5625.0 | 208.89 5 -3.40 4 | -116.47 45.37 5 | -168.84 4 | 6250.0 | 160.42 5 -3.41 4 | -134.58 47.12 5 | -211.33 4 |
6875.0 | 100.62 5 -3.43 4 | -152.70 48.87 5 | -265.13 4 | 7500.0 | 29.50 4 -3.44 4 | -170.81 29.63 4 | -330.25 5 | SUMMARY OF REINF. AREA FOR FLEXURE DESIGN (Sq.mm) -------------------------------------------------------------------SECTION | TOP | BOTTOM | STIRRUPS (in mm) | Reqd./Provided reinf. | Reqd./Provided reinf. | (2 legged) -------------------------------------------------------------------0.0 | 1232.70/1256.64( 4-20 )| 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 8 @ 425 mm 625.0 | 960.90/ 981.74( 2-25 )| 754.32/ 791.70( 7-12 )| 8 @ 510 mm 1250.0 | 751.24/ 791.70( 7-12 )| 937.49/ 942.48( 3-20 )| 8 @ 510 mm 1875.0 | 596.52/ 603.18( 3-16 )| 1075.72/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 510 mm 2500.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1165.13/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 510 mm 3125.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1203.00/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 220 mm 3750.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1188.08/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 220 mm 4375.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1120.87/1206.36( 6-16 )| 8 @ 220 mm 5000.0 | 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 1003.50/1005.30( 5-16 )| 8 @ 220 mm 5625.0 | 668.18/ 678.60( 6-12 )| 839.38/ 904.80( 8-12 )| 8 @ 220 mm
744 STAAD.Pro
6250.0 | 849.99/ 904.80( 8-12 )| 632.84/ 678.60( 6-12 )| 8 @ 220 mm 6875.0 | 1089.94/1206.36( 6-16 )| 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 8 @ 220 mm 7500.0 | 1397.16/1407.42( 7-16 )| 543.40/ 565.50( 5-12 )| 8 @ 220 mm -------------------------------------------------------------------TORSION REINFORCEMENT: Not required
LENGTH: 3660.0 mm CROSS SECTION: 750.0 mm X 460.0 mm COVER:40.0mm ** GUIDING LOAD CASE: 4 END JOINT: 1 SHORT COLUMN DESIGN FORCES (KNS-MET) ----------------------DESIGN AXIAL FORCE (Pu) : 915.6 About Z About Y
INITIAL MOMENTS : 0.00 0.00 MOMENTS DUE TO MINIMUM ECC. : 18.31 18.31 SLENDERNESS RATIOS : 7.96 4.88 ADDITION MOMENTS (Maddz and Maddy) : 0.00 0.00 TOTAL DESIGN MOMENTS : 555.13 21.91 REQD. STEEL AREA : 3349.20 Sq.mm. REQD. CONCRETE AREA: 114451.62 Sq.mm. MAIN REINFORCEMENT : Provide 32 - 12 dia. (1.05%, 3619.20 Sq.mm.) (Equally Distributed) TIE REINFORCEMENT : Provide 8 mm dia. rectangular ties @ 140 mm c/c SECTION CAPACITY BASED ON REINFORCEMENT REQUIRED (KNS-MET) ---------------------------------------------------------Puz : 2160.42 Muz1 : 570.23 Muy1 : 563.74
746 STAAD.Pro
analysis may be specified. Dynamic analysis may also be performed and the results combined with static analysis results. Refer to Section 5.37 of the Technical Reference Manual for additional information.
I Shapes
The following example illustrates the specification of I- shapes.
1 TO 15 TABLE ST IPE-AA100
H shapes
Designation of H shapes in STAAD is as follows. For example,
18 TO 20 TABLE ST 152X37UC
748 STAAD.Pro
PG shapes
Designation of PG shapes in STAAD is as follows.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST 720X200PG
Double Channels
Back to back double channels, with or without spacing between them, are specified by preceding the section designation by the letter D. For example, a back to back double channel section PFC140X60 without spacing in between should be specified as:
100 TO 150 TABLE D PFC140X60
A back-to-back double channel section 140X60X16C with spacing 0.01unitlength in between should be specified as:
100 TO 150 TABLE D 140X60X16C SP 0.01
Note: The specification SP after the section designation is used for providing the spacing. The spacing should always be provided in the current length unit.
Angles
To specify angles, the letter L succeeds the angle name. Thus, a 70X70 angle with a 25mm thickness is designated as 70X70X8L. The following examples illustrate angle specifications.
100 TO 150 TABLE ST 70X70X8L
Note that the above specification is for standard angles. In this specification, the local z-axis (see Fig. 2.6 in the Technical Reference Manual) corresponds to the YY axis shown in the CSA table. Another common practice of specifying angles assumes the local y-axis to correspond to the Y-Y axis. To specify angles in accordance with this convention, the reverse angle designation facility has been provided. A reverse angle may be specified by substituting the word ST with the word RA. Refer to the following example for details.
100 TO 150 TABLE RA 45X45X3L
The local axis systems for STANDARD and REVERSE angles are shown in Fig. 2.6 of the STAAD Technical Reference manual.
Double Angles
To specify double angles, the specification ST should be substituted with LD (for long leg back-to-back) or SD (short leg back-to-back). For equal angles, either SD or LD will serve the purpose. Spacing between angles may be provided by using the word SP followed by the value of spacing (in current length unit) after section designation.
100 TO 150 TABLE LD 50X50X3L 3 TABLE LD 40X40X5L SP 0.01
The second example above describes a double angle section consisting of 40X40X5 angles with a spacing of 0.01 length units.
Tees
Tee sections obtained by cutting W sections may be specified by using the T specification instead of ST before the name of the W shape. For example:
100 TO 150 TABLE T IPE-AA180
750 STAAD.Pro
In addition, any tube section may be specified by using the DT(for depth), WT(for width), and TH(for thickness) specifications. For example:
100 TO 150 TABLE ST TUBE TH 3 WT 100 DT 50
will describe a tube with a depth of 50mm, width of 100mm. and a wall thickness of 3mm. Note that the values of depth, width and thickness must be provided in current length unit.
In addition to sections listed in the SAB tables, circular hollow sections may be specified by using the OD (outside diameter) and ID (inside diameter) specifications. For example:
100 TO 150 TABLE ST PIPE OD 50 ID 48
will describe a pipe with an outside diameter of 50 length units and inside diameter of 48 length units. Note that the values of outside and inside diameters must be provided in terms of current length unit. Sample input file to demonstrate usage of South African shapes is shown below.
STAAD PLANE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 30-MAR-05 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 9 0 0; 3 0 6 0; 4 3 6 0; 5 6 6 0; 6 9 6 0; 7 0 10.5 0; 8 9 10.5 0; 9 2.25 10.5 0; 10 6.75 10.5 0; 11 4.5 10.5 0; 12 1.5 11.4 0; 13 7.5 11.4 0; 14 3 12.3 0; 15 6 12.3 0; 16 4.5 13.2 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 3; 2 3 7; 3 2 6; 4 6 8; 5 3 4; 6 4 5; 7 5 6; 8 7 12; 9 12 14; 10 14 16; 11 15 16; 12 13 15; 13 8 13; 14 9 12; 15 9 14; 16 11 14; 17 11 15; 18 10 15; 19 10 13; 20 7 9; 21 9 11; 22 10 11; 23 8 10; MEMBER PROPERTY SAFRICAN 1 TABLE ST IPE-AA100 2 TABLE T IPE120 3 TABLE ST 152X23UC 4 TABLE T 152X23UC 5 TABLE ST 812X200PG 6 TABLE T 812X200PG 7 TABLE ST 178X54X15C 8 TABLE D 178X54X15C 9 TABLE D 178X54X15C SP 0.1 10 TABLE ST 25X25X5L 11 TABLE RA 25X25X5L
752 STAAD.Pro
12 TABLE LD 25X25X5L 13 TABLE SD 25X25X5L 14 TABLE LD 25X25X5L SP 0.1 15 TABLE SD 25X25X5L SP 0.1 16 TABLE ST TUB40X2.5SHS 17 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0 WT 0 DT 50 18 TABLE ST TUBE TH 0.02 WT 100 DT 50 20 TABLE ST PIP48X2.0CHS 21 TABLE ST PIPE OD 0.5 ID 0.48 PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES FINISH
Axial Tension
The criterion governing the capacity of tension members is based on two limit states. The limit state of yielding in the gross section is intended to prevent excessive elongation of the member. The second limit state involves fracture at the section with the minimum effective net area. The net section area may be specified by the user through the use of the parameter NSF (see Table 13B.1). STAAD calculates the tension capacity of a member based on these two limits states per Cl.13.2 of SAB0162-1: 1993. Parameters FYLD, FU, and NSF are applicable for these calculations.
Axial Compression
The compressive resistance of columns is determined based on Clause 13.3 of the code. The equations presented in this section of the code assume that the compressive resistance is a function of the compressive strength of the gross section (Gross section Area times the Yield Strength) as well as the slenderness factor (KL/r ratios). The effective length for the calculation of compression resistance may be provided through the use of the parameters KX, KY, KZ, LX, LY, and LZ (see Table 13B.1). Some of the aspects of the axial compression capacity calculations are: 1. For frame members not subjected to any bending, and for truss members, the axial compression capacity in general column flexural buckling is calculated from Cl.13.3.1 using the slenderness ratios for the local Y-Y and Z-Z axis. The parameters KY, LY, KZ, and LZ are applicable for this. 2. For single angles, asymmetric or cruciform sections are checked as to whether torsional-flexural buckling is critical. But for KL/r ratio exceeding 50,as torsional flexural buckling is not critical, the axial compression capacities are calculated by using Cl.13.3. The reason for this is that the South African code doesnt provide any clear guidelines for calculating this value. The parameters KY, LY, KZ, and LZ are applicable for this. 3. The axial compression capacity is also calculated by taking flexural-torsional buckling into account. Parameters KX and LX may be used to provide the effective length factor and effective length value for flexural-torsional buckling. Flexural-torsional buckling capacity is computed for single channels, single angles, Tees and Double angles.
754 STAAD.Pro
4. While computing the general column flexural buckling capacity of sections with axial compression + bending, the special provisions of 13.8.1(a), 13.8.1(b) and 13.8.1(c) are applied. For example, Lambda = 0 for 13.8.1(a), K=1 for 13.8.1(b), etc.)
Bending
The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange for the purpose of computing the factored moment resistance is specified in STAAD with the help of the parameter UNL. If UNL is less than one tenth the member length (member length is the distance between the joints of the member), the member is treated as being continuously laterally supported. In this case, the moment resistance is computed from Clause 13.5 of the code. If UNL is greater than or equal to onetenth the member length, its value is used as the laterally unsupported length. The equations of Clause 13.6 of the code are used to arrive at the moment of resistance of laterally unsupported members. Some of the aspects of the bending capacity calculations are: 1. The weak axis bending capacity of all sections except single angles is calculated as: For Class 1 & 2 sections Phi*Py*Fy For Class 3 sections Phi*Sy*Fy Where: Phi = Resistance factor = 0.9 Py = Plastic section modulus about the local Y axis Sy = Elastic section modulus about the local Y axis Fy = Yield stress of steel 2. Single angles sections are not designed by STAAD, as the South African code doesnt provide any clear guidelines for calculating this value. 3. For calculating the bending capacity about the Z-Z axis of singly symmetric
shapes such as Tees and Double angles, SAB0162-1: 1993 stipulates in Clause 13.6(b), page 31, that a rational method.
Shear
The shear resistance of the cross section is determined using the equations of Clause 13.4 of the code. Once this is obtained, the ratio of the shear force acting on the cross section to the shear resistance of the section is calculated. If any of the ratios (for both local Y & Z axes) exceed 1.0 or the allowable value provided using the RATIO parameter (see Table 13B.1), the section is considered to have failed under shear. The code also requires that the slenderness ratio of the web be within a certain limit (See Cl.13.4.1.3, page 29 of SABS 0162-1:1993). Checks for safety in shear are performed only if this value is within the allowable limit. Users may by-pass this limitation by specifying a value of 2.0 for the MAIN parameter.
756 STAAD.Pro
The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 13B.1 - South African Steel Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified SAB0162. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manu
BEAM
Greater than 0.0 and less than 2.5,Value of Omega_ calculation Equal to 0.0: Calculate Omega_2
CMY
1.0
1 - Do not calculate Omega-1 for local Y axis. 2 - Calculate Omega-1 for local Y axis
CMZ
1.0
1 - Do not calculate Omega-1 for local Z axis. 2 - Calculate Omega-1 for local Z axis
0 0 0 1000 0
Start node of physical member for determining defle and should be set along with DFF parameter
End node of physical member for determining deflec and should be set along with DFF parameter Maximum allowable depth Minimum required depth
South African Codes - Steel Design Per SAB Standard SAB0162-1:1993 Parameter Name FYLD FU KT KY KZ LT LY LZ MAIN Default Value Description
300Mpa 345Mpa 1.0 1.0 1.0 Member length Member length Member length 0
Yield strength of steel Ultimate strength of steel K value for flexural torsional buckling K value in local Y-axis, usually minor axis K value in local Z-axis, usually major axis Length for flexural torsional buckling Length in local Y axis for slenderness value KL/r Length in local Z axis for slenderness value KL/r Flag for controlling slenderness check 0 - For Check for slenderness. 1 - For Do not check for slenderness
NSF RATIO
1.0 1.0
Net section factor for tension members Permissible ratio of applied load to section capacity
Used in altering the RHS of critical interaction equat SSY 0 Sidesway parameter 0 - Sideway about local Y-axis. 1 - No sideway about local Y-axis. SSZ 0 Sidesway parameter 0 - Sideway about local Z-axis. 1 - No sideway about local Z-axis. TRACK 0 Track parameter 0. Print the design output at the minimum detail
1. Print the design output at the intermediate de 2. Print the design output at maximum detail lev
758 STAAD.Pro
Default Value
Description
Unsupported length in bending compression of bott resistance Unsupported length in bending compression of top resistance
Example
Sample input data for South African Code Design
PARAMETER CODE SAB0162 MAIN 1 ALL LY 4 MEMB 1 LZ 4 MEMB 1 UNL 4 MEMB 1
CB 0 MEMB 1 TO 23 CMZ MEMB 2 1 TO 23 CMY MEMB2 1 TO 23 SSY 0 MEMB 1 TO 23 SSZ 0 MEMB 1 TO 23 FU 450000 MEMB 1 TO 23 BEAM 1 ALL NSF 0.85 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4 RATIO 1.0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL FYLD 300000 1 TO 23 CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
760 STAAD.Pro
If the TRACK parameter is set to 1.0, the output will be displayed as follows:
************************************** STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING (SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 ST 406X67UB (SOUTHAFRICAN SECTIONS) PASS SAB-13.8 0.543 1 0.00 0.00 -191.90 4.08 |--------------------------------------------------------------------| | FACTORED RESISTANCES FOR MEMBER1 UNIT - KN,M PHI = 0.90 | | MRZ= 353.27 MRY= 63.99 | | CR= 453.21 TR= 2308.50 VR= 642.00 | |--------------------------------------------------------------------| MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCA-
Factored member resistances will be printed out. Following is a description of some of the items printed out. Output Term MRZ MRY CR TR VR Description Factored moment of resistance in z direction Factored moment of resistance in y direction Factored compressive resistance for column Factored tensile capacity Factored shear resistance
Further details can be obtained by setting TRACK to 2.0. A typical output of track 2.0 parameter is as follows.
************************************** STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING (SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED)
TABLE
RESULT/ FX
CRITICAL COND/ MY
RATIO/ MZ
LOADLOCA-
======================================================================= 1 ST 406X67UB (SOUTHAFRICAN SECTIONS) PASS SAB-13.8 0.543 1 0.00 0.00 -191.90 4.08 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 8.55E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = 7.00E+02 IZ = 2.43E+04 SZ = 1.19E+03 PZ = 1.35E+03 IY = 1.36E+03 SY = 1.52E+02 PY = 2.37E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CRY = 4.532E+02 CRZ = 2.016E+03 CTORFLX = 4.532E+02 TENSILE CAPACITY = 2.308E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 4.532E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 6.399E+01 MRZ = 3.533E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 6.420E+02 VRZ = 6.075E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 85.000 KL/RY = 175.514 KL/RZ = 41.522 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 300.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 4.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.75 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = -6.305E+01 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 4.33E+01
Following is a description of some of the items printed out. Output Term CRY CRZ CTORFLX TENSILE CAPACITY Description Factored compressive resistance for column buckling about the local y axis Factored compressive resistance for column buckling about the local z axis Factored compressive resistance against torsional flexural buckling Factored tensile capacity
762 STAAD.Pro
Output Term COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE
Description Factored compressive capacity MRY = Factored moment of resistance in y direction MRZ = Factored moment of resistance in z direction VRY = Factored shear resistance in y direction VRZ = Factored shear resistance in z direction
Reference
Example 4.3.4.1, page 4.18, Structural Steel Design to SAB:0162-1(1993)(Limit state Design) by Greg Parrott, 1st edition, Shades Technical publication
Given
FYLD = 300 Mpa Length = 6000 mm
Comparison
Table 13B.2 - SAB0162-1:1993 Verification Problem 1 Source Axial Compressive Strength (kN) 1516 1516 None
Input File
STAAD PLANE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 0 6 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; MEMBER PROPERTY SAFRICAN 1 TABLE ST 356X67UB DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 1.99947E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8191 ALPHA 6E-006 DAMP 0.03
764 STAAD.Pro
TYPE STEEL STRENGTH FY 248210 FU 399894 RY 1.5 RT 1.2 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT MMS KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL UNIT METER KN SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FY -1500 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER 1 CODE SABS0162 LZ 6 ALL LY 3 ALL FU 450000 ALL BEAM 1 ALL NSF 0.85 ALL TRACK 2 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Output
(SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MEMBER TABLE MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION =======================================================================
PASS 1500.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 8.55E+01 IZ = 1.95E+04 SZ = 1.07E+03 IY = 1.36E+03 SY = 1.57E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0
1 0.00
6.00E+02
SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CRY = 1.516E+03 CRZ = 2.038E+03 CTORFLX = 1.516E+03 TENSILE CAPACITY = 1.918E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 1.516E+03 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 6.561E+01 MRZ = 1.991E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 5.903E+02 VRZ = 6.461E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 0.850 KL/RY = 75.220 KL/RZ = 39.730 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 200.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 6.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.00 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 0.000E+00 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 3.65E+01
Reference
Example 4.5, page 4.37, Structural Steel Design to SAB:0162-1(1993)(Limit state Design) by Greg Parrott, 1st edition, Shades Technical publication
Given
FYLD = 300 Mpa
766 STAAD.Pro
Comparison
Table 13B.3 - SAB0162-1:1993 Verification Problem 2 Source Major Axis Bending Resistance (kN) 353.4 353.3 Negligible
Input File
STAAD PLANE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 10 0 0; 3 7 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 3; 2 3 2 MEMBER PROPERTY SAFRICAN 1 2 TABLE ST 406X67UB DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC MATERIAL1 E 2.00E+008 POISSON 3 DENSITY 977 ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.00E+008
POISSON 3 DENSITY 8195 ALPHA 2E-005 DAMP 03 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT MMS KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL MEMB 1 2 UNIT METER KN SUPPORTS 1 3 PINNED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD 1 CON GY -104 4 1 UNI GY -4 2 UNI GY -2 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE SABS0162 CB 0 ALL UNL 4 MEMB 1 FU 450000 ALL BEAM 1 ALL NSF 85 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE MEMB 1 FINISH
768 STAAD.Pro
Output
************************************** STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING (SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MEMBER TABLE MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST 406X67UB (SOUTHAFRICAN SECTIONS) PASS SAB-13.8 0.543 1 0.00 0.00 -191.90 4.08 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 8.55E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = 7.00E+02 IZ = 2.43E+04 SZ = 1.19E+03 PZ = 1.35E+03 IY = 1.36E+03 SY = 1.52E+02 PY = 2.37E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CRY = 4.532E+02 CRZ = 2.016E+03 CTORFLX = 4.532E+02 TENSILE CAPACITY = 2.308E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 4.532E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 6.399E+01 MRZ = 3.533E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 6.420E+02 VRZ = 6.075E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 85.000 KL/RY = 175.514 KL/RZ = 41.522 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 300.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 4.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.75 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = -6.305E+01 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 4.33E+01
Reference
Example 4.6.5, page 4.54, Structural Steel Design to SAB:0162-1(1993)(Limit state Design) by Greg Parrott, 1st edition, Shades Technical publication
Given
FYLD = 300 Mpa
Comparison
Table 13B.4 - SAB0162-1:1993 Verification Problem 3 Source Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Shear Capacity (kN) 687.1 687.1 None
Input File
STAAD PLANE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE END JOB INFORMATION UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 8 0 0 MEMBER INCIDENCES 112 MEMBER PROPERTY SAFRICAN 1 TABLE ST 457X67UB
770 STAAD.Pro
DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC MATERIAL1 E 2E+008 POISSON 3 DENSITY 977 ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2E+008 POISSON 3 DENSITY 8195 ALPHA 2E-005 DAMP 03 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT MMS KN CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL MEMB 1 UNIT METER KN SUPPORTS 1 2 PINNED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -70 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER CODE SABS0162 FU 450000 ALL BEAM 1 ALL FYLD 300000 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Output
************************************** STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING (SOUTHAFRICAN STEEL/SAB-0162-01(1993)) ************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KNS MEMBER TABLE MET (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= * 1 ST 457X67UB (SOUTHAFRICAN SECTIONS) FAIL SAB-13.8 4.134 1 0.00 0.00 -560.00 4.00 MEMBER PROPERTIES (UNIT = CM) ----------------------------CROSS SECTION AREA = 8.55E+01 MEMBER LENGTH = 8.00E+02 IZ = 2.94E+04 SZ = 1.30E+03 PZ = 1.47E+03 IY = 1.45E+03 SY = 1.53E+02 PY = 2.37E+02 MATERIAL PROPERTIES (UNIT = MPA) -------------------------------FYLD = 300.0 FU = 345.0 SECTION CAPACITIES (UNIT - KN,M) --------------------------------CRY = 3.738E+02 CRZ = 1.996E+03 CTORFLX = 3.738E+02 TENSILE CAPACITY = 2.257E+03 COMPRESSIVE CAPACITY = 3.738E+02 FACTORED MOMENT RESISTANCE : MRY = 6.399E+01 MRZ = 1.355E+02 FACTORED SHEAR RESISTANCE : VRY = 6.871E+02 VRZ = 5.730E+02 MISCELLANEOUS INFORMATION -------------------------NET SECTION FACTOR FOR TENSION = 1.000 KL/RY = 194.263 KL/RZ = 43.142 ALLOWABLE KL/R = 300.000 UNSUPPORTED LENGTH OF THE COMPRESSION FLANGE (M) = 8.000 OMEGA-1 (Y-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-1 (Z-AXIS) = 1.00 OMEGA-2 = 1.00 SHEAR FORCE (KNS) : Y AXIS = 0.000E+00 Z AXIS = 0.000E+00 SLENDERNESS RATIO OF WEB (H/W) = 5.04E+01
772 STAAD.Pro
Section 14
Example:
1 TO 5 TA ST CS12X11.8 9 TA ST I8.00X13.1 11 33 45 67 TA ST LS8.00X8.00X0.625 18 TA ST 1.50PIPEX160 15 TA ST T(A-N)6.00X8.00X11.2 23 25 29 TA ST 20X12RECTX.500WALL
Example
3 TA BACK C(A-N)7X3.61 SPACING 1.5 5 TA BACK C15X17.33 SP 0.75
Example
2 TA FRONT CS12X10.3 SP 1.0 4 TA FR CS10X10.1 SP 0.5
Example
774 STAAD.Pro
14 TA LD LS4.00X3.00X0.375 SP 1.5
Example
12 TA SD L3.5X3X0.5 SP 0.25 13 TA SD L8X6X0.75 SP 1.0
Table 14A.1 - Aluminum Design Parameters Parameter Name Default Value Description
CODE
Must be specified as ALUMINUM Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
ALCLAD
This variable can take on a value of either 0 or 1. 0 - Material used in the section is not an Alclad. 1 - Material used in the section is an Alclad.
ALLOY
34
This variable can take on a value from 1 through 40. The default value represents the alloy 6061-T6. See Table 14A.2 below for a list of values for this parameter and the alloy they represent. Table 3.3-1 in Section I-B of the Aluminum specifications provides information on the properties of the various alloys.
776 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Description
BEAM
If this parameter is set to 1.0, the adequacy of the member is determined by checking a total of 13 equally spaced locations along the length of the member. If the BEAM value is 0.0, the 13 location check is not conducted, and instead, checking is done only at the locations specified by the SECTION command (See STAAD manual for details). If neither the BEAM parameter nor any SECTION command is specified, STAAD will terminate the run and ask the user to provide one of those 2 commands. This rule is not enforced for TRUSS members. Maximum depth permissible for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units. Minimum depth required for the section during member selection. This value must be provided in the current units.
DMAX
1000 in.
DMIN
0.0 in
Parameter Name
Description
KT
Effective length factor for torsional buckling. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the allowable stress in axial compression. See Equation 3.4.7.2-6 on page I-A-28 of the Aluminum specifications for details.
KY
1.0
Effective length factor for overall column buckling in the local Y-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the allowable stress in axial compression.
778 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Description
KZ
Effective length factor for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is a fraction and is unit-less. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the allowable stress in axial compression. Unbraced length for twisting. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from torsional buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for twisting for determining the allowable stress in axial compression. See Equation 3.4.7.2-6 on page I-A-28 of the Aluminum specifications for details.
LT
Member length
Parameter Name
Description
LY
Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Y-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the allowable stress in axial compression. Effective length for overall column buckling in the local Z-axis. It is input in the current units of length. Values can range from 0.01 (for a column completely prevented from buckling) to any user specified large value. It is used to compute the KL/R ratio for determining the allowable stress in axial compression.
LZ
Member length
780 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value 1
Description
PRODUCT
This variable can take on a value from 1 through 4. They represent: 1 - All 2 - Extrusions 3 - Drawn Tube 4 - Pipe The default value stands for All. The PRODUCT parameter finds mention in Table 3.3-1 in Section I-B of the Aluminum specifications.
Parameter Name
Description
SSY
Factor that indicates whether or not the structure is subjected to sidesway along the local Y axis of the member. The values are: 0 - Sidesway is present along the local Y-axis of the member 1 - There is no sidesway along the local Y-axis of the member. The sidesway condition is used to determine the value of Cm explained in Section 4.1.1, page I-A41 of the Aluminum specifications.
782 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Description
SSZ
Factor that indicates whether or not the structure is subjected to sidesway along the local Z axis of the member. The values are: 0 - Sidesway is present along the local Z-axis of the member 1 - There is no sidesway along the local Z-axis of the member. The sidesway condition is used to determine the value of Cm explained in Section 4.1.1, page I-A41 of the Aluminum specifications.
STIFF
Member length
Spacing in the longitudinal direction of shear stiffeners for stiffened flat webs. It is input in the current units of length. See section 3.4.21 on page I-A-40 of the Aluminum specifications for information regarding this parameter.
Parameter Name
Default Value 1
Description
STRUCTURE
In Table 3.4-1 in Section I-A of the Aluminum specifications, it is mentioned that the value of coefficients nu, ny and na are dependent upon whether the structure being designed is a building or a bridge. Users may convey this information to STAAD using the parameter STRUCTURE. The values that can be assigned to this parameter are: 1 - Buildings and similar type structures 2 - Bridges and similar type structures
784 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value 2
Description
TRACK
This parameter is used to control the level of detail in which the design output is reported in the output file. The allowable values are: 1 - Prints only the member number, section name, ratio, and PASS/FAIL status. 2 - Prints the design summary in addition to that printed by TRACK 1 3 - Prints the member properties and alloy properties in addition to that printed byTRACK 2. 4 - Prints the values of variables used in design in addition to that printed by TRACK 3.
UNL
Member length
Distance between points where the compression flange is braced against buckling or twisting. This value must be provided in the current units. This value is used to compute the allowable stress in bending compression.
Parameter Name
Default Value 0
Description
WELD
In Table 3.4-2 in Section I-A of the Aluminum specifications, it is mentioned that the value of coefficients Kt and Kc are dependent upon whether or not, the location of the section where design is done is within 1.0 inch of a weld. The WELD parameter is used in STAAD for this purpose. The values that can be assigned to this parameter are: 0 - Region is farther than 1.0in from a weld 1 - Region is within 1.0in from a weld
Aluminum Alloys available in STAAD Table 14A.2 - Alloy Parameters Value 1 2 3 4 5 6 Name 1100-H12 1100-H14 2014-T6 2014-T6510 2014-T6511 2014-T651
786 STAAD.Pro
Value 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30
Name 3003-H12 3003-H14 3003-H16 3003-H18 3004-H32 3004-H34 3004-H36 3004-H38 5005-H12 5005-H14 5005-H32 5005-H34 5050-H32 5050-H34 5052-H32 5052-H34 5083-H111 5086-H111 5086-H116 5086-H32 5086-H34 5454-H111 5454-H112 5456-H111
Value 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
Name 5456-H112 6005-T5 6105-T5 6061-T6 6061-T6510 6061-T6511 6061-T651 6063-T5 6063-T6 6351-T5
Example
Sample input data for Aluminum Design
PARAMETER CODE ALUMINUM BEAM 1 ALL KY 1.2 MEMB 3 4
788 STAAD.Pro
ALLOY 35 ALL PRODUCT 2 ALL TRACK 3 ALL SELECT ALL ALCLAD 1 ALL STRUCT 1 ALL CHECK CODE ALL
790 STAAD.Pro
Section 15
792 STAAD.Pro
In general, the concepts followed in MEMBER SELECTION and CODE CHECKING procedures are similar to that of the AISC based design. It is assumed that the user is familiar with the basic concepts of steel design facilities available in STAAD. Please refer to Section 2 of the STAAD Technical Reference Manual for detailed information on this topic. This section specifically addresses the implementation of steel design based on ASCE 10-97. Design is available for all standard sections listed in the AISC ASD 9th edition manual, namely, Wide Flanges, S, M, HP, Tees, Channels, Single Angles, Double Angles, Tubes and Pipes. Design of HSS sections (those listed in the 3rd edition AISC LRFD manual) and Composite beams (I shapes with concrete slab on top) is not supported.
referred to in the standard as Design Stresses. The appropriate sections of the ASCE standard where the procedure for calculating the design stresses is explained are as follows.
794 STAAD.Pro
Must be specified as ASCE to design per ASCE 10-97. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BEAM
1.0
0 = Perform design at beam ends and section locations specified according to the SECTION command 1 = Perform design at the ends and eleven intermediate sections of the beam
American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE 10-97 Parameter Name CMY CMZ Default Value 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 45.0 in. 0.75 in. Description
Cm value in local y and z axes as defined in equation 3.12-1 on p.10 of ASCE 10-97.
DMAX DBL
Maximum allowable depth for member selection Diameter of bolt for calculation of number of bolts required and the net section factor. Minimum allowable depth for member selection Indicates what type of end conditions are to be used from among Equations 3.7-4 thru 3.7-7 to determine the KL/R ratio. 1. EQN.3.7-4, Page 4 (VALID FOR LEG MEMBERS ONLY) 2. EQN.3.7-5, Page 4 3. EQN.3.7-6, Page 4 4. EQN.3.7-7, Page 5
DMIN ELA
0.0 in. 4
ELB
Indicates what type of end conditions are to be used from among Equations. 3.7-8 thru 3.710 and 3.7-12 thru 3.7-14 to determine the KL/R ratio. 1. EQN.3.7-8, Page 5, EQN.3.712, Page 5 2. EQN.3.7-9, Page 5, EQN.3.713, Page 5
796 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
3. EQN.3.7-10, Page 5, EQN.3.7-14,Page 5 FVB FYB FYLD KT 30 KSI 36 KSI 36.0 KSI 1.0 Shear strength of bolt. Yield strength of bolt. Yield Strength of steel Effective length coefficient for warping restraint (clause 3.14.4, pg 11) Effective length factor (K) for compression buckling about the Yaxis (minor axis) Effective length factor (K) for compression buckling about the Zaxis (major axis) This parameter is meant for plain angles. 0. indicates that the angle is connected by both legs and allowable stress in axial tension is 1.0FYLD. 1. indicates that the angle is connected only by the shorter leg and allowable tensile stress is computed per clause 3.10.2 as 0.9FYLD. 2. indicates that the angle is connected by the longer leg. LT LY Member Length Member Length Effective length for warping. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about the Y-axis
KY
1.0
KZ
1.0
LEG
0.0
American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE 10-97 Parameter Name Default Value Description
(minor axis) LZ Member Length 2 Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about the Z-axis (major axis) Parameter that indicates the member type for the purpose of calculating the KL/R ratio (SEE CLAUSE 3.4, PAGE 3, ASCE 10-97) 1. Leg member, KL/R <= 150 2. Compression member, KL/R <= 200 3. Tension member, KL/R <= 500 4. Hanger member, KL/R <= 375 (Clause 4C.4, page 43) 5. Redundant member, KL/R <= 250 10. Do not perform the KL/R Check NHL 0 Number of bolt holes on the cross section that should be used to determine the net section factor for tension capacity. Net section factor for tension members Permissible ratio that determines the cut off point for pass/fail status. A value below this quantity indicates PASS while a value greater than this quantity indicates FAILURE.
MAIN
NSF RATIO
1.0 1.0
798 STAAD.Pro
Description
SSZ TRACK
0.0 0.0
Same as above except in local zaxis 0.0 = Suppresses printing of allowable stresses 1.0 = Prints all allowable stresses
UNB
Member Length
Unsupported length of the bottom flange for calculating flexural strength. Will be used only if flexural compression is on the bottom flange. Same as UNL, but provided as a fraction of the member length Unsupported length of member for calculation of allowable bending stress
UNF UNL
UNT
Member Length
Unsupported length of the top flange for calculating flexural strength. Will be used only if flexural compression is on the top flange.
Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.
800 STAAD.Pro
American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports
15B.1 General Comments
This document presents some general statements regarding the implementation of the Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports on Engineering Practice No. 52 Guide for Design of Steel Transmission Towers, Second Edition. The design philosophy and procedural logistics for member selection and code checking is based upon the principles of allowable stress design. Two major failure modes are recognized: failure by overstressing and failure by stability considerations. The following sections describe the salient features regarding the process of calculation of the relevant allowable stresses and the stability criteria being used. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the allowable stresses and the most economical section is selected based on the least weight criteria. The code checking part of the program also checks the slenderness requirements, the minimum metal thickness requirements and the width-thickness requirements. It is generally assumed that the user will take care of the detailing requirements like provision of stiffeners and check the local effects like flange buckling, web crippling, etc. It general, it may be noted that the concepts followed in MEMBER SELECTION and CODE CHECKING procedures are similar to that of the AISC based design. It is assumed that the user is familiar with the basic concepts of Steel Design facilities available in STAAD. Please refer to Section 3 of the STAAD Technical Reference Manual for detailed information on this topic. This document specifically addresses the implementation of steel design based on ASCE Pub. 52.
American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports
802 STAAD.Pro
default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design.
American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports Parameter Default Name Value UNF TRACK 1.0 0.0 Description Same as UNL, but provided as a fraction of the member length 0.0 = Suppresses printing of allowable stresses 1.0 = Prints all allowable stresses Maximum allowable depth for member selection Minimum allowable depth for member selection Permissible ratio that determines the cut off point for pass/fail status. A value below this quantity indicates PASS while a value greater than this quantity indicates FAILURE. 2.0 = Perform design using the section locations specified according to the SECTION
command
BEAM
0.0
3.0 = Perform design at the ends and eleven intermediate sections of the beam
804 STAAD.Pro
Description Parameter that indicates the member type for the purpose of calculating the KL/R ratio (SEE CLAUSE 4.4, PAGE 25) = 10 : DO NOT PERFORM THE KL/R CHECK = 1 : LEG MEMBER KL/R <= 150 = 2 : COMPRESSION MEMBER KL/R <= 200 = 3 : TENSION MEMBER KL/R <= 500 = 4 : HANGAR MEMBERS KL/R <= 375 (Clause 4C.4, page 43) = 5 : REDUNDANT MEMBERS KL/R <= 250 Indicates what type of end conditions are to be used From among Equations 4.7-4 thru 4.7-7 to determine the the KL/R ratio. ELA=1 : EQN.4.7-4, Page 26 (VALID FOR LEG MEMBERS ONLY) ELA=2 : EQN.4.7-5, Page 27 ELA=3 : EQN.4.7-6, Page 27 ELA=4 : EQN.4.7-7, Page 27
ELA
American Transmission Tower Code - Steel Design per ASCE Manuals and Reports Parameter Default Name Value ELB 1 Description Indicates what type of end conditions are to be used from among Equations. 4.7-8 thru 4.7-10 to determine the KL/R ratio. ELB=1 : EQN.4.7-8, Page 27, EQN.4.712, Page 28 ELB=2 : EQN.4.7-9, Page 27, EQN.4.713, Page 28 ELB=3 : EQN.4.7-10, Page 27, EQN.4.714,Page28 This parameter is meant for plain angles. 3.0 = indicates that the angle is connected by both legs and allowable stress in
axial tension is 1.0 FYLD.
LEG
0.0
4.0 = indicates that the angle is connected only by the shorter leg and allowable
tensile stress is computed per clause 4.10.2 as 0.9FYLD.
5.0 = indicates that the angle is connected by the longer leg. 0.75 in. Diameter of bolt for calculation of number of bolts required and the net section factor. 36 KSI Yield strength of bolt. 30 KSI Shear strength of bolt. 0 Number of bolt holes on the cross section that should be used to determine the net section
factor for tension capacity.
Notes:
l
All values must be provided in the current unit system. Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.
806 STAAD.Pro
Section 16
Specify the members and the load cases to be considered in the design; Specify whether to perform code checking or member selection;
Specify design parameter values, if different from the default values; and Specify design parameters to carry out punching shear checks.
These operations may be repeated by the user any number of times depending upon the design requirements, but care should be taken when coupled with manipulation of the punching shear LEG parameter. The basic process is as follows: 1. Define the STAAD model geometry, loading and analysis. 2. Define the API code parameters with LEG 1.0. 3. Run the analysis and API design which creates the Geometry file and give preliminary design results. 4. Check and modify the Geometry file as necessary. 5. Reset the LEG parameter to 2.0 and re-run the analysis to read the modified Geometry file for the final design results.
808 STAAD.Pro
F = 0.4F
v
The maximum applied beam shear stress is per Eqn 3.2.4-1: f = V / 0.5 A
v
= 0.4F
F is the maximum torsional shear stress per Clause 3.2.4-3 of the API code.
xe
or F
xc
is substituted for F .
xy
F = the elastic local buckling stress calculated with C, the critical xe elastic buckling coefficient = 0.3 (3.2.2-3) F
xc
F = 0.75F
b
810 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 1.0 0.0 = design only for end moments or those at locations specified by the SECTION command. 1.0 = calculate moments at twelfth points along the beam, and use the maximum Mz location for design. 2.0 = Same for BEAM1.0, but additional check is made at each end. CB 1.0 Cb value as used in Section 1.5 of AISC 0.0 = Cb value to be calculated Any other value will mean the value to be used in design CMY CMZ DMAX DMIN 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.0 0.0 Cm value in local y & z axes Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
depth FYLD KY 36 KSI 1.0 Yield strength of steel. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. KZ 1.0 K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. LEG 1.0 2.0 To write out external parameters file. To read in the external parameters file. LY Member Length Length in local Y-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. Length in local Z-axis to calculate slenderness ratio. 1.0 = Main member 2.0 = Secondary member NSF RATIO 1.0 1.0 Net section factor for tension members. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses
LZ
Member Length
MAIN
0.0
812 STAAD.Pro
Default Value
Description
0.0
SSZ TRACK
0.0 0.0
Same as above except in local z-axis 1.0 = Print all critical member stresses 100.0 = Suppress all checks except punching shear
UNL
Member Length
Unsupported length for calculating allowable bending stress Same as above provided as a fraction of actual member length
UNF
1.0
WELD
1 for closed sections Weld type, as explained in section 3.1.1. 2 for open sections 1. = Welding is one side only except for wide flange or tee sections, where the web is always assumed to be welded on both sides. 2. = Welding is both sides. For closed sections like pipe or tube,
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
the welding will be only on one side. WSTR WMIN 0.4 X FLYD 1.16 in. Allowable welding stress Minimum thickness
Note: The parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used for member selection.
814 STAAD.Pro
originally designated for the member being designed. Member selection can also be constrained by the parameters DMAX and DMIN which limits the maximum and minimum depth of the members. Member selection can be performed with all types of hollow steel sections. Selection of members whose properties are originally input from a user created table will be limited to sections in the user table. Member selection cannot be performed on members whose section properties are input as prismatic. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.
Note: A value representing joint type and geometry must be provided for parameter PUNCH, in the external file. On the first run where no external table is present, LEG must equal 1.0.
816 STAAD.Pro
The default external output/input file name can be changed by using the command line: CODE API <filename>. This external output data file can be edited and used as an external input file to reperform the check using the parameter PUNCH 1.0 to 5.0. This external input file allows can/stub geometry data to be specified and chords to be assigned geometry where they could not be identified in the Automatic selection. The parameter LEG 2.0 must be used to read an external input file where the default name is APIPUN. The yield strength of the brace is used in the punching shear check. This can be changed in the external geometry file. The user should ensure that the correct cord member has been selected for the check.
Reference
1 Ref I: Boone, TJ. Yura, JA. and Hoadley, PW. Ultimate Strength if Tubular Joints Chord Stress Effects, OTC 4828, 1984
The parameters used in the external file are defined as follows: Table 16C.3 - External File Parameter Name PUNCH BRACE CHORD D T d T GAP Description Parameter for punching shear (See Section 12.10) Member number of brace Member number of chord Chord Diameter in inches Chord Thickness in inches Brace Diameter in inches Brace Thickness in inches Gap in inches (must be negative for overlap K-joint)
818 STAAD.Pro
Description Local yield strength used for joint in KIPS Angle of through brace in overlap K-joint in Degrees
Used in overlap K-joint, taken as the lesser of the weld throat thickn thinner brace in inches
SWAP
If parameter SWAP 0 is used then major moment Mz is taken for In SWAP 1 uses the minor moment My as the IPB.
Notes:
l
For overlap K-joints, the through brace is assumed to be the same diameter as the brace being checked. If any of the parameters for diameter and thickness specified in the external file are less than that for members being checked, then the member properties specified in the STAAD file shall be used. The member diameter and thickness should be used in API equation (4.1-1); in this check it has been assumed that the yield strength of the chord and brace members are the same. The geometry file name is currently limited to eight characters (4 if an extension as .TXT is used).
The overall process of performing punching shear checks consists of two steps. These steps are explained in section 16.16.
16.14 Limitations
The parameter SELECT 1.0 should not be used while carrying out punching shear checks. It can be used in initial runs for member selection. No classification of the joint is performed using the loading. No hydrostatic checks are performed.
820 STAAD.Pro
Step 1
Creating the geometry data file. This is done by specifying the name of the geometry data file alongside the command line CODE API. If a file name is not specified, STAAD automatically assigns the file name APIPUN to the geometry data file. The parameter instructions in the .STD file should contain the LEG parameter and it should be assigned the value 1.0. Example Reading External Geometry File
UNIT INCHES KIPS PARAMETERS * ALL JOINT DATA WILL BE WRITTEN TO EXTERNAL FILE GEOM1 FOR PUNCHING SHEAR. CODE API GEOM1 LEG 1.0 * JOINTS TO BE CONSIDERED AS T AND Y, I.E., PUNCH IS SET TO 3.0. FYLD 50.0 ALL TRACK 1.0 ALL RATIO 1.0 ALL BEAM 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE ALL
After ensuring that your STAAD input file contains the above data, run the analysis. Once the analysis is completed, you will find that a file by the name GEOM1 has been created and is located in the same folder as the one where your .std file is located. (In case you did not specify a file name - GEOM1 shown in the earlier example - STAAD will create the file named APIPUN.
Step 2
The geometry data file (GEOM 1 or otherwise) should be inspected and modified as required such as changing the PUNCH values and local section properties for the punching shear checks. Modify the .STD file so it reruns the code check process by reading the instructions of the GEOM file. This message is conveyed by changing the value of the LEG
parameter to 2.0. After making this change, a re-analysis will result in the program using the information in the geometry data file (GEOM1, APIPUN, or otherwise) for performing the code check. Example Reading an existing Joint Geometry Data File, GEOM1
UNIT INCHES KIPS PARAMETERS * ALL JOINT DATA WILL BE READ FROM THE EXTERNAL FILE GEOM1 FOR PUNCHING SHEAR. CODE API GEOM1 LEG 2.0 FYLD 50.0 ALL TRACK 1.0 ALL RATIO 1.0 ALL BEAM 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE ALL
822 STAAD.Pro
Section 17
824 STAAD.Pro
Design Process
Members subjected to both axial compression and bending stresses are proportioned to satisfy equation Q1.6-1a: SFCf /F +SMYC
a a my by
mz bz
+SMZf /F
bz
bz
1.0
when, f /F > 0.15, as per section Q1.6.1 of the code. Otherwise, equation Q1.6-2 must be satisfied: SFCf /F +SMYf /F
a a by by
+ SMZf /F
bz
bz
1.0
It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and [0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2)], but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway.
Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy equation Q1.6-3: SFTf /(0.6F ) +SMYf /F
a y by by
+SMZf /F
bz
bz
1.0
Where SFC, SFT, SMZ, and SMY are stress limit coefficient parameters used to control the components of the interaction equations. Refer to Table 17A.1 for details.
Table 17A.1 - Design Parameters for ANSI/AISC N690-1994 Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as AISC N690 Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BEAM
Beam parameter 0. Perform design at ends and those locations in the SECTIONcommand. 1. Perform design at ends and at 1/12th section locations along the member length.
CAN
826 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
0. Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1. Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient, as specified in Chapter Fof AISCASD. 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0 Cm value in local y & z axes
COMPOSITE
Composite action with connectors (CMP) 0. No composite action 1. Composite action 2. Ignore positive moments during design
Diameter of shear connectors (DIA), in current units. Height of shear connectors after welding (HGT), in current units. Cycles of maximum stress to which the shear connector is
subject(CYC). DFF None "Deflection Length" / Maximum (Mandatory allowable local deflection for deflection check) Start Joint of member End Joint of member 0.4 Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Ratio of moment due to dead load applied after the concrete hardens to the total moment (DR2). Ratio of moment due to dead load applied before the concrete hardens to the total moment (DR1). Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Effective width of concrete slab (WID). Yield strength of steel in current units. Compressive strength of concrete at 28 days, in current units. Full section shear for welding. 0. False 1. True
DLRATIO
0.4
828 STAAD.Pro
Description
Ultimate tensile strength of steel, in current units. Yield strength of steel, in current units. Effective length factor for flexural torsional buckling. Effective Length Factor for Compression in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. Effective Length Factor for Compression in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length for flexural torsional buckling. Length to calculate slenderness ratio (KL/r) for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). Design for slenderness: 0. check for slenderness 1. suppress slenderness check
KZ
1.0
LX LY
LZ MAIN
NSF OVR
1.0 1.0
Net section Factor for tension members Factor by which all allowable stresses/capacities should be multiplied. Default of 1.0 indicates that no overstressing is allowed. Thickness of the cover plate welded to the bottom flange of the com-
PLTHICK
posite beam (PLT), in current units. PLTWIDTH 0 Width of the cover plate welded to the bottom flange of the composite beam (PLT), in current units. Used to search for the lightest section for the profile(s) specified for member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Height of ribs of form steel deck (RBH), in current units. Width of ribs of form steel deck (RBW), in current units. Stress limit coefficient for compression (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Stress limit coefficient for tension (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Shear stress calculation option 0. Computes the actual shear stress using VQ/It 1. Computes the actual shear stress using V(Ay or Az) SHORING 0 Temporary shoring during construction 0. Without shoring 1. With shoring SLABTHICK 4 in Thickness of concrete slab or thick-
PROFILE
None
1.0 0 0 1.0
SFT SHE
1.0 0
830 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
ness of concrete slab above the form steel deck (THK), in current units. SMY 1.0 Stress limit coefficient for minor axis bending (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Stress limit coefficient for major axis bending (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Design for sidesway in the local y axis. 0. Sidesway 1. No sidesway SSZ 0 Design for sidesway in the local z axis. 0. Sidesway 1. No sidesway STIFF Member length or depth whichever is greater 0.0 Spacing of stiffeners for plate girder design, in current units.
SMZ
1.0
SSY
STYPE
TAPER
Design for tapered member. 0. Design for tapered I-section based on rules in Chapter F and Appendix B. 1. Design for tapered section
based on Appendix F. TMAIN 240 for main member 300 for Truss member TORSION 0 Design for torsion. 0. Do not design for torsion. 1. Design for torsion. TRACK 0.0 Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0. Minimum detail 1. Intermediate detail level 2. Maximum detail UNB Member Length Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange. Design for weld. 0. Closed sections. 1. Open sections. Slenderness limit under tension
UNT
Member Length
WELD
832 STAAD.Pro
Description
Maximum weld thickness, in current units. Minimum weld thickness, in current units. Allowable welding stress, in current units.
Notes
1. All values are entered in the current units 2. parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used with the MEMBER SELECTION command
17B.3 Examples
These example problems are included for the verification of design results.
17.3.1 Example 1
Solution
Allowable Compressive Stress: Maximum Slenderness Ratio, (Kl/r) Yield Stress of Steel, F = 36 ksi
y max
= 171.31
C =
c
[(22E)/F ]1/2 y
= 127.68
>C
c max
F = (122E)/[23(Kl/r)
] = 5.21 ksi
Comparison
Table 17A.2 - ANSI-AISC N690-1994 Code Verification Problem 1 Value of F (ks)
a
5.21
5.22
Negligible
Input File
This example is included as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\N690\N690_CASE1.STD
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 30-NOV-07 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 4 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.05E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN
834 STAAD.Pro
1 TABLE ST W6X12 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 PINNED 2 FIXED BUT FX MY MZ LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD 1 CON GY -10 2 UNIT METER KIP UNIT METER KN LOAD 2 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 2 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -1 LOAD COMB 3 COMBINATION LOAD CASE 3 1 1.0 2 9.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PRINT ANALYSIS RESULTS UNIT METER KIP PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Output
The corresponding TRACK 2 output is shown below:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( ANSI N690-1994) v1.0 ******************************************** |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES |
836 STAAD.Pro
17.3.2 Example 2
Solution
Allowable Compressive Stress: Maximum Slenderness Ratio, (Kl/r) Yield Stress of Steel, F = 36 ksi
y max
= 85.65
C =
c
[(22E)/F ]1/2 y
= 127.68
< 120.0
y max
= 9.07 ksi
Comparison
Table 17A.3 - ANSI-AISC N690-1994 Code Verification Problem 2 Value of F (ks)
a
9.07
9.08
Negligible
Input File
This example is included as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\N690\N690_CASE2.STD
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 30-NOV-07 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES
3 0 0 1; 4 2 0 1; MEMBER INCIDENCES 2 3 4; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.05E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 2 TABLE ST W6X12 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 3 PINNED 4 FIXED BUT FX MY MZ LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 MEMBER LOAD UNIT METER KIP 2 CON GY -2.24809 1 UNIT METER KN LOAD 2 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 2 JOINT LOAD 4 FX -1 LOAD COMB 3 COMBINATION LOAD CASE 3 1 1.0 2 9.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PRINT ANALYSIS RESULTS
838 STAAD.Pro
UNIT METER KIP PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Output
The corresponding TRACK 2 output is shown below:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( ANSI N690-1994) v1.0 ******************************************** |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN INCH UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ------------ | |MEMBER 2 * | AISC SECTIONS | | AX = 3.55 | | * | ST W6X12 | | --Z AY = 1.25 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 1.50 | |ANSI N690-94* =============================== ===|=== SY = 1.50 | | * SZ = 7.33 | | * |<---LENGTH (FT)= 6.56 --->| RY = 0.92 | |************* RZ = 2.50 | | | | 3.7 (KIP-FEET) | |PARAMETER | L1 STRESSES | |IN KIP INCH | IN KIP INCH | |--------------- + L1 L1 -------------| | KL/R-Y= 85.65 | FA = 9.08 | | KL/R-Z= 31.56 + L1 fa = 0.60 | | UNL = 78.74 | L1 FCZ = 21.60 | | CB = 1.00 + L1 L1 FTZ = 21.60 | | CMY = 0.85 | L1 FCY = 27.00 | | CMZ = 0.85 + L1 FTY = 27.00 | | FYLD = 36.00 |L0 L0 fbz = 6.04 | | NSF = 1.00 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| fby = 0.00 | | DFF = 0.00 -0.2 Fey = 18.60 | | dff= 0.00 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE Fez = 137.05 | | (KL/R)max = 85.65 (WITH LOAD NO.) FV = 14.40 | | fv = 0.90 | | | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) | | ------------------------| | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y MOMENT-Z | | |
17.3.3 Example 3
Solution
Allowable Compressive Stress: Maximum Slenderness Ratio, (Kl/r) Yield Stress of Steel, F = 36 ksi
y max
= 122.06
C =
c
[(22E)/F ]1/2 y
= 127.68
Allowable Compressive Stress for Austentic Stainless Steel, As, 120.0 <(Kl/r)
a y max
<C
c max
F = F [0.4 - (1/600)x(Kl/r)
] = 7.08 ksi
Comparison
Table 17A.4 - ANSI-AISC N690-1994 Code Verification Problem 3 Value of F (ks)
a
7.08
7.08
None
840 STAAD.Pro
Input File
This example is included as C:\SPROV8I\STAAD\EXAMP\N690\N690_CASE3.STD
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 30-NOV-07 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT METER KN JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 2.85 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 2.05E+008 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST W6X12 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 PINNED 2 FIXED BUT FX MY MZ LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1
MEMBER LOAD 1 CON GY -10 2 UNIT METER KIP UNIT METER KN LOAD 2 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 2 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -1 LOAD COMB 3 COMBINATION LOAD CASE 3 1 1.0 2 9.5 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT STATICS CHECK PRINT ANALYSIS RESULTS UNIT METER KIP PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Output
The corresponding TRACK 2 output is shown below:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( ANSI N690-1994) v1.0 ******************************************** |--------------------------------------------------------------------------| | Y PROPERTIES | |************* | IN INCH UNIT | | * |=============================| ===|=== ------------ | |MEMBER 1 * | AISC SECTIONS | | AX = 3.55 | | * | ST W6X12 | | --Z AY = 1.25 | |DESIGN CODE * | | | AZ = 1.50 | |ANSI N690-94* =============================== ===|=== SY = 1.50 | | * SZ = 7.33 | | * |<---LENGTH (FT)= 9.35 --->| RY = 0.92 | |************* RZ = 2.50 | | | | 4.2 (KIP-FEET) | |PARAMETER | L1 STRESSES | |IN KIP INCH | L1 IN KIP INCH |
842 STAAD.Pro
|--------------- + L1 -------------| | KL/R-Y= 122.06 | L1 FA = 7.08 | | KL/R-Z= 44.97 + L1 fa = 0.60 | | UNL = 112.20 | FCZ = 19.86 | | CB = 1.00 + L1 L1 FTZ = 21.60 | | CMY = 0.85 | L1 FCY = 27.00 | | CMZ = 0.85 + L1 FTY = 27.00 | | FYLD = 36.00 |L0 L0 fbz = 6.84 | | NSF = 1.00 +---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---+---| fby = 0.00 | | DFF = 0.00 -0.2 Fey = 9.16 | | dff= 0.00 ABSOLUTE MZ ENVELOPE Fez = 67.49 | | (KL/R)max = 122.06 (WITH LOAD NO.) FV = 14.40 | | fv = 0.54 | | | | MAX FORCE/ MOMENT SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) | | ------------------------| | | | AXIAL SHEAR-Y SHEAR-Z MOMENT-Y MOMENT-Z | | | | VALUE 2.1 1.6 0.0 0.0 4.2 | | LOCATION 0.0 7.0 0.0 0.0 6.2 | | LOADING 3 1 0 0 1 | | | |**************************************************************************| |* *| |* DESIGN SUMMARY (KIP-FEET) *| |* -------------*| |* *| |* RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ *| | FX MY MZ LOCATION | | ====================================================== | | PASS ANSI Q1.6-2 0.429 3 | | 2.14 C 0.00 -4.18 6.23 | |* *| |**************************************************************************| | | |--------------------------------------------------------------------------|
844 STAAD.Pro
17B.2.1. Slenderness
The maximum allowable slenderness ratio in Compression (KL/r_min), as per clause Q1.8.4 of the code shall not exceed 200. And the maximum allowable slenderness ratio in Tension (L/r_min) shall not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for bracing members and other secondary members. This can be controlled by using the existing MAIN and TMAIN parameters respectively. The default value of MAIN is 200 and for TMAIN is 240.
17B.2.3. Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as 0.60F , but not more
y
The Net Area (An) shall be determined in accordance with Q1.14, and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The Effective Net Area (Ae) of axially loaded tension members, where the load is transmitted by bolts through some but not all of the cross-sectional elements of the member, shall be computed from the formula (ref. Q1.14), A = C A
e t n
Unless otherwise specified, the default value of the CT parameter is set as 0.75. The value of CT parameter for other conditions is described at section Q1.14. The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.
17B.2.4. Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns which meet the provisions of section Q1.9, except those fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by Q1.5.1.3. The allowable compressive stress for columns fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be in accordance to section Q1.5.9. A. Gross Sections of Columns, except those fabricated of austenitic stainless steel: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) C,
c
c 2E/[23(kL/r)2] 12
846 STAAD.Pro
If the provisions of the section Q1.9 are not satisfied, A. For un-stiffened compression element, a reduction factor Q is introduced. s Detailed values of Qs for different shapes are given in Section QC2. B. For stiffened compression element, a reduced effective width b is e introduced. 1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness: b = 253t/F {1 - (50.3/[(b/t)F ]} b
e y y
Consequently, a reduction factor Q is introduced and is equal to the a effective area divided by the actual area. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or unstiffened elements shall not exceed F = Q Q [1 - (Kl/r)2/(2C 2)]F / {5/3 + [3(Kl/r)/(8C )] a s a c y c [(Kl/r)3/(8C 3)]}
c
17B.2.5.Bending Stress
Allowable bending stress for tension and compression for a structural member, as given in section Q1.5.1.4 is:
A. Along Major Axis: 1. Tension and compression on extreme fibers of compact hot rolled or built-up members symmetrical about and loaded in the plane of their minor axes and meeting the requirements of Subsection Q1.5.1.4.1.1 to 7, shall result in a maximum bending stress: F = 0.66F
b y
If meeting the requirements of this member of: a. Width-thickness ratio of unstiffened projecting elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 65/F .
y
b. Width-thickness ratio of stiffened elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 190/F .
y
c. The depth-thickness ratio of the web shall not exceed d/t = (640/F )[1 3.74(f /F )] when f /F
y a y a y
0.16
d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor 20000/(d/A )F .
f y f y
2. For noncompact and slender elements, section Q1.5.1.4.2 is followed. 3. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.60F
b y
B. Along Minor Axis: 1. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of section Q1.5.1.4.1, maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed the following value as per section Q1.5.1.4.3: F = 0.75F
b y
2. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of section Q1.5.1.4.1, except where b /2t > 65/F but is less than f f y 95/F , maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not y exceed: F = F [0.79 0.002(b /2t )F ]
b y f f y
848 STAAD.Pro
mz bz
+SMZf /F
bz
bz
1.0
when, f /F > 0.15, as per section Q1.6.1 of the code. Otherwise, equation Q1.6-2 must be satisfied: SFCf /F +SMYf /F
a a by by
+ SMZf /F
bz
bz
1.0
It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and [0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2)], but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy equation Q 1.6-1b: SFTf /(0.6F ) +SMYf /F
a y by by
+SMZf /F
bz
bz
1.0
Where SFC, SFT, SMZ, and SMY are stress limit coefficient parameters used to control the components of the interaction equations. Refer to Table 17B.1 for details.
ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code k = 5.34 + [4.00/(a/h)2], when a/h > 1.0 For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.
Table 17B.1 - Design Parameters for ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as AISC N690 1984 to use the ANSI/AISC N6901984 code for checking purposes. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
CAN
850 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
0 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.75 Cm value in local y & z axes
CT
Reduction Coefficient in computing net effective net area of an axially loaded tension member.
DFF
None "Deflection Length" / Maximum (Mandatory allowable local deflection for deflection check) Start Joint of member End Joint of member Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length"
DJ1 DJ2
ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code Parameter Name DMAX DMIN FU FYLD KY Default Value 45 inch 0.0 inch 60 KSI 36 KSI 1.0 Description
Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. Yield strength of steel in current units. Effective Length Factor for Compression in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. Effective Length Factor for Compression in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). Design for slenderness. 0. Check for slenderness 1. Suppress slenderness check
KZ
1.0
LY LZ MAIN
NSF PROFILE
1.0 None
Net section Factor for tension members Used to search for the lightest section for the profile(s) specified for member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Stress limit coefficient for com-
RATIO SFC
1.0 1.0
852 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
pression (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. SFT SMY 1.0 1.0 Stress limit coefficient for tension (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Stress limit coefficient for minor axis bending (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Stress limit coefficient for major axis bending (SLC) as found in Table Q 1.5.7.1. Spacing of stiffeners for plate girder design
SMZ
1.0
STIFF
STYPE
TMAIN
TRACK
0.0
Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0 = Minimum detail 1 = Intermediate detail level 2 = Maximum detail
UNB
Member Length
bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. UNT Member Length Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange.
Notes
1. All values are entered in the current units 2. parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used with the MEMBER SELECTION command
17B.6 Examples
These example problems are included for the verification of design results.
854 STAAD.Pro
Problem
A 10 ft long simply supported beam subject to axial (+/- 10 kip) and bending loads (3 kip/ft) in both the local y and z axis. The beam is a 5" diameter, Schedule 40 Pipe section made from Grade 36 steel.
Solution
Section Properties: A = 4.30 in.2
x
I = I = 15.20 in.4
y z
r = (15.20/4.30)1/2 = 1.88 in. O.D. = 5.56 in., t = 0.26 in. S = S = 15.20 in.42/5.56 in. = 5.468 in.3
x y
(Kl/r)
a
max y
<C
c c 2/[2(127.68)2]/{5/3 (63.83) c c
F = F [1.0 - (Kl/r)2/(2C 2]/[5/3 +3(Kl/r)/(8C ) - (Kl/r)3/(2C 3)] = 36.0 ksi{1.0 +3(63.83)/[8(127.68)] (63.83)3/[8(127.68)3]} = 36.0 ksi (0.875/1.835) = 17.06 ksi Actual Compressive Stress: f = 10 kip/4.30 in.2 = 2.33 ksi
a
=F
bz
Actual Bending Stress (include member selfweight in Y dir.): M = 0.315 kip/ft (10 ft)2/8 (12 in./ft) = 47.2 inkip
y z
M = 0.3 kip/ft (10 ft)2/8 (12 in./ft) = 45.0 inkip f = 47.2 inkip/5.468 in.3 = 8.63 ksi
by bz
Stress Ratio = 8.63 ksi/ 23.76 ksi = 0.363 < 1.0 Stress Ratio = 8.23 ksi/ 23.76 ksi = 0.346 < 1.0 Combined Stress Check: f /(0.6F ) +f /F +f /F = 3.10 ksi/[0.6(36 ksi)] +0.363 +0.346 = a y by by bz bz 0.853
f /F +f /F
by
by
+f /F
bz
bz
856 STAAD.Pro
Comparison
Table 17B.2 - ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code Verification Problem 1 Condition Tension Reference STAAD.Pro Difference 0.144 (0.107, CT = 1.0) Compression Tension +Bending 0.136 0.853 (0.817, CT = 1.0) 0.845 0.844 Negligible 0.136 0.815 None 2.51% 0.108
Compression +Bending
Input File
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 09-DEC-09 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 10 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 4.176E+006
POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 0.489024 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL UNIT INCHES KIP MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST PIPS50 UNIT FEET KIP CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 PINNED 2 FIXED BUT FX LOAD 1 TENSION ONLY JOINT LOAD 2 FX 10 LOAD 2 COMPRESSION ONLY JOINT LOAD 2 FX -10 LOAD 3 TENSION+BENDING SELFWEIGHT Y -1 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -0.3 JOINT LOAD 2 FX 10 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GZ 0.3 LOAD 4 COMPRESSION+BENDING SELFWEIGHT Y -1
858 STAAD.Pro
MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -0.3 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -10 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GZ 0.3 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT LOAD DATA PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES ALL UNIT INCHES KIP LOAD LIST 1 PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL
** FOLLOWING TO CHECK IF THE NET AREA IS USED IN CALCULATING TENSILE STRESS PARAMETER 11 CODE AISC N690 1984 FU 40 ALL CHECK CODE ALL LOAD LIST 2 PARAMETER 2 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL LOAD LIST 3 PARAMETER 3 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL
860 STAAD.Pro
CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL LOAD LIST 4 PARAMETER 4 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL
TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL LOAD LIST ALL PARAMETER 5 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 30 ALL UNT 30 ALL CT 0.75 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Output
The TRACK 2 output for the final parameter set is shown here: 862 STAAD.Pro
******************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 ST PIPS50 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS Q1.6-Eqn 2 0.844 4 10.00 C 44.84 47.02 120.00 |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 63.83 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 200.00 | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.71E+01 FCZ: 2.38E+01 FCY: 2.38E+01 FTZ: 2.38E+01 FTY: 2.38E+01 | | SHEAR: 1.44E+01 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 2.33E+00 FBZ: 8.60E+00 FBY: 8.20E+00 SHEAR: 9.12E-01 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) | | AXX: 4.30 AYY: 2.27 AZZ: 2.27 RZZ: 1.88 RYY: 1.88 | | SZZ: 5.46 SYY: 5.46 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 63.83 KL/R-Y: 63.83 UNL: 30.0 CMZ: 0.60 CMY: 0.60 | | CB: 1.00 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 1.00 | | CT: 0.75 STEEL TYPE: 0.0 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.108 1 1.00E+01 | INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCA-
| COMPRESSION 0.136 2 1.00E+01 | | COMP&BEND 0.844 4 1.00E+01 4.70E+01 4.48E+01 | | TEN&BEND 0.815 3 1.00E+01 4.70E+01 4.48E+01 | | SHEAR-Y 0.063 3 1.96E+00 | | SHEAR-Z 0.060 3 1.87E+00 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
Problem
A 12 ft long simply supported beam subject to uniform load (3 kip/ft). The beam is a W6x12 section made from Grade 36 steel.
Solution
Section Properties: A = 3.55 in.2 d = 6.03 in. t = 0.230 in.
w
S = 7.31 in.3
z
Actual Bending Stress (include member selfweight in Y dir.): M = 0.312 kip/ft (12 ft)2/8 (12 in./ft) = 67.4 inkip
z
bz
Stress Ratio = 9.22 ksi/ 23.76 ksi = 0.388 < 1.0, OK Allowable Shear Stress:
864 STAAD.Pro
vz
Comparison
Table 17B.3 - ANSI/AISC N690-1984 Code Verification Problem 3 Condition Reference STAAD.Pro Difference Bending Shear 0.388 0.094 0.387 0.094 Negligible None
Input File
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 09-DEC-09 END JOB INFORMATION INPUT WIDTH 79 UNIT FEET KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 12 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 4.176E+006 POISSON 0.3
DENSITY 0.489024 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST W6X12 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 2 PINNED LOAD 1 LOADTYPE NONE TITLE LOAD CASE 1 SELFWEIGHT Y -1 ALL MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -0.3 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT LOAD DATA PRINT MEMBER PROPERTIES ALL *UNIT KIP INCH PARAMETER 1 CODE AISC N690 1984 CB 1 ALL CMY 0 ALL CMZ 0 ALL * 36 & 58 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 1 ALL KZ 1 ALL MAIN 200 ALL NSF 1 ALL RATIO 1 ALL
866 STAAD.Pro
TMAIN 300 ALL TRACK 2 ALL UNB 3 ALL UNT 3 ALL UNIT KIP INCH CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
Output
The TRACK 2 output for the final parameter set is shown here:
STAAD.PRO CODE CHECKING - ( v1.0 ******************************************** ALL UNITS ARE - KIP MEMBER TABLE ING/ TION ======================================================================= 1 ST W6X12 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS Q1.6-Eqn 2 0.387 1 0.00 T 0.00 -67.40 72.00 |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 156.64 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 300.00 | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 6.09E+00 FCZ: 2.38E+01 FCY: 2.70E+01 FTZ: 2.38E+01 FTY: 2.70E+01 | | SHEAR: 1.44E+01 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 0.00E+00 FBZ: 9.20E+00 FBY: 0.00E+00 SHEAR: 0.00E+00 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) | | AXX: 3.55 AYY: 1.39 AZZ: 1.49 RZZ: 2.50 RYY: 0.92 | INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ FX MY RATIO/ MZ LOADLOCAAISC N690 1984)
7.33 SYY: 1.50 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 57.71 KL/R-Y:156.64 UNL: 36.0 CMZ: 0.60 CMY: 0.60 | | CB: 1.00 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 1.00 | | CT: 0.75 STEEL TYPE: 0.0 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | | COMPRESSION 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | | COMP&BEND 0.387 1 0.00E+00 6.74E+01 0.00E+00 | | TEN&BEND 0.000 1 0.00E+00 6.74E+01 0.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Y 0.094 1 1.87E+00 | | SHEAR-Z 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
| SZZ:
868 STAAD.Pro
Section 18
870 STAAD.Pro
18A.2.1Slenderness
As per clause XVII-2223 of NF-3000 1974, the slenderness ratio KL/r of compression members shall not exceed 200, and the slenderness ratio L/r of tension members, preferably should not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for lateral bracing members and other secondary members. The default limit for TRUSS members in Tension is set at 300.
18A.2.2Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as (0.60*F ), but not more y than (0.5*F ) on the Net area.
u
The Net Area (An) shall be determined in accordance with the clause XVII-2283 of NF-3000 1974, and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.
18A.2.3 Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns shall be as required by clause XVII2213 of NF-3000 1974. a. Gross Sections of Columns: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) <C,
c
Where:
872 STAAD.Pro
The above clauses are applicable only when the width-thickness ratio of the element satisfies all the sub-sections of clause XVII-2224 of NF-3000 1974. If the above-mentioned clauses are not satisfied, a. For un-stiffened compression element, a reduction factor, Q , is introduced. s Detailed values of Q for different shapes are given in the clause XVII-2225.2 s of NF-3000 1974. b. For stiffened compression element, a reduced effective width, b , is e introduced. 1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness:
Consequently, a reduction factor, Q , equal to the effective area divided by a the actual area is introduced. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or un-stiffened elements shall not exceed
Where:
18A.2.4Bending Stress
Allowable bending stress for tension and compression for a structural member, as given in XVII-2214 of NF-3000 1974 is: a. Along Major Axis: a. For Compact Sections, tension and compression on extreme fibers of compact hot rolled or built-up members symmetrical about and loaded in the plane of their minor axes and meeting the requirements of Subsection NF shall result in a maximum bending stress: F = 0.66*F
b y
If meeting the requirements of this member of: a. Width-thickness ratio of un-stiffened projecting elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 52.2/F .
y
b. Width-thickness ratio of stiffened elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 190/F .
y
c. The depth-thickness ratio of the web shall not exceed d/t = (412/F )[1 2.33(F /F )]
y a y
d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor f y 20000/(d/A )F .
f y
b. For noncompact and slender elements, clause XVII-2214.2 and XVII-2214.5 of NF-3000 1974 are followed respectively. c. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.60*F
b y
b. Along Minor Axis: For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of XVII2214.1(a) and (b) of NF-3000 1974, maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: F = 0.75*F
b y
874 STAAD.Pro
and
otherwise
It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and 0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2), but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy
18A.2.6Shear Stress
Allowable shear stress on the gross section [ref. XVII-2263.2 of NF-3000 1974] is calculated as
Where:
, when a/h < 1.0 , when a/h > 1.0 For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.
876 STAAD.Pro
Table 18A.1 - ASME NF 3000 Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as CODE NF3000 1974 or CODE NF3000 1977 Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
CAN
Used for Deflection Check only. 0 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type
CB
1.0
Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted.
CMY CMZ
0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member
DFF
DJ1
ASME NF 3000 - 1974 & 1977 Codes Parameter Name Default Value Description
for calculation of "Deflection Length" DJ2 DMAX End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for member calculation of "Deflection Length" 45 inch Maximum allowable depth. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Minimum allowable depth. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Yield strength of steel in current units. Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check NSF PROFILE 1.0 None Net Section Factor for tension member. Used in member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details.
DMIN
0.0 inch
FYLD FU KY KZ LY LZ MAIN
878 STAAD.Pro
Description
Member Spacing of stiffeners for plate length or girder design depth whichever is greater 240 for main member 300 for Truss member Slenderness limit under tension
TMAIN
TRACK
0.0
Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0. Minimum detail 1. Intermediate detail level 2. Maximum detail
UNB
Member Length
Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange.
UNT
Member Length
Refer to Section 2.5 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Code Checking. Refer to Section 5.48.2 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Code Checking command. Refer to Section 2.6 of the Technical Reference Manual for general information on Member Selection. Refer to Section 5.48.3 of the Technical Reference Manual for details the specification of the Member Selection command.
18A.6 Example
A cantilever beam of length 30 inch is loaded at its free end with 5 kip compressive load and 5 kip lateral load. The beam is assigned with W24X104 steel member and is designed in accordance with ASME NF3000 1974. The corresponding input of STAAD input editor file is shown as below:
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 18-JUN-08 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT INCHES KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 30 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 29000 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST W24X104
880 STAAD.Pro
CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -5 FY -5 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT SUPPORT REACTION PRINT JOINT DISPLACEMENTS PRINT MEMBER FORCES PARAMETER 1 CODE NF3000 1974 FYLD 36 ALL FU 58 ALL KY 0.9 ALL KZ 0.9 ALL NSF 0.85 ALL CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST W24X104 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS NF-74-EQN-21 0.032 1 5.00 C 0.00 150.00 0.00 |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 9.28 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 200.00 |
882 STAAD.Pro
18B.2.1 Slenderness
As per NF-3322.2(c), the slenderness ratio KL/r of compression members shall not exceed 200, and the slenderness ratio L/r of tension members, preferably should not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for lateral bracing members and other secondary members. The default limit for TRUSS members in Tension is set at 300.
18B.2.2 Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as (0.60*F ), but not more y than (0.5*F ) on the Effective Net area. u
The Net Area (A ) shall be determined in accordance with NF-3322.8(c)(1) - (a), n (b) and (c), and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The Effective Net Area (A ) of axially loaded tension members, where the load is e transmitted by bolts through some but not all of the cross-sectional elements of the member, shall be computed from the formula (ref. NF-3322.8(c)(1)(d)), A =C *A e t n Unless otherwise specified, the default value of the CT parameter is set as 0.75. The value of CT parameter for other conditions is described at section NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)(1), (2) and (3). The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.
18B.2.3 Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns, except those fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(1). The allowable compressive stress for columns fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(2). The allowable compressive stress for member elements other than columns constructed by any material, including austenitic stainless steel, shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(3). a. Gross Sections of Columns, except those fabricated of austenitic stainless steel: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) <C,
c
Where:
884 STAAD.Pro
b. Gross sections of columns fabricated from Austenitic Stainless steel: 1. When (Kl/r) 120,
c. Member elements other than columns: 1. For Plate Girder Stiffeners, F = 0.60F
a y
The above clauses are applicable only when the width-thickness ratio of the element satisfies all the sub-sections of NF-3322.2(d). If the above-mentioned clauses are not satisfied, a. For un-stiffened compression element, a reduction factor, Q , is introduced. s Detailed values of Q for different shapes are given in NF-3322.2(e)(2)(a) to s NF-3322.2(e)(2)(d). b. For stiffened compression element, a reduced effective width, b , is e introduced. 1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness:
Consequently, a reduction factor, Q , equal to the effective area divided by a the actual area is introduced. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or un-stiffened elements shall not exceed
Where:
886 STAAD.Pro
d/t = (640/F )[1 3.74(f /F )] when f /F <=0.16 y a y a y d/t = 257/F when f /F > 0.16 y a y d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor f y 20000/(d/A )F . f y 2. For noncompact and slender elements, NF-3322.1(d)(5) and NF3322.1(d)(3) are followed respectively. 3. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.60*F b y b. Along Minor Axis: 1. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF3322.1(d)(1)(a) and (b), maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: F = 0.75*F b y 2. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF3322.1(d)(1)(a), except where b /2t exceeds 65/F but is less than f f y 95/F , maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: y F = F [1.075 0.005(b /2t )F ] b y f f y
and
otherwise
It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and 0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2), but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy
, when a/h < 1.0 , when a/h > 1.0 For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.
888 STAAD.Pro
Member properties may also be specified using the User Table facility except for the General and Prismatic member. For more information on these facilities, refer to Section 1.7 the STAAD Technical Reference Manual.
Must be specified as NF3000 1989. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
CAN
Used for Deflection Check only. 0 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
type CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CT 0.75 Reduction Coefficient in computing effective net area of an axially loaded tension member. [Refer NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)] Cm value in local y & z axes
CMY CMZ
0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway None (Mandatory for deflection check) Start Joint of member End Joint of member 45 inch
DFF
DJ1
Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Maximum allowable depth, in current units. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Minimum allowable depth, in current units. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Yield strength of steel in current
DJ2 DMAX
DMIN
0.0 inch
FYLD
36 KSI
890 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
units. FU KY KZ LY 60 KSI 1.0 1.0 Member Length Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check NSF PROFILE 1.0 None Net Section Factor for tension member. Used in member selection. See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Spacing of stiffeners for plate girder design
LZ MAIN
RATIO STIFF
STYPE
TMAIN
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
member 300 for Truss member TRACK 0.0 Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0 = Minimum detail 1 = Intermediate detail level 2 = Maximum detail UNB Member Length Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange.
UNT
Member Length
892 STAAD.Pro
18B.6 Example
A cantilever beam of length 100 inch is loaded at its free end with 5 kip compressive load and a uniformly distributed load of 1 kip/inch over the whole span. The beam is assigned with B571806 steel member and is designed in accordance with ASME NF3000 1989. The corresponding input of STAAD input editor file is shown as below:
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 18-JUN-08 END JOB INFORMATION JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 360 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 29000 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST B571806 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1
JOINT LOAD 2 FX -5 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -1.0 0 100 PERFORM ANALYSIS PRINT SUPPORT REACTION PARAMETER 1 CODE NF3000 1989 STYPE 1 ALL FYLD 36 ALL KY 0.75 ALL KZ 0.75 ALL FU 58 ALL NSF 0.9 ALL CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST B571806 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS SHEAR Y 0.770 1 5.00 C 0.00 5000.00 0.00 |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 75.08 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 200.00 | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.13E+01 FCZ: 2.08E+01 FCY: 2.31E+01 FTZ: 2.16E+01 FTY: 2.31E+01 | | SHEAR: 5.18E+00 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.06E-01 FBZ: 5.86E+00 FBY: 0.00E+00 SHEAR: 3.99E+00 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) |
894 STAAD.Pro
| AXX: 47.00 AYY: 25.08 AZZ: 15.00 RZZ: 22.80 RYY: 3.60 | | SZZ: 853.77 SYY: 67.54 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 11.84 KL/R-Y: 75.08 UNL: 360.0 CMZ: 1.00 CMY: 1.00 | | CB: 1.75 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 0.90 | | CT: 0.75 STEEL TYPE: 1.0 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.005 1 5.00E+00 | | COMPRESSION 0.009 1 5.00E+00 | | COMP&BEND 0.290 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | TEN&BEND 0.000 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Y 0.770 1 1.00E+02 | | SHEAR-Z 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
896 STAAD.Pro
18C.2.1 Slenderness
As per NF-3322.2(c), the slenderness ratio KL/r of compression members shall not exceed 200, and the slenderness ratio L/r of tension members, preferably should not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for lateral bracing members and other secondary members. The default limit for TRUSS members in Tension is set at 300.
18C.2.2 Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as (0.60*F ), but not more y than (0.5*F ) on the Effective Net area. u
The Net Area (A ) shall be determined in accordance with NF-3322.8(c)(1) - (a), n (b) and (c), and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The Effective Net Area (A ) of axially loaded tension members, where the load is e transmitted by bolts through some but not all of the cross-sectional elements of the member, shall be computed from the formula (ref. NF-3322.8(c)(1)(d)), A =C *A e t n Unless otherwise specified, the default value of the CT parameter is set as 0.75. The value of CT parameter for other conditions is described at section NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)(1), (2) and (3). The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.
18C.2.3 Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns, except those fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(1). The allowable compressive stress for columns fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(2). The allowable compressive stress for member elements other than columns constructed by any material, including austenitic stainless steel, shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(3). a. Gross Sections of Columns, except those fabricated of austenitic stainless steel: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) <C,
c
Where:
898 STAAD.Pro
b. Gross sections of columns fabricated from Austenitic Stainless steel: 1. When (Kl/r) 120,
c. Member elements other than columns: 1. For Plate Girder Stiffeners, F = 0.60F
a y
The above clauses are applicable only when the width-thickness ratio of the element satisfies all the sub-sections of NF-3322.2(d). If the above-mentioned clauses are not satisfied, a. For un-stiffened compression element, a reduction factor, Q , is introduced. s Detailed values of Q for different shapes are given in NF-3322.2(e)(2)(a) to s NF-3322.2(e)(2)(d). In the case for angles or plates projecting from compression members and for projecting elements of compression flanges of girder, When ,
When
Where:
when h/t > 70, otherwise, kc = 1.0. b. For stiffened compression element, a reduced effective width, b , is e introduced. 1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness:
Consequently, a reduction factor, Q , equal to the effective area divided by a the actual area is introduced. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or un-stiffened elements shall not exceed
Where:
900 STAAD.Pro
plane of their minor axes and meeting the requirements of Subsection NF shall result in a maximum bending stress: F = 0.66*F b y If meeting the requirements of this member of: a. Width-thickness ratio of unstiffened projecting elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 65/F . y b. Width-thickness ratio of stiffened elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 190/F . y c. The depth-thickness ratio of the web shall not exceed d/t = (640/F )[1 3.74(f /F )] when f /F <=0.16 y a y a y d/t = 257/F when f /F > 0.16 y a y d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor f y 20000/(d/A )F . f y 2. For noncompact and slender elements, NF-3322.1(d)(5) and NF3322.1(d)(3) are followed respectively. 3. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.60*F b y b. Along Minor Axis: 1. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF3322.1(d)(1)(a) and (b), maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: F = 0.75*F b y 2. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF3322.1(d)(1)(a), except where b /2t exceeds 65/F but is less than f f y 95/F , maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: y F = F [1.075 0.005(b /2t )F ] b y f f y
proportioned to satisfy
and
otherwise
It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and 0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2), but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy
902 STAAD.Pro
, when a/h > 1.0 For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.
Must be specified as NF3000 1998. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the
Technical Reference Manual. CAN 0 Used for Deflection Check only. 0 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection occurs within the span between DJ1 and DJ2. 1 = Deflection check based on the principle that maximum deflection is of the cantilever type CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CMY CMZ CT 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.75 Cm value in local y & z axes
Reduction Coefficient in computing effective net area of an axially loaded tension member. [Refer NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)] "Deflection Length" / Maximum allowable local deflection Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length"
DFF
DJ1
904 STAAD.Pro
Default Value
Description
Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Maximum allowable depth, in current units. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Minimum allowable depth, in current units. Used only with the MEMBER SELECTION command. Yield strength of steel in current units. Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in zaxis (major). 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check
DMAX
DMIN
0.0 inch
FYLD FU KY KZ LY
LZ MAIN
NSF PROFILE
1.0 None
See Section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual for details. STIFF Member length or Spacing of stiffeners for depth whichever is plate girder design greater 0.0 0.0 = Normal Steel 1.0 = Austenitic Stainless Steel TMAIN 240 for main member 300 for Truss member TRACK 0.0 Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0 = Minimum detail 1 = Intermediate detail level 2 = Maximum detail RATIO UNB 1.0 Member Length Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating Slenderness limit under tension
STYPE
UNT
Member Length
906 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange. Notes 1. All values are entered in the current units. 2. The parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used with the MEMBER SELECTION command.
18C.6 Example
A cantilever beam of length 100 inch is loaded at its free end with 5 kip compressive load and a uniformly distributed load of 1 kip/inch over the whole span. The beam is assigned with B571806 steel member and is designed in accordance with ASME NF3000 1998. The corresponding input of STAAD input editor file is shown as below:
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 18-JUN-08 END JOB INFORMATION
UNIT INCHES KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 100 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 29000 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST B571806 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -5 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -1.0 0 100 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER 1 CODE NF3000 1998 STYPE 1 ALL FYLD 36 ALL KY 0.75 ALL
908 STAAD.Pro
KZ 0.75 ALL FU 58 ALL NSF 0.9 ALL CT 0.85 ALL CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
INCH (UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED) RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST B571806 (AISC SECTIONS) PASS SHEAR Y 0.635 1 5.00 C 0.00 5000.00 0.00 |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SLENDERNESS CHECK: ACTUAL RATIO: 20.85 ALLOWABLE RATIO: 200.00 | | ALLOWABLE STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.20E+01 FCZ: 2.22E+01 FCY: 2.31E+01 FTZ: 2.22E+01 FTY: 2.31E+01 | | SHEAR: 6.28E+00 | | ACTUAL STRESSES: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | AXIAL: 1.06E-01 FBZ: 5.86E+00 FBY: 0.00E+00 SHEAR: 3.99E+00 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) | | AXX: 47.00 AYY: 25.08 AZZ: 15.00 RZZ: 22.80 RYY: 3.60 | | SZZ: 853.77 SYY: 67.54 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 3.29 KL/R-Y: 20.85 UNL: 100.0 CMZ: 1.00 CMY: 1.00 | | CB: 1.75 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 0.90 | | CT: 0.85 STEEL TYPE: 1.0 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.005 1 5.00E+00 | | COMPRESSION 0.009 1 5.00E+00 | | COMP&BEND 0.272 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | TEN&BEND 0.000 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Y 0.635 1 1.00E+02 | | SHEAR-Z 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | |-----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
18D.2.1 Slenderness
As per NF-3322.2(c), the slenderness ratio KL/r of compression members shall not exceed 200, and the slenderness ratio L/r of tension members, preferably should not exceed 240 for main members and 300 for lateral bracing members and other secondary members. The default limit for TRUSS members in Tension is set at 300.
910 STAAD.Pro
18D.2.2 Tension
Allowable tensile stress on the Net section is calculated as (0.60F ), but not more y than (0.5F ) on the Effective Net area.
u
The Net Area (A ) shall be determined in accordance with NF-3322.8(c)(1) - (a), n (b) and (c), and the NSF parameter can be utilized for that. The Effective Net Area (A ) of axially loaded tension members, where the load is e transmitted by bolts through some but not all of the cross-sectional elements of the member, shall be computed from the formula (ref. NF-3322.8(c)(1)(d)), A =C A
e t n
Unless otherwise specified, the default value of the CT parameter is set as 0.75. The value of CT parameter for other conditions is described at section NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)(1), (2) and (3). The provisions for Pin-connected and Threaded tensile member are not implemented in STAAD.
18D.2.3 Compression
The allowable compressive stress for columns, except those fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(1). The allowable compressive stress for columns fabricated from austenitic stainless steel shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(2). The allowable compressive stress for member elements other than columns constructed by any material, including austenitic stainless steel, shall be as required by NF-3322.1(c)(3). A. Gross Sections of Columns, except those fabricated of austenitic stainless steel: 1. On gross section of axially loaded compression members, when (Kl/r) C,
c
c 2E/[23(kL/r)2] 12
B. Gross sections of columns fabricated from Austenitic Stainless steel: 1. When (Kl/r) 120, F = F [0.47 - (Kl/r)/444]
a y
C. Member elements other than columns: 1. For Plate Girder Stiffeners, F = 0.60F
a y
The above clauses are applicable only when the width-thickness ratio of the element satisfies all the sub-sections of NF-3322.2(d).. If the above-mentioned clauses are not satisfied, a. For un-stiffened compression element, A reduction factor Q is introduced. Detailed values of Q for different shapes s s are given in NF-3322.2(e)(2)(a) to NF-3322.2(e)(2)(d). In the case for angles or plates projecting from compression members and for projecting elements of compression flanges of girder, When 95/(F /kc)1/2 < b/t < 195/(F /kc)1/2, Q = 1.293 y y s 0.00309(b/t)(F /kc)1/2
y
912 STAAD.Pro
Where: kc = 4.05/[(h/t)0.46] if h/t >70, otherwise kc = 1.0. b. For stiffened compression element, A reduced effective width b is introduced.
e
1. For the flanges of square and rectangular sections of uniform thickness: b = 253t/(f){1 - 50.3/[(b/t)(f)]} b
e
Consequently, a reduction factor Q is introduced and is equal to the a effective area divided by the actual area. Combining both these factors, allowable stress for axially loaded compression members containing stiffened or unstiffened elements shall not exceed F = Q Q [1 - (Kl/r)2/(2C 2)]F / {5/3 + [3(Kl/r)/(8C )] a s a c y c [(Kl/r)3/(8C 3)]}
c
a. Width-thickness ratio of unstiffened projecting elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 65/F .
y
b. Width-thickness ratio of stiffened elements of the compression flange shall not exceed 190/F .
y
c. The depth-thickness ratio of the web shall not exceed d/t = (640/F )[1 3.74(f /F )] when f /F 0.16
y a y a y
d. The laterally unsupported length of the compression flange of members other than box-shaped members shall not exceed the value of 76b /F nor 20000/(d/A )F .
f y f y
2. For noncompact and slender elements, NF-3322.1(d)(5) and NF3322.1(d)(3) are followed respectively. 3. For box-type flexural members, maximum bending stress is: F = 0.75F
b y
B. Along Minor Axis: 1. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF-3322.1(d)(1)(a) and (b), maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not exceed: F = 0.75F
b y
2. For doubly symmetrical members (I shaped) meeting the requirements of NF-3322.1(d)(1)(a), except where b /2t > 65/F but is less than f f y 95/F , maximum tensile and compressive bending stress shall not y exceed: F = F [1.075 0.005(b /2t )F ]
b y f f y
914 STAAD.Pro
and
otherwise
It should be noted that during code checking or member selection, if f /F exceeds a a unity, the program does not compute the second and third part of the formula, because this would result in a misleadingly liberal ratio. The value of the coefficient Cm is taken as 0.85 for side-sway and 0.6 - 0.4(M1/M2), but not less than 0.4 for no side-sway. Members subjected to both axial tension and bending stress are proportioned to satisfy
For actual shear on the web, the gross section is taken as the product of the total depth and the web thickness. For shear on the flanges, the gross section is taken as the total flange areas.
Must be specified as NF3000 2004 Specified design code is followed for code checking purpose. Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical
916 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
Reference Manual. CB 1.0 Bending coefficient dependent upon moment gradient 0.0 = CB is calculated itself Any other user-defined value is accepted. CMY CMZ 0.85 for sidesway and calculated for no sidesway 0.75 Cm value in local y & z axes
CT
Reduction Coefficient in computing effective net area of an axially loaded tension member. [Refer NF3322.8(c)(1)(d)] "Deflection Length" / Maximum allowable local deflection
DFF
DJ1
Start Joint of the member End Joint of the member 45 inch 0.0 inch
Joint No. denoting starting point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of "Deflection Length" Maximum allowable depth Minimum allowable depth
DJ2
DMAX DMIN
ASME NF 3000 - 2004 Code Parameter Name FYLD FU KY KZ LY LZ MAIN Default Value 36 KSI 60 KSI 1.0 1.0 Member Length Member Length 0.0 Description
Yield strength of steel in current units. Ultimate tensile strength of steel in current units. K value in local y-axis. Usually, this is minor axis. K value in local z-axis. Usually, this is major axis. Length to calculate slenderness ratio for buckling about local Y axis. Same as above except in z-axis (major). 0.0 = check for slenderness 1.0 = suppress slenderness check
Net Section Factor for tension member. Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Spacing of stiffeners for plate girder design
STYPE
TRACK
0.0
Controls the levels of detail to which results are reported. 0. Minimum detail 1. Intermediate detail level
918 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
2. Maximum detail UNB Member Length Unsupported length of the bottom* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the bottom flange. Unsupported length of the top* flange for calculating allowable bending compressive stress. Will be used only if flexural compression on the top flange.
UNT
Member Length
Notes 1. All values are entered in the current units. 2. The parameters DMAX and DMIN are only used with the MEMBER SELECTION command.
18D.6 Example
A cantilever beam of length 100 inch is loaded at its free end with 5 kip compressive load and a uniformly distributed load of 1 kip/inch over the whole span. The beam is assigned with B571806 steel member and is designed in accordance with ASME NF3000 2004. The corresponding input of STAAD input editor file is shown as below: International Design Codes Manual 919
STAAD SPACE START JOB INFORMATION ENGINEER DATE 18-JUN-08 END JOB INFORMATION UNIT INCHES KIP JOINT COORDINATES 1 0 0 0; 2 100 0 0; MEMBER INCIDENCES 1 1 2; DEFINE MATERIAL START ISOTROPIC STEEL E 29000 POISSON 0.3 DENSITY 76.8195 ALPHA 1.2E-005 DAMP 0.03 END DEFINE MATERIAL MEMBER PROPERTY AMERICAN 1 TABLE ST B571806 CONSTANTS MATERIAL STEEL ALL SUPPORTS 1 FIXED LOAD 1 JOINT LOAD 2 FX -5 MEMBER LOAD 1 UNI GY -1.0 0 100 PERFORM ANALYSIS PARAMETER 1
920 STAAD.Pro
CODE NF3000 2004 STYPE 1 ALL FYLD 36 ALL KY 0.75 ALL KZ 0.75 ALL FU 58 ALL NSF 0.9 ALL CT 0.85 ALL CB 0 ALL TRACK 2 ALL CHECK CODE ALL FINISH
|----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | SECTION PROPERTIES: (UNIT - INCH) | | AXX: 47.00 AYY: 25.08 AZZ: 15.00 RZZ: 22.80 RYY: 3.60 | | SZZ: 853.77 SYY: 67.54 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | PARAMETER: (UNIT - KIP INCH) | | KL/R-Z: 3.29 KL/R-Y: 20.85 UNL: 100.0 CMZ: 1.00 CMY: 1.00 | | CB: 1.75 FYLD: 36.00 FU: 58.00 NET SECTION FACTOR: 0.90 | | CT: 0.85 STEEL TYPE: 1.0 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------| | CRITICAL LOADS FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (UNITS KIP -INCH) | | CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY | | TENSION 0.005 1 5.00E+00 | | COMPRESSION 0.009 1 5.00E+00 | | COMP&BEND 0.272 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | TEN&BEND 0.000 1 5.00E+00 5.00E+03 0.00E+00 | | SHEAR-Y 0.635 1 1.00E+02 | | SHEAR-Z 0.000 1 0.00E+00 | |----------------------------------------------------------------------------|
922 STAAD.Pro
Section 19
Norwegian Codes
924 STAAD.Pro
stability check (buckling) lateral buckling check yield check (von Mises) stability check including local plate buckling of un-stiffened pipe walls according to NPD
wide flange profiles (HEA, HEB, IPE etc.) pipe (OD xx ID xx) tube (RHS, HUP) channel angle type (only RA) rectangular massive box (prismatic) user table (wide flange, I-sections, tapered I, tube, channel and RA angle)
The code check is not available for the following cross-section types:
l
Double angles Tapered tubes Prismatic sections with too few section parameters defined Other sections that are not in the available list above
NS 3472 and NPD code checking covered in this document are available through two separate STAAD.Pro Code check packages.
This document is not a lecture in use of NS 3472 or NPD. This document explains how, and which parts of, the Norwegian steel codes that have been implemented in STAAD.Pro. When L-sections are used, the Code Check requires RA angle definition. Weld design is not included in the Norwegian code checks. The prismatic section defined in the code check (rectangular massive box) is not identical to the general prismatic profile defined in the STAAD.Pro analysis package.
EDR does not accept any liability for loss or damage from or in consequence for use of the program.
Nomenclature
NS - refers to NS 3472 ref. [1] NS2 - refers to NS 3472 ref. [6] NPD - refers to NPD94 ref. [5]
References
1. NS 3472 3.utg. 2001 Prosjektering av stlkonstruksjoner Beregning og dimensjonering 2. STAAD.Pro Technical Reference Manual, Release 2002 3. NS 3472 1.utg. 1973 Prosjektering av stlkonstruksjoner Beregning og dimensjonering 4. Roark &Young`s 5th edition 5. NPD utg. 1994 Veiledning om utforming, beregning og dimensjonering av stlkonstruksjoner. Sist endret 1. oktober 1993.
926 STAAD.Pro
The following sections describe the salient features of the design approach. Members are proportioned to resist the design loads without exceeding the characteristic stresses or capacities and the most economic section is selected on the basis of the least weight criteria. It is generally assumed that the user will take care of the detailing requirements like the provision of stiffeners and check the local effects like flange buckling, web crippling, etc. The user is allowed complete control over the design process through the use of the parameters listed in Table 2.1. Default values of parameters will yield reasonable results in most circumstances. However, the user should control the design and verify results through the use of the design parameters.
928 STAAD.Pro
Torsional properties for cross sections (torsional constant and warping constant) are calculated using formulae from NS 3472. This results in slightly conservative estimates of torsional parameters. The program will automatically select the maximum moment in cases where M is less than M .
vd zd
NS 3472
The material factor default value is 1.10. Other values may be input with the MF parameter. The nominal stresses should satisfy
NPD
The general requirement is according to NPD 3.1.1. For stability the NPD 3.1.1 and 3.1.3 requires that the structural coefficient is considered.
Where:
f = characteristic capacity
k
kd m
= design capacity
= material coefficient
m mk
= structural coefficient
is default set to 1.10. shall be equal to 1.0 for frames. For pipe members is a function of the mk mk reduced slenderness. In the STAAD.Pro implemented NPD code this is calculated automatically.
930 STAAD.Pro
the interaction formulae in NPD 3.4.4.1. The stability requirement is given in NPD 3.4.7.
Must be secified as either NS3472 for NS or NPD for NPD (NOR may also be used for both). Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BEAM
0.0
Parameter BEAM 1.0 ALL Sec. NS tells the program to calculate 12.2.2 von Mises at 13 sections along each member, and up to 8 points at each section. (Depending on what kind of shape is used.)
Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD Parameter Name Default Value Description Reference
Note: Must be set to 1.0 BY 1.0 Buckling length coefficient, Fig. NS 3 for weak axis buckling (y-y) Sec. NS (NOTE: BY > 0.0) 12.3 Buckling length coefficient, , for strong axis buckling (z-z) (NOTE: BZ > 0.0) Lateral buckling coefficient, Y. Used to calculate the ideal buckling moments, M
vi
BZ
1.0
Fig. NS 3 Sec. NS 12.3 Sec. NS2 A5.5.2 Fig. NS2 A5.5.2a)e) Valid for the NPD code only Sec. NS 12.3.4 Fig. NS 6. Fig. NS 3 Sec. NS 12.2 NS Table 11
CB
1.0
CMY
1.0
Water depth in meters for hydrostatic pressure calculation for pipe members for sections in conLT nection with lateral buckling Buckling curve coefficient, a about local z-axis (strong axis). Represent the a, a0, b, c, d curve. Maximum allowable depth of steel section. Minimum allowable depth of steel section. Yield strength of steel, fy (St37) [N/mm2 ]
CMZ
0.49
CY CZ
932 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Description
Reference
Sec. NPD 3.1 Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. 0.0 = No sidesway. calculated. > 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis weak axis =SSY
M
RATIO SSY
1.0 0.0
SSZ
0.0
0.0 = No sidesway. calSec. NS culated. > 0.0 = Sidesway in 12.3.4 local y-axis weak axis Tab. NS M 12 Sec NPD 3.2.1.4 0.0 = Supress critical member stresses. 1.0 = Print all critical member stresses, i.e., DESIGN VALUES 2.0 = Print von Mises stresses. 9.0 = Large output, 1 page for each member. See section 7 and Appendix A for complete list of available TRACKs and print examples. Effective length for lateral Sec. NS buckling calculations (spec- 12.3 ify buckling length). Distance between fork supports or between effective side supports for the beam
TRACK
0.0
UNL
Member length
The parameter CMY will, when given with negative value, define an inside pressure in pipe members. The pressure corresponds to given water depth in meters. The parameter CB defines the value with respect to calculation of the ideal lateral buckling moment for single symmetric wide flange profiles, ref. NS app. 5.2.2.
Example
Note: This is a partial example containing only the information pertaining to the Norwegian steel design code; used at the end of the input file.
* CODE CHECK ACCORDING TO NS3472 PARAMETERS CODE NS3472 BEAM 1.0 ALL FYLD 340 ALL MF 1.10 ALL CY 0.49 MEMB 1 CZ 0.49 MEMB 1 BY 0.9 MEMB 1 BZ 0.7 MEMB 1 SSY 1.1 MEMB 1 SSZ 1.3 MEMB 1 CB 0.9 MEMB 1 RATIO 1.0 ALL TRACK 9.0 ALL UNIT KNS METER LOAD LIST 1 CHECK CODE MEMB 1 FINISH
934 STAAD.Pro
Buckling
n
max
+k m +k m 1
z z y y
Lateral Buckling
i = z,y
The equivalent moment factor (for z and y) is calculated dependant on moment distributions as shown in the following table:
936 STAAD.Pro
( )
LT
= 1.8 - 0.7
M0
= 1.3
M0
= 1.4
The user can override the calculated factor with the following parameters: =SSY
y z
=SSZ
concern double symmetric cross sections where y is given in NS fig. A5.5.2, (input parameter CB), L = member length for lateral buckling (input parameter UNL), Cw and Ix , see section 5. For single symmetric cross sections, the ideal lateral buckling moment is
Where:
= distance from profile CoG to point where the load is acting, assumed to be on top flange. The parameter (ref NS fig. A5.5.2.g) is controlled by the input parameter CB.
938 STAAD.Pro
940 STAAD.Pro
Fig B - -koeffisienter for utraget bjelke med enkel last og fordelt last. Stiplede kurver gjelder last p overflens.
Where:
and
Where:
N and N are found from NS 3472 fig. 5.4.la C-curve for y- and zkyd kzd axis, respectively.
Possible lateral buckling effects and torsional buckling (NS A5.4.5) is not included in the code check. This has to be evaluated by the user separately.
942 STAAD.Pro
bz
= M /W
z a
z b z a b
warp
IR = M
/M
vd
+M
y,max
/M
yd
1.0
mk
= structural coefficient
B = bending amplification factor about the Z-axis B = bending amplification factor about the Y-axis
y
l = kl
k
k = effective length factor f = characteristic buckling capacity according to NS fig. 5.4.1a, curve k A.
944 STAAD.Pro
Where:
= design axial stress in the shell due to axial forces (tension positive)
a
= design bending stress in the shell due to global bending moment b (tension positive) = = design circumferential stress in the shell due to external p pressure (tension positive) = design shear stress in the shell due to torsional moments and shear S force. f , f , f and f are the elastic buckling resistances of curved panels ea eb ep e or circular cylindrical shells subjected to axial compression forces, global bending moments, lateral pressure, and torsional moments and/or shear forces respectively.
where k is a buckling coefficient dependent on loading condition, aspect ratio, curvature, boundary conditions, and geometrical imperfections. The buckling coefficient is:
The values of , and p are given in Table 4.1 for the most important loading cases. Table 19A.3 - Table 4.1 Buckling coefficients for un-stiffened cylindrical shells Axial stress 1 0.702 Z p
Bending
0.702 Z
Torsion and shear force 5.34 0.856 Z0.75 0.6 Lateral pressure Hyrdostatic pressure 4 2 1.04 Z0.5 1.04 Z0.5 0.6 0.6
946 STAAD.Pro
For long shells the elastic buckling resistance against shear stresses is independent
Where:
= slenderness of the cylinder as a column. B, , and are calculated in accordance with NPD 3.2.2.
a b
F actual shear in local z-direction at section M max. torsional moment along member
x
M actual bending about local z-axis at section For all profiles other than angle sections absolute values of the stresses are used. For double symmetric profiles there will always be one stresspoint. The stresses are calculated in several stress points at each member section. At each stress point the von Mises stress is checked as follows:
948 STAAD.Pro
Where:
tot p
=| +
x
by
bz
Section Properties
A , I , I and I are taken from STAAD.Pro database
x x y z
ref. NS app. C3 T = dA z
y z
T = dA y
In general wide flange profiles are not suitable for large torsional moments. The reported torsional stresses are indicative only. For members with major torsional stresses a separate evaluation has to be carried out. Actual torsional stress distribution is largely dependent on surface curvature at stress point and warping resistance.
950 STAAD.Pro
Section properties
A , I , I and I are taken from STAAD.Pro database, except for x x y z tapered sections where these values are calculated for each section checked. (i.e., Iz, Iy values are taken from the middle of the member.) A = h s Applied in STAAD.Pro print option PRINT MEMBER y STRESSES
ref. NS app. C3
T = dA z
y z
T = dA y
952 STAAD.Pro
In general wide flange profiles are not suitable for large torsional moments. The reported torsional stresses are indicative only. For members with major torsional stresses a separate evaluation has to be carried out. Actual torsional stress distribution is largely dependent on surface curvature at stress point and warping resistance.
Section properties
d = D - 2t r = 0.5 ( D-t )
z y (D2 - d2) x
A = A = 0.5A
x z
Note: In the STAAD.Pro analysis package slightly different values are used for A , A and I , however this has insignificant influence y z x on the force distribution. A = A = 0.6A
Y z
I = 2R3t
x
954 STAAD.Pro
Section Properties
956 STAAD.Pro
958 STAAD.Pro
Axes y and z are principal axes. Axes u and w are local axes.
Section forces
The section forces from the STAAD.Pro analysis are about the principle axis y and z. The second moment of area (Ty L TZ): T =AZ
y z
T =AY
960 STAAD.Pro
962 STAAD.Pro
Note: Note that b may not be much greater than h. If that is the case, define the member with h > b and Beta angle 90 instead.
Section Properties
ref. [4] tab. 20, case 4 at midpoint the largest side i.e., point 2
964 STAAD.Pro
below called GEOM1. This file is used as input in the second run. The file is an editable ACSII file saved under the file name given in the CODE NPD parameter. The TRACK parameter is then set to 98 which directs the program to read from the file GEOM1 file and use it as input to the second run, i.e., the joint capacity checking. The program will check the capacity for both chord members entering the joint. The local y and z moments will be transformed into the plane defined by the joint itself and the far end joints of the brace and chord, defined as in- and out-of plane moments. The ASCII file should be edited to reflect the correct classification of the joints, gap, can or stub dimensions, yield stress and other geometric options if required. The program will not change the brace or chord definition if this is changed or modified in the input file GEOM1. See Appendix A page xx for GEOM1 example file. Joint classification parameters in the file GEOM1 are: KO K joint overlapped KG K joint with gap TY T or Y joint X X joint Input example for the classification run.
*CLASSIFICATION OF JOINTS, TRACK 99 UNITS MM NEWTON PARAMETER CODE NPD GEOM1 FYLD 350 ALL TRACK 99 ALL BEAM 1.0 ALL CHECK CODE ALL
The following symbols are used: T = Cord wall thickness t = Brace wall thickness R = Outer radius of chord r = Outer radius of brace = Angel between chord and considered brace D = Outer diameter of chord d = Outer diameter of brace a = Gap (clear distance) between considered brace and nearest loadcarrying brace measured along chord outer surface = r/R g = R/T g = a/D f = Yield stress
y
Q = Factor
f
Q d = See table 6.1 N = Design axial force in brace M = Design in-plane bending moment in brace
IP
OP
N = Characteristic axial load capacity of brace (as governed by the k chord strength) M = Characteristic out-of-plane bending moment capacity of brace OPk (as governed by the chord strength)
ax IP
966 STAAD.Pro
OP
This section gives design formulae for simple tubular joints without overlap and without gussets, diaphragms or stiffeners. Tubular joints in a space frame structure shall satisfy:
Q is given in Table 6.1. Qf is a factor to account for the nominal longitudinal stress u in the chord.
Type of load in brace member Axial In-plane bending Out-ofplane bending 3.2/(1-0.81)
T and Y X K
5.0()
0.90(2+21)Q
When 0.9, Q is set to 1.0. This is also applicable for moment loading. For f cases with tension in the chord, Qf is set to 1.0. This is also applicable for moment loading. The brace end moments shall be accounted for in the following cases: a. Out-of-plane bending moment when > 0.85 b. When the brace acts as a cantilever c. When the rotational stiffness of the connection is considered in the determination of effective buckling length, and / or the structural coefficient mk = 1.00 for the beam-column design of the brace or chord. See Section 3.1.3. The characteristic capacity of the brace subjected to in-plane bending moment shall be determined by:
The characteristic capacity of the brace subjected to out-of-plane bending moment shall be determined by:
968 STAAD.Pro
For combined axial and bending loads in the brace, the following interaction equation should be satisfied:
For overlapping tubular joints without gussets, diaphragms, or stiffeners, the total load component normal to the chord, NN, shall not exceed
where (see NPD fig. 3.10) l = circumference for that portion of the brace in contact with the chord l (actual length) l = circumference of brace contact with chord, neglecting presence of overlap N = characteristic axial load capacity of brace
k
t = the lesser of the throat thickness of the overlapping weld or the w thickness t of the thinner brace l = length as shown in NPD fig. 3.10
2
The above formula for the capacity of overlapping joints is valid only for K joints, where compression in a brace is essentially balanced by tension in brace(s) in the same side of the joint.
Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NS 3472 / NPD Table 19A.5 - Available TRACKs TRACK no. 0 1 2 3 9 Description
Brief print of member utilizations (2 lines for each member) sorted with highest utilized members first Based on TRACK 3 with additional information regarding stability factors and capacities Simple print of stresses, incl von Mises stress Brief print of member utilizations (2 lines for each member) Comprehensive print with detailed information about member and member utilization(one page for each member) Used in connection with tubular joint check according to NPD. This TRACK identifies tubular joints to be checked and classifies all members entering the joint as T connection Used in connection with tubular joint check according to NPD. This TRACK performs the joint capacity check Prints member end forces for members entering each joint (at the end of the member connected to the joint) Prints maximum and minimum member end forces (axial force defines max and min) at member end 1 Prints maximum and minimum member end forces (axial force defines max and min) at member end 2
99
98 49 31 32
970 STAAD.Pro
TRACK = 1.0
972 STAAD.Pro
TRACK = 2.0
TRACK = 3.0
TRACK = 9.0
Member in tension:
974 STAAD.Pro
Member in compression:
976 STAAD.Pro
978 STAAD.Pro
TRACK = 98
980 STAAD.Pro
TRACK = 31
TRACK = 32
982 STAAD.Pro
The code check is available for the pipe cross sections only. The design of conical transitions and joints with joint cans is not performed.
General Provisions
The general safety check is per Section 4. Checks are made to ensure that the design action effect (S ) is less than or equal to the design resistance (R ):
d d
S R
d
The design resistance is evaluated for each condition and this check is applied as described in the following sections.
Tubular Members
Clause 6.3.1 deals with the general considerations while using tubular members. Warning: Only tubular sections can be used with the N-004 code in STAAD.Pro. A warning is presented for any other section type. The dimensions of the tubular sections are limited as follows:
l
The thickness t 6 mm. The thickness t <150 mm. The slenderness ratio of the cross section D/t < 120. Where D is the diameter and t is the wall thickness of the section.
If any of these conditions are not met for a member selected for design, a warning will be issued by the engine and the design of that member is aborted. Note: N-004 uses Y to define the action effects that is in plane and Z to define out of plane effects. This is the opposite to what STAAD uses, where Z defines the in plane effects and Y the out of plane effects. This document will follow the STAAD.Pro convention for the Z and Y axes.
984 STAAD.Pro
The N-004 code also segregates members into those that are subject to hydrostatic pressure and those that are not subject to hydrostatic pressure. The program allows you to specify whether a member is subject to hydrostatic pressure or not and, if so, to specify the hydrostatic pressure for the element. By default the program will assume that all members are not subject to any hydrostatic pressure. The design parameter HYD is used to specify the maximum water level with respect to the origin. If the HYD parameter is specified, the program will take that to be the water level and will evaluate the pressure distribution on each element assuming a linear increase in pressure with depth (The density of water is assumed to be 9.8 KN/m3). Also, if the HYD parameter is specified, the program will assume that the hydrostatic loads have not been included in the analysis. For members that are subject to a combination of loads (i.e., bending plus compression) along with a hydrostatic pressure, the design will be done according to Clause 6.3.9 of the code. In the absence of any hydrostatic pressure on the member the design will be performed in accordance with Clause 6.3.8 of the code.
t,Rd
= A f /
y
Axial Compression
Clause 6.3.3 states that tubular members subject to axial compression shall satisfy the following condition:
N Where: N
Sd
c,Rd
= A f /
c
Sd
The design axial compressive strength for a member that is not subject to any hydrostatic pressure will be taken as the smaller of in plane or out of plane buckling strengths determined by the equations given below: f = [1.0 - 028 2]f when 1.34
c c y
f =
0.9/2
cl E
E = Young's modulus of elasticity = 2.1x105 MPa k = Effective length factor, refer to Clause 6.3.8.2 l = Longer unbraced length in y or z direction i = Radius of gyration. The characteristic local buckling strength is determined from: f = f when f /f
cl y y cle
when f /f
y cle
Where: f
cle e
986 STAAD.Pro
D = Outside diameter t = wall thickness For a member that is subject to pure compression, if f /f > 0.170, the section will y cle be classed as a CLASS 4 (slender section). In such cases, the value of the material factor ( ) used in the above checks is increased according to equation 6.22 (Cl. m 6.3.7) of the code.
Bending
Clause 6.3.4 states that tubular members subject to pure bending alone shall satisfy: M Where: M
Sd Sd
Rd
=f
W/
f = [1.13 - 2.58 f D/(E t)] Z/W f when 0.0517 < f D/(E t) m y y y 0.1034 f = [0.94 - 0.76 f D/(E t)] Z/W f when 0.1034 < f D/(E t) m y y y 120 f /E
y
Shear
Clause 6.3.5 states that tubular members subject to shear shall satisfy: V
Sd
Rd
= A f /(23
y
m)
Where: V
Sd
f = Yield strength
y
When torsional shear stresses are present, the following condition shall also be satisfied: M Where: M
T,Sd T,Sd
T,Rd
= 2 I f /(D3
py
m)
Hydrostatic Pressure
Clause 6.3.6 states that tubular members subject to an external pressure shall primarily be checked for hoop buckling. The condition to be satisfied is:
p,Sd
h,Rd
= f /
h
m)
Where: p
p,Sd Sd
=p
Sd
D/(2 t)
m)
> 2.44 f
f = 0.7 f (f /f f =f
he
y he y he
y 0.4 when )
2.44 f f
y
he
> 0.55 f
when f
0.55 f
y he
= 2C E t/D
h
Where:
988 STAAD.Pro
C = 0.44 t/D + 0.21 (D/t)3/4 when 0.825 D/t <1.6 D/t C = 0.737/( - 0.579) when 1.5 < 0.825 D/t C = 0.8 when <1.5 = Geometric Parameter = L/D(2 D/t) L = Length of tubular member between stiffening rings, diaphragms, or end connections.
Where: M M N
y,Sd z,Sd
is the design bending moment about the y axis (out-of plane axis) is the design bending moment about the z axis (in plane axis)
Sd Rd
is the design axial force is the moment resistance (as determined by Clause 6.3.4)
N is the tension capacity of the section (as determined by Clause t,Rd 6.3.2)
and
Where: N
Sd
C and C are the reduction factors corresponding to the Y and Z my mz axes respectively. You may specify a value for these using the CMY and CMZ design parameters, respectively (default is 0.85 for both). N and N are the Euler buckling loads about y & z axes and are ey ez given by:
k is the effective length factor and is given in table 6-2 of the code. N
cl, Rd
f is the characteristic local buckling strength(as determined by Clause cl 6.3.3) The reduction factors used in this clause depend on the structural element type and will be as given in Table 6-2 of N-004. This requires the member to be classified under any one of the section types given in the table.
990 STAAD.Pro
M /M
If the member is subject to shear forces due to torsion along with bending moments, the condition to be satisfied is: M /M
Sd Sd Red,Rd Red,Rd
M /M Where: M f
Red,Rd
=W f
m
m,Red
m,Red T,Sd
= f [1 - 3(
T,Sd
=M
y
/(2
T,Sd d R2 t)
/f )2]
f = f /
d
program will assume that the hydrostatic forces have not been included in the analysis and will perform the necessary checks as per Method A in code. If, on the other hand, the HYD parameter has not been specified, the program will use the section forces and use Method B in the code.
q,Sd
Where: is the design axial stress, excluding any axial a,Sd compression from hydrostatic pressure. is the design axial compressive stress due to q,Sd hydrostatic pressure. (i.e., the axial load arising from the hydrostatic pressure being applied as nodal loads). f f
my,Sd mz,Sd
th,RD
mh,RD
B=
psd
/f
h,Rd h y a,Sd
= 5 - 4 f /f
<
q,Sd
992 STAAD.Pro
Where: f
cl,Rd
= f /
cl
f is the characteristic local buckling strength(as cl determined by Clause 6.3.3) Additionally, when:
c,Sd
> 0.5 f /
he
and f
cle
>0.5 f
he
Where:
c,Sd
Where:
ac,Sd
A. Method used when HYDhas been specified: The following condition is to be satisfied:
and
Where: is the design axial stress that excludes the stress from a,Sd hydrostatic pressure
Additionally, when:
c,Sd
> 0.5 f /
he
and f
cle
>0.5 f
he
994 STAAD.Pro
B. Method used when HYD has not been specified: The following condition is to be satisfied: a. For the net axial tension condition (
ac,Sd
q,Sd
and
(Refer to the previous section for an explanation of these terms). b. For the net axial compression condition (
ac,Sd
<
q,Sd
(Refer to the previous section for an explanation of these terms). Additionally, when:
c,Sd
> 0.5 f /
he
and f / >0.5 f /
cle m he m
Where:
c,Sd
Must be specified as NORSOK. Note: Do not use the shortened NOR, as this initiates an NS3472 design.
FYLD
235 [MPa]
Note: Note, if the SGR value is specified, then the associated value of f for that steel grade will y be used for a member in lieu of the FYLD value. KY KZ LY 1.0 1.0 Member Length Effective length factor, k, in local Yaxis, usually minor axis. Effective length factor, k, in local Zaxis, usually major axis. Length in local Y axis for slenderness value KL/r
996 STAAD.Pro
Description
Length in local Z axis for slenderness value KL/r Reduction factor C corresponding m to the Y axis. Reduction factor C corresponding m to the Z axis. Length of Tubular between Stiffening Rings. This value is required to calculate Design Hoop Stress due to Hydrostatic Pressure to check Hoop Buckling as per clause 6.3.6.1.
HYD
0.0
The Y-coordinate, current units, of the maximum water level with respect to the origin. Note: If SETZUP command has been specified, then yi will be the Z co-ordinate of the max water level. For HYD > 0, the value of max. hydrostatic pressure calculated is reported for each member in a TRACK 2.0 output.
PSD SGR
0.0 0.0
Water pressure at each section in absence of HYD. Steel Grade per EC3 (EN 1993-11:2005): 0.0 = S 235 grade steel 1.0 = S 275 grade steel 2.0 = S 355 grade steel
Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004 Parameter Name Default Value Description
3.0 = S 420 grade steel 4.0 = S 460 grade steel DMAX DMIN DFF 100.0 [cm] Maximum allowable depth of steel section. 0.0 [cm] Minimum allowable depth of steel section.
None (Man- "Deflection length"/maximum allowdatory for able local deflection. deflection check) 0.0 Option to design for slenderness. 0.0 = Check for slenderness 1.0 = Do not check for slenderness Any value greater than 1.0 is used as the limit for slenderness in compression.
MAIN
TMAIN
180.0
Slenderness limit in tension. Slenderness limit is checked based the MAIN parameter. Output detail: 0.0 = Only a summary of the design checks performed is printed. 2.0 = All the details of the member checks and the various clause checks performed are printed.
TRACK
0.0
998 STAAD.Pro
Description
Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. Beam segment locations for design: 0.0 = design only for end moments and those at locations specified by SECTION command. 1.0 = Perform design for moments at twelfth points along the beam.
DJ1 DJ2
Joint No. denoting start point for calculation of deflection length Joint No. denoting end point for calculation of deflection length
Notes
a. C1 and C2 Parameters The default values of these coefficients are taken from Table 6-4 of N-004 and depend on the joint and load type: Table 19B.2 - Default values for C1 and C2 parameters Joint Type T or Y joints under brace axial load X joints under brace axial load K joints under balanced axial load C1 C2 25 11 20 22 20 22
Note: These values can be changed by setting the K, X, and Y values in the external geometry file.
Example
Note: This is a partial example containing only the information pertaining to the NORSOK N-004 steel design code; used at the end of the input file.
* CHECK TUBULAR MEMBERS ACCORDING NORSOK N-004 CODENORSOK HYD 3.0 MEMB 1 TO 3 PSD 10 MEMB 7 10 SGR 2 MEMB 1 TO 3 7 10 TRACK 2 MEMB 1 TO 3 7 10 CHECK CODE MEMB 1 TO 3 7 10
1000 STAAD.Pro
designated for the member being designed. Member selection can also be constrained by the parameters DMAX and DMIN which limit the maximum and minimum depth of the members. Selection of members whose properties are originally input from a user created table will be limited to sections in the user table.
Figure - Typical Tubular Joint (Fig 6-1 in N004) Prior to completing a joint design, the joint should be classified into one of the three categories given by the code. Joint classification is the process whereby a BRACE member connecting into a CHORD member is classified into one of these categories based on the axial force components in the brace. The classification normally considers all the members at a joint that lie in a plane. N-004 defines three joint classification categories: K, X, or Y (or a combination of these). Joint Classification K Description
The axial force in the brace should be balanced by forces in the other braces in the same
Norwegian Codes - Steel Design per NORSOK N-004 Joint Classification Description
plane and on the same side of the joint. The code allows a 10% tolerance in the balancing force. X The axial force in the brace is reacted as a beam shear in the chord. The axial force in the brace is carried through the chord to braces in the opposite side.
Note: Typical examples of these joint types are given in Figure 6-3 of the N004 code. It is worth noting that the joint class for each brace will be different for each load case.
Note: STAAD.Pro does not perform an automatic classification of the joints. This is left up to the engineer. All joints will initially be classified as Y in the generation of the external geometry file. Joints should be re-classified as necessary before performing the final joint capacity checks. The checks for joint capacity are given in Cl. 6.4.3.2 to 6.4.3.6 and STAAD.Pro performs the checks as per these clauses. However, the program does not deal with conical joint transitions and joints with joint cans. The code also specifies checks and limits for the gaps and eccentricity of joints. This implementation will not perform such geometry checks. The details of the checks done and the methodology will be discussed in the following sections.
1002 STAAD.Pro
You can then use this text file to edit or modify the input variables and perform a final check as necessary. The following syntax is used to initiate the joint checking in the engine. LOAD LIST load_list PARAMETER 1 CHECK JOINT { node_list | ALL } Where:
load_list = a list of load case numbers to be check against node_list = the NODE numbers to be checked. Specifying the ALL keyword option will cause the program to perform the joint check at all the nodes.
For each node specified in the CHECK JOINT command, the program automatically separates out all the members at the node into one CHORD member and one or more BRACE members. The section with the biggest diameter is assumed to be the CHORD and all the other members are assumed as BRACE members. If two or more possible CHORD members have the same diameter, the member with the maximum thickness is considered as the CHORD. The angle between the two members should be within the range of 30 and 90 (inclusive). Once all the CHORD and BRACE members are identified, the program considers every CHORD to BRACE connection as a separate JOINT. The program the automatically creates the joints and initially considers all the joints as joint class Y. The program then performs all the necessary joint checks as detailed in the following sections and produces the design output. The program will also produce an output file called FILENAME_ JOINTS.TXT, where "filename" will be the name of the .STD file. This format of this text file is explained in Section 19B.8. You can then edit this text file to set up the necessary design parameters. Once the program finds of the _JOINTS.TXT file, it will read in the necessary parameters from this file and perform the subsequent design checks. Note: This file will be produced only once (i.e., when this file does not exist). If this file exists, it is assumed that you have already done a joint design check and hence the program reads the values from this file and uses these for joint checks.
Where: N
Rd Rd
is the joint design axial resistance is the joint design bending moment resistance.
M
y
is the angle between the chord and the brace (max = 90 degrees) Q = Strength factor which varies with the joint type and the action u type in the brace. Refer to Table 6-3 and Clause 6.4.3.3 of N-004 for these equations. Q = 1.0 A2
f
p,Sd
is the design axial stress in the chord is the design in-plane bending stress in the chord is the design out-of-plane bending stress in the chord
my,Sd mz,Sd
C1 is the coefficient used for the axial stress term in calculating the joint resistance. C2 is the coefficient used for the bending stress term in calculating the joint resistance. The default values of C1 and C2 are as given in Table 6-4 of N-004. The actual values used are dependent
1004 STAAD.Pro
on the values of K, X, and Y specified for the joint in the external geometry file. See also Figures 6-3 to 6-6 of N-004 for definition of the various terms for various joint classes.
Where: N N
Sd Rd
is the design axial force in the brace, is the joint design axial resistance is the in plane bending moment in the brace is the out of plane bending moment in the brace is the in plane bending moment resistance is the out of plane bending moment resistance
M M M M
General Format
LOAD LIST load_list JOINT NODE K X Y CHORD CLEN D T BRACE BLEN d t GAP j# n# K% X% Y% C# CLEN D T B# BLEN d t gap Where: j# = the joint number
n# = the node number K%, X%, and Y% = The fractional contributions of K-type, X type and Y-type, respectively. Initially the joints will be classed as Y (i.e., K=0, X=0 and Y=1). C# = the member numbers of the CHORD CLEN = the length of chord member D, T = Diameter and thickness of CHORD B# = the member number of the brace BLEN = the length of chord member d, t = Diameter and thickness of BRACE gap = Distance required to calculate gap factor for K bracing. Initially, the value of GAP is assumed as 0.
Example
LOAD LIST 1 2 4 JOINT NODE K BLEN D T 1 3 0 0.140 0.010 0 2 3 0 0.075 0.005 0
X GAP 0 0
Y 1 1
CHORD 2 2
D 0.168 0.168
T 0.10 0.10
1006 STAAD.Pro
design. e. RATIO prints the ratio of the actual stresses to allowable stresses for the critical condition. Normally a value of 1.0 or less will mean the member has passed. f. LOADING provides the load case number which governed the design. g. FX, MY, and MZ provide the axial force, moment in local Y-axis, and the moment in local Z-axis respectively. Although STAAD does consider all the member forces and moments (except torsion) to perform design, only FX, MY and MZ are printed since they are the ones which are of interest, in most cases. h. LOCATION specifies the actual distance from the start of the member to the section where design forces govern. i. If the parameter TRACK is set to 2.0, the program will block out part of the table and will print the allowable bending stressed in compression (FCY & FCZ) and tension (FTY & FTZ), allowable axial stress in compression (FA), and allowable shear stress (FV).
RESULT/ CRITICAL COND/ RATIO/ LOADING/ FX MY MZ LOCATION ======================================================================= 1 ST PIP13910.0 (BRITISH SECTIONS) PASS Eq. 6.44 0.170 1 0.01 C 1.01 6.39 0.00 ======================================================================= MATERIAL DATA Grade of steel = S 355 Modulus of elasticity = 204999.98 N/mm2 Design Strength (py) =355.00 N/mm2 SECTION PROPERTIES (units - cm) Member Length = 400.00 Gross Area of cross section =
: :
CAPACITIES (units - kN,m) Tension Capacity : Compression Capacity : Bending Capacity : Shear Capacity : Shear Capacity due to torsional moment:
HYDROSTATIC PRESSURE CALCULATION (units - N,mm) - Cl.6.3.6 Max design hydrostatic pressure, (psd) : 0.000 Max design hoop stress, (sigma_psd)) : 0.000 CRITICAL LOAD FOR EACH CLAUSE CHECK (units - kN,m): CLAUSE RATIO LOAD FX VY VZ MZ MY Cl:6.3.2 0.000 1 0.0 Cl:6.3.3 0.000 1 0.0 Cl:6.3.4 0.102 1 -5.3 0.0 Cl:6.3.5 0.031 1 -11.2 0.5 Cl:6.3.8.(1 & 2) 0.124 1 0.0 6.4 1.0 Cl:6.3.8.(3 & 4) 0.102 1 -0.5 0.5 -5.3 0.0 Cl:6.3.9 0.170 1 0.0 6.4 1.0 =======================================================================
1008 STAAD.Pro
structure. Table 19B.3 - Design Parameters for NS 3473 design code Parameter Default Name Value CODE none Description
Must be specified as NS3473 Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
ACTAGE BRACE
70 years 0
Enter the actual age, in years. Column Brace Parameter 0. Beam/Column braced in both directions. 1. One-way plate/ Column unbraced about the local z axis only. 2. Column unbraced about the local y axis only. 3. Column unbraced in both directions.
25 mm 100% 0 1 1 2
Clear cover to outermost reinforcing bar. Drying exposure, in percent. Distance from the end node of the beam to face of support for shear design. Member length factor about the local y direction. Member length factor about the local z direction Environment class 1. LA Least aggressive 2. NA Aggressive
Norwegian Codes - Concrete Design per NS 3473 Parameter Default Name Value Description
3. MA Very aggressive FC FYMAIN LAGE MAXMAIN MINMAIN MOY MOZ NMAG REIANG RELHUM RFACE 0 70% 1 35 N/mm2 500 N/mm2 7 days 32 10 Compressive strength of concrete. Yield strength of main reinforcing steel. Age when loaded, in days. Maximum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. Minimum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. moy factor moz factor nmag factor Reinforcement angle, in degrees. Relative humidity, in percent. Column bar arrangement 1. Four longitudinal bars. 2. Two faced distribution about minor axis. 3. Two faced distribution about major axis. 4. Faced symmetric distribution SFACE STIRANG STIRDIA TORANG 0 90 10 mm 45 Distance from the start node of the beam to face of support for shear design. Stirrup angle, in degrees. Stirrup diameter Torsion angle, in degrees.
1010 STAAD.Pro
Description
Track parameter to control output detail 10. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit state design & Slab Two-way plate design 11. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit statedesign with tension stiffening. 12. Beam Ultimate limit statedesign only 20. Slab Plane stress design. 30. Slab Simplified membrane design.
1012 STAAD.Pro
Section 20
Cypriot Codes
Cypriot Codes - Concrete Design in Cyprus
20.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design to the concrete code of Cyprus. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 20A.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.
Table 20C.1 - Cypriot Concrete Design Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as CYPRUS. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BRACE
0.0
Bracing parameter for column design: 0. Column braced in both directions 1. Column braced in only the local Y direction. 2. Column braced in only the local Z direction. 3. Column unbraced in either direction.
CLEAR
20 mm
Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.
DEPTH
YD
EFACE
0.0
ELY ELZ FC
Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength, in current units
1014 STAAD.Pro
Description
Yield Stress for main reinforcement, in current units (For slabs, it is for reinforcement in both directions) Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a, in current units. Applicable to shear bars in beams. Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Factor by which column design moments are magnified Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 23. Serviceability checks: 0. No serviceability check performed. 1. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were continuous. 2. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were simply supported. 3. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were cantilever
FYSEC
60 ksi
MAXMAIN
50 mm
MINMAIN
8 mm
MINSEC
8 mm
MMAG NSECTION
1.0 12
SERV
0.0
Parameter Name
Description
SFACE
0.0
Face of support location at start of beam, in current units. (Only applicable for shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending ) Skew angle considered in Wood & Armer equations where A is the angle in degrees. Two special values are also considered: 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calculate Wood & Armer moments for design.
SRA
0.0
TRACK
0.0
Controls level of detail in output: 0. Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1. For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2. Beam design only. Details of reinforcement at sections defined by the NSECTION parameter.
1016 STAAD.Pro
Default Value ZD
Description
Width of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.
1018 STAAD.Pro
Section 21
Danish Codes
Danish Codes - Steel Design per DS412
21.1 Design Parameters
The design parameters outlined in Table 21.1 may be used to control the design procedure. These parameters communicate design decisions from the engineer to the program and thus allow you to control the design process to suit an application's specific needs. The default parameter values have been selected such that they are frequently used numbers for conventional design. Depending on the particular design requirements, some or all of these parameter values may be changed to exactly model the physical structure. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.
Table 21D.1 - Danish Steel Design DS412 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description Must be specified as DS412 Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 1.0 1.0 = Calculatevon Mises at twelfth points along the beam. Buckling length coefficient, Beta, about the local Y axis. Buckling length coefficient, Beta, about the local Z axis. Lateral buckling coefficient. Used to calculate the ideal buckling moment. Water depth, in meters, for hydrostatic pressure calculation for pipe members.
BY
1.0
BZ
1.0
CB
1.0
CMY
1.0
1020 STAAD.Pro
Description AlphaT in connection with lateral buckling. Buckling curve coefficient, Alpha, about local Y-axis. Buckling curve coefficient, Alpha, about local Z-axis.
CY
CZ
DMAX
1,000 mm
Maximum allowable depth (Applicable for member selection) Minimum required depth (Applicable for member selection) Yield strength of steel. Ratio of material factor to resistance factor. Permissible ratio of actual load effect to the design strength. Equivalent moment factor, BetaM, for local Y-axis. Valid
DMIN
0.0 mm
FYLD MF
RATIO
1.0
SSY
Parameter Name
Default Value
SSZ
Equivalent moment factor, BetaM, for local Z-axis. Valid values between 0 and 2.5. 0.0 Used to specify a level of detail in output: 0. Report only minimum design results. 1. Report design strengths also. 2. Provide full details of design.
TRACK
UNL
Member Length
Unsupported length in bending compression of the bottom flange for calculating moment resistance.
1022 STAAD.Pro
Section 22
Dutch Codes
Dutch Codes - Steel Design per NEN 6770
22.1 Design Parameters
Available design parameters to be used in conjunction with NEN 6770 are listed in table 22.1 along with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes. Table 22E.1 - Dutch Steel Design NEN 6770 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description Must be specified as DUTCH Design Code to follow.
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. Used to specify the number of sections to be check along the length of the beam: 0. Check sections with end forces only. 1. Check at location of maximum Mz along beam. 2. Check sections with end forces and forces at location of BEAM= 1.0 check. 3. Check at every 1/13th point of the beam and report the maximum. Loading type per Tables F.1.1 and F.1.2 1. Pin ended member with uniform loading 2. Fix ended member with uniform loading 3. Pin ended member with central point load. 4. Fix ended member with central point load. 5. Pin ended member with point loads at third points. 6. Pin ended member with varying end moments. Used to describe the end restraints: 1.0 = No fixity
BEAM
3.0
CMM
1.0
CMN
1.0
1024 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description 0.7 = One end fixed, the other free. 0.5 = Both ends fixed. "Deflection Length" / Maximum allowable local deflection
DFF
DJ1
DJ2
DMAX DMIN KY KZ LY
LZ
NSF PY RATIO
None (Mandatory for deflection check, See Note 1d in Section 2B.6. TRACK 4.0) Start Joint Joint No. denoting starting point of member for calculation of "Deflection Length" . See Note 1 below. End Joint of Joint No. denoting end point for member calculation of "Deflection Length". See Note 1 below. 10,000 cm Maximum allowable depth 0.0 cm Minimum allowable depth 1.0 K factor value in local y - axis. Usually, this is the minor axis. 1.0 K factor value in local z - axis. Usually, this is the major axis. Member Length Length in local y - axis (current units) to calculate (KY)(LY)/Ryy slenderness ratio. Member Length Length in local z - axis (current units) to calculate (KZ)(LZ)/Rzz slenderness ratio. 1.0 Net section factor for tension members. Set according to Design strength of steel steel grade (SGR) 1.0 Permissible ratio of the actual capacities.
Description Controls the sections to try during a SELECT process. 0. Try every section of the same type as original 1. Try only those sections with a similar name as original (e.g., if the original is an HEA 100, then only HEA sections will be selected, even if there are HEMs in the same table). Identify Section type for section classification 0. Rolled Section
SBLT
0.0
SGR
0.0
TRACK
0.0
2. Grade Fe 510 Used to control the level output detail: 0. Output summary of results. 1. Output summary of results with member capacities. 2. Output detailed results.
UNL
3. Deflection Check (separate check to main select / check code) Member Length Unrestrained member length in lateral torsional buckling checks.
1026 STAAD.Pro
Section 23
Finnish Codes
Finnish Codes - Concrete Design per B4
23A.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design to the B4 code. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 26B.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.
Table 23F.1 - Finnish Concrete Design per B4 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as FINNISH. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
ACTAGE BRACE
70 0.0
Actual age of concrete, in years. Bracing parameter for design: 0. Beam or column braced in both directions 1. One-way plate or column braced in only the local Zdirection. 2. Column braced in only the local Y direction. 3. Column unbraced in either direction.
CLEAR
25 mm
Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Drying exposure, in percent.
DRYCIR
100
EFACE
0.0
Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.
ELY ELZ
1.0 1.0
Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design.
1028 STAAD.Pro
Default Value 2
Description
FC FYMAIN LAGE MAXMAIN MINMAIN MOY MOZ NMAG REIANG RELHUM RFACE
Compressive strength of concrete. Yield strength of main reinforcing steel. Age when loaded, in days. Maximum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. Minimum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. moy factor moz factor nmag factor
0 40 1
Reinforcement angle, in degrees. Relative humidity, in percent. Column bar arrangement 1. Four longitudinal bars. 2. Two faced distribution about minor axis. 3. Two faced distribution about major axis. 4. Faced symmetric distribution
SFACE
Distance from the start node of the beam to face of support for shear design.
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. STIRANG STIRDIA TORANG TRACK 90 10 mm 45 10 Stirrup angle, in degrees. Stirrup diameter Torsion angle, in degrees. Track parameter to control output detail 10. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit state design & Slab Two-way plate design 11. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit statedesign with tension stiffening. 12. Beam Ultimate limit statedesign only 20. Slab Plane stress design. 30. Slab Simplified membrane design.
1030 STAAD.Pro
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
NS or NPD for NPD (NOR may also be used for both). Design Code to follow. See section 5.48.1 of the Technical Reference Manual. BEAM 0.0 Parameter BEAM 1.0 ALL tells the program to calculate von Mises at 13 sections along each member, and up to 8 points at each section. (Depending on what kind of shape is used.) Note: Must be set to 1.0 BY BZ 1.0 1.0 Buckling length coefficient, for weak axis buckling (y-y) (NOTE: BY > 0.0) Buckling length coefficient, , for strong axis buckling (z-z) (NOTE: BZ > 0.0) Lateral buckling coefficient, Y. Used to calculate the ideal buckling moments, M
vi
CB
1.0
Water depth in meters for hydrostatic pressure calculation for pipe members for sections in connection with latLT eral buckling Buckling curve coefficient, a about local z-axis (strong axis). Represent the a, a0, b, c, d curve. Maximum allowable depth of steel section.
Description
Minimum allowable depth of steel section. Yield strength of steel, fy (St37) [N/mm2 ]
1.1 Material factor / Resistance factor, m (NS3472) 1.15 (NPD) 1.0 0.0 Permissible ratio of the actual to allowable stresses. 0.0 = No sidesway. calculated. > 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis weak axis =SSY
M
RATIO SSY
SSZ
0.0
0.0 = No sidesway. calculated. > 0.0 = Sidesway in local y-axis weak axis
M
TRACK
0.0
0.0 = Supress critical member stresses. 1.0 = Print all critical member stresses, i.e., DESIGN VALUES 2.0 = Print von Mises stresses. 9.0 = Large output, 1 page for each member. See section 7 and Appendix A for complete list of available TRACKs and print examples. Effective length for lateral buckling calculations (specify buckling length). Distance between fork supports or between effective side supports for the beam
UNL
Member length
The parameter CMY will, when given with negative value, define an inside pressure in pipe members. The pressure corresponds to given water depth in meters.
1032 STAAD.Pro
The parameter CB defines the value with respect to calculation of the ideal lateral buckling moment for single symmetric wide flange profiles, ref. NS app. 5.2.2.
1034 STAAD.Pro
Section 24
Singaporian Codes
Singaporean Codes - Concrete Design per CP65
24.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design per the CP65 code. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 24.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.
Table 24G.1 - Singaporean Concrete Design CP65 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as CP65. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
BRACE
0.0
Bracing parameter for column design: 0. Column braced in both directions 1. Column braced in only the local Y direction. 2. Column braced in only the local Z direction. 3. Column unbraced in either direction.
CLEAR
20 mm
Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Depth of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as YD in MEMBER PROPERTIES. Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.
DEPTH
YD
EFACE
0.0
ELY ELZ FC
Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design. Concrete Yield Stress / cube strength, in current units
1036 STAAD.Pro
Description
Yield Stress for main reinforcement, in current units (For slabs, it is for reinforcement in both directions) Yield Stress for secondary reinforcement a, in current units. Applicable to shear bars in beams. Maximum required reinforcement bar size Acceptable bars are per MINMAIN above. Minimum main reinforcement bar size Acceptable bar sizes: 6 8 10 12 16 20 25 32 40 50 Minimum secondary bar size a. Applicable to shear reinforcement in beams Factor by which column design moments are magnified Number of equally-spaced sections to be considered in finding critical moment for beam design. The upper limit is 23. Serviceability checks: 0. No serviceability check performed. 1. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were continuous. 2. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were simply supported. 3. Perform serviceability check for beams as if they were cantilever
FYSEC
60 ksi
MAXMAIN
50 mm
MINMAIN
8 mm
MINSEC
8 mm
MMAG NSECTION
1.0 12
SERV
0.0
Parameter Name
Description
SFACE
0.0
Face of support location at start of beam, in current units. (Only applicable for shear - use MEMBER OFFSET for bending ) Skew angle considered in Wood & Armer equations where A is the angle in degrees. Two special values are also considered: 0.0 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout without considering torsional moment Mxy slabs only -500 = Orthogonal reinforcement layout with Mxy used to calculate Wood & Armer moments for design.
SRA
0.0
TRACK
0.0
Controls level of detail in output: 0. Critical Moment will not be printed with beam design report. Column design gives no detailed results. 1. For beam gives min/max steel % and spacing. For columns gives a detailed table of output with additional moments calculated. 2. Beam design only. Details of reinforcement at sections defined by the NSECTION parameter.
1038 STAAD.Pro
Default Value ZD
Description
Width of concrete member, in current units. This value default is as provided as ZD in MEMBER PROPERTIES.
1040 STAAD.Pro
Section 25
Spanish Codes
Spanish Codes - Concrete Design per EHE
25B.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform design per the Espaola del Hormign Estructural (EHE)code. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the engineer control over the actual design process. Default values, which are commonly used numbers in conventional design practice, have been used for simplicity. Table 25A.1 contains a list of available parameters and their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.
Table 25H.1 - Spanish Concrete Design per EHEParameters Parameter Default Name Value CLB CLS CLT DEPTH 1.5 in 1.5 in 1.5 in YD Description
Clear cover to reinforcing bar at bottom of cross section. Clear cover to reinforcing bar along the side of the cross section. Clear cover to reinforcing bar at top of cross section. Depth of the concrete member. This value defaults to YD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
EFACE
0.0 Distance of face of support from end Face of node of beam. Used for shear and Support torsion calculation. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.
Specified compressive strength of concrete. Yield Stress for main reinforcing steel. Yield Stress for secondary reinforcing steel.
Number Maximum main reinforcement bar size. 55 bar Number Minimum main reinforcement bar size 10 bar Number Minimum secondary (stirrup) 10 bar reinforcement bar size. 1.0 12 A factor by which the column design moments will be magnified. Number of equally-spaced sections to be
1042 STAAD.Pro
Description
considered in finding critical moments for beam design. REINF 0.0 Used to specify type of column shear reinforcement: 0. Tied Column. 1. Spiral Column. SFACE 0.0 Distance of face of support from start node of beam. Used for shear and torsion calculation. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. TRACK 0.0 Used to specify detail of output: 0. Only minimum details are printed for beam or column designs. 1. Beam Design:Intermediate level of detail. Column Design:TRACK 0 output plus intermediate level of detail. 2. Beam Design: TRACK1 detail plus steel required at 1/12th secitons. Column Design:detailed output. WIDTH ZD Width of the concrete member. This value defaults to ZD as provided under MEMBER PROPERTIES.
1044 STAAD.Pro
Section 26
Swedish Codes
Swedish Codes - Concrete Design per BBK 94
26B.1 Design Parameters
The program contains a number of parameters which are needed to perform and control the design to the BBK 94 code. These parameters not only act as a method to input required data for code calculations but give the Engineer control over the actual design process. Default values of commonly used parameters for conventional design practice have been chosen as the basis. Table 26B.1 contains a complete list of available parameters with their default values. Note: Once a parameter is specified, its value stays at that specified number till it is specified again. This is the way STAAD works for all codes.
Table 26I.1 - Swedish Concrete Design per BBK 94 Parameters Parameter Name CODE Default Value Description
Must be specified as SWEDISH. Design Code to follow. See section 5.52.2 of the Technical Reference Manual.
ACTAGE BRACE
70 0.0
Actual age of concrete, in years. Bracing parameter for design: 0. Beam or column braced in both directions 1. One-way plate or column braced in only the local Zdirection. 2. Column braced in only the local Y direction. 3. Column unbraced in either direction.
CLEAR
25 mm
Clearance of reinforcement measured from concrete surface to closest bar perimeter, in current units. Drying exposure, in percent.
DRYCIR
100
EFACE
0.0
Face of support location at end of beam, in current units. Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers.
ELY ELZ
1.0 1.0
Member length factor about local Y direction for column design. Member length factor about local Z direction for column design.
1046 STAAD.Pro
Default Value 2
Description
FC FYMAIN LAGE MAXMAIN MINMAIN MOY MOZ NMAG REIANG RELHUM RFACE
Compressive strength of concrete. Yield strength of main reinforcing steel. Age when loaded, in days. Maximum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. Minimum size permitted for main reinforcement bar. moy factor moz factor nmag factor
0 40 1
Reinforcement angle, in degrees. Relative humidity, in percent. Column bar arrangement 1. Four longitudinal bars. 2. Two faced distribution about minor axis. 3. Two faced distribution about major axis. 4. Faced symmetric distribution
SFACE
Distance from the start node of the beam to face of support for shear design.
Parameter Name
Default Value
Description
Note: Both SFACE & EFACE must be positive numbers. STIRANG STIRDIA TORANG TRACK 90 10 mm 45 10 Stirrup angle, in degrees. Stirrup diameter Torsion angle, in degrees. Track parameter to control output detail 10. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit state design & Slab Two-way plate design 11. Beam Ultimate limit state and Service limit statedesign with tension stiffening. 12. Beam Ultimate limit statedesign only 20. Slab Plane stress design. 30. Slab Simplified membrane design.
1048 STAAD.Pro
Technical Support
These resources are provided to help you answer support questions:
l
Service Ticket Manager http://www.bentley.com/serviceticketmanager Create and track a service ticket using Bentley Systems' online site for reporting problems or suggesting new features. You do not need to be a Bentley SELECT member to use Service Ticket Manager, however you do need to register as a user. Knowledge Base http://appsnet.bentley.com/kbase/ Search the Bentley Systems knowledge base for solutions for common problems. FAQs and TechNotes http://communities.bentley.com/Products/Structural/Structural_Analysis___ Design/w/Structural_Analysis_and_Design__Wiki/structural-product-technotes-and-faqs.aspx Here you can find detailed resolutions and answers to the most common questions posted to us by you. Ask Your Peers http://communities.bentley.com/forums/5932/ShowForum.aspx Post questions in the BeCommunity forums to receive help and advice from fellow users.
1050 STAAD.Pro
Index
A AIJ 1991 AIJ 2002 AIJ 2005 AISC Alclad Aluminum Design SeeConcrete Design, AIJ 1991 SeeSteel Design, AIJ 2002 SeeSteel Design, AIJ 2005 97 776 773
Axially Loaded Members 288, 305, 307, 309 Design 288, 305, 307, 309 B British Codes National Annex British Codes BS 5950-5 57 SeeNational Annex, British 81-82, 108
American Transmission Tower Code795, 801, 803 Analysis PDelta ANSI/AISC N690 Codes AS 1170 AS 3600 AS 3600 - 2001 14 823 21 9 SeeConcrete Design, AS 3600
SeeSteel Design, BS 5950-5 337 96 SeeSteel Design, BS5400 SeeSteel Design, BS5950 SeeSteel Design, BS8007 SeeConcrete Design, BS8110
AS 4100 - 1998 SeeSteel Design, AS 4100 ASCE 10 ASCE 10-97 ASCE Manuals ASME NF Codes 795 SeeSteel Design, ASCE 10-97 801, 803 869
651 739 156, 160 SeeConcrete Design, CSA A23.3 SeeSteel Design, CSA CAN/CSAS16-01
Canadian Codes
Canadian Wood Design Manual227 Changing Chinese Codes 266 247, 261, 266267
CSA CAN/CSA-S16-01
Cold Formed Steel IS801 Combined Loading stress Concrete Design AIJ 1991 AS 3600 BBK 94 BS8110 CP65 CSA A23.3 DIN 1045 Egyptian Code Eurocode EC2 GB50010 IS13920 IS456 603 9 1045 59, 62 1035 155 473 433 275 249 521 495 593 267 266
288, 305, 307, 309, 323 288, 305, 307, 309 459 459
Design Rules Structural Steelwork Dutch National Annex E EC5 ECCS205 Egyptian Section 2.6.3 Egyptian Codes
405 433
444 431
1052 STAAD.Pro
301 89 IS801
IS456 SeeSteel Design, IS801 J Japanese Codes Concrete Design 601 SeeConcrete Design, AIJ 1991
283, 288, 303, 305, 307, 309, 323 288, 301, 305, 307, 309, 323
Steel Design
European Codes 273, 275, 303, 305, 307, 309, 323 Extrusions F Finnish National Annex French Codes Concrete Design National Annex Steel Design G GB 1591 GBJ 50017-2003 96 SeeSteel Design, GBJ 50017 451 453 SeeNational Annex, French 459 SeeNational Annex, Finnish 781
Steel Design
Modulus of Elasticity N N690 Codes National Annex British Dutch Finnish French Norwegian Polish
29
823 302, 332, 336, 343 337 337 337 337 337 337
National Application Documents 275, 284 NEN-EN 1993 NF EN 1993-1-1 Norwegian Codes 923 337 337
National Annex
793 123 113 81, 108 119 163 481 1019 301 441 283, 288, 301, 303, 305, 307, 309, 323 459 261 593 1023 669 207 747 715 266 266 266 267 267
NS-EN 1993
NTC 1987 SeeConcrete Design, NTC 1987 P PN EN 1993-1-1 Polish National Annex S S136-94 SeeSteel Design, S136-94 SeeSteel Design, SAB0162-1 1993 SeeConcrete Design, SABS0100-1 337 SeeNational Annex, Polish 337
SAB0162-1 1993
French Code GBJ 50017 IS801 NEN 6770 NTC 1987 S136-94 SAB0162-1 1993 SNiP 2.23-81 Stress Axial Compression Axial Tension Bending Combined Loading
SABS-0100-1
SeeSteel Design, SNiP 2.23-81 288, 305, 307, 309, 323, 795, 801, 803 613 613, 632 825 19
Structural Steelwork Design Rules T Timber Design EC5 U UK National Annex V Verification Problem AIJ 2005 ASME NF 3000 1974 ASME NF 3000 1989 ASME NF 3000 1998 ASME NF 3000 2004 British Cold Formed Steel CSA CSA Wood EC5 SAB0162-1 W Weld Type
459 459
405
185, 189, 193, 197 227 420, 425 763, 766, 769
97